Anda di halaman 1dari 409

Installation and Operation Manual

Blackmagic
Studio Cameras
June 2017

English, , Franais, Deutsch, Espaol,


, and .
Languages
To go directly to your preferred language, simply click on the hyperlinks listed in the
contents below.

English 3

50

Franais 98

Deutsch 146

Espaol 194

245

296

338
English

Welcome
Thank you for purchasing a Blackmagic Studio Camera!

We are extremely excited to have designed the Blackmagic Studio Camera and Micro
Studio Camera 4K. Ever since I was a teenager I have loved live production, its so exciting!

Traditionally cameras with talkback and tally were very expensive and physically large,
so hard to manage. We really wanted to solve this problem by designing a more compact
camera that included all the talkback, tally and camera control features of physically
much larger cameras.

Thats why the Blackmagic Studio Camera was developed. We wanted to build a much
smaller camera for portability, however normally small cameras have small tiny screens.
We did not want that. What we really wanted was a much larger viewfinder! The result is
Blackmagic Studio Camera, a small broadcast camera with a very large viewfinder thats
wonderful to use! Precise focus and framing are so easy with a viewfinder this large!

Of course you get tally indicators, talkback, of course a fantastic quality camera with
flexible MFT lens mount. Its everything you need in a complete package! You can plug
in larger wind protected microphones even with phantom power and with user installable
optical fiber, you can add an SFP module when you need to run your camera miles away
from your switcher! If you need, you can even add a HyperDeck Shuttle and use the
camera for general production use!

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K takes the small size and capability of Blackmagic
Studio Camera even further! This tiny camera pairs an amazing Ultra HD sensor with
an incredibly tiny chassis and a host of remote control options. Now you can capture
broadcast production footage from previously impossible locations, all with complete
control from an ATEM switcher or via custom remote.

We hope you use your new camera for some amazing live productions and produce some
fantastic looking work! We are extremely excited to see what creative work you produce!

Grant Petty
CEO Blackmagic Design
Contents
Blackmagic Studio Cameras

Getting Started 5 Remote Settings 25


Attaching a Lens 5 Button Settings 26
Turning Your Camera On 5 Camera Video Output 27
Connecting to a switcher 6
Connecting to Video Switchers 27
Camera Features 9 Connecting to Recorders 28
Blackmagic Studio Camera Features 9
Connecting Tally using the
Blackmagic Micro Studio
Blackmagic3G-SDI Arduino Shield 28
Camera 4K Features 11
Camera Connections 13 Blackmagic Camera Setup 30

Blackmagic Studio Camera - Left Side 13 Attaching Accessories 31


Blackmagic Studio Camera - Right Side 14 Sun Shade 31
Blackmagic Micro Studio Other Accessories 31
Camera 4K - Left Side 15
Blackmagic Micro Studio Using ATEM Software Control 31
Camera 4K - Right Side 16 Introducing Camera Control 31
Customization
17 Using Camera Control 33
Blackmagic Micro Studio DaVinci Resolve Primary Color
Camera 4K Expansion Cable 17 Corrector38
Wiring diagram for the Developer Information 41
Blackmagic Micro Studio
Blackmagic SDI Camera
Camera 4K Expansion Cable 18
Control Protocol 41
Settings 19
Blackmagic Embedded
Camera Settings 19
TallyControl Protocol 49
Audio Settings 21
Help 51
Monitoring Settings 22
Studio Settings 24 Warranty
52

Contents
Getting Started
Attaching a Lens
Getting started with your Blackmagic Studio Camera or Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K is
as simple as attaching a lens and turning the camera on. To remove the protective dust cap
from the lens mount, hold down the locking button and rotate the cap counterclockwise until it
is released. We recommend you always turn off your Blackmagic camera prior to attaching or
removing a lens.
To attach a lens:
1 Align the dot on your lens with the dot on the camera mount. Many lenses have either
ablue, red or white dot or some other indicator.
2 Twist the lens clockwise until it locks into place.
3 To remove the lens, hold down the locking button, rotate the lens counterclockwise
until its dot or indicator reaches the 12 oclock position and gently remove.
When no lens is attached to the camera, the lens mount is exposed to dust and other debris so
youll want to keep the dust cap on whenever possible.

1 1
1

1
PUSH

PUSH
3

3
2

2 2
1

1
PUSH

PUSH
3

3
2

Attaching and removing a lens on Studio Camera.

Attaching and removing a lens on Micro Studio Camera 4K.

Turning Your Camera On


1 Press the power button below the LCD. On Blackmagic Studio Camera and Studio
Camera 4K models, the live camera image will appear on the LCD.
2 Press and hold the power button to switch off the camera.

TIP Blackmagic Studio Camera HD and Studio Camera 4K have internal batteries that
can be charged using the supplied power adapter. These camera can be charged and
operated while connected via external power and will switch between power sources
without interruption. Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 and Studio Camera 4K 2 does not
contain an internal battery and does not need to be charged.

Getting Started 5
Micro Studio Camera 4K accepts LP-E6 and LP-E6N batteries, which can be charged with an
external battery charger or slowly trickle charged by the camera. The camera can also be
charged and operated via external power and will switch between power sources automatically
if external power is interrupted. External power is provided via the Micro Studio Camera 4Ks
expansion port.
1 Press the power button on the right hand side of the camera. The tally light will glow
white to indicate the camera is on.
2 Press and hold the power button to switch off your camera.
Thats all there is to getting started. You can now connect your camera to a switcher,
orATEMConverter, and start creating your live production!

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN

SDI IN

REF

REF

12V

12V

Use the supplied power adapter to power the Studio Camera.

Connecting to a switcher
Your Blackmagic Studio Camera and Micro Studio Camera 4K can be remotely controlled from
an ATEM switcher via SDI for fast, interactive camera control during your live production.

Connecting via SDI


1 Connect your Blackmagic Studio Cameras and Micro Studio Camera 4Ks SDI output to
any SDI input on the ATEM switcher.
2 Connect any one of the ATEM switchers SDI outputs, except down converted or multi
view outputs, to your Studio Cameras SDI program input. Camera control signals are
not sent via the multi view and down converted SDI outputs.

TIP If you have the optional SFP Optical Module installed, you can use optical fiber to
connect your Blackmagic Studio Camera to an ATEM Switcher. This is great for long
cable runs as optical fiber can carry a signal up to 28 miles.
An ATEM Studio Converter or ATEM Talkback Converter 4K is required to complete the
connection to your ATEM Switcher. For more information on optical fiber setup refer to
the connection diagrams section in the ATEM Converters manual.

Getting Started 6
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 1 IN 3 1 1 3 1 REMOTE REMOTE
1 3 5 1 7 3 9 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH
STEREO IN

CONTROL CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 IN 2 2 HD 2 HD HD HD HD HD
1 2 4 1 6 2 8 4 10 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 REF IN
PREVIEW AUXPROGRAM
1-3 PREVIEW
OUTPUTS PROGRAM OUTPUTS
MULTI-VIEW MULTI-VIEW
ANALOG AUDIO IN

IN IN IN IN IN 1 3 1 REMOTE
All SDI and HDMI video connections are
1 3 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH SD, HD and Ultra HD switchable unless indicated

CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 2 HD HD HD
1 2 4 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2 CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 PREVIEW PROGRAM OUTPUTS MULTI-VIEW ANALOG AUDIO IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT

To connect your camera to an ATEM switcher, simply plug your cameras


SDIoutput into any of your switchers SDI inputs. For camera control,
plug any of the ATEM switchers non down-converted outputs to your
cameras programSDIinput. A quick and easy way to plug your switcher
into the camera isto connect one of the switchers program outputs.

Setting Button Mapping and Tally


Open ATEM Software Control Preferences and set the switchers button mapping settings to
make sure you are switching the right camera with correct tally.
To set the mapping settings:
1 Click on the menu bar at the top of the screen and open the ATEM Software Control
Preferences.
2 Click on the Mapping tab and check the buttons correspond with the correct input.
Forexample, because your Studio Camera is connected to input 1 on your switcher,
Button 1 should be set to Input 1: Camera 1.
3 On your Blackmagic Studio Camera, press Menu. Navigate to Studio Settings>Camera
Number and set it to match the switcher input. In this example, your Studio Camera is
connected to Cam 1 on the ATEM switcher, so the camera number must also be set to 1.
This ensures tally is sent to the correct camera.
Now that everything is plugged in and mapping is set, you can check that the program output
can be monitored on your camera and confirm that tally is working. A fast way to check is to
press the program button on your Blackmagic Studio Camera, then switch color bars to the
program output on your ATEM switcher. If you see color bars on your camera, you know the
program output is working properly with your camera.
Now switch camera 1 to the program output. The tally light on the Studio Camera should now
illuminate. If not, double check your camera number is set to the corresponding input on the
switcher, and that the mapping settings in the switcher are correct.

Using Camera Control


Your Blackmagic Studio Camera can be controlled from an ATEM switcher using the Camera
Control feature in ATEM Software Control.
Launch ATEM Software Control and click on the Camera button located at the bottom of the
software window to open the camera control page. You will see a row of labeled camera
controllers containing tools to adjust and refine each cameras image. Camera 1 is labelled
Cam 1. If the camera is switched to the program output it will display a red On Air status.
Inside the Cam 1 controller you can make camera adjustments including color correction, lens
control on compatible lenses, camera settings and more. For more details on how to use the
camera control features, refer to the using ATEM software control section for more information.

Getting Started 7
Connecting to a Recorder
You can also connect your Blackmagic Studio Camera to an external recorder, for example a
Blackmagic HyperDeck Studio disk recorder for indoor studio recording. Or even mount a
HyperDeck Shuttle or Blackmagic Video Assist to your studio camera and loop through to the
switcher for ISO recordings during an outside broadcast.
Thats all there is to getting started! Live production is exciting and your Blackmagic Studio
Camera is designed to give you an easy and fun experience. Please keep reading the manual
to learn about all the different features and settings on your Blackmagic Studio Camera.

Getting Started 8
Camera Features
Blackmagic Studio Camera Features
Front Panel
1 Front Tally Light
Indicates to the on-air talent which camera is currently live. See the monitoring
settings section in this manual for more details.

2
3

4
1

PUSH
5 2

PUSH

Left Panel
2 LANC Remote
2.5mm stereo jack for LANC remote control supports iris, zoom and focus control.
3 Aviation Headphones
0.25 TRS connector for monitoring PGM and control room audio with aviation
style headsets.
4 Headphones Microphone Input
0.206 TRS connector for talking to the control room with aviation style headsets.
5 Audio Inputs
2 x 1/4 balanced XLR connectors for audio input.
Refer to the Blackmagic Studio Camera - left panel section in this manual for
more details.

Camera Features 9
Right Panel
6 Optical Input/Output
Optical input and output allows cable runs of up to 28 miles when the optional SFP
optical module is fitted.
7 SDI Out
SDI output for connecting to a switcher or other device.
8 SDI In
SDI input allows the camera operator to view the Program (PGM) output.
9 Reference Input
Allows multiple cameras to be genlocked to a blackburst or tri-level reference signal.
10 Power
12 24V power input for power supply and battery charging, where applicable.
Refer to the Blackmagic Studio Camera - right panel section in this manual for
more details.

12
11

6 OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

7 SDI OUT

8 SDI IN

9 REF

13 14 15 16 17 18 19 18 20 21 22 10 12V

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU

Rear Panel
11 10 LCD
Monitor live camera output or program output, or view the menu. See the monitoring
settings in this manual for more details.
12 Rear Tally Light
When lit, it indicates to the camera operator that their camera is currently live.
13 Focus Button
Press once to auto focus or twice to display focus peaking on the LCD.
14 Iris Button
Press once for auto exposure.
15 Push To Talk Button (PTT)
Press and HOLD to talk. Press twice in quick succession for hands free communication.
Press again to revert to the default behavior.
16 Program (PGM) Button
Press to toggle between live camera output and program output from a switcher
control room.
17 Look Up Table (LUT) Button
Currently not implemented.

Camera Features 10
12V

18 Menu Navigation Buttons


Navigate the menu on the LCD.
REF

19 Set Button
SDI IN

Use this button to confirm your menu selections.


SDI OUT

20 Display Button
OPTICAL IN

OPTICAL OUT

Press this button to toggle overlays on and off.


21 Menu Button
Access the menu on the LCD.
22 Power Button
Press the power button to turn on the Blackmagic Studio Camera. Press and hold the
button to turn the camera off.
Refer to the button settings section in this manual for more details.

Bottom Panel
23 USB Connector
USB Mini-B port for camera firmware updates. See Blackmagic Camera Setup section in
this manual.

23

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K Features


Front Panel
1 Tally Light
The Tally light indicates to on-air talent which camera is currently live, as well as
alerting the operator to the status of the camera. The following scenarios are possible:
White - Powered
Red - Live
Alternating red and orange - Battery low when live
Alternating white and orange - Battery low
You can adjust the brightness of the tally light in Micro Studio Camera 4Ks settings.
See the camera settings section for more information.

1 2 4
5
6
PUSH

7
3
2

8
PUSH

Camera Features 11
Left Panel
2 HDMI Out
The HDMI output lets you preview your video output and navigate the camera menus
using external monitors such as Blackmagic Video Assist. Output resolution is always
1080HD, regardless of the camera resolution, and you can choose to display overlays
such as frame guides, a histogram, and audio levels. See the monitoring settings
section in this manual for more detail.
3 Expansion Port
DB-HD15 connector. Used for external power input and a range of remote control
options as well as reference input. See the section Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera
4K Expansion Cable for details.
4 Menu Button
Use the menu buttons to access the cameras built in menu which can be displayed on
an attached HDMI display.
5 Up Button
Use the button to navigate menus.
6 Down Button
Use this button to navigate menus.
7 Set Button
Use this button to confirm your menu selections.
8 Power Button
Press the power button to turn on the Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K. Press and
hold the button to turn the camera off.

Right Panel
9 Analog Audio In
3.5mm stereo audio input, switchable between microphone and line-level
input in menu.
10 SDI Out
SDI output for connecting to a switcher, external recorder or other device.
11 SDI In
SDI input allows camera control via ATEM switchers or the Blackmagic 3G-SDI
Arduino Shield.
12 Headphone / Talkback
3.5mm jack for talkback with iPhone and Android style headsets. Double
press the play/pause button on your headset to toggle talkback on
and press it once again to turn talkback off.

10
13
11

12

Camera Features 12
Rear Panel
13 Battery Slot
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K comes with one LP-E6 battery which fits into this
slot. The battery will be trickle charged while the camera is connected to power via its
expansion port.

Top Panel
14 Battery Release
Slide forward to release the battery.

Bottom Panel
15 USB Connector
USB port for camera firmware updates. See the Blackmagic Camera Setup section in
this manual.

14

15

Camera Connections
Blackmagic Studio Camera - Left Side
LANC Remote Control
The remote port on your camera is used to remotely control lens focus, iris and zoom
adjustments when using a compatible lens. The port takes a 2.5 mm stereo jack using the
standard LANC protocol.
Active MFT lenses allow you to control the zoom servo with a LANC controller. The following
lenses are currently supported:
Panasonic Lumix G X Vario PZ 14-42mm f/3.5-5.6 Power O.I.S. Lens
Panasonic Lumix G X Vario PZ 45-175mm f/4.0-5.6 Zoom O.I.S. Lens
Olympus M.Zuiko Digital ED 12-50mm f/3.5-6.3 EZ Micro 4/3 Lens
Olympus M.Zuiko Digital ED 14-42mm f/3.5-5.6 EZ Micro 4/3 Lens

Headphones Output
For monitoring program and control room audio with aviation style headsets with fixed wing
connectors. Aviation headsets range from single ear models for use in studio environments to
full size noise cancelling models which are suitable for loud concerts or sporting events. Audio
is taken from channel 15 and 16 of the incoming SDI signal. Channels 15 and 16 are rarely if ever
used during production and so are very suitable to serve for the audio talkback.

Camera Connections 13
Headphones Microphone Input
For talking to the control room with aviation style headsets. Audio is embedded into channel
15and 16 of the SDI signal output.

Audio Inputs
Two channels of professional balanced analog audio is supported via XLR connectors. Use the
audio menu to set the input levels for each channel. The inputs support both mic level inputs
and line level inputs and the input type is also selected from the audio menu. Audio is
embedded into channel 1 and 2 of the SDI stream.

1
1
PUSH

3
2

2
1
PUSH

3
2

Blackmagic Studio Camera - Right Side


Optical Input/Output
For optical fiber input and output, you will need to install an optional optical fiber SFP module.
This lets you connect industry standard LC connectors, supporting 3G-SDI on Studio Camera
HD, and 6G-SDI on Studio Camera 4K. Optical fiber cable is widely available because its the
same cable used in computer networking. Optical fiber allows cable runs of up to 28 miles
which is more than enough for even the most demanding outside broadcast event. If both
optical and SDI inputs are connected, the output from the device which was connected first will
be used. To purchase an optical fiber SFP module for your Blackmagic Studio Camera, contact
your nearest Blackmagic Design reseller. You can find your nearest reseller on our website at
www.blackmagicdesign.com/resellers.

SDI Out
Use the SDI Out connector to output 10-bit 4:2:2 video to professional SDI video equipment
such as routers, monitors, SDI capture devices and broadcast switchers. Blackmagic Studio
Camera HD supports 3G-SDI, and Studio Camera 4K supports 12G-SDI.

SDI In
The SDI input allows the camera operator to view the Program (PGM) output. Simply press the
PGM button to toggle between live camera output and Program output from a switcher
control room.
If both optical and SDI inputs are connected, the output from the device which was connected
first will be used. If youre using the Studio Camera to record to a device such as the
Blackmagic Hyperdeck Shuttle, the output from the Hyperdeck can be connected to the SDI
input so you can playback what you have just recorded.

Camera Connections 14
Reference Input
This allows multiple cameras to be genlocked to a blackburst or tri-level reference signal.
Genlocking cameras to an external reference signal helps to prevent timing errors which may
result in the picture jumping when switching between different cameras.

Power
Use the 12 - 24V power input for connecting your power supply and to charge the internal
battery in Blackmagic Studio Camera HD and Blackmagic Studio Camera 4K. When the battery
in these cameras is charged it will power the camera for up to 4 hours on Studio Camera HD,
and up to 3 hours on Studio Camera 4K.
Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 and Studio Camera 4K 2 do not have internal batteries.

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN

REF

12V

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K - Left Side


HDMI Output
The HDMI port on your Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K outputs 10-bit 4:2:2 1080p video
with 2 channels of audio for monitoring purposes. You can connect any HD capable HDMI
monitor, such as Blackmagic Video Assist, to frame and focus shots as well as navigating the
Micro Studio Camera 4Ks menus.
The frame rate of the HDMI output will match the format of the camera. For example, if the
camera is set to 2160p30, the HDMI output will be in 1080p30.

MENU
EXPANSION

SET

Camera Connections 15
Expansion Port
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4Ks small size makes it easy to capture unique shots from
close to the action or difficult to reach spots. While your Micro Studio Camera 4K can be easily
tucked away out of sight, the same cant always be said of a camera operator. So being able to
remotely control your camera is important to making full use of its tiny size.
You can adjust some settings on Micro Studio Camera 4K via SDI input with an ATEM Switcher,
as detailed in the section Introducing Camera Control in this manual. However, the majority of
control options are provided by the expansion port.
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4Ks DB-HD15 connector provides a wide range of connections,
including power, LANC remote, pan, tilt, zoom and genlock via the expansion cable included.
We encourage you to use a wide range of easily available cables to access specific features, or to
solder your own custom connections and adapt the Micro Studio Camera 4K to your needs. See the
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K Expansion Cable section in this manual for more information.

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K - Right Side


Analog Audio In
The 3.5mm stereo audio connector accepts microphone or line level audio. You can switch
between these options in the cameras audio settings menu. Its important to select the
appropriate setting or your audio may sound too quiet or too loud.

SDI Out
Use the SDI out connector to output 10-bit 4:2:2 video to professional SDI video equipment
such as routers, monitors, SDI capture devices and broadcast switchers. Blackmagic Micro
Studio Camera 4K supports 6G-SDI. You will need a DIN 1.0/2.3 to SDI adapter cable to connect
to devices with full size SDI connectors.

SDI In
Use the SDI in connector to control your Micro Studio Camera 4K via ATEM switchers. Refer to
the section Introducing Camera Control for information about which controls are available.

TIP You can also control your Micro Studio Camera via a Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino
Shield. The shield embeds the same Blackmagic control data packets in the SDI signal
as you would get with an ATEM switcher. This means by connecting the program return
feed from any SDI switcher, through the shield to the SDI input on your camera, you can
access all the same Blackmagic camera controls you get with ATEM switchers.

Camera Connections 16
Headphone / Talkback audio
The 3.5mm headphone / talkback input lets you talk to the control room with iPhone or Android
style headsets. Double press the play/pause button on your headset to enable talkback, and
press once to disable. Audio is embedded into channel 15 and 16 of the SDI signal output.

Customization
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K Expansion Cable
There are two ways to access the expansion ports functions. You can use the expansion cable
that comes with your Micro Studio Camera 4K, or solder your own custom connectors.
The expansion cable provides connectors for the following control options.

4 Micro Studio Cam MSC Breakout Cable Micro Studio Cam MSC Breakout Cable

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K expansion cable.

1 Power Input
The 12V power input connects via a DC jack and provides power to the Micro Studio
Camera 4K, as well as trickle charging any batteries attached. When mains power is
supplied, the camera will automatically turn on.
2 Reference Input
This allows multiple cameras to be genlocked to a blackburst or tri-level reference
signal. Genlocking cameras to an external reference signal helps to prevent timing errors
which may result in the picture jumping when switching between different cameras.
3 LANC
Connect wired LANC remote controllers to the 2.5mm jack for controlling functions like
zoom, iris adjustment, and focus from a tripod arm when using compatible lenses.
4 Pan Tilt Zoom
The RS-422 connector is used to relay pan tilt zoom commands received by
MicroStudio Camera 4K from its SDI input to a motorized head.

Customization 17
5 B4 Communication
The DB-9 connector allows you to power and control B4 broadcast lenses attached to
the Micro Studio Camera 4K via an MFT to B4 adapter. To control a compatible B4 lens,
simply connect the optional Digital B4 Control Adapter cable to the cable from the lens,
then connect the other end to the DB-9 serial connector on your expansion cable.
You can adjust settings such as iris, focus and zoom in the same way you would an
active MFT lens, either via an ATEM switcher using the camera control page, or via
other remote control interfaces that can be connected to the Micro Studio Camera 4K
expansion cable. For a list of supported B4 digital lenses, refer to the Blackmagic
Design support center at www.blackmagicdesign.com/support/faq/59011
6 S.Bus Digital Servo
By connecting to a compatible S.Bus receiver using the Futaba J cable, you have 18
S.Bus remote channels where features of the camera can be assigned to and remotely
controlled. These features can include focus, servo zoom, iris control and other such
features. For more information about mapping functions to S.Bus remote channels, see
the Remote Settings section of this manual.

Wiring diagram for the Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K


Expansion Cable
When using Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4Ks expansion port you may only want to access
one or two functions. For example, you may want to control an attached B4 Broadcast Lens
while simultaneously receiving 12V power and a reference signal. Its easy to make a connector
that will give you just these functions without the clutter of additional, unused connectors.
Use the following diagram when wiring the expansion cable included or use it as an example for
how you can wire up the connections on your own custom cable correctly. The full range of
available pins are listed under group P1, while the subsets used for particular functions, as well as
their layout within the appropriate connectors, are shown in groups P2 through P7.

P1 PIN ASSIGNMENT
2 S. Bus 1
2 P2
GROUND 3

GROUND 1
12 PTZ RS422 Rx- 2
8 PTZ RS422 Tx+ 3 5
9
GROUND 4 4

GROUND
5
6
3
2
8
7 P3
6
13 PTZ RS422 Rx+ 7 1

3 PTZ RS422 Tx- 8


GROUND 9

5 15
GROUND 1
10 14 B4 Lens Control Transmit 2 5
9
4 14 4
15 B4 Lens Control Receive 3
P4
9 8
3 13 3
8 GROUND 4 2
7
2
7
12 6 Power +12V in* 5 1
6
1 11 OTHER
6

5 Reference Input CENTER


GROUND SLEEVE P5
1 Ground 6 Power +12V in 11 Ground LANC Data
9 TIP
2
3
S. Bus
PTZ RS422 Tx-
7
8
Ground
PTZ RS422 Tx+
12
13
PTZ RS422 Rx-
PTZ RS422 Rx+
10
GROUND
LANC Power RING
SLEEVE
P6
4 Ground 9 LANC Data 14 B4 Lens Control Transmit
5 Reference Input 10 LANC Power 15 B4 Lens Control Receive
6 Power +12V in PIN
GROUND SLEEVE P7

* Power input to the camera is also used to power the lens. Beware of applying excessive voltages if youre using
your own power supply to avoid damage to the lens.

Customization 18
Settings
You can change settings on your Blackmagic camera to get the best picture, such as video
format, shutter speed and white balance, plus you can adjust audio levels, monitoring settings,
and studio tally and talkback settings for effective communication with the control room.
This section of the manual contains detailed information on each of the settings in your camera.

Camera Settings
To configure the camera settings on your Blackmagic Studio Camera or Blackmagic Micro
Studio Camera 4K, press the menu button. Use the menu navigation buttons to highlight items
and press the set button to confirm your selection.
If you are using the Micro Studio Camera 4K, you will need to connect an external monitor via
the cameras HDMI port to view menu settings.

Video Format
Select your desired video format using the navigation buttons. For example, to select between
1080p and 1080i formats, press the left or right arrow buttons to progress through the format
options. Press the set button to confirm the format you want.
A list of supported video formats is provided later in this section.
Gain
Gain settings are helpful when you are shooting in low light conditions. The default setting is
0dB and gain can be increased in 6dB increments up to 18dB.
Detail
Use this setting to sharpen your image live from your Studio Camera. Decrease or increase the
level of sharpening by selecting off or default for low sharpening, medium and high.
Auto Exposure
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K gives you several auto exposure options.
Iris
Maintains a constant shutter speed while changing the aperture to achieve a constant exposure.
Shutter
Maintains a constant aperture while changing the shutter speed to achieve a constant exposure.

Camera settings - Blackmagic Studio Camera.

Settings 19
Iris + Shutter
Mantains the correct exposure levels by adjusting the aperture. If the maximum or minimum
available aperture is reached and exposure still cannot be maintained, Micro Studio Camera 4K
will begin adjusting the shutter speed to keep exposure constant.

Shutter + Iris
Maintains the correct exposure levels by adjusting the shutter speed. If the maximum or
minimum available shutter speed is reached and exposure still cannot be maintained,
MicroStudio Camera 4K will begin adjusting the aperture to keep exposure constant.

Manual Trigger
Iris aperture and shutter speed are set manually and exposure may vary with changing light
conditions.

White Balance
Eighteen white balance presets are selectable for a variety of color temperature conditions.
2500, 2800, 3000, 3200, 3400, 3600, 4000, 4500 and 4800K for various conditions
under tungsten, incandescent or fluorescent light, or under dull natural light including
candle light, sunrise/sunset, morning, and after noon light.
5000, 5200, 5400 and 5600K for outdoors on a clear, sunny day.
6000, 6500, 7000, 7500 and 8000K for a variety of daylight conditions.

Shutter Speed
Shutter speed complements the gain setting by regulating the amount of light on the sensor.
There are 15 different shutter speeds available ranging from 1/50 sec to 1/2000 sec.

Camera settings - Blackmagic


Micro Studio Camera 4K.

Blackmagic Studio Cameras Supported Video Formats

Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Micro Studio


Camera Camera 4K Camera 4K

720p50 720p50 1080i50

720p59.94 720p59.94 1080i59.94

720p60 720p60 1080i60

1080i50 1080i50 1080p23.98

Settings 20
Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Micro Studio
Camera Camera 4K Camera 4K

1080i59.94 1080i59.94 1080p24

1080i60 1080i60 1080p25

1080p23.98 1080p23.98 1080p29.97

1080p24 1080p24 1080p30

1080p25 1080p25 1080p50

1080p29.97 1080p29.97 1080p59.94

1080p30 1080p30 1080p60

1080p50 1080p50 2160p23.98

1080p59.94 1080p59.94 2160p24

1080p60 1080p60 2160p25

2160p23.98 2160p29.97

2160p24 2160p30

2160p25

2160p29.97

2160p30

2160p50

2160p59.94

2160p60

Audio Settings
To adjust audio input and audio monitoring settings on your Blackmagic Studio Camera,
pressthe menu button and select the microphone icon to the left of the display. Use the menu
navigation buttons to highlight menus and use the set button to confirm your selection.

Audio settings - Blackmagic Studio Camera.

Settings 21
Automatic Gain Control
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K features an automatic audio gain control setting that lets
camera adjust the audio recording levels. It automatically reduces the audio gain levels if the
input level gets too loud and subtly raises it if it is too low.

Audio Input
Switches audio between using the cameras internal microphone and the XLR audio connectors.

Microphone Level
Microphone input adjusts the recording levels of the built in microphone. Move the audio
sliderleft or right to increase or decrease levels. Studio Camera has a built in stereo
microphone. The built in microphone records to audio channels 1 and 2 when no external audio
source isconnected.

Input Level
External audio connectors support audio at microphone level or line level. Select Line when
connecting external audioequipmentsuch as an audio mixer or amplifier.Select the mic low or
mic high setting depending on the signal strength of your microphone. Its important to select
the appropriate level to avoid your external audio sounding almost inaudible or too hot and
distorted. Set the external audio input levels by using the left and right arrows.

Ch 1 Input
Move the audio slider icon left or right to increase or decrease levels for channel 1. The external
audio input overrides the built in microphone and is output to audio channel 1.

Ch 2 Uses Ch 1 Input
Select on if you want to embed channel 1 external audio into channels 1 and 2 of the SDI or the
optional optical fiber output. This is the same as connecting input 1 to both audio channels in
the camera and is useful when using microphones with a single mini audio output and you need
to connect both stereo audio channels to it. Select this setting to off if you want channel 1 audio
to remain on one channel only and channel 2 will take audio from the channel 2 audio input,
which is preferred when using stereo audio sources.

Ch 2 Input
Move the audio slider icon left or right to increase or decrease levels for channel 2.
Theexternal audio input overrides the built in microphone and is output to audio channel 2.

Phantom Power
Phantom power supplies power through microphone cables and is a convenient power source for
condenser microphones. Enable or disable phantom power for studio cameras with XLR inputs by
navigating to the audio menu and selecting on or off using the arrow buttons. Phantom power is
automatically disabled when the line input level setting is selected. Be sure to wait at least 10
seconds for phantom power to discharge after disconnecting before plugging in a self powered
microphone. Older ribbon type microphones are not suitable for phantom power usage.

Monitoring Settings
To adjust the display settings for the LCD, press the menu button and select the monitor
icon. Use the menu navigation buttons to highlight menus and use the set button to confirm
your selection.

Settings 22
Monitoring settings - Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K.

HDMI Meters
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K gives you the option to select which meters you want to
display on the HDMI output.

Histogram
The histogram shows the contrast between whites and blacks along a horizontal scale.
The left edge of the histogram displays shadows, or blacks, and the far right displays highlights,
or whites. When you close or open the lens aperture, youll notice the information in the
histogram moves to the left or right accordingly.
This setting toggles the histogram on and off. When on, this will appear in the bottom right
corner of an attached monitor when HDMI overlays are set to on.

Audio
The audio meter represents the current volume of left and right audio channels in two horizontal
bars. Left is on top, right is on the bottom. If your audio levels rise too high, your audio peaks
can be clipped and you will hear distortion in your audio. To avoid this, adjust the audio gain on
your camera until your audio levels stay within safe levels.
This setting toggles the audio meter on and off. When on, this will appear in the bottom left
corner of an attached monitor when HDMI overlay are set to on.

HDMI Overlays
This setting is only available on Micro Studio Camera 4K. When set to on, HDMI video output
will include frame guides and information about the camera settings and identity, as well
as any meters enabled via the HDMI meters setting.

Brightness
Move the slider icon left or right to adjust brightness settings for the LCD. The default
setting is 60%.

Zebra
Blackmagic Cameras have a zebra feature which gives an indication of exposure levels.
Diagonal lines will appear across any part of the video that exceeds the zebra exposure level.
Turn zebra on and select the desired zebra warning level by using the left and right arrows.
Thedefault setting is medium.

Settings 23
Focus Peaking
Allows you to change the level of focus peaking. The settings include: off, low, medium and
high. Adjust this setting when you are using a very sharp lens and the peaking covers the entire
image. The default setting is medium.

Front Tally Brightness


Changes the brightness of the front tally light. Settings include: off, low, medium and high.
Thedefault setting is medium.

Rear Tally Brightness


Changes the brightness of the rear tally light. Settings include: low, medium and high.
Thedefault setting is medium.

Tally Light Brightness


Changes the brightness of the tally light on Micro Studio Camera 4K. The default setting is
medium but you can also set it to high, low or off.
If you have set the tally brightness to off, the tally light will illuminate when your camera is
powered on, and then will turn off shortly afterwards.

Display Battery Percentage


Some LP-E6 batteries can tell the camera their charge levels directly via digital serial
communication. If this option is enabled, you can display the battery levels for Micro Studio
Camera 4K using a percentage value instead of graphical bars. However, if you find the
percentage display inaccurate, you can switch back to using graphical bars which measures of
the state of charge directly off the battery.

Studio Settings
To adjust the display settings for the LCD, press the menu button and select the headphones
icon. Use the menu navigation buttons to highlight menus and use the set button to confirm
your selection.

Studio settings - Blackmagic Studio Camera.

Camera Number
If you want your Studio Camera to receive tally signals from an ATEM switcher, youll need to set
the camera number on your camera. This ensures the switcher sends the tally signal to the
correct camera. The camera number can be set to a value of 1-99. The default setting is 1.

Settings 24
TIP You can also connect the program return feed from any SDI switcher to your
camera via a Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield and display tally on each camera.
AllSDI switchers that have open collector tally outputs are configurable for tally using
the Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield. Refer to the section titled Connecting tally
using the Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield for more information.

Reference Source
Used to select the genlock source. The Studio Camera can lock to program SDI input or
external genlock source. If using an external genlock source, be aware that changing that
source will most likely cause a glitch as the camera locks to the new source.

Reference Timing
Allows you to manually adjust the reference timing on a line or pixel basis.

Headset Level
Move the volume slider left or right to increase or decrease audio monitoring levels. The default
setting is 50%.

Headset Mic Level


Move the volume slider left or right to increase or decrease audio microphone input levels.
Thedefault setting is 50%.

Program Mix
Changes the balance of camera sound to talkback sound. The headphones will output audio
following what is displayed on the LCD. For instance, if you are in camera view, camera audio is
heard. And if you are in program view, program audio is heard. The default setting is 0%.

Remote Settings
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K features an additional menu for setting remote functions.
Ifyou are using S.Bus to control your camera, you can use this menu to assign functions such,
iris, shutter speed and so on to individual S.Bus channels. Simply select the function you wish to
control and assign an available channel using the up, down and set buttons.

Remote settings - Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K.

Settings 25
Button Settings
Adjusting Lens Settings
Blackmagic Studio Camera supports electronic lens control, which allows you to adjust lens
settings such as aperture and auto focus. The focus peaking feature creates a green edge
around the sharpest parts of the image so you can easily confirm your focus. Focus peaking is
only visible on the LCD and does not affect the SDI output.

Focus Button
When using the Studio Camera with an auto focus lens, press the focus button for focus
peaking or auto focus. Press the focus button once to auto focus. A quick double press of the
focus button activates focus peaking.
When using a manual lens, press the focus button once for focus peaking.

Iris Button
When using video dynamic range settings, a single press of the iris button will set an average
exposure based on the highlights and shadows in your shot. When using film dynamic range
settings, pressing the iris button sets your exposure to accommodate the brightest highlight in
your shot. To set your aperture manually on your Studio camera, press the up and down menu
navigation buttons.

Additional Settings
Push to Talk (PTT) Button
When doing live production it is vital that camera operators can talk to the director and others
within the control room. Simply press and hold the button to begin talking. Press twice in quick
succession for hands free communication. Press again to revert to the default behavior.

Program (PGM) Button


It is sometimes important for camera operators to see the program output, rather than just the
view from their own camera. Press the button to toggle between live camera output and the
program output from a switcher control room. You can use either the SDI input, or user
upgradable optical fiber input to connect your external video source.

Look Up Table (LUT) Button


Currently not implemented.

Left, Up, Down, Right Buttons


Use these buttons to navigate the menus.

Set Button
Use this button to confirm your menu selections.

Display Button
Press this button to display useful information on your Studio Cameras 10 monitor, including:
Frame guides with camera and lens settings such as camera number, video format and
frame rate, shutter speed, white balance, battery life, gain setting and f-stop number.
Press the Disp button again to turn overlays off and monitor the image only. Overlays are visible
on the 10 monitor. The SDI output is always clean.

NOTE Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 and Studio Camera 4K 2 to do not have internal
batteries, these cameras will not display battery life remaining.

Settings 26
Menu Button
OPTICAL OUT Press this button to bring up the menu and then use the arrow buttons to navigate.
OPTICAL IN

Power Button
SDI OUT

Press the power button to turn on the Blackmagic Studio Camera. Press and hold the button to
SDI IN turn the camera.

REF

12V

OPTICAL OUT OPTICAL OUT OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN OPTICAL IN OPTICAL IN

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT FOCUS IRIS SET PTT PGM LUT
DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRISSET PTT PGM DISPLAY
LUT MENU SET DISPLAY MENU
SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT

SDI IN SDI IN SDI IN

REF REF REF

12V 12V 12V

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU

Press the focus button once Press the iris button for auto The Studio Camera features
to auto focus. A quick double exposure or use the up and settings like PTT and
press of the focus button down navigation controls PGM which are essential
activates focus peaking. for manual exposure. for live production.

Camera Video Output


Connecting to Video Switchers
Blackmagic Studio Cameras output 10-bit 4:2:2 video so you can connect to broadcast
switchers and other SDI video equipment. With the user upgradable SFP module installed you
can connect via optical fiber, which means ATEM Camera Converters are not required at the
camera end.
If youre using a Blackmagic Studio Camera HD or Studio Camera 4K, you can easily view the
Program (PGM) output from the switcher by connecting it to your Studio Cameras SDI input,
orto the optical fiber input when the user upgradable SFP module is installed.
Blackmagic Studio Camera also features a reference input which allows multiple cameras to be
genlocked to a blackburst or tri-level reference signal. Genlocking cameras, VTRs and other
devices to an external reference signal helps to eliminate timing errors which may result in the
picture jumping when switching between different sources.

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

OPTICAL OUT

SDI IN
OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

REF
SDI IN

REF

12V

12V

Connect your Studio Camera to a switcher via SDI, or via


optical fiber with user upgradable SFP module installed

Camera Video Output 27


Connecting to Recorders
If you simply wish to record your Studio Cameras output, you can connect the SDI output to the
SDI input of an SSD recorder such as the Blackmagic HyperDeck Shuttle. The SDI output from
the HyperDeck can then be connected to the Studio Cameras SDI input, so you can view your
recordings on the cameras LCD.
+12V POWER HDMI IN HDMI OUT SDI IN SDI OUT

+12V POWER HDMI IN HDMI OUT SDI IN SDI OUT

Connect the cameras SDI output to the HyperDecks SDI input and connect the
HyperDecks SDI output to the cameras SDI input to view your recordings.

Connecting Tally using the


Blackmagic3G-SDI Arduino Shield
If you are using an SDI switcher with a tally output connector, you can connect the tally outputs
to a Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield to send tally signals to your Blackmagic Studio Cameras.
This means you can still get tally on your Blackmagic cameras via the SDI program return feed
even if you arent using an ATEM switcher.
For example, the switchers parallel tally port connects to pins D2 - D9 of your Blackmagic
shieldand the shields SDI output is connected to all Blackmagic cameras via a distribution
amplifier, such as a Blackmagic Mini Converter SDI Distribution. This way you can send tally to 8
separate Blackmagic cameras.
The Blackmagic camera number must match the switchers tally outputs, which means you may
need to wire a custom connector to make sure the pins correspond to each camera number.
The common GND from the switchers tally connector must be connected to the GND pin of the
Arduino shield.
Below is a configuration example showing how the Blackmagic camera numbers match the tally
outputs from the switcher, which are then connected to the pins on the Blackmagic
Arduino shield.

Blackmagic Switcher
Camera Number Input Number Arduino Pin

1 1 D2

2 2 D3

3 3 D4

4 4 D5

5 5 D6

6 6 D7

7 7 D8

8 8 D9

Connecting Tally using the Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield 28


The example sketch below shows how the Blackmagic Arduino shield is programmed to send a
tally signal to the camera that has been switched to the program output. All SDI switchers that
have open collector outputs are configurable for tally using the Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino
Shield. For more information, download the Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield instruction
manual from the Blackmagic Design support center at www.blackmagicdesign.com/support.

The example sketch above shows how the Blackmagic Arduino shield is programmed to detect
a tally signal for input 1 or 2 via the switchers tally output, and then embed that tally signal into
the shields SDI output. The tally light on the corresponding camera will then illuminate.

Connecting Tally using the Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield 29


1

PUSH
2

PUSHBlackmagic Camera Setup


How to Update Your Camera Software on Mac OS X
After downloading the Blackmagic Camera Setup software, unzip the downloaded file and
double click on the .dmg disk image file. Launch the Blackmagic Camera Setup installer and
follow the onscreen instructions.

Blackmagic Camera Setup software.


1
PUSH

How to Update Your Camera Software on Windows


PUSH

After downloading the Blackmagic Camera Setup software and unzipping the downloaded file,
you should see a Blackmagic Camera Setup installer window. Double click on the installer icon
and follow the onscreen prompts to complete the installation.
After the installation is complete, click on the Windows start menu, and go to all programs.
Click on the Blackmagic Design folder to open the Blackmagic Camera setup software and
instruction manuals.

How to Update your Cameras Internal Software


After installing the latest Blackmagic Camera setup software on your computer, connect a USB
cable between the computer and your camera. The Mini-B USB 2.0 port is located on the
underside of the camera.
Launch Blackmagic Camera Setup and follow the onscreen prompts to update the
camera software.

The Mini-B USB 2.0 ports are located on the underside of the cameras.

Blackmagic Camera Setup 30


Attaching Accessories
Sun Shade
The Studio Cameras include a foldable sun shade to shade the LCD in bright conditions and
ensure optimum viewing is possible at all times.
1 Locate the 6 thumbscrews that are included with your Studio Camera.
2 Align the holes in the sun shade with the cameras mounting points and screw in 2
thumbscrews to the top and each side of the camera to firmly secure the sun shade.

Other Accessories
For studio use, you might want to mount the camera on a pedestal and add rails for large
broadcast lenses and teleprompters. For outside broadcast use, your may want to attach
microphones, external batteries, or LANC remote controllers. The camera includes two 3/8
mounting points on the bottom, and ten 1/4 mounting points on the sides and the top.
This means you have the flexibility to customize your rig for any size production.

1
1
PUSH

3
2

2
1
PUSH

3
2

Using ATEM Software Control


Introducing Camera Control
Your Blackmagic Studio Camera can be controlled from an ATEM switcher using the Camera
Control feature in ATEM Software Control. Clicking on the Camera button opens the camera
control feature. Settings such as iris, gain, focus and zoom control are easily adjusted using
compatible lenses, plus you can color balance cameras and create unique looks using the
DaVinci Resolve primary color corrector.
The ATEM switcher control works by broadcasting camera control packets via all the non down
converted SDI outputs of an ATEM switcher. So this means you can connect an SDI output of an
ATEM switcher to your cameras video input, your camera will detect the control packets in the
SDI link and allow you to control features in the camera itself. You can control your camera via
both regular SDI, or via user upgradable optical fiber when the SFP module is installed.

Using ATEM Software Control 31


ATEM Camera Control.

Connecting via SDI


1 Connect your Blackmagic Studio Cameras SDI Out to any SDI In on the ATEM switcher.
2 Connect any one of the ATEM switchers SDI outputs, except down converted or multi
view outputs, to your Studio Cameras SDI In. Camera control signals are not sent via
the multi view and down converted SDI outputs.
3 On your Blackmagic Studio Camera, press Menu. Navigate to Studio Settings>Camera
Number and set it to match the switcher input. For example, if studio camera 1 is
connected to Cam 1 on the ATEM switcher, the camera number must also be set to 1.
This ensures tally is sent to the correct camera.

IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 1 IN 3 1 1 3 1 REMOTE REMOTE
1 3 5 1 7 3 9 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH
STEREO IN

CONTROL CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 IN 2 2 HD 2 HD HD HD HD HD
1 2 4 1 6 2 8 4 10 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 REF IN
PREVIEW AUXPROGRAM
1-3 PREVIEW
OUTPUTS PROGRAM OUTPUTS
MULTI-VIEW MULTI-VIEW
ANALOG AUDIO IN

IN IN IN IN IN 1 3 1 REMOTE
All SDI and HDMI video connections are
1 3 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH SD, HD and Ultra HD switchable unless indicated

CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 2 HD HD HD
1 2 4 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2 CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 PREVIEW PROGRAM OUTPUTS MULTI-VIEW ANALOG AUDIO IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT

Connect your Blackmagic Studio Camera to any of the ATEM switchers SDI inputs.

Using ATEM Software Control 32


Connecting via Optical Fiber
1 With the user upgradable optical fiber SFP module installed in your Studio Camera,
connect the Optical Out/In to the Optical Out/In on an ATEM Studio Converter.
2 Connect a suitable SDI out from ATEM Studio Converter to any SDI In on the
ATEM switcher.
3 Connect any one of the ATEM switchers SDI outputs, except down converted or multi
view outputs to ATEM Studio Converters SDI In. Camera control signals are not sent via
the multi view and down converted SDI outputs.
4 On your Blackmagic Studio Camera, press Menu. Navigate to Studio Settings>Camera
Number and set it to match the switcher input. For example, if studio camera 1 is
connected to Cam 1 on the ATEM switcher, your camera number must also be set to 1.
This ensures tally is sent to the correct camera.
Open ATEM Software Control Preferences and set the switchers button mapping to make sure
you are switching the right camera with correct tally. Now you have a video connection from the
switcher to your Blackmagic Studio Camera, you can also get the advantage of live tally
indicators on your camera, as well as being able to view the program feed of the switcher by
pressing your cameras PGM button.

AES/EBU TALKBACK LOOPS

3 1 4 2 OUT
3OUT OUT
4

L R

UT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT IN IN SDI OUT IN

L +12V
R BACKUP L L R R L L R R L R
POWER USB 2.0
OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN
OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG
ANALOG AUDIO OUTAUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO
OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG
OUT AUDIO OUT PGM SDI OPTICAL
MICOUT/IN H/PHONE ANALOG AUDIO OUT OP

AES/EBU TALKBACK LOOPS

1 2 3 4 OUT OUT OUT

L R

SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT IN IN IN

+12V BACKUP L R L R L R L R
POWER USB 2.0 OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT PGM SDI MIC H/PHONE

Connect multiple Blackmagic Studio Cameras via optical fiber using an ATEM Studio Converter.

Using Camera Control


Launch ATEM Software Control and click on the Camera button located at the bottom of the
software window. Youll see a row of labeled camera controllers containing tools to adjust and
refine each cameras image. The controllers are easy to use. Simply click the buttons using your
mouse, or click and drag to adjust.

Camera Control Selection


The button row at the top of the camera control page lets you select the camera number you
would like to control. If you have more cameras that fit onto the window size, or you are running
the color corrector window, then you can use these buttons to select between which camera
you would like to control. If you are using an Aux output for monitoring your camera control,
pushing these buttons to change the camera to control will also send that cameras video
output to the Aux output. Your chosen Aux output for camera control can be set in the general
switcher settings.

Using ATEM Software Control 33


Channel Status
The channel status at the top of each camera controller displays the camera label, On Air
indicator and lock button. Press the lock button to lock all the controls for a specific camera.
When on air, the channel status illuminates red and displays the On Air alert.

Each camera controller displays the channel


status so you know which camera is on air.
Use the color wheels to adjust each YRGB
channels lift, gamma and gain settings.

Color Wheel
The color wheel is a powerful feature of the DaVinci Resolve color corrector and used to make
color adjustments to each YRGB channels lift, gamma and gain settings. You can select which
setting to adjust by clicking on the three selection buttons above the color wheel.

Master Wheel
Use the master wheel below the color wheel to make contrast adjustments to all YRGB
channels at once, or luminance only for each lift, gamma or gain setting.

Camera Settings
The camera settings button near the bottom left of the master wheel lets you turn on the color
bars feature in Blackmagic Studio Cameras, Micro Studio Cameras and URSA mini, plus adjust
detail settings for each cameras picture signal.

Show/Hide Color Bars


Blackmagic cameras have a color bars feature built in which you can turn on or off by selecting
show or hide color bars. This feature can be very useful for visually identifying individual
cameras while setting up for your live production. Color bars also provide an audio tone so you
can easily check and set the audio levels from each camera.

Detail
Use this setting to sharpen the image from your cameras live. Decrease or increase the level of
sharpening by selecting: Detail off, detail default for low sharpening, medium detail, and
high detail.

Using ATEM Software Control 34


The camera settings button lets you turn
color bars on or off and adjust the in-camera
sharpening of connected Blackmagic cameras.

Reset Buttons
The reset button near the bottom right of each camera controller lets you easily choose color
correction settings to reset, copy or paste. Each color wheel also has its own reset button.
Press to restore a setting to its default state, or copy/paste a setting. Locked controllers are not
affected by the Paste feature.
The master reset button on the bottom right corner of the color corrector panel lets you reset lift,
gamma and gain color wheels plus Contrast, Hue, Saturation and Lum Mix settings. You can paste
color correction settings to camera controllers individually, or all cameras at once for a unified
look. Iris, focus, coarse and pedestal settings are not affected by the Paste feature. When
applying Paste to all, a warning message will appear asking you to confirm your action. This is
so you dont accidentally paste new settings to any unlocked cameras that are currently on air.

When applying Paste to all, a warning message will appear asking


you to confirm your action. This is so you dont accidentally paste
new settings to any unlocked cameras that are currently on air.

Iris/Pedestal Control
The iris/pedestal control is located within the cross hairs of each camera controller. The control
illuminates red when its camera is on air.

Using ATEM Software Control 35


The iris/pedestal control illuminates red
when its respective camera is on air.

To open or close the iris, drag the control up or down. Holding the shift key allows only iris
adjustments.
To darken or lift the pedestal, drag the control left or right. Holding the command key on a Mac,
or the Control key on Windows, allows only pedestal adjustments.

Zoom Control
When using compatible lenses with an electronic zoom feature, you can zoom your lens in and
out using the zoom control. The controller works just like the zoom rocker on a lens, with
telephoto on one end, and wide angle on the other. Click on the zoom control, located above
the coarse slider, and drag up to zoom in, or drag down to zoom out.
If your lens does not have active lens control or your camera does not support zoom control via
the SDI camera control protocol then these settings will have no affect. If you are using
Blackmagic Studio Camera or Blackmagic Studio Camera 4K, please make sure you have
updated your camera software to v1.9.11 or later to ensure your camera has support for
controlling MFT lenses with active zoom.

Coarse Setting
The coarse setting is located to the left of the iris/pedestal control and is used to limit the iris
range. This feature helps you prevent over exposed images from going to air.
To set your coarse threshold, completely open the iris using the iris control, then drag the
coarse setting up or down to set optimum exposure. Now when you adjust the iris, the coarse
threshold will prevent it from going above optimum exposure.

Iris Indicator
The iris indicator is located to the right of the iris/pedestal control and displays a visual
reference so you can easily see how open or closed the lens aperture is. The iris indicator is
affected by the coarse setting.

Using ATEM Software Control 36


Auto Focus Button
The auto focus button is located at the bottom left corner of each camera controller. Press to
automatically set the focus when you have an active lens that supports electronic focus
adjustments. Its important to know that while most lenses support electronic focus, some
lenses can be set to manual or auto focus modes, and so you need to ensure your lens is set to
auto focus mode. Sometimes this is set by sliding the focus ring on the lens forward or backward.

Click on the auto focus button or drag the manual focus


adjustment left or right to focus a compatible lens.

Manual Focus Adjustment


When you want to adjust the focus on your camera manually, you can use the focus adjustment
located at the bottom of each camera controller. Drag the wheel control left or right to manually
adjust focus while viewing the video feed from the camera to ensure your image is nice
and sharp.

Camera Gain
The camera gain setting allows you to turn on additional gain in your camera. This is important
when you are operating in low light conditions and need extra gain in the front end of your
camera to avoid your images being under exposed. You can decrease or increase gain by
clicking on the left or right arrows on the dB gain setting.
You can turn on some gain when you need it, such as outdoor shoots when the light fades at sunset
and you need to increase your image brightness. Its worth noting that adding gain will increase noise
in your images.

Shutter Speed Control


The shutter speed control is located in the section between the color wheel and the iris/
pedestal control. Decrease or increase the shutter speed by hovering your mouse pointer over
the shutter speed indicator and then clicking on the left or right arrows.
If you see flicker in lights you can decrease your shutter speed to eliminate it. Decreasing
shutter speed is a good way to brighten your images without using camera gain because you
are increasing the exposure time of the image sensor. Increasing shutter speed will reduce
motion blur so can be used when you want action shots to be sharp and clean with minimal
motion blur.

White Balance
The white balance setting next to the shutter speed control can be adjusted by clicking on the
left or right arrows on each side of the color temperature indicator. Different light sources emit
warm or cool colors, so you can compensate by adjusting the white balance. This ensures the
whites in your image stay white.

Using ATEM Software Control 37


Hovering your mouse pointer over the gain, shutter
speed and white balance indicators reveal arrows
you can click on to adjust their respective settings.

DaVinci Resolve Primary Color Corrector


If you have a color correction background, then you can change the camera control from a
switcher style CCU interface to a user interface thats more like a primary color corrector on a
post production color grading system.
Your Blackmagic Studio Camera features a DaVinci Resolve primary color corrector built in.
Ifyou have used DaVinci Resolve, then creatively, grading in your Blackmagic Studio Camera
will be identical so you can use your color grading experience for live production.
The color corrector panel can be expanded out of any camera controller and provides expanded
color correction control with extra settings and a full primary color corrector interface.
You have color wheels and settings such as saturation available and you can see shadows,
midtones and highlight settings all at the same time. Simply switch between cameras using the
camera selection controls at the top of the window as you need.

Click on the DaVinci Resolve primary color corrector button


to expand the color correction window and adjust settings.

Color Wheels
The Lift/Gamma/Gain controls allow tonally specific yet overlapping regions of adjustment.
In photographic terms lift, gamma and gain corresponds to shadows, mid tones and highlights.

Using ATEM Software Control 38


Lift, gamma and gain color wheels in the color corrector panel.

Use the color wheels in the following ways to make fine or aggressive adjustments:

Click and drag anywhere within the color ring: Note that you dont need to drag the
color balance indicator itself. As the color balance indicator moves, the RGB parameters
underneath change to reflect the adjustments being made to each channel.
Shift-Click and drag within the color ring: Jumps the color balance indicator to the
absolute position of the pointer, letting you make faster and more extreme adjustments.
Double-click within the color ring: Resets the color adjustment without resetting the
master wheel adjustment for that control.
Click the reset control at the upper-right of a color ring: Resets both the color
balance control and its corresponding master wheel.

Master Wheels
Use the master wheels below the color wheels to adjust each YRGB channels lift, gamma and
gain controls.

Adjust the master wheels by dragging the wheel


control left or right.

To make adjustments using the master wheel:


Drag the master wheel left or right: Dragging to the left darkens the selected
parameter of the image, dragging to the right lightens that parameter. As you make
an adjustment, the YRGB parameters underneath change to reflect the adjustment
youre making. To make a Y-only adjustment, hold down the ALT or Command key
and drag left or right. Because the color corrector uses YRGB processing, you can
get quite creative and create unique affects by adjusting the Y channel only.
Y channel adjustments work best when the Lum Mix setting is set to the right side to
use YRGB processing vs the left side to use regular RGB processing. Normally, most
DaVinci Resolve colorists use the YRGB color corrector as you get a lot more control
of color balance without affecting overall gain, so you spend less time getting the
look you want.

Using ATEM Software Control 39


Drag the sliders left or right to adjust Contrast,
Saturation, Hue and Lum Mix settings..

Contrast Setting
The Contrast setting gives you control over the distance between the darkest and lightest
values of an image. The effect is similar to making opposing adjustments using the lift and gain
master wheels. The default setting is 50%.

Saturation Setting
The Saturation setting increases or decreases the amount of color in the image. The default
setting is 50%.

Hue Setting
The Hue setting rotates all hues of the image around the full perimeter of the color wheel.
Thedefault setting of 180 degrees shows the original distribution of hues. Raising or lowering
this value rotates all hues forward or backward along the hue distribution as seen on a
color wheel.

Lum Mix Setting


The color corrector built into your Blackmagic Studio Camera is based on the DaVinci Resolve
primary color corrector. DaVinci has been building color correctors since the early 1980s and
most Hollywood films are color graded on DaVinci Resolve than any other method.
This means the color corrector built into your Blackmagic Studio Camera has some unique and
creatively powerful features. The YRGB processing is one of those features.
When color grading, you can choose to use RGB processing, or YRGB processing. High end
colorists use YRGB processing because you have more precise control over color and you can
independently adjust the channels with better separation and more creative options.
When the Lum Mix control is set to the right side, you have the 100% output of the YRGB color
corrector. When you have the Lum Mix control set to the left side, you get 100% output of the
RGB corrector. You can set the Lum Mix to any position between the left and right to get a blend
of output from both the RGB and YRGB correctors.
Which is the correct setting to use? Thats up to you, as color correction is a pure creative
process and there is no right and wrong, and the best setting is what you like the most and
what you think looks good!

Synchronizing Settings
When connected, camera control signals are sent from the ATEM switcher to your Blackmagic
Studio Camera. If a setting is accidentally adjusted from your Studio Camera, camera control will
automatically reset that setting to maintain synchronization.

Using ATEM Software Control 40


Developer Information
Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol
Version 1.1
If you are a software developer you can use the SDI Camera Control Protocol to construct
devices that integrate with our products. Here at Blackmagic Design our approach is to open up
our protocols and we eagerly look forward to seeing what you come up with!

Overview
The Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol is used by ATEM switchers, Blackmagic 3G-SDI
Arduino Shield and Blackmagic Camera Remote to provide Camera Control functionality with
supported Blackmagic Design cameras. Please refer to the Understanding Studio Camera
Control chapter section of this manual, or the ATEM Switchers Manual and SDKmanual for
more information. These can be downloaded at www.blackmagicdesign.com/support.
This document describes an extensible protocol for sending a uni directional stream of small
control messages embedded in the non-active picture region of a digital video stream.
Thevideo stream containing the protocol stream may be broadcast to a number of devices.
Device addressing is used to allow the sender to specify which device each message is
directed to.

Assumptions
Alignment and padding constraints are explicitly described in the protocol document. Bit fields
are packed from LSB first. Message groups, individual messages and command headers are
defined as, and can be assumed to be, 32 bit aligned.

Blanking Encoding
A message group is encoded into a SMPTE 291M packet with DID/SDID x51/x53 in the active
region of VANC line 16.

Message Grouping
Up to 32 messages may be concatenated and transmitted in one blanking packet up to a
maximum of 255 bytes payload. Under most circumstances, this should allow all messages to
be sent with a maximum of one frame latency.
If the transmitting device queues more bytes of message packets than can be sent in a single
frame, it should use heuristics to determine which packets to prioritize and send immediately.
Lower priority messages can be delayed to later frames, or dropped entirely as appropriate.

Abstract Message Packet Format


Every message packet consists of a three byte header followed by an optional variable length
data block. The maximum packet size is 64 bytes.

Device addresses are represented as an 8 bit unsigned integer. Individual


Destination device (uint8) devices are numbered 0 through 254 with the value 255 reserved to
indicate a broadcast message to all devices.

The command length is an 8 bit unsigned integer which specifies the


Command length (uint8) length of the included command data. The length does NOT include the
length of the header or any trailing padding bytes.

Developer Information 41
The command id is an 8 bit unsigned integer which indicates themessage
type being sent. Receiving devices should ignore any commands that they
Command id (uint8) do not understand. Commands 0 through 127 are reserved for commands
that apply to multiple types of devices. Commands 128 through 255 are
device specific.

This byte is reserved for alignment and expansion purposes. Itshould be


Reserved (uint8)
set to zero.

The command data may contain between 0 and 60 bytes of data.


Command data(uint8[])
Theformat of the data section is defined by the command itself.

Messages must be padded up to a 32 bit boundary with 0x0bytes. Any


Padding(uint8[])
padding bytes are NOT included in the command length.

Receiving devices should use the destination device address and or the command identifier to
determine which messages to process. The receiver should use the command length to skip
irrelevant or unknown commands and should be careful to skip the implicit padding as well.

Defined Commands
Command 0 : change configuration

The category number specifies one of up to 256 configuration categories


Category (uint8)
available on the device.

The parameter number specifies one of 256 potential configuration


parameters available on the device. Parameters 0 through 127 are device
Parameter (uint8)
specific parameters. Parameters 128 though 255 are reserved for
parameters that apply to multiple types of devices.

The data type specifies the type of the remaining data. Thepacket length is
Data type (uint8) used to determine the number of elements in the message. Each message
must contain an integral number of data elements.

Currently defined values are:

A void value is represented as a boolean array of length zero.


0: void / boolean The data field is a 8 bit value with 0 meaning false and all other values
meaning true.

1: signed byte Data elements are signed bytes

2: signed 16bit integer Data elements are signed 16 bit values

3: signed 32bit integer Data elements are signed 32 bit values

4: signed 64bit integer Data elements are signed 64 bit values

5: UTF-8 string Data elements represent a UTF-8 string with no terminating character.

Data types 6 through 127 are reserved.

Data elements are signed 16 bit integers representing a real number with
5 bits for the integer component and 11 bits for the fractional component.
128: signed 5.11fixed point The fixed point representation is equal to the real value multiplied by 2^11.
The representable range is from -16.0 to 15.9995
(15 + 2047/2048).

Developer Information 42
Data types 129 through 255 are available for device specific purposes.

The operation type specifies what action to perform on the specified


Operation type (uint8)
parameter. Currently defined values are:

The supplied values are assigned to the specified parameter. Each


element will be clamped according to its valid range. A void parameter
0: assign value may only be assigned an empty list of boolean type. This operation will
trigger the action associated with that parameter. A boolean value may be
assigned the value zero for false, and any other value for true.

Each value specifies signed offsets of the same type to be added to the
current parameter values. The resulting parameter value will be clamped
1: offset / toggle value according to their valid range. It is not valid to apply an offset to a void
value. Applying any offset other than zero to a boolean value will invert
that value.

Operation types 2 through 127 are reserved.

Operation types 128through 255 are available for device specific purposes.

The data field is 0 or more bytes as determined by the data type and
Data (void)
number of elements.

The category, parameter, data type and operation type partition a 24 bit operation space.

Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

.0 Focus fixed16 0 1 0.0=near, 1.0=far

trigger
.1 Instantaneous autofocus void
instantaneous autofocus

Aperture Value (where


.2 Aperture (f-stop) fixed16 -1 16
fnumber = sqrt(2^AV))

.3 Aperture (normalised) fixed16 0 1 0.0=smallest, 1.0=largest

Steps through available


aperture values from
.4 Aperture (ordinal) int16 0 n
minimum (0) to
maximum (n)

Instantaneous trigger instantaneous


.5 void
Lens auto aperture auto aperture

Optical image true=enabled,


.6 boolean
stabilisation false=disabled

Move to specified focal


length in mm, from
.7 Set absolute zoom (mm) int16 0 max
minimum (0) to
maximum (max)

Set absolute zoom Move to specified focal


.8 fixed16 0 1
(normalised) length: 0.0=wide, 1.0=tele

Start/stop zooming at
Set continuous specified rate: -1.0=zoom
.9 fixed16 -1 +1.0
zoom (speed) wider fast, 0.0=stop,
+1=zoom tele fast

Developer Information 43
Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

1
[0] = frame rate 24, 25, 30, 50, 60
[1] = M-rate 0=regular, 1=M-rate
0=NTSC, 1=PAL, 2=720,
[2] = dimensions 3=1080, 4=2k, 5=2k DCI,
.0 Video mode int8 6=4k, 7=4k DCI
0=progressive,
[3] = interlaced
1=interlaced
[4] =
0=YUV
colour space
.1 Sensor Gain int8 1 16 1x, 2x, 4x, 8x, 16x gain
int16 color temp 2500 10000 Colour temperature in K
.2 Manual White Balance
int16 tint -50 50 tint
Calculate and set auto
.3 Set auto WB void
white balance
Use latest auto white
.4 Restore auto WB void
balance setting
.5 Exposure (us) int32 1 42000 time in us
Steps through
availableexposure
.6 Exposure (ordinal) int16 0 n
valuesfrom minimum (0)
tomaximum (n)
int8
.7 Dynamic Range Mode 0 1 0 = film, 1 = video
enum
Video int8
.8 Video sharpening level 0 3
enum
fps as integer
[0] = file
(eg 24, 25, 30,
frame rate
50, 60, 120)
fps as integer, valid when
sensor-off-speed set
[1] = sensor (eg 24,25, 30, 33, 48, 50,

frame rate 60, 120), no change will
beperformed if this value
is set to 0
[2] = frame width in pixels
.9 Recording format int16
[3] =
in pixels
frame height
[0]=file-M-rate
[1]=sensor-M-rate,
valid when sensor-
[4] = flags off-speed-set
[2]=sensor-off-speed
[3]=interlaced
[4]=windowed mode
0=Manual Trigger,
1=Iris,
Set auto
.10 int8 0 4 2=Shutter,
exposure mode
3=Iris + Shutter,
4=Shutter + Iris

Developer Information 44
Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

2
0.0=minimum,
.0 Mic level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0.0=minimum,
.1 Headphone level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Headphone 0.0=minimum,
.2 fixed16 0 1
program mix 1.0=maximum
0.0=minimum,
.3 Speaker level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Audio 0=internal mic,
1=line level input,
.4 Input type int8 0 2
2=low mic level input,
3=high mic level input
0.0=minimum,
[0] ch0 0 1
1.0=maximum
.5 Input levels fixed16
0.0=minimum,
[1] ch1 0 1
1.0=maximum
true = powered,
.6 Phantom power boolean
false = not powered
3
bit flags: [0] = display
status, [1] = display
frame guides
uint16
.0 Overlay enables Some cameras don't
bit field
allow separate control of
frame guides and
status overlays.
0=off, 1=2.4:1, 2=2.39:1,
Frame guides style [0] = frame
.1 int8 0 8 3=2.35:1, 4=1.85:1, 5=16:9,
(Camera 3.x) guides style
Output 6=14:9, 7=4:3
Frame guides opacity [1] = frame 0.0=transparent,
.2 fixed16 0.1 1
(Camera 3.x) guide opacity 1.0=opaque
0=off, 1=2.4:1, 2=2.39:1,
[0] = frame
3=2.35:1, 4=1.85:1, 5=16:9,
guides style
Overlays 6=14:9, 7=4:3
(replaces .1 and .2 [1] = frame 0=transparent,
.3 int8 0 100
abovefrom guide opacity 100=opaque
Cameras 4.0) percentage of full frame
[2] = safe area
0 100 used by safe area guide
percentage
(0 means off)
4
0.0=minimum,
.0 Brightness fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0x4 = zebra
Display int16
.1 Overlay enables 0x8 = peaking
bit field

0.0=minimum,
.2 Zebra level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

Developer Information 45
Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

0.0=minimum,
.3 Peaking level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0=disable bars,
Color bars display
.4 int8 0 30 1-30=enable bars with
time (seconds)
timeout (s)

Display [0] = focus 0=Peak,



assist method 1=Colored lines
0=Red,
.5 Focus Assist int8 1=Green,
[1] = focus
2=Blue,
line color
3=White,
4=Black
5
Sets the tally front and
tally rear brightness to
.0 Tally brightness fixed16 0 1 the same level.
0.0=minimum,
1.0=maximum
Sets the tally front
Tally brightness.
.1 Front tally brightness fixed16 0 1
0.0=minimum,
1.0=maximum
Sets the tally rear
brightness.
0.0=minimum,
.2 Rear tally brightness fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Tally rear brightness
cannot be turned off
6
0=internal,
int8
Reference .0 Source 0 2 1=program,
enum
2=external
.1 Offset int32 +/- offset in pixels
7
[0] time _ _ BCD - HHMMSSFF (UCT)
.0 Real Time Clock int32
[1] date _ _ BCD - YYYYMMDD
ISO-639-1 two character
.1 System language string _ _ _
language code
.2 Timezone int32 _ _ _ Minutes offset from UTC
BCD -
s0DDdddddddddddd
Confi- where s is the sign:
guration [0] latitude _ _ 0=north (+), 1=south (-);
DD degrees,
dddddddddddd
.3 Location int64 decimal degrees
BCD -
sDDDdddddddddddd
where s is the sign:
[1] longitude _ _
0=west (-), 1=east (+); DDD
degrees, dddddddddddd
decimal degrees

Developer Information 46
Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

8
[0] red -2 2 default 0.0
[1] green -2 2 default 0.0
.0 Lift Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -2 2 default 0.0
[3] luma -2 2 default 0.0
[0] red -4 4 default 0.0
[1] green -4 4 default 0.0
.1 Gamma Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -4 4 default 0.0
[3] luma -4 4 default 0.0
[0] red 0 16 default 1.0
[1] green 0 16 default 1.0
.2 Gain Adjust fixed16
Colour [2] blue 0 16 default 1.0
Correction [3] luma 0 16 default 1.0
[0] red -8 8 default 0.0
[1] green -8 8 default 0.0
.3 Offset Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -8 8 default 0.0
[3] luma -8 8 default 0.0
[0] pivot 0 1 default 0.5
.4 Contrast Adjust fixed16
[1] adj 0 2 default 1.0

.5 Luma mix fixed16 0 1 default 1.0

[0] hue -1 1 default 0.0


.6 Colour Adjust fixed16
[1] sat 0 2 default 1.0
Correction
.7 void reset to defaults
Reset Default
10
0 = RAW, 1 = DNxHD,
[0] = basic codec
2 = ProRes
RAW: 0=Uncompressed,
int8
.0 Codec 1=lossy 3:1, 2=lossy 4:1
enum [1] =
codec variant ProRes: 0=HQ, 1=422,
2=LT, 3=Proxy,
4=444, 5=444XQ
0=Preview,
[0] = mode
1=Play, 2=Record
Media
-ve = multiple speeds
backwards, 0 = pause,
[1] = speed
+ve = multiple
speeds forwards
.1 Transport mode int8 1<<0=loop, 1<<1=play all,
1<<5=disk1 active,
[2] = flags 1<<6=disk2 active,
1<<7=time-
lapse recording
[3] = active
0=CFast card, 1=SD
storage medium

Developer Information 47
Example Protocol Packets

Packet
Operation Length Byte

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15

header command data


destination

parameter
command

operation
reserved

category
length

type
trigger instantaneous
8 4 4 0 0 0 1 0 0
auto focus on camera 4

turn on OIS on all cameras 12 255 5 0 0 0 6 0 0 1 0 0 0

set exposure to 10 ms on
camera 4 (10 ms = 10000 12 4 8 0 0 1 5 3 0 0x10 0x27 0x00 0x00
us = 0x00002710)

add 15% to zebra level


12 4 6 0 0 4 2 128 1 0x33 0x01 0 0
(15 % = 0.15 f = 0x0133 fp)

select 1080p 23.98 mode on


16 255 9 0 0 1 0 1 0 24 1 3 0 0 0 0 0
all cameras

subtract 0.3 from gamma


adjust for green & blue 16 4 12 0 0 8 1 128 1 0 0 0x9a 0xfd 0x9a 0xfd 0 0
(-0.3 ~= 0xfd9a fp)

all operations combined 76 4 4 0 0 0 1 0 0 255 5 0 0 0 6 0 0

1 0 0 0 4 8 0 0 1 5 3 0 0x10 0x27 0x00 0x00

4 6 0 0 4 2 128 1 0x33 0x01 0 0 255 9 0 0

1 0 1 0 24 1 3 0 0 0 0 0 4 12 0 0

8 1 128 1 0 0 0x9a 0xfd 0x9a 0xfd 0 0

Developer Information 48
Blackmagic Embedded TallyControl Protocol
Version 1.0 (30/04/14)
This section is for third party developers or anybody who may wish to add support for the
Blackmagic Embedded Tally Control Protocol to their products or system. It describes the
protocol for sending tally information embedded in the non-active picture region of a digital
video stream.

Data Flow
A master device such as a broadcast switcher embeds tally information into its program feed
which is broadcast to a number of slave devices such as cameras or camera controllers.
The output from the slave devices is typically fed back to the master device, but may also be
sent to a video monitor.
The primary flow of tally information is from the master device to the slaves. Each slave device
may use its device id to extract and display the relevant tally information.
Slave devices pass through the tally packet on their output and update the monitor tally status,
so that monitor devices connected to that individual output may display tally status without
knowledge of the device id they are monitoring.

Assumptions
Any data alignment / padding is explicit in the protocol. Bit fields are packed from LSB first.

Blanking Encoding
One tally control packet may be sent per video frame. Packets are encoded as a SMPTE 291M
packet with DID/SDID x51/x52 in the active region of VANC line 15. A tally control packet may
contain up to 256 bytes of tally information.

Packet Format
Each tally status consists of 4 bits of information:
uint4
bit 0: program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0x0)
The first byte of the tally packet contains the monitor device tally status and a version number.
Subsequent bytes of the tally packet contain tally status for pairs of slave devices. The master
device sends tally status for the number of devices configured/supported, up to a
maximum of 510.

struct tally
uint8
bit 0: monitor device program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: monitor device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4-7: protocol version (0b0000)

Developer Information 49
uint8[0]
bit 0: slave device 1 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: slave device 1 device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4: slave device 2 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 5: slave device 2 preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 6-7: reserved (0b00)
uint8[1]
bit 0: slave device 3 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: slave device 3 device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4: slave device 4 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 5: slave device 4 preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 6-7: reserved (0b00)
...

Slave Device
(1)

Master Device Slave Device


(2)

Slave Device
Monitor Device
(3)

Byte 7 MSB 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LSB

Version Version Version Version Reserved Reserved Monitor Monitor


0
(0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

Reserved Reserved Slave 1 Slave 1 Reserved Reserved Slave 0 Slave 0


1
(0b0) (0b0) Preview Program (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

Reserved Reserved Slave 3 Slave 3 Reserved Reserved Slave 2 Slave 2


2
(0b0) (0b0) Preview Program (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

3 ...

Developer Information 50
Help
Getting Help
The fastest way to obtain help is to go to the Blackmagic Design online support pages and
check the latest support material available for your camera.

Blackmagic Design Online Support Pages


The latest manual, software and support notes can be found at the Blackmagic Design support
centre at www.blackmagicdesign.com/support.

Contacting Blackmagic Design Support


If you cant find the help you need in our support material, please use the Send us an email
button on the support page for your camera to email a support request. Alternatively, click on
the Find your local support team button on the support page and call your nearest Blackmagic
Design support office.

Checking the Software Version Currently Installed


To check which version of Blackmagic Camera Setup software is installed on your computer,
open the About Blackmagic Camera Setup window.
On Mac OS X, open Blackmagic Camera Setup from the Applications folder.
Select About Blackmagic Camera Setup from the application menu to reveal the
version number.
On Windows, open Blackmagic Camera Setup from your Start menu or Start Screen.
Click on the Help menu and select About Blackmagic Camera Setup to reveal the
version number.
How to Get the Latest Software Updates
After checking the version of Blackmagic Camera Setup software installed on your computer,
please visit the Blackmagic Support Center at www.blackmagicdesign.com/support to check for
the latest updates. While it is usually a good idea to run the latest updates, it is wise to avoid
updating any software if you are in the middle of an important project.

Battery Replacement
The Studio Cameras built in battery is not user-serviceable. Should the battery require
replacement, you will need to send it to your nearest Blackmagic Design service center for
replacement. If the camera is outside of its warranty period, the battery replacement will incur a
small service fee for the cost of the battery, labor and return of the camera to you. Please
contact Blackmagic Design Support to find out details of where to send your camera, how to
package it safely and how much the replacement will cost in your country.

NOTE Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 and Blackmagic Studio Camera 4K 2 do not have
internal batteries.

Help 51
Warranty
12 Month Limited Warranty
Blackmagic Design warrants that this product will be free from defects in materials and
workmanship for a period of 12 months from the date of purchase. If a product proves to be
defective during this warranty period, Blackmagic Design, at its option, either will repair the
defective product without charge for parts and labor, or will provide a replacement in exchange
for the defective product.
In order to obtain service under this warranty, you the Customer, must notify Blackmagic Design
of the defect before the expiration of the warranty period and make suitable arrangements for
the performance of service. The Customer shall be responsible for packaging and shipping the
defective product to a designated service center nominated by Blackmagic Design, with
shipping charges pre paid. Customer shall be responsible for paying all shipping charges,
insurance, duties, taxes, and any other charges for products returned to us for any reason.
This warranty shall not apply to any defect, failure or damage caused by improper use or
improper or inadequate maintenance and care. Blackmagic Design shall not be obligated to
furnish service under this warranty: a) to repair damage resulting from attempts by personnel
other than Blackmagic Design representatives to install, repair or service the product, b) to
repair damage resulting from improper use or connection to incompatible equipment, c) to
repair any damage or malfunction caused by the use of non Blackmagic Design parts or
supplies, or d) to service a product that has been modified or integrated with other products
when the effect of such a modification or integration increases the time or difficulty of servicing
the product. THIS WARRANTY IS GIVEN BY BLACKMAGIC DESIGN IN LIEU OF ANY OTHER
WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED. BLACKMAGIC DESIGN AND ITS VENDORS DISCLAIM
ANY IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE. BLACKMAGIC DESIGNS RESPONSIBILITY TO REPAIR OR REPLACE DEFECTIVE
PRODUCTS IS THE WHOLE AND EXCLUSIVE REMEDY PROVIDED TO THE CUSTOMER FOR
ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES IRRESPECTIVE OF
WHETHER BLACKMAGIC DESIGN OR THE VENDOR HAS ADVANCE NOTICE OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. BLACKMAGIC DESIGN IS NOT LIABLE FOR ANY ILLEGAL
USE OF EQUIPMENT BY CUSTOMER. BLACKMAGIC IS NOT LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES
RESULTING FROM USE OF THIS PRODUCT. USER OPERATES THIS PRODUCT AT OWN RISK.
Copyright 2017 Blackmagic Design. All rights reserved. Blackmagic Design, DeckLink, HDLink, Workgroup Videohub,
Multibridge Pro, Multibridge Extreme, Intensity and Leading the creative video revolution are registered trademarks in the
US and other countries. All other company and product names may be trade marks of their respective companies with which
they are associated.

Warranty 52
/

Blackmagic

20176


Blackmagic Studio Camera

Blackmagic Studio CameraMicro Studio Camera 4K


10

Blackmagic Studio Camera

Blackmagic Studio Camera

MFT

HyperDeck
Shuttle

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4KBlackmagic Studio Camera


Ultra HD
ATEM

Blackmagic Design CEO



Blackmagic Studio Camera

53 Remote 73
53 74
53 75
54
75
57 76
Blackmagic Studio Camera 57 Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino
Blackmagic Micro Studio Shield
Camera 4K 59 76
61 Blackmagic Camera Setup 78
Blackmagic Studio Camera - 61
79
Blackmagic Studio Camera - 62
Blackmagic Micro Studio 79
Camera 4K - 63 79
Blackmagic Micro Studio ATEM Software Control 79
Camera 4K - 64
79
65 81
Blackmagic Micro Studio DaVinci Resolve
Camera 4K 65 86
Blackmagic Micro Studio
Camera 4K 66
Developer Information 89
Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol 89
67
Blackmagic Embedded
67
TallyControl Protocol 97
Audio 69
99
Monitoring 70
Studio 72 100

Blackmagic Studio CameraBlackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

Blackmagic Camera
Off

1

2
3 12

1 1
1

1
PUSH

PUSH
3

3
2

2 2
1

1
PUSH

PUSH
3

3
2

Studio Camera/

Micro Studio Camera 4K/

1 LCDBlackmagic Studio CameraStudio Camera 4K


LCD
2

Blackmagic Studio Camera HDStudio Camera 4K


Studio Camera

Blackmagic Studio Camera 2Studio Camera 4K 2

53
Micro Studio Camera 4KLP-E6LP-E6N
/

Micro Studio Camera 4K


1

2
ATEM Converter

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN

SDI IN

REF

REF

12V

12V

ACStudio Camera

Blackmagic Studio CameraMicro Studio Camera 4KATEMSDI

SDI
1 Blackmagic Studio CameraMicro Studio Camera 4KSDIATEM
SDI
2 ATEMSDIMulti ViewStudio
CameraSDIMulti View
SDI

SFP Optical Module


Blackmagic Studio CameraATEM Switcher
2845km

ATEM Studio ConverterATEM Talkback
Conver ter 4K
Connection Diagrams

54
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 1 IN 3 1 1 3 1 REMOTE REMOTE
1 3 5 1 7 3 9 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH
STEREO IN

CONTROL CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 IN 2 2 HD 2 HD HD HD HD HD
1 2 4 1 6 2 8 4 10 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 REF IN
PREVIEW AUXPROGRAM
1-3 PREVIEW
OUTPUTS PROGRAM OUTPUTS
MULTI-VIEW MULTI-VIEW
ANALOG AUDIO IN

IN IN IN IN IN 1 3 1 REMOTE
All SDI and HDMI video connections are
1 3 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH SD, HD and Ultra HD switchable unless indicated

CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 2 HD HD HD
1 2 4 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2 CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 PREVIEW PROGRAM OUTPUTS MULTI-VIEW ANALOG AUDIO IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT

ATEMSDISDI
ATEMSDISDI


ATEM Software Control


1 ATEM Software Control
2
1Studio Camera
1 1: Camera 1

3 Blackmagic Studio CameraMENUStudio Settings > Camera Number
Studio Camera 1
ATEMCam 1Camera Number1


Blackmagic Studio CameraPGM
ATEM

1Studio Camera


Blackmagic Studio CameraATEM Software ControlATEM

ATEM Software Control

/ 1C am 1
On Air
Cam 1
ATEM Software Control

55

Blackmagic Studio CameraBlackmagic HyperDeck
StudioHyperDeck Shuttle
Blackmagic Video AssistStudio CameraISO

Blackmagic Studio Camera


Blackmagic
Studio Camera

56

Blackmagic Studio Camera

2
3

4
1

PUSH
5 2

PUSH

2 LANC
LANC2.5mm

3
0.25TRSPGM/

4
0.206TRS

5

1/4 XLR 2
Blackmagic Studio Camera -

57

6 /OPTICAL IN/OUT
SFP
2845km
7 SDISDI OUT
SDI
8 SDISDI IN
SDIPGM
9 REF
3
10
12-24V
Blackmagic Studio Camera -

12
11

6 OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

7 SDI OUT

8 SDI IN

9 REF

13 14 15 16 17 18 19 18 20 21 22 10 12V

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU

11 10LCD


12

13 FOCUS
12LCD
14 IRIS
1
15 PTT
2

16 PGM

17 LUT

58
18
LCD
12V

19 SET REF


SDI IN

20 DISPLAY
SDI OUT

/
OPTICAL IN

21 MENU
OPTICAL OUT

LCD
22
Blackmagic Studio Camera

23 USB

USB miniBlackmagic Camera


Setup

23

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

1


-
-
-
-
Micro Studio Camera 4K

1 2 4
5
6
7
3
8
PUSH

2
PUSH

59

2 HDMI
HDMIBlackmagic Video Assist

1080HD/


3
DB-HD15
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
4 MENU
HDMI

5

6

7 SET

8
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

9
3.5mmmin/line
10 SDISDI OUT
SDI
11 SDISDI IN
SDIATEMBlackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield

12 /
3.5mmiPhone/
/21

10
13
11

12

60

13
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4KLP-E61

14

15 USB
USBBlackmagic Camera
Setup

14

15

Blackmagic Studio Camera -


LANC

L A N C2. 5 m m

MFTLANC

Panasonic Lumix G X Vario PZ 14-42mm f/3.5-5.6 Power O.I.S.


Panasonic Lumix G X Vario PZ 45-175mm f/4.0-5.6 Zoom O.I.S.
Olympus M.Zuiko Digital ED 12-50mm f/3.5-6.3 EZ Micro 4/3
Olympus M.Zuiko Digital ED 14-42mm f/3.5-5.6 EZ Micro 4/3

PGM/

SDI15161516

61

SDI
1516

2XLR
mic/line
SDI
12

1
1
PUSH

3
2

2
1
PUSH

3
2

Blackmagic Studio Camera -


/OPTICAL IN/OUT
SFP
LCStudio Camera HD3G-SDIStudio Camera 4K
6G-SDI

2845km
SDI
Blackmagic Studio CameraSFP
Blackmagic Design
www.blackmagicdesign.com/jp/resellers/

SDISDI OUT
SDISDI
SDI10-bit 4:2:2Blackmagic Studio Camera HD3G-SDIStudio
Camera 4K12G-SDI

SDISDI IN
SDIPGMPGM
/
SDI
Studio CameraBlackmagic HyperDeck Shuttle
HyperDeckSDI

62
REF
3

12 24VBlackmagic Studio Camera HDBlackmagic Studio Camera


4KStudio Camera HD
4Studio Camera 4K3
Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 Studio Camera 4K 2

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN

REF

12V

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K -


HDMI
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4KHDMI10-bit 4:2:2 1080p2
Blackmagic Video AssistHDHDMI
Micro Studio Camera 4K

HDMI2160p30
HDMI1080p30

MENU
EXPANSION

SET

63

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
Micro Studio Camera 4K

Micro Studio Camera 4K


ATEMSDI

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4KDB-HD15LANC

Micro
Studio Camera 4K Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K -

3.5mmmic/line

SDISDI OUT
SDISDI
SDI10-bit 4:2:2Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K6G-SDI
SDIDIN 1.0/2.3 - SDI

SDISDI IN
SDIATEMMicro Studio Camera 4K

Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino ShieldMicro Studio Camera


ATEM
BlackmagicSDI
SDISDI
ATEM
Blackmagic

64
/
3.5mm/iPhone/
/2
1SDI1516

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K


21Micro Studio Camera 4
1

4 Micro Studio Cam MSC Breakout Cable Micro Studio Cam MSC Breakout Cable

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

1
12VDCMicro Studio Camera 4K


2
3


3 LANC
LANC2.5mm

4 //
RS-422Micro Studio Camera 4KSDI//

65
5 B4
DB-9MFT - B4Micro Studio Camera 4KB4
/B4Digital
B4 Control AdapterDB-9

MFTATEM
Micro Studio Camera 4K
B4
Blackmagic Designhttps://www.blackmagicdesign.com/jp/support/
faq/59011
6 S.Bus
S.BusFutaba J18S.Bus

S.Bus

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K


Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K12
B412V



P1
P2P7

P1 PIN ASSIGNMENT
2 S. Bus 1
2 P2
GROUND 3

GROUND 1
12 PTZ RS422 Rx- 2
8 PTZ RS422 Tx+ 3 5
9
GROUND 4 4

GROUND
5
6
3
2
8
7 P3
6
13 PTZ RS422 Rx+ 7 1

3 PTZ RS422 Tx- 8


GROUND 9

5 15
GROUND 1
10 14 B4 Lens Control Transmit 2 5
9
4 14 4
15 B4 Lens Control Receive 3
P4
9 8
3 13 3
8 GROUND 4 2
7
2
7
12 6 Power +12V in* 5 1
6
1 11 OTHER
6

5 Reference Input CENTER


GROUND SLEEVE P5
1 Ground 6 Power +12V in 11 Ground LANC Data
9 TIP
2
3
S. Bus
PTZ RS422 Tx-
7
8
Ground
PTZ RS422 Tx+
12
13
PTZ RS422 Rx-
PTZ RS422 Rx+
10
GROUND
LANC Power RING
SLEEVE
P6
4 Ground 9 LANC Data 14 B4 Lens Control Transmit
5 Reference Input 10 LANC Power 15 B4 Lens Control Receive
6 Power +12V in PIN
GROUND SLEEVE P7

* Power input to the camera is also used to power the lens. Beware of applying excessive voltages if youre using
your own power supply to avoid damage to the lens.

66

Blackmagic

Blackmagic Studio CameraBlackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4KMENU


SET

Micro Studio Camera 4KHDMI

Video Format
For example, to select between
1080p1080i
SET

Gain
0dB
6dB18dB

Detail
Studio Camera
OffDefaultLowMediumHigh

Auto Exposure
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
Iris

Shutter

Camera- Blackmagic Studio Camera

67
Iris + Shutter
/
Micro Studio Camera 4K

Shutter + Iris
/
Micro Studio Camera 4K

Manual Trigger

White Balance
18
250028003000320034003600400045004800K
/

5000520054005600K
60006500K7000K8000K

Shutter Speed
1/501/2000
15

Camera- Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

Blackmagic Studio Camera

Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Micro


Camera Camera 4K Studio Camera 4K

720p50 720p50 1080i50

720p59.94 720p59.94 1080i59.94

720p60 720p60 1080i60

1080i50 1080i50 1080p23.98

68
Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Micro
Camera Camera 4K Studio Camera 4K

1080i59.94 1080i59.94 1080p24

1080i60 1080i60 1080p25

1080p23.98 1080p23.98 1080p29.97

1080p24 1080p24 1080p30

1080p25 1080p25 1080p50

1080p29.97 1080p29.97 1080p59.94

1080p30 1080p30 1080p60

1080p50 1080p50 2160p23.98

1080p59.94 1080p59.94 2160p24

1080p60 1080p60 2160p25

2160p23.98 2160p29.97

2160p24 2160p30

2160p25

2160p29.97

2160p30

2160p50

2160p59.94

2160p60

Audio
MENU
Blackmagic Studio Camera

SET

AudioBlackmagic Studio Camera

69

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

Audio Input
XLR

Microphone Level

Studio Camera
12

Input Level
mic/line
Line Mic LowMic High

1 Ch 1 Input
1
1

21Ch 2 Uses Ch 1 Input


SDI121
1
1
11
22

2
1
2

Phantom Power
XLR
/ Audio
OnOff
Input LevelsLine
10

Monitoring
MENU
LCD
SET

70
MonitoringBlackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

HDMIHDMI Meters
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4KHDMI

Histgram

/HDMI Overlays

Audio
2

/HDMI Overlays

HDMIHDMI Overlays
Micro Studio Camera 4K On
HDMI Meters HDMI

Brightness
LC D
60

Zebra
Blackmagic Camera100%

Medium

71
Focus Peaking
OffLowMediumHigh

Medium

Front Tally Brightness


OffLowMediumHigh
Medium

Rear Tally Brightness


LowMediumHigh
Medium

Tally Light Brightness


Micro Studio Camera 4KMedium
OffLowHigh
Off

Display Battery Percentage


LP-E6
Micro Studio Camera 4K

Studio
MENU
LCD
S E T

Studio- Blackmagic Studio Camera

Camera Number
ATEMStudio Camera

1-990

72
SDIBlackmagic
3G-SDI Arduino Shield
SDIBlackmagic 3G-SDI
Arduino Shield Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino
Shield

Reference Source
Studio CameraSDI

Reference Timing
/

Headset Level

50

Headset Mic Level

50

Program Mix
LCD

Remote
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
S.BusS.Bus
SET

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

73

Blackmagic Studio Camera

LCD
SDI

FOCUS
Studio Camera FOCUS/
FOCUS1 FOCUS2

FOCUS1

IRIS
IRIS1
Video
Film IRIS
Studio Camera

PTT

PTT2

PGM

S D I

LUT

SET

DISPLAY
Studio Camera10

F
Disp
10SDI

Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 Studio Camera 4K 2


74
OPTICAL OUT MENU

OPTICAL IN


SDI OUT

SDI IN Blackmagic Studio Camera

REF

12V

OPTICAL OUT OPTICAL OUT OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN OPTICAL IN OPTICAL IN

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT FOCUS IRIS SET PTT PGM LUT
DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRISSET PTT PGM DISPLAY
LUT MENU SET DISPLAY MENU
SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT

SDI IN SDI IN SDI IN

REF REF REF

12V 12V 12V

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU

FOCUS1 IRIS StudioCameraPTTPGM


FOCUS
2



Blackmagic Studio Camera10-bit 4:2:2SDI
SFP
ATEM Camera Converter
Blackmagic Studio Camera HDStudio Camera 4KStudio
CameraSDISFP


Blackmagic Studio Camera
3VTR

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

OPTICAL OUT

SDI IN
OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

REF
SDI IN

REF

12V

12V

SDISFP
Studio Camera

75

Studio CameraSDIBlackmagic HyperDeck Shuttle
SSDSDIHyperDeckSDIStudio CameraSDI
LCD

+12V POWER HDMI IN HDMI OUT SDI IN SDI OUT

+12V POWER HDMI IN HDMI OUT SDI IN SDI OUT

SDIHyperDeckSDIHyperDeckSDI
Studio CameraSDI

Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield

SDIBlackmagic 3G-SDI
Arduino ShieldBlackmagic Studio CameraATEM
SDIBlackmagic

BlackmagicD2 - D9
SDIBlackmagic Mini Converter SDI Distribution
BlackmagicBlackmagic8
Blackmagic

GNDArduinoGND

BlackmagicBlackmagic Arduino

Blackmagic
Arduino

1 1 D2

2 2 D3

3 3 D4

4 4 D5

5 5 D6

6 6 D7

7 7 D8

8 8 D9

Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield 76


Arduino
Blackmagic ArduinoSDI
Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino ShieldBlackmagic
3G-SDI Arduino ShieldBlackmagic
Designwww.blackmagicdesign.com/jp/support

Blackmagic Arduino12
SDI

Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield 77


1

PUSH
2

PUSH
Blackmagic Camera Setup
Mac OS X
Blackmagic Camera Setupzip
.dmg Blackmagic Camera Setup

Blackmagic Camera Setup


PUSH

2
PUSH

Windows
Blackmagic Camera Setupzip
Blackmagic Camera Setup

Windows All Programs
Blackmagic DesignBlackmagic Camera


Blackmagic CameraUSB
Mini-B USB 2.0
Blackmagic Camera Setup

Mini-B USB 2.0

Blackmagic Camera Setup 78


Studio CameraLCD

1 Studio Camera6
2 2

LANC
Studio Camera2

1
1
PUSH

3
2

2
1
PUSH

3
2

ATEM Software Control

Blackmagic Studio CameraATEM Software ControlATEM


Camera

DaVinci Resolve

ATEMATEMSDI
ATEMSDI
SDI
SDISFP

ATEM Software Control 79


ATEM

SDI
1 Blackmagic Studio CameraSDIATEMSDI
2 ATEMSDIMulti ViewStudio
CameraSDIMulti View
SDI
3 Blackmagic Studio CameraMENUStudio Settings > Camera Number
Studio Camera 1ATEM
Cam 1Camera Number1

IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 1 IN 3 1 1 3 1 REMOTE REMOTE
1 3 5 1 7 3 9 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH
STEREO IN

CONTROL CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 IN 2 2 HD 2 HD HD HD HD HD
1 2 4 1 6 2 8 4 10 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 REF IN
PREVIEW AUXPROGRAM
1-3 PREVIEW
OUTPUTS PROGRAM OUTPUTS
MULTI-VIEW MULTI-VIEW
ANALOG AUDIO IN

IN IN IN IN IN 1 3 1 REMOTE
All SDI and HDMI video connections are
1 3 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH SD, HD and Ultra HD switchable unless indicated

CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 2 HD HD HD
1 2 4 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2 CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 PREVIEW PROGRAM OUTPUTS MULTI-VIEW ANALOG AUDIO IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT

Blackmagic Studio Camera ATEMSDI

ATEM Software Control 80



1 Studio CameraSFP
Optical Out/InATEM Studio ConverterOptical Out/In
2 ATEM Studio ConverterSDIATEMSDI
3 ATEMSDIMulti ViewATEM Studio
ConverterSDIMulti View
SDI
4 Blackmagic Studio CameraMENUStudio Settings > Camera Number
Studio Camera 1ATEM
Cam 1Camera Number1

ATEM Software Control Preferences
Blackmagic Studio
CameraPGM

AES/EBU TALKBACK LOOPS

3 1 4 2 OUT
3OUT OUT
4

L R

UT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT IN IN SDI OUT IN

L +12V
R BACKUP L L R R L L R R L R
POWER USB 2.0
OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN
OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG
ANALOG AUDIO OUTAUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO
OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG
OUT AUDIO OUT PGM SDI OPTICAL
MICOUT/IN H/PHONE ANALOG AUDIO OUT OP

AES/EBU TALKBACK LOOPS

1 2 3 4 OUT OUT OUT

L R

SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT IN IN IN

+12V BACKUP L R L R L R L R
POWER USB 2.0 OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT PGM SDI MIC H/PHONE

Blackmagic Studio Camera ATEM Studio Converter


ATEM Software Control
/





Aux
AuxAux

ATEM Software Control 81



On Air



YRGB

DaVinci ResolveYRGB
3

YRGB

Blackmagic Studio CameraMicro Studio Camera


URSA Mini

/

Blackmagic
/

ATEM Software Control 82


/
Blackmagic

//

Paste to all

Paste to all


/
/

ATEM Software Control 83


/

/
SHIFT

/Maccommand
WindowsCONTROL

SDI
Blackmagic
Studio CameraBlackmagic Studio Camera 4K
1.9.11MFT

ATEM Software Control 84


dB

ATEM Software Control 85




DaVinci Resolve

CCU

Blackmagic Studio CameraDaVinci Resolve


Blackmagic Studio CameraDaVinci Resolve
DaVinci Resolve

DaVinci Resolve

//

ATEM Software Control 86


//


RGB






YRGB


YRGB
YALTCommand
YRGB
YY
YRGB
RGBDaVinci ResolveYRGB

ATEM Software Control 87



50

50

180

Blackmagic Studio CameraDaVinci Resolve


DaVinci Resolve1980
DaVinci Resolve
Blackmagic Studio Camera
YRGB1
RGBYRGBYRGB

YRGB100
RGB100
RGBYRGB

ATEMStudio CameraATEMBlackmagic
Studio CameraStudio Camera

ATEM Software Control 88


Developer Information
Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol
Version 1.1
If you are a software developer you can use the SDI Camera Control Protocol to construct devices
that integrate with our products. Here at Blackmagic Design our approach is to open up our protocols
and we eagerly look forward to seeing what you come up with!

Overview
The Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol is used by ATEM switchers, Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino
Shield and Blackmagic Camera Remote to provide Camera Control functionality with supported
Blackmagic Design cameras. Please refer to the Understanding Studio Camera Control chapter
section of this manual, or the ATEM Switchers Manual and SDKmanual for more information. These
can be downloaded at www.blackmagicdesign.com/support.
This document describes an extensible protocol for sending a uni directional stream of small control
messages embedded in the non-active picture region of a digital video stream. Thevideo stream
containing the protocol stream may be broadcast to a number of devices. Device addressing is used
to allow the sender to specify which device each message is directed to.

Assumptions
Alignment and padding constraints are explicitly described in the protocol document. Bit fields are
packed from LSB first. Message groups, individual messages and command headers are defined as,
and can be assumed to be, 32 bit aligned.

Blanking Encoding
A message group is encoded into a SMPTE 291M packet with DID/SDID x51/x53 in the active region
of VANC line 16.

Message Grouping
Up to 32 messages may be concatenated and transmitted in one blanking packet up to a maximum
of 255 bytes payload. Under most circumstances, this should allow all messages to be sent with a
maximum of one frame latency.
If the transmitting device queues more bytes of message packets than can be sent in a single frame,
it should use heuristics to determine which packets to prioritize and send immediately. Lower priority
messages can be delayed to later frames, or dropped entirely as appropriate.

Abstract Message Packet Format


Every message packet consists of a three byte header followed by an optional variable length data
block. The maximum packet size is 64 bytes.

Device addresses are represented as an 8 bit unsigned integer. Individual


Destination device (uint8) devices are numbered 0 through 254 with the value 255 reserved to
indicate a broadcast message to all devices.

The command length is an 8 bit unsigned integer which specifies the length
Command length (uint8) of the included command data. The length does NOT include the length of
the header or any trailing padding bytes.

89
The command id is an 8 bit unsigned integer which indicates themessage
type being sent. Receiving devices should ignore any commands that they
Command id (uint8) do not understand. Commands 0 through 127 are reserved for commands
that apply to multiple types of devices. Commands 128 through 255 are
device specific.

This byte is reserved for alignment and expansion purposes. Itshould be


Reserved (uint8)
set to zero.

The command data may contain between 0 and 60 bytes of data. The format
Command data(uint8[])
of the data section is defined by the command itself.

Messages must be padded up to a 32 bit boundary with 0x0bytes. Any


Padding(uint8[])
padding bytes are NOT included in the command length.

Receiving devices should use the destination device address and or the command identifier to
determine which messages to process. The receiver should use the command length to skip irrelevant
or unknown commands and should be careful to skip the implicit padding as well.

Defined Commands
Command 0 : change configuration

The category number specifies one of up to 256 configuration categories


Category (uint8)
available on the device.

The parameter number specifies one of 256 potential configuration


parameters available on the device. Parameters 0 through 127 are device
Parameter (uint8)
specific parameters. Parameters 128 though 255 are reserved for parameters
that apply to multiple types of devices.

The data type specifies the type of the remaining data. Thepacket length is
Data type (uint8) used to determine the number of elements in the message. Each message
must contain an integral number of data elements.

Currently defined values are:

A void value is represented as a boolean array of length zero.


0: void / boolean The data field is a 8 bit value with 0 meaning false and all other values
meaning true.

1: signed byte Data elements are signed bytes

2: signed 16bit integer Data elements are signed 16 bit values

3: signed 32bit integer Data elements are signed 32 bit values

4: signed 64bit integer Data elements are signed 64 bit values

5: UTF-8 string Data elements represent a UTF-8 string with no terminating character.

Data types 6 through 127 are reserved.

Data elements are signed 16 bit integers representing a real number with 5
bits for the integer component and 11 bits for the fractional component.
128: signed 5.11fixed point The fixed point representation is equal to the real value multiplied by 2^11.
The representable range is from -16.0 to 15.9995
(15 + 2047/2048).

90
Data types 129 through 255 are available for device specific purposes.

The operation type specifies what action to perform on the specified


Operation type (uint8)
parameter. Currently defined values are:

The supplied values are assigned to the specified parameter. Each element
will be clamped according to its valid range. A void parameter may only be
0: assign value assigned an empty list of boolean type. This operation will trigger the
action associated with that parameter. A boolean value may be assigned the
value zero for false, and any other value for true.

Each value specifies signed offsets of the same type to be added to the
current parameter values. The resulting parameter value will be clamped
1: offset / toggle value according to their valid range. It is not valid to apply an offset to a void
value. Applying any offset other than zero to a boolean value will invert
that value.

Operation types 2 through 127 are reserved.

Operation types 128through 255 are available for device specific purposes.

The data field is 0 or more bytes as determined by the data type and
Data (void)
number of elements.

The category, parameter, data type and operation type partition a 24 bit operation space.

Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

.0 Focus fixed16 0 1 0.0=near, 1.0=far

trigger
.1 Instantaneous autofocus void
instantaneous autofocus

Aperture Value (where


.2 Aperture (f-stop) fixed16 -1 16
fnumber = sqrt(2^AV))

.3 Aperture (normalised) fixed16 0 1 0.0=smallest, 1.0=largest

Steps through available


aperture values from
.4 Aperture (ordinal) int16 0 n
minimum (0) to
maximum (n)

Instantaneous trigger instantaneous


.5 void
Lens auto aperture auto aperture

Optical image true=enabled,


.6 boolean
stabilisation false=disabled

Move to specified focal


length in mm, from
.7 Set absolute zoom (mm) int16 0 max
minimum (0) to
maximum (max)

Set absolute zoom Move to specified focal


.8 fixed16 0 1
(normalised) length: 0.0=wide, 1.0=tele

Start/stop zooming at
Set continuous specified rate: -1.0=zoom
.9 fixed16 -1 +1.0
zoom (speed) wider fast, 0.0=stop,
+1=zoom tele fast

91
Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

[0] = frame rate 24, 25, 30, 50, 60

[1] = M-rate 0=regular, 1=M-rate

0=NTSC, 1=PAL, 2=720,


[2] = dimensions 3=1080, 4=2k, 5=2k DCI,
.0 Video mode int8 6=4k, 7=4k DCI

0=progressive,
[3] = interlaced
1=interlaced

[4] =
0=YUV
colour space

.1 Sensor Gain int8 1 16 1x, 2x, 4x, 8x, 16x gain

int16 color temp 2500 10000 Colour temperature in K


.2 Manual White Balance
int16 tint -50 50 tint

Calculate and set auto


.3 Set auto WB void
white balance

Use latest auto white


.4 Restore auto WB void
balance setting

.5 Exposure (us) int32 1 42000 time in us

Steps through
availableexposure
.6 Exposure (ordinal) int16 0 n
valuesfrom minimum (0)
tomaximum (n)

.7 Dynamic Range Mode int8 enum 0 1 0 = film, 1 = video


Video
.8 Video sharpening level int8 enum 0 3

fps as integer
[0] = file
(eg 24, 25, 30,
frame rate
50, 60, 120)

fps as integer, valid when


sensor-off-speed set
[1] = sensor (eg 24,25, 30, 33, 48, 50,

frame rate 60, 120), no change will
beperformed if this value
is set to 0

[2] = frame width in pixels


.9 Recording format int16
[3] = frame height in pixels

[0]=file-M-rate

[1]=sensor-M-rate,
valid when sensor-
off-speed-set
[4] = flags
[2]=sensor-off-speed

[3]=interlaced

[4]=windowed mode

0=Manual Trigger,
1=Iris,
.10 Set auto exposure mode int8 0 4 2=Shutter,
3=Iris + Shutter,
4=Shutter + Iris

92
Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

0.0=minimum,
.0 Mic level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

0.0=minimum,
.1 Headphone level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

0.0=minimum,
.2 Headphone program mix fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

0.0=minimum,
.3 Speaker level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Audio
0=internal mic,
1=line level input,
.4 Input type int8 0 2
2=low mic level input,
3=high mic level input

0.0=minimum,
[0] ch0 0 1
1.0=maximum
.5 Input levels fixed16
0.0=minimum,
[1] ch1 0 1
1.0=maximum

true = powered,
.6 Phantom power boolean
false = not powered

bit flags: [0] = display


status, [1] = display
frame guides
uint16
.0 Overlay enables Some cameras don't allow
bit field
separate control of frame
guides and
status overlays.

0=off, 1=2.4:1, 2=2.39:1,


Frame guides style [0] = frame
.1 int8 0 8 3=2.35:1, 4=1.85:1, 5=16:9,
(Camera 3.x) guides style
Output 6=14:9, 7=4:3

Frame guides opacity [1] = frame 0.0=transparent,


.2 fixed16 0.1 1
(Camera 3.x) guide opacity 1.0=opaque

0=off, 1=2.4:1, 2=2.39:1,


[0] = frame
3=2.35:1, 4=1.85:1, 5=16:9,
guides style
6=14:9, 7=4:3
Overlays
(replaces .1 and .2 [1] = frame 0=transparent,
.3 int8 0 100
abovefrom guide opacity 100=opaque
Cameras 4.0)
percentage of full frame
[2] = safe area
0 100 used by safe area guide
percentage
(0 means off)

0.0=minimum,
.0 Brightness fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

0x4 = zebra
Display int16
.1 Overlay enables 0x8 = peaking
bit field

0.0=minimum,
.2 Zebra level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

93
Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

0.0=minimum,
.3 Peaking level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

0=disable bars,
Color bars display
.4 int8 0 30 1-30=enable bars with
time (seconds)
timeout (s)

Display [0] = focus 0=Peak,



assist method 1=Colored lines

0=Red,
.5 Focus Assist int8 1=Green,
[1] = focus
2=Blue,
line color
3=White,
4=Black

Sets the tally front and


tally rear brightness to the
.0 Tally brightness fixed16 0 1 same level.
0.0=minimum,
1.0=maximum

Sets the tally front


Tally brightness.
.1 Front tally brightness fixed16 0 1
0.0=minimum,
1.0=maximum

Sets the tally rear


brightness.
0.0=minimum,
.2 Rear tally brightness fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Tally rear brightness
cannot be turned off

0=internal,
Reference .0 Source int8 enum 0 2 1=program,
2=external

.1 Offset int32 +/- offset in pixels

[0] time _ _ BCD - HHMMSSFF (UCT)


.0 Real Time Clock int32
[1] date _ _ BCD - YYYYMMDD

ISO-639-1 two character


.1 System language string _ _ _
language code

.2 Timezone int32 _ _ _ Minutes offset from UTC

BCD -
Confi- s0DDdddddddddddd
guration where s is the sign:
[0] latitude _ _
0=north (+), 1=south (-); DD
degrees, dddddddddddd
decimal degrees
.3 Location int64
BCD -
sDDDdddddddddddd
where s is the sign:
[1] longitude _ _
0=west (-), 1=east (+); DDD
degrees, dddddddddddd
decimal degrees

94
Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

[0] red -2 2 default 0.0

[1] green -2 2 default 0.0


.0 Lift Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -2 2 default 0.0

[3] luma -2 2 default 0.0

[0] red -4 4 default 0.0

[1] green -4 4 default 0.0


.1 Gamma Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -4 4 default 0.0

[3] luma -4 4 default 0.0

[0] red 0 16 default 1.0

[1] green 0 16 default 1.0


Colour .2 Gain Adjust fixed16
[2] blue 0 16 default 1.0
Correction
[3] luma 0 16 default 1.0

[0] red -8 8 default 0.0

[1] green -8 8 default 0.0


.3 Offset Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -8 8 default 0.0

[3] luma -8 8 default 0.0

[0] pivot 0 1 default 0.5


.4 Contrast Adjust fixed16
[1] adj 0 2 default 1.0

.5 Luma mix fixed16 0 1 default 1.0

[0] hue -1 1 default 0.0


.6 Colour Adjust fixed16
[1] sat 0 2 default 1.0

.7 Correction Reset Default void reset to defaults

10

0 = RAW, 1 = DNxHD,
[0] = basic codec
2 = ProRes

RAW: 0=Uncompressed,
int8
.0 Codec 1=lossy 3:1, 2=lossy 4:1
enum [1] =
codec variant ProRes: 0=HQ, 1=422,
2=LT, 3=Proxy,
4=444, 5=444XQ

0=Preview,
[0] = mode
Media 1=Play, 2=Record

-ve = multiple speeds


backwards, 0 = pause, +ve
[1] = speed
= multiple
speeds forwards
.1 Transport mode int8
1<<0=loop, 1<<1=play all,
1<<5=disk1 active,
[2] = flags
1<<6=disk2 active,
1<<7=time-lapse recording

[3] = active
0=CFast card, 1=SD
storage medium

95
Example Protocol Packets

Length
Packet
Operation Byte

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15

header command data

destination

parameter
command

operation
reserved

category
length

type
trigger instantaneous auto
8 4 4 0 0 0 1 0 0
focus on camera 4

turn on OIS on all cameras 12 255 5 0 0 0 6 0 0 1 0 0 0

set exposure to 10 ms on
camera 4 (10 ms = 10000 12 4 8 0 0 1 5 3 0 0x10 0x27 0x00 0x00
us = 0x00002710)

add 15% to zebra level


12 4 6 0 0 4 2 128 1 0x33 0x01 0 0
(15 % = 0.15 f = 0x0133 fp)

select 1080p 23.98 mode


16 255 9 0 0 1 0 1 0 24 1 3 0 0 0 0 0
on all cameras

subtract 0.3 from gamma


adjust for green & blue 16 4 12 0 0 8 1 128 1 0 0 0x9a 0xfd 0x9a 0xfd 0 0
(-0.3 ~= 0xfd9a fp)

all operations combined 76 4 4 0 0 0 1 0 0 255 5 0 0 0 6 0 0

1 0 0 0 4 8 0 0 1 5 3 0 0x10 0x27 0x00 0x00

4 6 0 0 4 2 128 1 0x33 0x01 0 0 255 9 0 0

1 0 1 0 24 1 3 0 0 0 0 0 4 12 0 0

8 1 128 1 0 0 0x9a 0xfd 0x9a 0xfd 0 0

96
Blackmagic Embedded TallyControl Protocol
Version 1.0 (30/04/14)
This section is for third party developers or anybody who may wish to add support for the Blackmagic
Embedded Tally Control Protocol to their products or system. It describes the protocol for sending
tally information embedded in the non-active picture region of a digital video stream.

Data Flow
A master device such as a broadcast switcher embeds tally information into its program feed which
is broadcast to a number of slave devices such as cameras or camera controllers. The output from
the slave devices is typically fed back to the master device, but may also be sent to a video monitor.
The primary flow of tally information is from the master device to the slaves. Each slave device may
use its device id to extract and display the relevant tally information.
Slave devices pass through the tally packet on their output and update the monitor tally status, so
that monitor devices connected to that individual output may display tally status without knowledge
of the device id they are monitoring.

Assumptions
Any data alignment / padding is explicit in the protocol. Bit fields are packed from LSB first.

Blanking Encoding
One tally control packet may be sent per video frame. Packets are encoded as a SMPTE 291M packet
with DID/SDID x51/x52 in the active region of VANC line 15. A tally control packet may contain up to
256 bytes of tally information.

Packet Format
Each tally status consists of 4 bits of information:
uint4
bit 0: program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0x0)
The first byte of the tally packet contains the monitor device tally status and a version number.
Subsequent bytes of the tally packet contain tally status for pairs of slave devices. The master device
sends tally status for the number of devices configured/supported, up to a maximum of 510.

struct tally
uint8
bit 0: monitor device program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: monitor device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4-7: protocol version (0b0000)

97
uint8[0]
bit 0: slave device 1 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: slave device 1 device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4: slave device 2 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 5: slave device 2 preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 6-7: reserved (0b00)
uint8[1]
bit 0: slave device 3 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: slave device 3 device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4: slave device 4 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 5: slave device 4 preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 6-7: reserved (0b00)
...

Slave Device
(1)

Master Device Slave Device


(2)

Slave Device
Monitor Device
(3)

Byte 7 MSB 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LSB

Version Version Version Version Reserved Reserved Monitor Monitor


0
(0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

Reserved Reserved Slave 1 Slave 1 Reserved Reserved Slave 0 Slave 0


1
(0b0) (0b0) Preview Program (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

Reserved Reserved Slave 3 Slave 3 Reserved Reserved Slave 2 Slave 2


2
(0b0) (0b0) Preview Program (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

3 ...

98

Blackmagic DesignBlackmagic Camera

Blackmagic Design
www.blackmagicdesign.com/jp/supportBlackmagic
Design

Blackmagic Design
Blackmagic Camera

Blackmagic Design

Blackmagic Camera Setup


About Blackmagic Camera Setup
Mac OS XBlackmagic Camera Setup
About Blackmagic Camera Setup

WindowsBlackmagic Camera Setup
About Blackmagic Camera Setup

Blackmagic Camera Setup


Blackmagic Designwww.blackmagicdesign.com/jp/support

Studio Camera
Blackmagic Design

Blackmagic Design

Blackmagic Studio Camera2Blackmagic Studio Camera 4K 2


99

12
Blackmagic Design12
Blackmagic Design

Blackmagic Design

Blackmagic Design
Blackmagic Design

aBlackmagic Design
b
cBlackmagic Design
d
Blackmagic Design
Blackmagic Design
Blackmagic Design
Blackmagic Design
Blackmagic Design
Blackmagic Design

Copyright 2017 Blackmagic Design Blackmagic Design


DeckLink
HDLink Workgroup Videohub Multibridge Pro
Multibridge ExtremeIntensity
Leading the creative video
revolution

100
Manuel d'utilisation et d'installation

Blackmagic
Studio Cameras
Juin 2017

Franais
Bienvenue
Nous vous remercions d'avoir fait l'acquisition d'une Blackmagic Studio Camera.

Nous avons conu la Blackmagic Studio Camera et la Micro Studio Camera 4K avec beaucoup
d'enthousiasme car j'ai toujours ador la production en direct, et cela depuis mon adolescence.

Dans le pass, les camras pourvues des fonctions tally et rseau d'ordres taient trs onreuses
et trs grandes, donc difficiles grer. Nous souhaitions vraiment remdier ce problme en crant
une camra plus compacte incluant des fonctionnalits telles que le rseau d'ordres, le tally et le
contrle de la camra qui sont normalement offertes par des camras de plus grande taille.

C'est la raison pour laquelle nous avons dvelopp la Blackmagic Studio Camera. Nous dsirions
crer une camra beaucoup plus petite pour des raisons de portabilit, cependant les petites
camras sont gnralement dotes de tous petits crans. C'est ce que nous voulions viter. Ce que
nous recherchions, c'tait un viseur beaucoup plus grand ! Et voil le rsultat : la Blackmagic Studio
Camera est une petite camra broadcast dote d'un trs grand viseur, qui est un vrai plaisir utiliser.
Il est trs facile de raliser une mise au point et un cadrage prcis avec un viseur de cette taille.

Il va sans dire que vous bnficiez galement d'indicateurs tally et du rseau d'ordres, sans oublier
une camra d'excellente qualit quipe d'une monture d'objectif Micro 4/3 flexible. C'est tout
ce dont vous avez besoin dans un seul produit ! Vous pouvez brancher des microphones munis
de bonnettes anti-vent mme si ces derniers ncessitent une alimentation fantme. Vous pouvez
galement ajouter un module SFP pour disposer d'une connexion fibre optique lorsque vous devez
placer votre camra des kilomtres de votre mlangeur. Si vous le souhaitez, vous pouvez mme
ajouter un HyperDeck Shuttle et utiliser la camra pour la production gnrale.

Malgr sa petite taille, la Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K repousse les limites fixes par
la Blackmagic Studio Camera ! Cette petite camra allie un capteur Ultra HD incroyable de
nombreuses fonctionnalits de contrle distance. Vous tes dsormais en mesure de capturer des
images de qualit professionnelle et de contrler la camra grce un mlangeur ATEM ou votre
propre systme de contrle distance.

Nous esprons que vous allez utiliser votre nouvelle camra pour crer des productions en direct
exceptionnelles et produire des travaux au rendu remarquable ! Nous nous rjouissons de dcouvrir
vos ambitieux projets !

Grant Petty
PDG de Blackmagic Design
Sommaire
Blackmagic Studio Camera

Mise en route 101 Paramtres du menu Monitoring 118


Monter un objectif 101 Paramtres du menu Studio 120
Mise en marche de votre camra 101 Paramtres du menu Remote 121
Connexion un mlangeur 102 Paramtres supplmentaires 122

Fonctions de la camra 105 Sortie vido de la camra 123


Caractristiques de la Connexion des mlangeurs vido 123
Blackmagic Studio Camera 105 Connexion des enregistreurs 124
Caractristiques de la
Connecter le tally avec la
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K 107
Blackmagic3G-SDI Shield 124
Connexions de la camra 109
Blackmagic Camera Setup 126
Blackmagic Studio Camera -
Ct gauche 109 Fixer les accessoires 127
Blackmagic Studio Camera - Ct droit 110 Pare-soleil127
Blackmagic Micro Studio Autres accessoires 127
Camera 4K - Face gauche 111 Utiliser l'ATEM Software Control 127
Blackmagic Micro Studio
Fonction Camera Control 127
Camera 4K - face droite 112
Utilisation de la fonction Camera Control 129
Personnalisation 113
Outil d'talonnage primaire de
Cble expansion de la DaVinci Resolve 134
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K 113
Developer Information 137
Schma de cblage pour le
cble Expansion de la Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol 137
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K 114 Blackmagic Embedded
TallyControl Protocol 145
Menu Paramtres 115
Paramtres du menu Camera 115 Assistance 147

Paramtres du menu Audio 117 Garantie


148

Sommaire
Mise en route
Monter un objectif
Pour mettre en route votre Blackmagic Studio Camera ou Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K,
ilvous suffit de monter un objectif et d'allumer la camra. Pour retirer le cache de protection de la
monture d'objectif, maintenez le bouton de verrouillage enfonc et tournez le cache dans le sens
inverse des aiguilles d'une montre jusqu' ce qu'il soit libr. Nous vous recommandons d'teindre
systmatiquement votre camra Blackmagic avant de monter ou de retirer un objectif.
Pour monter un objectif :
1 Alignez le point situ sur votre objectif avec celui de la monture. De nombreux objectifs
possdent un point bleu, rouge ou blanc ou un autre indicateur.
2 Tournez l'objectif dans le sens des aiguilles d'une montre jusqu' ce qu'il s'embote correctement.
3 Pour retirer l'objectif, maintenez le bouton de verrouillage enfonc et tournez l'objectif dans
le sens inverse des aiguilles d'une montre jusqu' ce que le point atteigne la position de
midi puis retirez-le dlicatement.
Afin d'viter d'exposer le botier la poussire lorsqu'aucun objectif n'est mont, il est vivement
conseill de garder le cache anti-poussire autant que possible.

1 1
1

1
PUSH

PUSH
3

3
2

2 2
1

1
PUSH

PUSH
3

3
2

Monter et retirer un objectif sur la Studio Camera.

Monter et retirer un objectif sur la Micro Studio Camera 4K.

Mise en marche de votre camra


1 Appuyez sur le bouton de mise en marche situ au-dessous de l'cran LCD. Sur les
modles Blackmagic Studio Camera et Studio Camera 4K, l'image en direct de la camra
apparat l'cran.
2 Appuyez et maintenez le bouton de mise en marche enfonc pour teindre la camra.

CONSEIL Les modles Blackmagic Studio Camera HD et Studio Camera 4K possdent


des batteries internes qui peuvent tre charges laide de ladaptateur fourni. Ces
camras peuvent tre charges et utilises tout en tant connectes une source
dalimentation externe. Elles basculeront dune source dalimentation lautre sans
interruption. Les modles Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 et Studio Camera 4K 2 ne
possdent pas de batterie interne et ne doivent pas tre charges.

Mise en route 101


La Micro Studio Camera 4K fonctionne avec des batteries LP-E6N et LP-E6. Elles peuvent tre
recharges l'aide d'un chargeur externe ou en charge lente lorsqu'elles sont places sur la
camra. De plus, la camra peut tre charge et utilise tout en tant connecte une source
d'alimentation externe. Elle basculera vers l'alimentation par batterie si lalimentation externe est
interrompue. L'alimentation externe est fournie par le port expansion de la Micro Studio Camera 4K.
1 Appuyez sur le bouton de mise en marche situ droite de la camra. Le voyant tally
s'allume dune lumire blanche pour indiquer que la camra est allume.
2 Appuyez et maintenez le bouton de mise en marche enfonc pour teindre la camra.
C'est tout ce que vous devez savoir pour dmarrer ! Vous pouvez dsormais connecter votre camra
un mlangeur ou un convertisseur ATEM et commencer raliser votre production en direct.

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN

SDI IN

REF

REF

12V

12V

Utilisez ladaptateur fourni pour alimenter la Studio Camera.

Connexion un mlangeur
La Blackmagic Studio Camera et la Micro Studio Camera 4K peuvent tre contrles distance via
SDI partir d'un mlangeur ATEM. Vous disposez ainsi d'un contrle de camra rapide et interactif
durant la production en direct.

Connexion via SDI


1 Connectez la sortie SDI de la Blackmagic Studio Camera ou de la Micro Studio Camera 4K
n'importe quelle entre SDI du mlangeur ATEM.
2 Connectez nimporte quelle sortie SDI du mlangeur ATEM, except les sorties down-
converties ou multi view, lentre programme SDI de la Studio Camera. Les signaux
Camera Control ne sont pas achemins via les sorties SDI down-converties et multi view.

CONSEIL Si le module optique SFP en option est install, vous pouvez utiliser un
cble fibre optique pour connecter la Blackmagic Studio Camera un mlangeur
ATEM. C'est la solution idale si vous avez besoin de longs cbles car la fibre optique
peut acheminer le signal sur 45 kilomtres.
Il est alors ncessaire de connecter un ATEM Studio Converter ou un ATEM Talkback
Converter au mlangeur ATEM. Pour plus d'information sur les installations fibre
optique, consultez la section Schmas de connexion du manuel ATEM Converters.

Mise en route 102


IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 1 IN 3 1 1 3 1 REMOTE REMOTE
1 3 5 1 7 3 9 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH
STEREO IN

CONTROL CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 IN 2 2 HD 2 HD HD HD HD HD
1 2 4 1 6 2 8 4 10 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 REF IN
PREVIEW AUXPROGRAM
1-3 PREVIEW
OUTPUTS PROGRAM OUTPUTS
MULTI-VIEW MULTI-VIEW
ANALOG AUDIO IN

IN IN IN IN IN 1 3 1 REMOTE
All SDI and HDMI video connections are
1 3 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH SD, HD and Ultra HD switchable unless indicated

CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 2 HD HD HD
1 2 4 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2 CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 PREVIEW PROGRAM OUTPUTS MULTI-VIEW ANALOG AUDIO IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT

Pour connecter la camra un mlangeur ATEM, il suffit de brancher la sortie SDI de la camra n'importe
quelle entre SDI du mlangeur. Pour contrler la camra, connectez n'importe quelle sortie non down-
convertie du mlangeur ATEM l'entre programme SDI de votre camra. Une faon rapide de brancher le
mlangeur la camra est de connecter une des sorties programme du mlangeur.

Configurer le mappage des boutons et le tally


Ouvrez les prfrences de l'ATEM Software Control et configurez le mappage des boutons du
mlangeur pour garantir une commutation de la bonne camra avec le tally appropri.
Pour configurer les paramtres du mappage :
1 Cliquez sur la barre de menus situe en haut de l'cran et ouvrez les prfrences de l'ATEM
Software Control.
2 Cliquez sur l'onglet Mapping et vrifiez que les boutons correspondent l'entre souhaite.
Par exemple, comme la Studio Camera est connecte l'entre 1 du mlangeur, Button 1
doit tre rgl sur Input 1: Camera 1.
3 Appuyez sur le bouton Menu de la Blackmagic Studio Camera. Allez sur Studio >Camera
Number et faites correspondre le numro l'entre du mlangeur. Par exemple, si la Studio
Camera 1 est connecte la Cam 1 sur le mlangeur ATEM, le numro de la camra doit
galement tre configur sur 1. Ainsi, le tally est envoy la bonne camra.
Maintenant que tout est branch et que le mappage est configur, vous pouvez vrifier que la sortie
du programme apparat sur la camra et confirmer que le tally fonctionne. Pour vrifier cela
rapidement, il suffit d'appuyer sur le bouton programme de la Blackmagic Studio Camera, puis de
faire basculer la mire de barres couleurs sur la sortie programme du mlangeur ATEM. Si la mire de
barres couleurs s'affiche, tout fonctionne parfaitement.
Maintenant, connectez la camra 1 la sortie programme. Le voyant tally de la Studio Camera
devrait s'allumer. Si a n'est pas le cas, vrifiez que le numro de la camra est rgl sur l'entre
approprie du mlangeur, et que les paramtres de mappage du mlangeur sont corrects.

Utilisation de la fonction Camera Control


La Blackmagic Studio Camera peut tre contrle partir d'un mlangeur ATEM au moyen de la
fonction Camera Control du logiciel ATEM Software Control.
Lancez le logiciel ATEM Software Control et cliquez sur le bouton Camra situ au bas de la fentre
du logiciel afin d'ouvrir la page de contrle des camras. Vous voyez prsent une range de
fentres qui permettent de contrler toutes les camras et qui contiennent des outils pour ajuster et
affiner l'image de chaque camra. La camra 1 est nomme Cam 1. Lorsque le signal de la camra
commute sur la sortie programme, un libell rouge On Air s'affiche.
Au sein de la fentre de contrle de la camra 1, vous pouvez ajuster le signal de la camra,
notamment corriger les couleurs, contrler l'objectif (s'il est compatible) et modifier les paramtres
de la camra. Pour plus d'information sur la faon d'utiliser cette fonction, consultez le paragraphe
Utilisation de la fonction Camera Control dans la section Utilisation de l'ATEM Software Control
de ce manuel.

Mise en route 103


Connexion un enregistreur
Vous pouvez galement connecter la Blackmagic Studio Camera un enregistreur externe, par
exemple un Blackmagic HyperDeck Studio pour un enregistrement en studio. Il est aussi possible de
connecter un HyperDeck Shuttle ou un Blackmagic Video Assist votre camra de studio et de le relier
au mlangeur pour effectuer des enregistrements indpendants durant une diffusion en extrieur.
C'est tout ce que vous devez savoir pour dmarrer ! La production en direct est un domaine
passionnant et la Blackmagic Studio Camera est conue pour vous faciliter le travail. Consultez le
reste de ce manuel pour en apprendre davantage sur les diffrentes fonctions et les paramtres de
la Blackmagic Studio Camera.

Mise en route 104


Fonctions de la camra
Caractristiques de la Blackmagic Studio Camera
Face avant
1 Voyant tally avant
Indique l'acteur quelle camra est l'antenne. Pour plus d'information, consultez la section
Paramtres du menu Monitoring de ce manuel.

2
3

4
1

PUSH
5 2

PUSH

Face gauche
2 Contrle distance LANC
Le jack stro de 2,5mm pour le contrle distance LANC prend en charge le contrle du
diaphragme, du zoom et de la mise au point.
3 Casque d'aviation
Connecteur TRS de 0,25 pour le contrle du programme et du son en rgie par le biais
d'un casque d'aviation.
4 Entre pour le micro du casque
Connecteur TRS de 0,206 pour communiquer avec la rgie au moyen d'un casque
d'aviation.
5 Entres audio
Deux connecteurs XLR symtriques de 1/4 pour le signal audio.
Pour plus d'information, consultez la section Blackmagic Studio Camera - Face gauche
de ce manuel.

Fonctions de la camra 105


Face droite
6 Entre/Sortie optiques
L'entre et la sortie optiques permettent d'utiliser des cbles de 45 km lorsque le module
SFP optique en option est install.
7 Sortie SDI
La sortie SDI permet de connecter la camra un mlangeur ou un autre appareil.
8 Entre SDI
L'entre SDI permet au cameraman de visualiser le signal de sortie du programme (PGM).
9 Entre de rfrence
Permet plusieurs camras d'tre synchronises un signal de rfrence blackburst ou
tri-level.
10 Alimentation
Entre 12 - 24V pour l'alimentation et le chargement de la batterie, s'il y a lieu.
Pour plus d'information, consultez la section Blackmagic Studio Camera - Face droite
dece manuel.

12
11

6 OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

7 SDI OUT

8 SDI IN

9 REF

13 14 15 16 17 18 19 18 20 21 22 10 12V

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU

Face arrire
11 Ecran LCD 10
Contrlez le signal de la camra en direct ou le signal du programme, ou visualisez
le menu. Pour plus d'information, consultez la section Paramtres du menu Monitoring
de ce manuel.
12 Voyant tally arrire
Lorsqu'il est allum, il indique au cameraman que la camra est l'antenne.
13 Bouton Focus
Appuyez une fois pour une mise au point automatique ou deux fois pour afficher le focus
peaking sur l'cran LCD.
14 Bouton Iris
Appuyez une fois pour un rglage automatique de l'exposition.
15 Bouton PTT
Appuyez et maintenez le bouton ENFONC pour parler. Appuyez deux fois rapidement
pour une communication mains libres. Appuyez nouveau pour revenir la configuration
par dfaut.
16 Bouton PGM
Il vous suffit d'appuyer sur le bouton PGM pour basculer entre le signal en direct de la
camra et le signal du programme provenant de la rgie o se trouve le mlangeur.
17 Bouton LUT
Cette fonction n'est pas disponible actuellement.

Fonctions de la camra 106


12V

18 Boutons de navigation
Naviguez sur le menu affich sur l'cran LCD.
REF

19 Bouton Set SDI IN

Utilisez ce bouton pour confirmer les slections faites dans les menus.
SDI OUT

20 Bouton Display
OPTICAL IN

Appuyez sur ce bouton pour activer ou dsactiver les informations affiches l'cran.
OPTICAL OUT

21 Bouton Menu
Accdez au menu sur l'cran LCD.
22 Bouton de mise en marche
Appuyez sur ce bouton pour allumer la Blackmagic Studio Camera. Appuyez sur le bouton
et maintenez-le enfonc pour teindre la camra.
Pour plus d'information, consultez la section Paramtres des boutons de ce manuel.

Face infrieure
23 Connecteur USB
Port USB Mini-B pour les mises jour du firmware de la camra. Pour plus d'information,
consultez la section Blackmagic Camera Setup de ce manuel.

23

Caractristiques de la Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K


Face avant
1 Voyant tally
Le voyant tally indique quelle camra est l'antenne et informe le camraman de l'tat de la
camra. Les scnarios suivants sont possibles :
Lumire blanche - Camra allume
Lumire rouge - Camra l'antenne
Lumire rouge et orange clignotante - Camra l'antenne et batterie faible
Lumire blanche et orange clignotante - Batterie faible
Vous pouvez rgler la luminosit du voyant tally dans les paramtres de la Micro Studio
Camera 4K. Pour plus d'informations ce sujet, consultez la section Paramtres du
menu Camera .

1 2 4
5
6
PUSH

7
3
2

8
PUSH

Fonctions de la camra 107


Face gauche
2 Sortie HDMI
Reliez la sortie HDMI un cran externe, par exemple le Blackmagic Video Assist, pour
visionner les images et naviguer dans les menus de la camra. La rsolution de sortie
est toujours de HD 1080, peu importe la rsolution de la camra, et vous pouvez choisir
d'afficher les informations, telles que les repres de cadrage, l'histogramme et les niveaux
audio lcran. Pour plus d'information, consultez la section Paramtres du menu
Monitoring de ce manuel.
3 Port expansion
Connecteur DB-HD15. Prend en charge l'alimentation externe, le contrle distance et
l'entre de rfrence. Pour plus d'information, consultez la section Cble expansion de la
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K de ce manuel.
4 Bouton Menu
Utilisez le bouton Menu pour ouvrir les paramtres de la camra et les visualiser sur un
cran HDMI externe.
5 Flche de navigation vers le haut
Utilisez ce bouton pour naviguer entre les menus.
6 Flche de navigation vers le bas
Utilisez ce bouton pour naviguer entre les menus.
7 Bouton Set
Utilisez ce bouton pour confirmer les slections faites dans les menus.
8 Bouton de mise en marche
Appuyez sur le bouton de mise en marche pour allumer la Blackmagic Micro Studio
Camera4K. Maintenez-le enfonc pour teindre la camra.

Face droite
9 Entre audio analogique
Entre audio stro de 3,5mm. Commutable entre les entres de niveau micro et de niveau
ligne partir du menu.
10 Sortie SDI
Sortie SDI permettant de connecter des appareils tels que des mlangeurs,
desenregistreurs externes ou d'autres appareils.
11 Entre SDI
L'entre SDI offre un contrle de la camra via un mlangeur ATEM ou la Blackmagic
3G-SDI Arduino Shield.
12 Casque / Rseau d'ordres
Jack de 3,5mm compatible avec les micros-casques iPhone et Android pour le rseau
dordres. Appuyez deux fois sur le bouton lecture/pause du micro-casque pour basculer
vers le rseau d'ordres. Appuyez une nouvelle fois pour teindre la connexion.

10
13
11

12

Fonctions de la camra 108


Face arrire
13 Logement pour batterie
La Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K est vendue avec une batterie LP-E6 compatible.
La batterie peut tre recharge par charge lente lorsqu'elle est fixe la camra, et que
celle-ci est connecte une source d'alimentation via le port expansion.

Face suprieure
14 Bouton d'jection de la batterie
Faites glisser ce bouton pour jecter la batterie.

Face infrieure
15 Connecteur USB
Port USB pour les mises jour du firmware de la camra. Pour plus d'information,
consultezla section Blackmagic Camera Setup de ce manuel.

14

15

Connexions de la camra
Blackmagic Studio Camera - Ct gauche
Contrle distance LANC
Le port LANC de votre camra permet de contrler distance la mise au point de l'objectif, l'iris et le
zoom lorsque vous utilisez un objectif compatible. Le port fonctionne avec un jack stro de 2,5 mm
qui prend en charge le protocole LANC.
Les objectifs Micro 4/3 actifs vous permettent de contrler le servomcanisme du zoom l'aide du
contrle distance LANC. Les objectifs suivants sont pris en charge :
Objectif Panasonic Lumix G X Vario PZ 14-42mm f/3.5-5.6 Power O.I.S.
Objectif Panasonic Lumix G X Vario PZ 45-175mm f/4.0-5.6 Zoom O.I.S.
Objectif Olympus M.Zuiko Digital ED 12-50mm f/3.5-6.3 EZ Micro 4/3
Objectif Olympus M.Zuiko Digital ED 14-42mm f/3.5-5.6 EZ Micro 4/3

Sortie Casque
Permet de contrler le programme et le son en rgie au moyen d'un casque d'aviation muni de
connecteurs de type fixed wing . La gamme de casques d'aviation est tendue, elle part de
modles d'oreillettes pour une utilisation dans les studios jusqu'aux casques rduction de bruit de
taille normale qui conviennent aux concerts et vnements sportifs. L'audio est achemin partir
des canaux 15 et 16 du signal vido SDI entrant. Les canaux 15 et 16 sont rarement utiliss durant la
production et sont donc appropris une utilisation pour le rseau d'ordres.

Connexions de la camra 109


Entre pour le micro du casque
Pour communiquer avec la rgie au moyen d'un casque d'aviation. Le son est intgr aux canaux 15
et 16 du signal de sortie SDI.

Entres audio
2 canaux d'audio symtrique analogique professionnelle sont pris en charge par les connecteurs
XLR. Configurez les niveaux d'entre de chaque canal l'aide du menu audio. Les entres prennent
en charge les signaux de niveau micro ainsi que les signaux de niveau ligne. Le type de signal est
galement slectionnable partir du menu audio. Le son est intgr aux canaux 1 et 2 du flux SDI.

1
1
PUSH

3
2

2
1
PUSH

3
2

Blackmagic Studio Camera - Ct droit


Entre/Sortie optiques
Pour disposer d'une entre et d'une sortie fibre optique, il vous faudra installer un module SFP
fibre optique en option. Cela vous permet d'utiliser des connecteurs LC conformes aux normes de
l'industrie, qui prennent en charge des signaux 3G-SDI sur la Studio Camera HD, et des signaux
6G-SDI sur la Studio Camera 4K. Le cble fibre optique est trs courant car il est galement
utilis dans les rseaux informatiques. La fibre optique permet une longueur de cble de 45
kilomtres ce qui est bien plus qu'il n'en faut, mme pour les diffusions d'vnements en plein air
les plus exigeantes. Si les entres optiques et SDI sont toutes deux connectes, le signal de
sortie provenant de l'appareil qui a t connect en premier sera utilis. Pour vous procurer un
module SFP fibre optique, contactez le revendeur Blackmagic Design le plus proche de chez
vous. Pour trouver un revendeur Blackmagic Design, veuillez vous rendre sur notre site web :
www.blackmagicdesign.com/fr/resellers.

Sortie SDI
Utilisez la sortie SDI pour acheminer de la vido 4:2:2 10 bits du matriel vido SDI professionnel
tel que des grilles de commutation, moniteurs, priphriques de capture SDI et mlangeurs
broadcast. La Blackmagic Studio Camera HD prend en charge les signaux 3G-SDI et la Studio
Camera 4K les signaux 12G-SDI.

Entre SDI
L'entre SDI permet au cameraman de visualiser le signal de sortie du programme (PGM). Il vous
suffit d'appuyer sur le bouton PGM pour basculer entre le signal en direct de la camra et le signal
du programme provenant de la rgie o se trouve le mlangeur.
Si les entres optiques et SDI sont toutes deux connectes, le signal de sortie provenant de
l'appareil qui a t connect en premier sera utilis. Si vous utilisez la Studio Camera pour
enregistrer sur un appareil tel que le Blackmagic Hyperdeck Shuttle, la sortie de l'Hyperdeck peut
tre connecte l'entre SDI pour vous permettre de lire ce que vous venez d'enregistrer.

Connexions de la camra 110


Entre de rfrence
Elle permet de synchroniser de multiples camras avec un signal de rfrence blackburst ou
tri-level. Le fait de synchroniser des camras un signal de rfrence externe prvient les erreurs
de timing qui peuvent provoquer un saut de l'image au cours de la commutation entre
diffrentes camras.

Alimentation
Utilisez l'entre 12 - 24V pour connecter votre source d'alimentation et charger la batterie interne de
la Blackmagic Studio Camera HD et de la Blackmagic Studio Camera 4K. Une fois la batterie
charge, elle alimentera la Studio Camera HD pour une dure de 4 heures, et la Studio Camera 4K
pour une dure de 3 heures.
La Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 et la Studio Camera 4K 2 ne possdent pas de batterie interne.

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN

REF

12V

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K - Face gauche


Sortie HDMI
Le port HDMI de votre Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K achemine de la vido 1 080p 4:2:2 10
bits intgrant 2 canaux audio pour le contrle de vos enregistrements. Vous pouvez connecter
n'importe quel type de moniteur HDMI prenant en charge la HD, tel que le Blackmagic Video Assist,
afin de faciliter le cadrage et la mise au point de vos images. Cela vous permet aussi de naviguer
dans les diffrents menus de la Micro Studio Camera 4K.
La sortie HDMI adapte la frquence d'images au format des images captures par la camra.
Parexemple, si la camra est configure en 2160p30, la sortie HDMI acheminera du 1080p30.

MENU
EXPANSION

SET

Connexions de la camra 111


Port expansion
La petite taille de la Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K favorise la ralisation de prises de vues uniques,
de gros plans, de scnes d'action et de squences tournes dans des lieux restreints. Cependant, mme
si la Micro Studio Camera 4K peut tre facilement dissimule, il n'en est pas de mme pour le camraman.
Il est donc important de pouvoir contrler la camra distance pour profiter pleinement de sa petite taille.
Il est possible de configurer certains paramtres de la Micro Studio Camera 4K l'aide d'un mlangeur
ATEM connect l'entre SDI de la camra, comme indiqu dans la section Fonction Camera Control
de ce manuel. Cependant, la majorit des options de contrle sont disponibles via le port expansion.
Le connecteur DB-HD15 de la Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K et le cble expansion fourni offrent
une large gamme de connexions, notamment l'alimentation, le contrle LANC, les commandes PTZ et
le genlock. Nous vous encourageons utiliser les cbles disponibles dans le commerce pour pouvoir
exploiter au maximum certaines fonctions spcifiques de la camra ou de personnaliser vos propres
cbles pour configurer la Micro Studio Camera 4K en fonction de vos besoins. Pour plus d'information,
consultez la section Cble expansion de la Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K de ce manuel.

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K - face droite


Entre audio analogique
Le connecteur audio stro de 3,5mm fonctionne avec les liaisons de niveau micro et les liaisons de niveau
ligne. Vous pouvez choisir entre ces deux liaisons dans les paramtres du menu Audio de la camra. Il est
important de choisir le rglage appropri afin d'viter que le son soit trop faible ou trop lev.

Sortie SDI
Utilisez la sortie SDI pour acheminer de la vido 4:2:2 10 bits du matriel vido SDI professionnel tel
que des grilles de commutation, moniteurs, priphriques de capture SDI et mlangeurs broadcast.
La Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K prend en charge le 6G-SDI. Vous aurez besoin d'un cble
adaptateur DIN 1.0/2.3 vers SDI pour connecter la camra des connecteurs SDI de taille standard.

Entre SDI
Utilisez l'entre SDI pour contrler la Micro Studio Camera 4K laide dun mlangeur ATEM.
Pourplus d'information sur les fonctions de contrle disponibles, consultez la section Fonction
Camera Control de ce manuel.

CONSEIL Vous pouvez galement contrler la Micro Studio Camera avec une Blackmagic
3G-SDI Arduino Shield. La carte intgre les mmes paquets de donnes Blackmagic au
signal SDI que le mlangeur ATEM. Ainsi, en connectant le flux du programme de n'importe
quel mlangeur SDI l'entre SDI de la camra via cette carte, vous aurez accs la
fonction de contrle pour camra de Blackmagic, comme avec un mlangeur ATEM.

Connexions de la camra 112


Casque / Rseau d'ordres
L'entre casque / rseau d'ordres de 3,5mm vous permet de communiquer avec la rgie l'aide dun
casque-micro pour iPhone et Android. Appuyez deux fois sur le bouton lecture/pause du micro-
casque pour basculer vers le rseau d'ordres. Appuyez une nouvelle fois pour teindre la
connexion. Le son est intgr aux canaux 15 et 16 du signal de sortie SDI.

Personnalisation
Cble expansion de la Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
Il existe deux faons d'accder aux fonctionnalits du port expansion. Vous pouvez utiliser le cble
expansion vendu avec la Micro Studio Camera 4K ou personnaliser vos propres cbles.
Le cble expansion est dot de connecteurs permettant de contrler les options suivantes.

4 Micro Studio Cam MSC Breakout Cable Micro Studio Cam MSC Breakout Cable

Cble expansion de la Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K.

1 Entre d'alimentation
L'entre d'alimentation de 12V de la camra fonctionne avec un jack DC. Ce cble permet
dalimenter la Micro Studio Camera 4K et d'effectuer une charge lente de la batterie lorsque
celle-ci est fixe la camra. Lorsque l'alimentation externe est utilise, la camra s'allume
automatiquement.
2 Entre de rfrence
Cette entre permet plusieurs camras d'tre synchronises un signal de rfrence
blackburst ou tri-level. Le fait de synchroniser des camras un signal de rfrence externe
prvient les erreurs de timing qui peuvent provoquer un saut de l'image au cours de la
commutation entre diffrentes camras.
3 LANC
Connectez un jack de 2,5mm des tlcommandes LANC pour contrler les nombreuses
fonctionnalits de la camra, telles que le zoom, le rglage de l'iris et la mise au point,
avecun bras fix au trpied lorsqu'un objectif compatible est utilis.
4 Commandes PTZ
Le connecteur RS-422 est utilis pour envoyer les commandes PTZ reues par le signal SDI
de la Micro Studio Camera 4K vers une tte motorise.

Personnalisation 113
5 Communication B4
Le connecteur DB-9 vous permet d'alimenter et de contrler les objectifs broadcast
B4 monts sur la Micro Studio Camera 4K l'aide d'un adaptateur Micro 4/3 vers B4.
Pourcontrler un objectif B4 compatible, il suffit de connecter le cble Digital B4 Control
Adapter en option au cble de l'objectif, puis de connecter l'autre extrmit au connecteur
srie DB-9 du cble expansion.
Vous pouvez rgler diffrents paramtres, tels que l'iris, la mise au point et le zoom de la
mme faon que sur un objectif Micro 4/3 actif. Le contrle peut tre effectu via un
mlangeur ATEM partir de la page Camera Control ou partir dune interface de
contrle distance connecte au cble expansion de la Micro Studio Camera 4K. Pour une
liste complte des objectifs numriques B4 pris en charge, veuillez consulter la page
d'assistance de Blackmagic Design www.blackmagicdesign.com/fr/support/faq/59011.
6 Servo numrique S.Bus
En connectant la camra un rcepteur S.Bus compatible avec un cble Futaba J,
vousdisposez de 18 canaux S.Bus. Ces canaux peuvent tre assigns des fonctionnalits
de la camra (la mise au point, le zoom motoris, le contrle de l'iris et autres) et ainsi tre
contrls distance. Pour obtenir plus d'informations sur l'assignation de fonctionnalits aux
canaux S.Bus, consultez la section Paramtres du menu Remote de ce manuel.

Schma de cblage pour le cble Expansion


de la Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
Lorsque vous utilisez le port Expansion de la Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K, vous n'aurez
peut-tre besoin que d'une seule ou de deux fonctions. Par exemple, il vous faudra peut-tre
contrler un objectif broadcast B4 tout en recevant une alimentation de 12V et un signal de
rfrence. Il est trs facile de personnaliser un connecteur pour quil offre ces fonctionnalits sans
vous encombrer de nombreux connecteurs supplmentaires.
Utilisez le schma suivant pour connecter le cble Expansion fourni ou consultez-le pour relier
correctement les connexions de votre cble personnalis. La gamme complte des broches
disponibles est liste dans la section P1, tandis que les sous-groupes utiliss pour des fonctions
particulires, ainsi que leur disposition au sein des connecteurs appropris, sont affichs dans les
sections P2 P7.

P1 PIN ASSIGNMENT
2 S. Bus 1
2 P2
GROUND 3

GROUND 1
12 PTZ RS422 Rx- 2
8 PTZ RS422 Tx+ 3 5
9
GROUND 4 4

GROUND
5
6
3
2
8
7 P3
6
13 PTZ RS422 Rx+ 7 1

3 PTZ RS422 Tx- 8


GROUND 9

5 15
GROUND 1
10 14 B4 Lens Control Transmit 2 5
9
4 14 4
15 B4 Lens Control Receive 3
P4
9 8
3 13 3
8 GROUND 4 2
7
2
7
12 6 Power +12V in* 5 1
6
1 11 OTHER
6

5 Reference Input CENTER


GROUND SLEEVE P5
1 Ground 6 Power +12V in 11 Ground LANC Data
9 TIP
2
3
S. Bus
PTZ RS422 Tx-
7
8
Ground
PTZ RS422 Tx+
12
13
PTZ RS422 Rx-
PTZ RS422 Rx+
10
GROUND
LANC Power RING
SLEEVE
P6
4 Ground 9 LANC Data 14 B4 Lens Control Transmit
5 Reference Input 10 LANC Power 15 B4 Lens Control Receive
6 Power +12V in PIN
GROUND SLEEVE P7

* Power input to the camera is also used to power the lens. Beware of applying excessive voltages if youre using
your own power supply to avoid damage to the lens.

Personnalisation 114
Menu Paramtres
Les paramtres de la camra Blackmagic peuvent tre modifis pour capturer une image
dexcellente qualit. Vous pouvez notamment changer le format vido, la vitesse d'obturation,
labalance des blancs, les niveaux audio, le monitoring, le tally ainsi que le rseau d'ordres pour une
communication efficace avec la rgie.
Cette section contient des informations relatives aux paramtres de votre camra.

Paramtres du menu Camera


Pour configurer les paramtres de la Blackmagic Studio Camera ou de la Blackmagic Micro Studio
Camera 4K, appuyez sur le bouton Menu. Utilisez les flches de navigation pour mettre les menus
en surbrillance et confirmez votre slection l'aide du bouton Set.
Si vous utilisez une Micro Studio Camera 4K, il faudra connecter un moniteur externe via le port
HDMI de la camra pour visualiser les paramtres du menu.
Format vido
Slectionnez le format vido voulu l'aide du menu de navigation. Par exemple, pour slectionner
les formats 1080p et 1080i, appuyez sur la flche gauche ou droite pour faire dfiler les options.
Appuyez sur le bouton Set pour confirmer le format de votre choix.
Une liste des formats vido pris en charge est disponible plus loin dans ce manuel.
Gain
Les paramtres Gain sont utiles lorsque vous tournez dans des situations de faible clairage.
Leparamtre par dfaut est de 0dB et le gain peut tre augment par tranches de 6dB jusqu' 18dB.
Dtails
Ce paramtre permet de rgler la nettet de votre image en direct au sein de votre Studio Camera.
Augmentez et diminuez le niveau de nettet en slectionnant Off ou Default pour une nettet Low,
Medium et High.
Exposition automatique (Auto Exposure)
La Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K vous offre plusieurs options d'exposition automatique.
Iris
Maintient une vitesse d'obturation constante en changeant l'ouverture de liris pour obtenir une
exposition constante.
Obturateur (Shutter)
Maintient une ouverture constante en changeant la vitesse d'obturation pour obtenir une
expositionconstante.

Menu Paramtres 115


Paramtres du menu Camera - Blackmagic Studio Camera.
Iris + Obturateur (Iris + Shutter)
Maintient le niveau d'exposition appropri en modifiant louverture de liris. Lorsque l'ouverture
maximale ou minimale a t atteinte et qu'il n'est toujours pas possible de maintenir la mme exposition,
la Micro Studio Camera 4K ajuste la vitesse d'obturation pour que l'exposition reste constante.

Obturateur + Iris (Shutter + Iris)


Maintient le niveau d'exposition appropri en modifiant la vitesse d'obturation. Lorsque la vitesse
d'obturation maximale ou minimale a t atteinte et qu'il n'est toujours pas possible de maintenir la
mme exposition, la Micro Studio Camera 4K ajuste l'ouverture pour que l'exposition reste constante.

Dclenchement manuel (Manual Trigger)


L'ouverture de l'iris et la vitesse d'obturation peuvent tre rgles manuellement. L'exposition peut
varier selon les conditions d'clairage.

Balance des blancs (White Balance)


Votre camra comporte 18 prrglages de balance des blancs pour une varit de tempratures
de couleur.
2500, 2800, 3000, 3200, 3400, 3600, 4000, 4500 et 4800K pour lclairage avec des
lampes incandescence tungstne et des tubes fluorescents ou pour la lumire naturelle
diffuse, telle que l'clairage la bougie, le lever/coucher du soleil, la lumire du matin et de
l'aprs-midi.
5000, 5200, 5400 et 5600K pour l'extrieur lors d'une journe ensoleille et sans nuages.
6000, 6500, 7000, 7500 et 8000K pour une diversit de conditions de lumire naturelle.

Vitesse d'obturation (Shutter Speed)


La vitesse d'obturation complte le paramtre Gain en rgulant la quantit de lumire reue par le
capteur. Il y a 15 vitesses d'obturation diffrentes disponibles, de 1/50 sec 1/2000 sec.

Paramtres du menu Camera -


Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K.

Formats vido pris en charge par les Blackmagic Studio Cameras

Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Micro Studio


Camera Camera 4K Camera 4K

720p50 720p50 1080i50

720p59.94 720p59.94 1080i59.94

720p60 720p60 1080i60

1080i50 1080i50 1080p23.98

Menu Paramtres 116


Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Micro Studio
Camera Camera 4K Camera 4K

1080i59.94 1080i59.94 1080p24

1080i60 1080i60 1080p25

1080p23.98 1080p23.98 1080p29.97

1080p24 1080p24 1080p30

1080p25 1080p25 1080p50

1080p29.97 1080p29.97 1080p59.94

1080p30 1080p30 1080p60

1080p50 1080p50 2160p23.98

1080p59.94 1080p59.94 2160p24

1080p60 1080p60 2160p25

2160p23.98 2160p29.97

2160p24 2160p30

2160p25

2160p29.97

2160p30

2160p50

2160p59.94

2160p60

Paramtres du menu Audio


Pour rgler les paramtres de l'entre et du contrle audio sur votre Blackmagic Studio Camera,
appuyez sur le bouton Menu et slectionnez l'icne microphone situe gauche de l'cran.
Utilisezles boutons de navigation pour mettre les menus en surbrillance et confirmez votre slection
l'aide du bouton Set.

Paramtres du menu Audio - Blackmagic Studio Camera.

Menu Paramtres 117


Contrle automatique du gain
La Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K intgre un paramtre de contrle automatique du gain audio
d'ajuster les niveaux de l'enregistrement audio. Il rduit automatiquement le gain audio lorsque le
niveau d'entre est trop lev et l'augmente lorsque le niveau d'entre est trop bas.

Audio Input
Fait basculer l'audio entre le microphone interne de la camra et les connecteurs audio XLR.

Niveau du microphone (Microphone Level)


L'entre microphone ajuste les niveaux d'enregistrement du microphone intgr. Dplacez le
curseur vers la gauche ou la droite pour augmenter ou diminuer les niveaux. La Studio Camera est
quipe d'un microphone stro intgr. Le microphone intgr enregistre sur les canaux audio 1 et
2 quand aucune source audio externe n'est connecte.

Niveau du signal d'entre (Input Level)


Les connecteurs audio externes prennent en charge de l'audio de niveau micro ou de niveau ligne.
Slectionnez Line lorsque vous connectez des appareils audio externe, notamment un mixer audio
ou un ampli. Slectionnez Mic Low ou Mic High en fonction de l'intensit du signal de votre micro.
Ilest important de slectionner le niveau appropri pour viter que votre audio externe soit presque
inaudible, trop forte ou distordue. Configurez les niveaux des signaux audio externes l'aide des
flches gauche et droite.

Signal d'entre canal 1 (Ch 1 Input)


Dplacez l'icne du curseur audio vers la gauche ou vers la droite pour augmenter ou diminuer les
niveaux du canal 1. Le signal audio externe a la priorit sur le microphone intgr et est achemin
sur le canal audio 1.

Canal 2 utilise l'entre du canal 1 (Channel 2 uses Channel 1 Input)


Slectionnez l'option On si vous souhaitez intgrer le canal audio externe 1 aux canaux 1 et 2 de la
sortie SDI ou de la sortie fibre optique en option. Cela revient connecter l'entre 1 aux deux entres
audio de la camra, et s'avre trs utile lorsque vous utilisez des micros disposant d'une seule sortie
audio mini que vous devez connecter deux canaux stro. Slectionnez l'option Off si vous
souhaitez que le canal 1 n'utiliser qu'un seul canal audio, et le canal 2 enregistrera l'audio partir de
l'entre audio du canal 2. Cette solution est conseille pour l'utilisation de sources audio stro.

Signal d'entre canal 2 (Ch 2 Input)


Dplacez l'icne du curseur audio vers la gauche ou vers la droite pour augmenter ou diminuer les
niveaux du canal 2. Le signal audio externe a la priorit sur le microphone intgr et est achemin
sur le canal audio 2.

Alimentation fantme (Phantom Power)


L'alimentation fantme fournit de l'alimentation lectrique via les cbles pour microphone. C'est une
source d'alimentation trs pratique pour les microphones condensateur. Pour activer ou dsactiver
l'alimentation fantme de la Studio Camera, ouvrez le menu Audio et slectionnez les fonctions On
ou Off l'aide des flches. L'alimentation fantme est automatiquement dsactive lorsque le
paramtre Line Input Level est slectionn. Il vous faut attendre au moins 10 secondes pour que
l'alimentation fantme se dcharge aprs la dconnexion avant de brancher un microphone
autonome. Les microphones plus anciens de type microphones ruban ne prennent pas en charge
l'alimentation fantme.

Paramtres du menu Monitoring


Pour ajuster les paramtres d'affichage de l'cran LCD, appuyez sur le bouton Menu et slectionnez
l'icne moniteur. Utilisez les boutons de navigation pour mettre les menus en surbrillance et confirmez
votre slection l'aide du bouton Set.

Menu Paramtres 118


Paramtres du menu Monitoring -
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K.

HDMI Meters
La Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K vous permet de choisir les outils de mesure que vous
souhaitez afficher sur la sortie HDMI.

Histogramme
Il affiche la distribution des hautes et des basses lumires sur un axe horizontal. Le ct gauche de
l'histogramme reprsente les basses lumires, ou les noirs, et le ct droit reprsente les hautes
lumires, ou les blancs. Lorsque vous ouvrez ou fermez l'ouverture de l'objectif, la distribution des
informations sur l'histogramme change en consquence vers la gauche ou vers la droite.
Ce paramtre active et dsactive l'histogramme. Lorsque ce paramtre et le paramtre HDMI
Overlays sont activs, lhistogramme apparat en bas droite du moniteur connect.

Audio
Les vumtres affichent le volume des canaux audio gauche et droit sur deux barres horizontales.
Lecanal gauche est situ au-dessus, le droit en dessous. Si le niveau audio est trop lev,
uncrtage se produit et provoque un son distordu. Pour viter cela, ajustez le gain audio sur votre
camra jusqu' ce que les niveaux audio restent dans la plage approprie.
Ce paramtre active et dsactive les vumtres. Lorsque ce paramtre et le paramtre HDMI
Overlays sont activs, ils apparaissent en bas gauche du moniteur connect.

HDMI Overlays
Ce paramtre est seulement disponible sur la Micro Studio Camera 4K. Lorsqu'il est rgl sur On,
lasortie vido HDMI inclut les repres de cadrage, des informations concernant les paramtres et le
nom de la camra ainsi que tous les outils de mesure qui ont t activs via le paramtre
HDMI Meters.

Luminosit (Brightness)
Dplacez le curseur vers la gauche ou vers la droite pour ajuster les paramtres de luminosit de
l'cran LCD. Par dfaut, ce paramtre est rgl sur 60%.

Paramtre Zebra
Les Blackmagic Cameras possdent une fonction zebra qui vous indique les niveaux d'exposition.
Des lignes diagonales apparatront sur n'importe quelle zone de la vido qui excde le niveau
d'exposition zebra.
Activez la fonction zebra et slectionnez le niveau d'alerte zebra souhait l'aide des flches
gauche et droite. Par dfaut, ce paramtre est rgl sur Medium.

Menu Paramtres 119


Focus Peaking
Ce paramtre vous permet de changer le niveau de la fonction focus peaking (aide la mise au
point). Faites votre choix entre : off, low, medium et high. Ajustez ce paramtre lorsque vous utilisez
un objectif trs net et que l'image entire est crte. Par dfaut, ce paramtre est rgl sur Medium.

Luminosit du tally avant ( Front Tally Brightness)


Ce paramtre permet de changer la luminosit du voyant tally avant. Faites votre choix entre :
off,low, medium et high. Par dfaut, ce paramtre est rgl sur Medium.

Luminosit du tally arrire (Rear Tally Brightness)


Ce paramtre permet de changer la luminosit du voyant tally arrire. Faites votre choix entre :
low,medium et high. Par dfaut, ce paramtre est rgl sur Medium.

Luminosit du voyant tally (Tally Light Brightness)


Change la luminosit du voyant tally sur la Micro Studio Camera 4K. Par dfaut, ce paramtre est
rgl sur Medium, mais vous pouvez le rgler sur High, Low et Off.
Si la luminosit du tally est rgle sur Off, le voyant s'allume lorsque vous allumez la camra et
s'teint ensuite rapidement.

Affichage du pourcentage de la batterie (Display Battery Percentage)


ertaines batteries LP-E6 communiquent leur niveau de charge la camra directement via la
communication srie numrique. Lorsque cette option est active, vous pouvez afficher les niveaux
de la batterie de la Micro Studio Camera 4K en pourcentage au lieu de barres graphiques. Toutefois,
si l'affichage du pourcentage n'est pas suffisamment prcis votre got, vous pouvez revenir aux
barres graphiques qui mesurent l'tat de la charge directement partir de la batterie.

Paramtres du menu Studio


Pour ajuster les paramtres d'affichage de l'cran LCD, appuyez sur le bouton Menu et slectionnez
l'icne casque. Utilisez les boutons de navigation pour mettre les menus en surbrillance et confirmez
votre slection l'aide du bouton Set.

Paramtres du menu Studio - Blackmagic Studio Camera.

Numro de la camra (Camera Number)


Si vous dsirez que votre Studio Camera reoive des signaux tally d'un mlangeur ATEM, il vous
faudra configurer le numro de la camra sur votre camra. Cela permettra au mlangeur d'envoyer
le signal tally la bonne camra. Le numro de camra peut tre rgl sur une valeur entre 1-99.
Pardfaut, ce paramtre est rgl sur 1.
Menu Paramtres 120
CONSEIL Vous pouvez galement connecter le signal de retour du programme dun
mlangeur SDI une camra via la carte extension Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield.
Cela permet alors dafficher le voyant tally sur chaque camra. Tous les mlangeurs SDI
qui comprennent des sorties tally collecteur ouvert peuvent prendre en charge ce
signal grce la Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield. Pour plus d'information, consultez la
section Connecter le tally avec la Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield de ce manuel.

Source de rfrence (Reference Source)


Ce paramtre est utilis pour slectionner la source du genlock. La Studio Camera peut tre
synchronise au signal de programme SDI ou une source de genlock externe. Si vous utilisez une
source de genlock externe, gardez l'esprit que le changement de source peut crer un saut
d'image lorsque la camra se synchronise la nouvelle source.

Rythme de rfrence (Reference Timing)


Ce paramtre vous permet d'ajuster manuellement le rythme de rfrence dfini par un nombre de
lignes ou de pixels.

Niveau du casque (Headset Level)


Dplacez le curseur de volume vers la gauche ou vers la droite pour augmenter ou diminuer les
niveaux du contrle audio. Par dfaut, ce paramtre est rgl sur 50 %.

Niveau du micro du casque (Headset Mic Level)


Dplacez le curseur de volume gauche ou droite pour augmenter ou diminuer les niveaux
d'entre audio du microphone. Par dfaut, ce paramtre est rgl sur 50 %.

Balance audio du rseau d'ordres (Program Mix)


Ce paramtre permet de basculer de la balance du son de la camra celle du son du rseau
d'ordres. Le casque achemine l'audio en fonction du contenu affich sur l'cran LCD. Par exemple,
sile signal provenant de la camra est affich, vous entendrez l'audio provenant de la camra.
Parcontre, si c'est le signal du programme qui est affich, vous entendrez l'audio du programme.
Pardfaut, ce paramtre est rgl sur 0 %.

Paramtres du menu Remote


La Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K intgre un menu supplmentaire qui permet de rgler les
fonctions de contrle distance. Si vous vous servez du S.Bus pour contrler votre camra, utilisez ce
menu pour attribuer des fonctions telles que l'iris, la vitesse d'obturation et autres aux canaux S.Bus.
Ilsuffit de slectionner la fonction que vous souhaitez contrler et de lui attribuer un canal disponible
l'aide de la flche de navigation vers le haut, de la flche de navigation vers le bas et du bouton Set.

Paramtres du menu Remote - Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K.


Menu Paramtres 121
Paramtres supplmentaires
Rglage des paramtres de l'objectif
La Blackmagic Studio Camera prend en charge le contrle d'objectif lectronique, ce qui vous permet de
rgler les paramtres de l'objectif tels que le diaphragme et la mise au point automatique. Le focus
peaking entoure dune bordure verte les zones de l'image les plus nettes, une manire trs efficace de
vrifier votre mise au point. Cette fonction n'apparat que sur votre cran LCD et n'affecte pas la sortie SDI.
Bouton Mise au point (Focus)
Lorsque vous utilisez la Studio Camera avec un objectif mise au point automatique, appuyez sur le
bouton Focus pour faire votre slection entre les fonctions focus peaking et mise au point
automatique (autofocus). Pour slectionner la mise au point automatique, appuyez une fois sur le
bouton Focus. Pour activer le focus peaking, appuyez deux fois rapidement sur le bouton Focus.
Lorsque vous utilisez un objectif manuel, appuyez une fois sur le bouton Focus pour activer la
fonction focus peaking.
Bouton Iris
Lorsque le mode Video est slectionn dans les paramtres de la plage dynamique (Dynamic
range), appuyez simplement sur le bouton Iris pour rgler l'exposition moyenne en fonction des
hautes lumires et des zones d'ombres de la scne. Lorsque le mode Film est slectionn dans les
paramtres de la plage dynamique, une simple pression sur le bouton IRIS rgle lexposition en
fonction des plus hautes lumires de la scne. Pour rgler l'ouverture manuellement sur la Studio
Camera, appuyez sur les boutons hauts et bas du menu de navigation.

Paramtres supplmentaires
Bouton PTT (Appuyer pour parler)
Lors de la production en direct, il est primordial que les oprateurs puissent communiquer avec le
ralisateur et les personnes se trouvant en rgie. Il vous suffit d'appuyer et de maintenir le bouton
enfonc et vous pouvez ensuite commencer parler. Appuyez deux fois rapidement pour une
communication mains libres. Appuyez nouveau pour revenir la configuration par dfaut.
Bouton Programme (PMG)
Parfois, il est important que les oprateurs puissent visualiser le signal du programme au lieu du signal
de leur propre camra. Il vous suffit d'appuyer sur le bouton PGM pour basculer entre le signal en direct
de la camra et le signal du programme provenant de la rgie o se trouve le mlangeur. Vous pouvez
utiliser l'entre SDI ou l'entre fibre optique en option pour connecter votre source vido externe.
Bouton LUT
Fonction non disponible actuellement.
Flches vers le haut, le bas, la gauche ou la droite
Utilisez ces boutons pour naviguer sur les menus.
Bouton Set
Utilisez ce bouton pour confirmer les slections faites dans les menus.
Bouton Disp
Appuyez sur ce bouton pour afficher des informations importantes sur le moniteur de 10" de la
Studio Camera, notamment :
Les repres de cadrage contenant les paramtres de la camra et de l'objectif, tels que le
numro de la camra, le format vido et la frquence d'images, la vitesse d'obturation, la
balance des blancs, l'autonomie de la batterie, les paramtres de gain et l'ouverture.
Appuyez de nouveau sur le bouton Disp pour masquer les informations l'cran et visionner l'image
uniquement. Les informations l'cran sont visibles sur l'cran de 10". La sortie SDI est toujours propre.

REMARQUE Les Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 et Studio Camera 4K 2 ne comprennent pas


de batterie interne. Ces camras ne peuvent donc pas afficher le temps de charge restant.

Menu Paramtres 122


Bouton Menu
OPTICAL OUT
Appuyez sur ce bouton pour faire apparatre le menu, puis naviguez l'aide des boutons flche.
OPTICAL IN

Bouton de mise en marche


SDI OUT

Appuyez sur le bouton de mise en marche pour allumer la Blackmagic Studio Camera. Appuyez sur
SDI IN le bouton et maintenez-le enfonc pour teindre la camra.

REF

12V

OPTICAL OUT OPTICAL OUT OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN OPTICAL IN OPTICAL IN

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT FOCUS IRIS SET PTT PGM LUT
DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRISSET PTT PGM DISPLAY
LUT MENU SET DISPLAY MENU
SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT

SDI IN SDI IN SDI IN

REF REF REF

12V 12V 12V

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU

Pour slectionner la mise au point Appuyez sur le bouton Iris pour La Studio Camera dispose de
automatique, appuyez une fois sur une exposition automatique ou paramtres essentiels pour la
le bouton Focus. Pour activer le utilisez les boutons de navigation production en direct, tels que
focus peaking, appuyez deux fois flches vers le bas ou vers le haut PTT et PGM.
rapidement sur le bouton Focus. pour une exposition manuelle.

Sortie vido de la camra


Connexion des mlangeurs vido
Les Blackmagic Studio Cameras acheminent de la vido 4:2:2 10 bits, ce qui vous permet de vous
connecter des mlangeurs broadcast ainsi qu' d'autres priphriques vido SDI. En installant un
module SFP vous pouvez vous connecter via fibre optique, il n'est donc pas ncessaire de
connecter de convertisseurs ATEM Camera Converters la camra.
Si vous utilisez une Blackmagic Studio Camera HD ou Studio Camera, vous pouvez facilement
visualiser la sortie du programme (PGM) sur le mlangeur. Il suffit de connecter le mlangeur
l'entre SDI de votre Studio Camera ou l'entre fibre optique lorsqu'un module SFP est install
surla camra.
La Blackmagic Studio Camera comporte galement une entre de rfrence qui permet de
multiples camras d'tre synchronises un signal blackburst ou tri-level. Le fait de synchroniser
des camras, magntoscopes et autres appareils un signal de rfrence externe facilite
l'limination d'erreurs de timing qui peuvent provoquer un saut de l'image lors de la commutation
entre diffrentes sources.

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

OPTICAL OUT

SDI IN
OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

REF
SDI IN

REF

12V

12V

Vous pouvez connecter votre Studio Camera un mlangeur via SDI,


ou via fibre optique lorsquun module SFP est install.

Sortie vido de la camra 123


Connexion des enregistreurs
Si vous souhaitez enregistrer le signal de sortie de votre Studio Camera, il vous suffit de connecter
la sortie SDI l'entre SDI d'un enregistreur SSD comme le Blackmagic Hyperdeck Shuttle. La sortie
SDI de l'HyperDeck peut ensuite tre connecte l'entre SDI de la Studio Camera, ce qui vous
permet de visualiser vos enregistrements sur l'cran LCD de la camra.

+12V POWER HDMI IN HDMI OUT SDI IN SDI OUT

+12V POWER HDMI IN HDMI OUT SDI IN SDI OUT

Connectez la sortie SDI de la camra l'entre SDI de l'HyperDeck et connectez la sortie


SDI de l'HyperDeck l'entre SDI de la camra pour visionner vos enregistrements.

Connecter le tally avec la


Blackmagic3G-SDI Shield
Si vous utilisez un mlangeur SDI quip d'une sortie tally, vous pouvez la connecter une
Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield. Cela permettra d'envoyer les signaux tally aux Blackmagic
Studio Camera. Mme si vous n'utilisez pas de mlangeur ATEM, le flux de programme SDI
permettra denvoyer le signal tally vers les camras Blackmagic.
Par exemple, le port tally parallle du mlangeur peut tre connect aux broches D2 - D9 de la
Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield. La sortie SDI de cette carte Arduino est alors connecte toutes
les camras Blackmagic via un distributeur de signal, tel qu'un Blackmagic Mini Converter SDI
Distribution. Vous pouvez ainsi envoyer le signal tally vers huis camras Blackmagic diffrentes.
Les numros des camras Blackmagic doivent correspondre aux sorties tally du mlangeur. Il faudra
peut-tre connecter un connecteur personnalis pour vous assurer que les broches correspondent
bien aux numros des camras. La broche terre du connecteur tally du mlangeur doit tre
connecte la broche terre de l'Arduino Shield.
Veuillez trouver ci-dessous un exemple indiquant les numros des camras Blackmagic
correspondants aux sorties tally du mlangeur. Ces sorties sont ensuite connectes aux broches sur
le Blackmagic Arduino Shield.

Numro de la camra Numro de l'entre Broche Arduino


Blackmagic du mlangeur

1 1 D2

2 2 D3

3 3 D4

4 4 D5

5 5 D6

6 6 D7

7 7 D8

8 8 D9

Connecter le tally avec la Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield 124


L'exemple de sketch ci-dessous indique comment la Blackmagic Arduino Shield est programme
pour envoyer un signal tally une camra utilisant le signal de sortie du programme. Tous les
mlangeurs SDI qui comprennent des sorties tally collecteur ouvert peuvent prendre en charge ce
signal grce une Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield. Pour plus d'information, tlchargez le
manuel d'utilisation de la Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield sur la page d'assistance Blackmagic
Design : www.blackmagicdesign.com/fr/support.

L'exemple de sketch ci-dessous indique comment l Blackmagic Arduino Shield est programme pour
dtecter un signal tally sur les entres 1 et 2 via la sortie tally du mlangeur. Ce signal tally est ensuite intgr
la sortie SDI de la carte extension. Le voyant tally de la camra correspondante s'allume.

Connecter le tally avec la Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield 125


1

PUSH
2

PUSHBlackmagic Camera Setup


Comment mettre jour le logiciel de votre camra sous Mac OS X
Aprs avoir tlcharg le logiciel Blackmagic Camera Setup, dzippez le fichier tlcharg et
double-cliquez sur le fichier .dmg. Lancez l'utilitaire Blackmagic Camera Setup et suivez les
instructions affiches lcran.

Logiciel Blackmagic Camera Setup

1
PUSH

Comment mettre jour le logiciel de votre camra sous Windows


2
PUSH

Aprs avoir tlcharg le logiciel Blackmagic Camera Setup et dzipp le fichier tlcharg,
lafentre Blackmagic Camera Setup devrait safficher pour vous permettre d'installer l'utilitaire.
Double-cliquez sur l'icne d'installation et suivez les instructions affiches lcran pour terminer
linstallation.
Une fois l'installation termine, cliquez sur le menu Dmarrer et allez sur Tous les programmes.
Cliquez sur le dossier Blackmagic Design pour ouvrir le logiciel Blackmagic Camera Setup et le
manuel d'utilisation.

Mise jour du logiciel interne de la camra


Aprs avoir install le logiciel Blackmagic Camera Setup le plus rcent sur votre ordinateur,
connectez un cble USB entre lordinateur et la camra. Le port Mini-B USB 2.0 est situ sous
la camra.
Lancez le logiciel Blackmagic Camera Setup et suivez les instructions affiches lcran pour
mettre jour le logiciel de la camra.

Les ports Mini-B USB 2.0 sont situs sous la camra.

Blackmagic Camera Setup 126


Fixer les accessoires
Pare-soleil
La Studio Camera inclut un pare-soleil pliable pour abriter lcran lorsque la luminosit est forte et
assurer un affichage optimal en permanence.
1 Reprez les 6 vis ailes se trouvant sur votre Studio Camera.
2 Alignez les trous situs sur le pare-soleil avec les points de montage de la camra et vissez
2 vis ailes sur le dessus et les deux cts de la camra pour que le pare-soleil tienne
bien en place.

Autres accessoires
Pour les productions en studio, vous pouvez avoir besoin de monter la camra sur un support et
d'utiliser des rails pour les gros objectifs broadcast et les prompteurs. Pour la production en plein air,
vous prfrerez peut-tre utiliser des micros, des batteries externes ou des contrleurs distance
LANC. La camra dispose de deux pas de vis de 3/8 sur la face infrieure, et de dix pas de vis de
1/4 sur les cts et la face suprieure. Cela signifie que vous avez la flexibilit de configurer votre
matriel pour n'importe quel type de production.

1
1
PUSH

3
2

2
1
PUSH

3
2

Utiliser l'ATEM Software Control


Fonction Camera Control
La Blackmagic Studio Camera peut tre contrle partir d'un mlangeur ATEM au moyen de la
fonction Camera Control du logiciel ATEM Software Control. Pour ouvrir la fonction Camera Control,
il suffit de cliquer sur le bouton Camera. Les paramtres tels que l'iris, le gain, la mise au point et le
contrle du zoom sont facilement ajustables avec des objectifs compatibles. Vous pouvez
galement ajuster l'quilibrage des camras et crer des rendus fabuleux l'aide de l'outil
d'talonnage primaire de DaVinci Resolve.
Le mlangeur ATEM contrle la camra en diffusant des paquets de contrle via toutes les sorties SDI
de votre mlangeur qui ne sont pas down-converties. Cela signifie que vous pouvez connecter une
sortie SDI de votre mlangeur ATEM l'entre vido de la camra et cette dernire dtectera les
paquets de contrle dans la connexion SDI et vous permettra de contrler les fonctionnalits de la
camra. Vous pouvez contrler votre camra partir de la connexion SDI, ou partir de la connexion
fibre optique en option lorsqu'un module SFP est install.

Utiliser l'ATEM Software Control 127


Fonction Camera Control de lATEM

Connexion via SDI


1 Connectez la sortie SDI de votre Blackmagic Studio Camera n'importe quelle entre SDI
du mlangeur ATEM.
2 Connectez n'importe quelle sortie SDI du mlangeur ATEM, except les sorties down-
converties ou Multi View, l'entre SDI de votre Studio Camera. Les signaux Camera
Control ne sont pas achemins via les sorties SDI down-converties et multi view.
3 Appuyez sur le bouton Menu de votre Blackmagic Studio Camera. Allez sur Studio >Camera
Number et faites correspondre le numro l'entre du mlangeur. Par exemple, si la Studio
Camera 1 est connecte la Cam 1 sur le mlangeur ATEM, le numro de la camra doit
galement tre configur sur 1. Ainsi, le tally est envoy la bonne camra.

IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 1 IN 3 1 1 3 1 REMOTE REMOTE
1 3 5 1 7 3 9 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH
STEREO IN

CONTROL CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 IN 2 2 HD 2 HD HD HD HD HD
1 2 4 1 6 2 8 4 10 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 REF IN
PREVIEW AUXPROGRAM
1-3 PREVIEW
OUTPUTS PROGRAM OUTPUTS
MULTI-VIEW MULTI-VIEW
ANALOG AUDIO IN

IN IN IN IN IN 1 3 1 REMOTE
All SDI and HDMI video connections are
1 3 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH SD, HD and Ultra HD switchable unless indicated

CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 2 HD HD HD
1 2 4 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2 CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 PREVIEW PROGRAM OUTPUTS MULTI-VIEW ANALOG AUDIO IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT

Connectez votre Blackmagic Studio Camera n'importe quelle entre SDI du mlangeur ATEM.

Utiliser l'ATEM Software Control 128


Connexion via fibre optique
1 Lorsque vous avez install le module SFP fibre optique sur votre Studio Camera, connectez
l'entre/sortie fibre optique de la camra l'entre/sortie fibre optique d'un ATEM Studio
Converter.
2 Connectez une sortie SDI approprie de l'ATEM Studio Converter n'importe quelle entre
SDI du mlangeur ATEM.
3 Connectez n'importe quelle sortie SDI du mlangeur ATEM, except les sorties down-
converties ou Multi View, l'entre SDI de l'ATEM Studio Converter. Les signaux Camera
Control ne sont pas achemins via les sorties SDI down-converties et multi view.
4 Appuyez sur le bouton Menu de votre Blackmagic Studio Camera. Allez sur Studio >Camera
Number et faites correspondre le numro l'entre du mlangeur. Par exemple, si la Studio
Camera 1 est connecte la Cam 1 sur le mlangeur ATEM, le numro de la camra doit
galement tre configur sur 1. Ainsi, le tally est envoy la bonne camra.
Ouvrez les prfrences de l'ATEM Software Control et configurez le mappage des boutons du
mlangeur pour garantir une commutation de la camra avec le tally appropri. Vous avez prsent
une connexion vido partant du mlangeur vers votre Blackmagic Studio Camera, vous pouvez
galement bnficier des indicateurs tally en direct sur la camra. De plus, il est possible de
visualiser le flux de programme du mlangeur en appuyant sur le bouton PGM de votre camra.

AES/EBU TALKBACK LOOPS

3 1 4 2 OUT
3OUT OUT
4

L R

UT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT IN IN SDI OUT IN

L +12V
R BACKUP L L R R L L R R L R
POWER USB 2.0
OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN
OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG
ANALOG AUDIO OUTAUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO
OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG
OUT AUDIO OUT PGM SDI OPTICAL
MICOUT/IN H/PHONE ANALOG AUDIO OUT OP

AES/EBU TALKBACK LOOPS

1 2 3 4 OUT OUT OUT

L R

SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT IN IN IN

+12V BACKUP L R L R L R L R
POWER USB 2.0 OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT PGM SDI MIC H/PHONE

Connectez plusieurs Blackmagic Studio Camera via fibre optique au moyen d'un ATEM Studio Converter.

Utilisation de la fonction Camera Control


Lancez le logiciel ATEM Software Control et cliquez sur le bouton Camera situ au bas de la fentre
du logiciel. Vous apercevrez une range de fentres qui permettent de commander toutes les
camras et qui contiennent des outils puissants pour ajuster et affiner l'image de chaque camra.
Les commandes sont trs faciles utiliser. Il vous suffit de cliquer sur les boutons l'aide de votre
souris, ou de cliquer et dplacer les curseurs pour effectuer des ajustements.

Slection de la camra commander


La range de boutons situe sur le haut de la fentre de contrle de la camra vous permet de
slectionner le numro de la camra que vous souhaitez commander. Si plusieurs camras
apparaissent sur cette fentre, ou si vous utilisez la fentre de correction colorimtrique, appuyez
simplement sur ces boutons pour slectionner la camra que vous souhaitez commander. Si vous
utilisez une sortie auxiliaire pour le monitoring du Camera Control, les modifications apportes
aux signaux de chaque camra seront galement envoyes vers la sortie auxiliaire choisie.
Lasortie auxiliaire correspondant la fonction Camera Control peut tre configure dans les
paramtres du mlangeur.

Utiliser l'ATEM Software Control 129


tat du canal
La section tat du canal est situe dans la partie suprieure de chaque fentre de contrle de
camra et affiche le libell de la camra, l'indicateur de passage l'antenne et le bouton de
verrouillage. Appuyez sur le bouton de verrouillage pour verrouiller toutes les commandes relatives
une camra spcifique. Lorsque la camra est l'antenne, la section tat du canal s'allume en
rouge et affiche l'alerte On Air.

Chaque fentre de contrle de camra affiche


l'tat du canal afin que vous sachiez quelle
camra est l'antenne. Utilisez les roues
chromatiques pour ajuster les paramtres
Lift, Gamma et Gain de chaque canal YRGB.

Roues chromatiques
La roue chromatique est une fonctionnalit puissante du correcteur de couleurs DaVinci Resolve et
permet d'effectuer des ajustements de couleur pour les paramtres Lift, Gamma et Gain de chaque
canal YRGB. Pour slectionner le paramtre ajuster, il vous suffit de cliquer sur un des trois
boutons de slection situs au-dessus de la roue chromatique.

Roue matresse
Utilisez la roue matresse situe sous la roue chromatique pour effectuer des ajustements de
contraste sur tous les canaux YRGB en mme temps, ou uniquement de luminance pour les
paramtres lift, gamma ou gain.

Paramtres du menu Camera


Le bouton de paramtrage de la camra situ en bas gauche de la roue matresse vous permet
d'activer la fonction mire de barres couleurs sur les Blackmagic Studio Cameras, Micro Studio
Cameras et URSA Mini, mais aussi d'ajuster les dtails du signal d'image de chaque camra.

Afficher/masquer la mire de barres couleurs


Les Blackmagic Studio Cameras intgrent une fonction mire de barres couleurs que vous pouvez
activer et dsactiver en slectionnant Afficher la mire de barres couleurs ou Masquer la mire de
barres couleurs. Cette fonction est trs utile pour identifier individuellement les camras lors de la
mise en place de votre production en direct. La mire de barres couleurs fournit galement une
tonalit pour vous permettre de vrifier et de rgler les niveaux audio de chaque camra.

Dtails
Ce paramtre permet de rgler la nettet de l'image en direct des camras. Rduisez ou augmentez
le niveau de nettet en slectionnant : Dsactiver les dtails, Dtails par dfaut pour une nettet
faible, Dtails moyens et Dtails levs.

Utiliser l'ATEM Software Control 130


Le bouton de paramtrage de la camra vous permet d'activer
et de dsactiver la mire de barres couleurs et d'ajuster la nettet
d'image des camras Blackmagic connectes au mlangeur.

Boutons de rinitialisation
Le bouton de rinitialisation situ en bas droite de la fentre de contrle de la camra vous permet
de choisir aisment les paramtres de correction colorimtrique que vous souhaitez rinitialiser,
copier ou coller. Chaque roue chromatique possde galement son propre bouton de rinitialisation.
Appuyez sur ce bouton pour restaurer le paramtre par dfaut, ou pour copier/coller un paramtre.
Les fentres de contrle de camra verrouilles ne sont pas affectes par la fonction Coller.
Le bouton de rinitialisation principal est situ en bas droite de la fentre de correction
colorimtrique. Il vous permet de rinitialiser les roues chromatiques Lift, Gamma et Gain ainsi que
les paramtres Contraste, Teinte, Saturation et Lum Mix. Vous pouvez coller les paramtres de
correction colorimtrique des fentres de contrle de camra individuelles ou toutes les fentres
en mme temps pour crer un rendu uniforme. Les paramtres relatifs l'iris, la mise au point et au
niveau de noir ainsi que le paramtre Limite ne sont pas affects par la fonction Coller. Lorsque vous
souhaitez appliquer la fonction Coller tout, un message apparat pour vous demander de confirmer
votre action. De cette faon, vous ne collez pas de nouveaux paramtres accidentellement aux
camras non verrouilles en cours de diffusion.

Lorsque vous souhaitez appliquer la fonction Coller tout, un message


apparat pour vous demander de confirmer votre action. De cette faon,
vous ne collez pas de nouveaux paramtres accidentellement aux camras
non verrouilles en cours de diffusion.

Contrle de l'iris et du niveau de noir


Le bouton de l'iris et du niveau de noir est situ dans le pointeur en croix de chaque fentre de
contrle des camras. Le contrle s'allume en rouge lorsque la camra est l'antenne.

Utiliser l'ATEM Software Control 131


Le contrle de l'iris/niveau de noir s'allume
en rouge lorsque la camra est l'antenne.

Pour ouvrir ou fermer l'iris, dplacez le bouton vers le haut ou vers le bas. En maintenant la touche
SHIFT enfonce, vous pouvez ajuster uniquement l'iris.
Pour assombrir ou claircir le niveau de noir, dplacez le bouton vers la gauche ou vers la droite.
Enmaintenant la touche Command (Mac) ou Control (Windows) enfonce, vous pourrez ajuster
uniquement le niveau de noir.

Contrle du zoom
Lorsque vous utilisez des objectifs compatibles dots d'un zoom lectronique, vous pouvez
effectuer des zooms avant et arrire l'aide de la fonction de contrle du zoom. Cette fonction
fonctionne de la mme manire que la bague de zoom sur un objectif, avec le tlobjectif d'un ct
et le grand-angle de l'autre. Cliquez sur le contrle du zoom situ au-dessus du curseur Limite,
etdplacez-le vers le haut pour faire un zoom avant ou vers le bas pour faire un zoom arrire.
Si votre objectif ne dispose pas d'un contrle actif de l'objectif ou si votre camra ne prend pas en
charge le contrle du zoom via le protocole SDI de contrle de camra, alors ces paramtres
n'auront aucune incidence. Si vous utilisez une Blackmagic Studio Camera ou Blackmagic Studio
Camera 4K, assurez-vous que la mise jour logicielle v1.9.11 ou ultrieure est installe afin de
bnficier du contrle d'objectif Micro 4/3 avec zoom actif.

Paramtre Limite
Le paramtre Coarse est situ gauche du contrle de l'iris/niveau de noir et permet de limiter
l'ouverture de l'iris. Cette fonctionnalit vous aide ne pas faire passer des images surexposes
l'antenne.
Pour configurer cette limite, ouvrez compltement l'iris l'aide de la fonction de contrle de l'iris,
puis dplacez le curseur vers le haut ou vers le bas pour configurer l'exposition optimale. prsent,
lorsque vous ajustez l'iris, la limite que vous avez configure l'aide du paramtre Limite
l'empchera de dpasser l'exposition optimale.

Indicateur de l'iris
L'indicateur de l'iris est situ droite du contrle de l'iris/niveau de noir et fait office de rfrence
visuelle vous permettant de visualiser l'ouverture de lentille. L'indicateur de l'iris est affect par le
paramtre Limite.

Utiliser l'ATEM Software Control 132


Bouton de mise au point automatique
Le bouton de mise au point automatique est situ en bas gauche de chaque fentre de contrle
de camra. Appuyez sur ce bouton pour un rglage automatique de la mise au point lorsque vous
utilisez un objectif actif qui prend en charge les ajustements de mise au point lectronique. La
plupart des objectifs prennent en charge la mise au point automatique, cependant, certains dentre
eux peuvent tre rgls en mode manuel ou automatique. Il vous faudra donc vrifier que votre
objectif est rgl en mode automatique. Pour ce faire, il suffit parfois de faire glisser la bague de
mise au point vers l'avant ou vers l'arrire.

Cliquez sur le bouton de mise au point automatique ou dplacez le curseur de mise au point
manuelle vers la gauche ou vers la droite pour effectuer la mise au point d'un objectif compatible.

Rglage manuel de la mise au point


Lorsque vous souhaitez ajuster manuellement la mise au point sur votre camra, vous pouvez utiliser
l'ajustement de mise au point situ au bas de chaque fentre de contrle de camra. Dplacez la
roue vers la gauche ou vers la droite pour ajuster manuellement la mise au point tout en visualisant
l'image pour vous assurer qu'elle est nette.

Gain de la camra
Le paramtre relatif au gain de la camra vous permet d'ajouter du gain supplmentaire votre
camra. C'est trs important lorsque vous travaillez dans des conditions o la lumire est minime et
que vous avez besoin de gain supplmentaire au niveau du capteur pour viter que vos images ne
soient sous-exposes. Vous pouvez rduire ou augmenter le gain en cliquant sur les flches gauche
ou droite situes ct du paramtre gain (dB).
Il est possible d'ajouter du gain tout moment, par exemple lorsque la lumire baisse au coucher du
soleil lors d'un tournage en extrieur et qu'il vous faut augmenter la luminosit de votre image. Il faut
bien garder l'esprit que le fait d'ajouter du gain augmentera le bruit dans vos images.

Contrle de la vitesse d'obturation


Le contrle de la vitesse d'obturation est situ dans la section entre la roue chromatique et le
contrle de l'iris/niveau de noir. Rduisez ou augmentez la vitesse d'obturation en faisant passer le
pointeur de votre souris sur l'indicateur de la vitesse d'obturation, puis cliquez sur les flches gauche
ou droite.
Si vous observez des scintillements, vous pouvez diminuer votre vitesse d'obturation pour les
liminer. Diminuer la vitesse d'obturation est un bon moyen d'claircir vos images sans utiliser le
gain de la camra, car vous augmentez ainsi le temps de pose du capteur d'image. Le fait
d'augmenter la vitesse d'obturation rduira le flou de boug, ce qui est idal lorsque vous souhaitez
obtenir des scnes d'action nettes avec un flou de boug minimal.

Balance des blancs (White Balance)


Le paramtre de balance des blancs est situ ct du contrle de la vitesse d'obturation. Il peut
tre rgl en utilisant les flches gauche et droite situes de chaque ct de l'indicateur de
temprature de couleur. Les sources lumineuses mettent des couleurs plus ou moins chaudes ou
froides qui peuvent tre rgles l'aide de la balance des blancs. Les blancs de votre image
demeureront ainsi rellement blancs.

Utiliser l'ATEM Software Control 133


Faites passer le pointeur de votre souris sur les indicateurs
de gain, de vitesse d'obturation et de balance des blancs pour
faire apparatre les flches qui vous permettront d'ajuster leurs
paramtres respectifs.

Outil d'talonnage primaire de DaVinci Resolve


Si vous avez de l'exprience dans le domaine de la correction colorimtrique, il est possible de
changer l'interface de commande des camras pour obtenir un style d'interface qui ressemble
celle d'un outil d'talonnage primaire communment install sur les systmes dtalonnage.
La Blackmagic Studio Camera intgre le correcteur colorimtrique primaire DaVinci Resolve. Si vous
avez utilis DaVinci Resolve auparavant, crativement parlant, l'talonnage sur la Blackmagic Studio
Camera sera identique celui de DaVinci, vous aurez donc loccasion de mettre votre exprience
d'talonnage profit pour la production en direct.
La fentre de correction colorimtrique peut tre agrandie et fournit un contrle de correction
colorimtrique plus tendu comprenant des paramtres supplmentaires ainsi qu'une interface de
correction colorimtrique primaire complte.
Vous disposez prsent de roues chromatiques et de paramtres, tels que la saturation. Vous
pouvez galement visualiser tous les paramtres relatifs aux basses lumires, aux tons moyens et
aux hautes lumires en mme temps. Il vous suffit de commuter entre les camras l'aide des
commandes de slection situes sur le haut de la fentre lorsqu'il est ncessaire.

Cliquez sur le bouton DaVinci Resolve pour agrandir la fentre


de correction colorimtrique et ajuster les paramtres.

Roues chromatiques
Les commandes Lift/Gamma/Gain permettent de contrler des zones en fonction de leurs tons,
mme si elles se chevauchent. En photographie, les termes lift, gamma et gain correspondent aux
basses lumires, tons moyens et hautes lumires.

Utiliser l'ATEM Software Control 134


Roues chromatiques Lift, Gamma et Gain dans la fentre de correction colorimtrique.

Utilisez les roues chromatiques de l'une ou l'autre des faons dcrites ci-aprs pour effectuer des
ajustements minutieux ou extrmes :

Cliquez et dplacez-vous n'importe o dans le cercle de couleur : Notez qu'il n'est
pas ncessaire de positionner votre pointeur sur l'indicateur de la balance des couleurs.
Lorsque l'indicateur de la balance des couleurs se dplace, les paramtres RGB situs sous
la roue chromatique se modifient pour reflter les ajustements apports chaque canal.
Cliquez en maintenant le bouton SHIFT enfonc et dplacez-vous n'importe o dans
le cercle de couleur : L'indicateur de la balance des couleurs se positionnera l'endroit
mme o se trouve le pointeur, ce qui vous permet de faire des ajustements plus rapides
et extrmes.
Double-cliquez n'importe o dans le cercle de couleur : Rinitialise l'ajustement apport la
couleur sans rinitialiser l'ajustement apport la roue matresse pour la commande en question.
Cliquez sur la commande de rinitialisation situe en haut droite du cercle de
couleur : Rinitialise le contrle de la balance des couleurs ainsi que la roue matresse
correspondante.

Roues matresses
Utilisez les roues matresses situes sous les roues chromatiques pour ajuster les commandes Lift,
Gamma et Gain de chaque canal YRGB.

Ajustez les roues matresses en dplaant la commande vers la gauche ou vers la droite.

Pour effectuer des ajustements l'aide de la roue matresse :


Dplacez la roue matresse vers la gauche ou vers la droite : Un dplacement vers la
gauche assombrit le paramtre slectionn de l'image alors qu'un dplacement vers la
droite claircit ce mme paramtre. Lors de l'ajustement, les paramtres YRGB situs
au-dessous de la roue matresse se modifient pour reflter l'ajustement en cours. Pour
effectuer un ajustement n'affectant que la luminance, maintenez la touche ALT ou Command
enfonce et dplacez la roue vers la gauche ou vers la droite. Comme le correcteur
colorimtrique prend en charge un traitement YRGB, il vous permet de faire preuve de
crativit et de crer des effets uniques en ajustant uniquement le canal Y. Les ajustements
du canal Y fonctionnent mieux lorsque le paramtre Lum Mix est rgl sur le ct droit pour
un traitement YRGB et sur le ct gauche pour un traitement RGB standard. En gnral, la
plupart des coloristes DaVinci Resolve utilisent le correcteur colorimtrique YRGB, car on
obtient une meilleure matrise de la balance des couleurs sans affecter le gain gnral. Il
vous faudra ainsi moins de temps pour obtenir le rendu dsir.

Utiliser l'ATEM Software Control 135


Dplacez les curseurs vers la gauche ou vers la droite pour ajuster
les paramtres Contraste, Saturation, Teinte et Lum Mix.

Paramtre Contraste
Le paramtre Contraste vous permet de contrler la distance entre les valeurs les plus sombres et
les plus claires d'une image. L'effet ressemble celui effectu lorsque vous utilisez les roues
matresses Lift et Gain. Par dfaut, ce paramtre est rgl sur 50 %.

Paramtre Saturation
Le paramtre Saturation augmente ou rduit la quantit de couleur de l'image. Par dfaut,
ceparamtre est rgl sur 50 %.

Paramtre Teinte
Le paramtre Teinte fait tourner toutes les teintes de l'image sur le primtre complet de la roue
chromatique. Le paramtre par dfaut de 180 degrs affiche la distribution originale des teintes.
L'augmentation ou la diminution de cette valeur fait tourner toutes les teintes vers l'avant ou vers
l'arrire selon la distribution des teintes d'une roue chromatique.

Paramtre Lum Mix


Le correcteur colorimtrique intgr votre Blackmagic Studio Camera est bas sur le correcteur
colorimtrique primaire DaVinci Resolve. DaVinci cre des logiciels de correction colorimtrique
depuis le dbut des annes 80 et la plupart des films hollywoodiens sont talonns sur
DaVinci Resolve.
Cela signifie que le correcteur colorimtrique intgr votre Blackmagic Studio Camera possde
des fonctionnalits uniques et puissantes sur le plan cratif. Le traitement YRGB est l'une de ces
fonctionnalits.
Lorsque vous talonnez, vous pouvez choisir entre un traitement RGB ou un traitement YRGB.
Lescoloristes professionnels utilisent le traitement YRGB, car ils obtiennent ainsi un contrle plus
prcis de la couleur et peuvent ajuster les canaux de faon indpendante avec une meilleure
sparation et davantage d'options cratives.
Lorsque le paramtre Lum Mix est rgl sur le ct droit, vous avez une sortie provenant 100 % du
correcteur colorimtrique YRGB. Lorsque le paramtre Lum Mix est rgl sur le ct gauche,
vousobtenez une sortie provenant 100 % du correcteur RGB. Vous pouvez rgler le paramtre
Lum Mix sur n'importe quelle position entre la gauche et la droite pour obtenir un mlange de sorties
provenant des deux correcteurs RGB et YRGB.
Quelle est la configuration idale ? Cela ne tient qu' vous, car la correction colorimtrique est un
procd purement cratif o il n'y a pas de vrai ou de faux. Le meilleur paramtrage est donc celui
qui vous plat le plus !

Synchronisation des paramtres


Lorsque les deux appareils sont connects, les signaux Camera Control sont envoys du mlangeur
ATEM votre Blackmagic Studio Camera. Si un paramtre est accidentellement ajust partir de
votre Studio Camera, la fonction Camera Control rinitialisera automatiquement le paramtre en
question pour maintenir la synchronisation.

Utiliser l'ATEM Software Control 136


Developer Information
Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol
Version 1.1
If you are a software developer you can use the SDI Camera Control Protocol to construct devices
that integrate with our products. Here at Blackmagic Design our approach is to open up our
protocols and we eagerly look forward to seeing what you come up with!

Overview
The Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol is used by ATEM switchers, Blackmagic 3G-SDI
Arduino Shield and Blackmagic Camera Remote to provide Camera Control functionality with
supported Blackmagic Design cameras. Please refer to the Understanding Studio Camera Control
chapter section of this manual, or the ATEM Switchers Manual and SDKmanual for more information.
These can be downloaded at www.blackmagicdesign.com/support.
This document describes an extensible protocol for sending a uni directional stream of small control
messages embedded in the non-active picture region of a digital video stream. Thevideo stream
containing the protocol stream may be broadcast to a number of devices. Device addressing is used
to allow the sender to specify which device each message is directed to.

Assumptions
Alignment and padding constraints are explicitly described in the protocol document. Bit fields are
packed from LSB first. Message groups, individual messages and command headers are defined as,
and can be assumed to be, 32 bit aligned.

Blanking Encoding
A message group is encoded into a SMPTE 291M packet with DID/SDID x51/x53 in the active region
of VANC line 16.

Message Grouping
Up to 32 messages may be concatenated and transmitted in one blanking packet up to a maximum
of 255 bytes payload. Under most circumstances, this should allow all messages to be sent with a
maximum of one frame latency.
If the transmitting device queues more bytes of message packets than can be sent in a single frame,
it should use heuristics to determine which packets to prioritize and send immediately. Lower priority
messages can be delayed to later frames, or dropped entirely as appropriate.

Abstract Message Packet Format


Every message packet consists of a three byte header followed by an optional variable length data
block. The maximum packet size is 64 bytes.

Device addresses are represented as an 8 bit unsigned integer. Individual


Destination device (uint8) devices are numbered 0 through 254 with the value 255 reserved to
indicate a broadcast message to all devices.

The command length is an 8 bit unsigned integer which specifies the


Command length (uint8) length of the included command data. The length does NOT include the
length of the header or any trailing padding bytes.

Developer Information 137


The command id is an 8 bit unsigned integer which indicates themessage
type being sent. Receiving devices should ignore any commands that they
Command id (uint8) do not understand. Commands 0 through 127 are reserved for commands
that apply to multiple types of devices. Commands 128 through 255 are
device specific.

This byte is reserved for alignment and expansion purposes. Itshould be


Reserved (uint8)
set to zero.

The command data may contain between 0 and 60 bytes of data.


Command data(uint8[])
Theformat of the data section is defined by the command itself.

Messages must be padded up to a 32 bit boundary with 0x0bytes. Any


Padding(uint8[])
padding bytes are NOT included in the command length.

Receiving devices should use the destination device address and or the command identifier to
determine which messages to process. The receiver should use the command length to skip
irrelevant or unknown commands and should be careful to skip the implicit padding as well.

Defined Commands
Command 0 : change configuration

The category number specifies one of up to 256 configuration categories


Category (uint8)
available on the device.

The parameter number specifies one of 256 potential configuration


parameters available on the device. Parameters 0 through 127 are device
Parameter (uint8)
specific parameters. Parameters 128 though 255 are reserved for
parameters that apply to multiple types of devices.

The data type specifies the type of the remaining data. Thepacket length is
Data type (uint8) used to determine the number of elements in the message. Each message
must contain an integral number of data elements.

Currently defined values are:

A void value is represented as a boolean array of length zero.


0: void / boolean The data field is a 8 bit value with 0 meaning false and all other values
meaning true.

1: signed byte Data elements are signed bytes

2: signed 16bit integer Data elements are signed 16 bit values

3: signed 32bit integer Data elements are signed 32 bit values

4: signed 64bit integer Data elements are signed 64 bit values

5: UTF-8 string Data elements represent a UTF-8 string with no terminating character.

Data types 6 through 127 are reserved.

Data elements are signed 16 bit integers representing a real number with
5 bits for the integer component and 11 bits for the fractional component.
128: signed 5.11fixed point The fixed point representation is equal to the real value multiplied by 2^11.
The representable range is from -16.0 to 15.9995
(15 + 2047/2048).

Developer Information 138


Data types 129 through 255 are available for device specific purposes.

The operation type specifies what action to perform on the specified


Operation type (uint8)
parameter. Currently defined values are:

The supplied values are assigned to the specified parameter. Each


element will be clamped according to its valid range. A void parameter
0: assign value may only be assigned an empty list of boolean type. This operation will
trigger the action associated with that parameter. A boolean value may be
assigned the value zero for false, and any other value for true.

Each value specifies signed offsets of the same type to be added to the
current parameter values. The resulting parameter value will be clamped
1: offset / toggle value according to their valid range. It is not valid to apply an offset to a void
value. Applying any offset other than zero to a boolean value will invert
that value.

Operation types 2 through 127 are reserved.

Operation types 128through 255 are available for device specific purposes.

The data field is 0 or more bytes as determined by the data type and
Data (void)
number of elements.

The category, parameter, data type and operation type partition a 24 bit operation space.

Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

0
.0 Focus fixed16 0 1 0.0=near, 1.0=far
trigger
.1 Instantaneous autofocus void
instantaneous autofocus
Aperture Value (where
.2 Aperture (f-stop) fixed16 -1 16
fnumber = sqrt(2^AV))
.3 Aperture (normalised) fixed16 0 1 0.0=smallest, 1.0=largest
Steps through available
aperture values from
.4 Aperture (ordinal) int16 0 n
minimum (0) to
maximum (n)
Instantaneous trigger instantaneous
.5 void
Lens auto aperture auto aperture
Optical image true=enabled,
.6 boolean
stabilisation false=disabled
Move to specified focal
length in mm, from
.7 Set absolute zoom (mm) int16 0 max
minimum (0) to
maximum (max)
Set absolute zoom Move to specified focal
.8 fixed16 0 1
(normalised) length: 0.0=wide, 1.0=tele
Start/stop zooming at
Set continuous specified rate: -1.0=zoom
.9 fixed16 -1 +1.0
zoom (speed) wider fast, 0.0=stop,
+1=zoom tele fast

Developer Information 139


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation
1
[0] = frame rate 24, 25, 30, 50, 60
[1] = M-rate 0=regular, 1=M-rate
0=NTSC, 1=PAL, 2=720,
[2] = dimensions 3=1080, 4=2k, 5=2k DCI,
.0 Video mode int8 6=4k, 7=4k DCI
0=progressive,
[3] = interlaced
1=interlaced
[4] =
0=YUV
colour space
.1 Sensor Gain int8 1 16 1x, 2x, 4x, 8x, 16x gain
int16 color temp 2500 10000 Colour temperature in K
.2 Manual White Balance
int16 tint -50 50 tint
Calculate and set auto
.3 Set auto WB void
white balance
Use latest auto white
.4 Restore auto WB void
balance setting
.5 Exposure (us) int32 1 42000 time in us
Steps through
availableexposure
.6 Exposure (ordinal) int16 0 n
valuesfrom minimum (0)
tomaximum (n)
int8
.7 Dynamic Range Mode 0 1 0 = film, 1 = video
enum
Video int8
.8 Video sharpening level 0 3
enum
fps as integer
[0] = file
(eg 24, 25, 30,
frame rate
50, 60, 120)
fps as integer, valid when
sensor-off-speed set
[1] = sensor (eg 24,25, 30, 33, 48, 50,

frame rate 60, 120), no change will
beperformed if this value
is set to 0
[2] = frame width in pixels
.9 Recording format int16
[3] =
in pixels
frame height
[0]=file-M-rate
[1]=sensor-M-rate,
valid when sensor-
[4] = flags off-speed-set
[2]=sensor-off-speed
[3]=interlaced
[4]=windowed mode
0=Manual Trigger,
1=Iris,
Set auto
.10 int8 0 4 2=Shutter,
exposure mode
3=Iris + Shutter,
4=Shutter + Iris

Developer Information 140


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation
2
0.0=minimum,
.0 Mic level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0.0=minimum,
.1 Headphone level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Headphone 0.0=minimum,
.2 fixed16 0 1
program mix 1.0=maximum
0.0=minimum,
.3 Speaker level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Audio 0=internal mic,
1=line level input,
.4 Input type int8 0 2
2=low mic level input,
3=high mic level input
0.0=minimum,
[0] ch0 0 1
1.0=maximum
.5 Input levels fixed16
0.0=minimum,
[1] ch1 0 1
1.0=maximum
true = powered,
.6 Phantom power boolean
false = not powered
3
bit flags: [0] = display
status, [1] = display
frame guides
uint16
.0 Overlay enables Some cameras don't
bit field
allow separate control of
frame guides and
status overlays.
0=off, 1=2.4:1, 2=2.39:1,
Frame guides style [0] = frame
.1 int8 0 8 3=2.35:1, 4=1.85:1, 5=16:9,
(Camera 3.x) guides style
Output 6=14:9, 7=4:3
Frame guides opacity [1] = frame 0.0=transparent,
.2 fixed16 0.1 1
(Camera 3.x) guide opacity 1.0=opaque
0=off, 1=2.4:1, 2=2.39:1,
[0] = frame
3=2.35:1, 4=1.85:1, 5=16:9,
guides style
Overlays 6=14:9, 7=4:3
(replaces .1 and .2 [1] = frame 0=transparent,
.3 int8 0 100
abovefrom guide opacity 100=opaque
Cameras 4.0) percentage of full frame
[2] = safe area
0 100 used by safe area guide
percentage
(0 means off)
4
0.0=minimum,
.0 Brightness fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0x4 = zebra
Display int16
.1 Overlay enables 0x8 = peaking
bit field

0.0=minimum,
.2 Zebra level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

Developer Information 141


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation
0.0=minimum,
.3 Peaking level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0=disable bars,
Color bars display
.4 int8 0 30 1-30=enable bars with
time (seconds)
timeout (s)

Display [0] = focus 0=Peak,



assist method 1=Colored lines
0=Red,
.5 Focus Assist int8 1=Green,
[1] = focus
2=Blue,
line color
3=White,
4=Black
5
Sets the tally front and
tally rear brightness to
.0 Tally brightness fixed16 0 1 the same level.
0.0=minimum,
1.0=maximum
Sets the tally front
Tally brightness.
.1 Front tally brightness fixed16 0 1
0.0=minimum,
1.0=maximum
Sets the tally rear
brightness.
0.0=minimum,
.2 Rear tally brightness fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Tally rear brightness
cannot be turned off
6
0=internal,
int8
Reference .0 Source 0 2 1=program,
enum
2=external
.1 Offset int32 +/- offset in pixels
7
[0] time _ _ BCD - HHMMSSFF (UCT)
.0 Real Time Clock int32
[1] date _ _ BCD - YYYYMMDD
ISO-639-1 two character
.1 System language string _ _ _
language code
.2 Timezone int32 _ _ _ Minutes offset from UTC
BCD -
s0DDdddddddddddd
Confi- where s is the sign:
guration [0] latitude _ _ 0=north (+), 1=south (-);
DD degrees,
dddddddddddd
.3 Location int64 decimal degrees
BCD -
sDDDdddddddddddd
where s is the sign:
[1] longitude _ _
0=west (-), 1=east (+); DDD
degrees, dddddddddddd
decimal degrees

Developer Information 142


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation
8
[0] red -2 2 default 0.0
[1] green -2 2 default 0.0
.0 Lift Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -2 2 default 0.0
[3] luma -2 2 default 0.0
[0] red -4 4 default 0.0
[1] green -4 4 default 0.0
.1 Gamma Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -4 4 default 0.0
[3] luma -4 4 default 0.0
[0] red 0 16 default 1.0
[1] green 0 16 default 1.0
.2 Gain Adjust fixed16
Colour [2] blue 0 16 default 1.0
Correction [3] luma 0 16 default 1.0
[0] red -8 8 default 0.0
[1] green -8 8 default 0.0
.3 Offset Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -8 8 default 0.0
[3] luma -8 8 default 0.0
[0] pivot 0 1 default 0.5
.4 Contrast Adjust fixed16
[1] adj 0 2 default 1.0

.5 Luma mix fixed16 0 1 default 1.0

[0] hue -1 1 default 0.0


.6 Colour Adjust fixed16
[1] sat 0 2 default 1.0
Correction
.7 void reset to defaults
Reset Default
10
0 = RAW, 1 = DNxHD,
[0] = basic codec
2 = ProRes
RAW: 0=Uncompressed,
int8
.0 Codec 1=lossy 3:1, 2=lossy 4:1
enum [1] =
codec variant ProRes: 0=HQ, 1=422,
2=LT, 3=Proxy,
4=444, 5=444XQ
0=Preview,
[0] = mode
1=Play, 2=Record
Media
-ve = multiple speeds
backwards, 0 = pause,
[1] = speed
+ve = multiple
speeds forwards
.1 Transport mode int8 1<<0=loop, 1<<1=play all,
1<<5=disk1 active,
[2] = flags 1<<6=disk2 active,
1<<7=time-
lapse recording
[3] = active
0=CFast card, 1=SD
storage medium

Developer Information 143


Example Protocol Packets

Length
Packet
Operation Byte

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15

header command data

destination

parameter
command

operation
reserved

category
length

type
trigger instantaneous auto
8 4 4 0 0 0 1 0 0
focus on camera 4

turn on OIS on all cameras 12 255 5 0 0 0 6 0 0 1 0 0 0

set exposure to 10 ms on
camera 4 (10 ms = 10000 12 4 8 0 0 1 5 3 0 0x10 0x27 0x00 0x00
us = 0x00002710)

add 15% to zebra level


12 4 6 0 0 4 2 128 1 0x33 0x01 0 0
(15 % = 0.15 f = 0x0133 fp)

select 1080p 23.98 mode


16 255 9 0 0 1 0 1 0 24 1 3 0 0 0 0 0
on all cameras

subtract 0.3 from gamma


adjust for green & blue 16 4 12 0 0 8 1 128 1 0 0 0x9a 0xfd 0x9a 0xfd 0 0
(-0.3 ~= 0xfd9a fp)

all operations combined 76 4 4 0 0 0 1 0 0 255 5 0 0 0 6 0 0

1 0 0 0 4 8 0 0 1 5 3 0 0x10 0x27 0x00 0x00

4 6 0 0 4 2 128 1 0x33 0x01 0 0 255 9 0 0

1 0 1 0 24 1 3 0 0 0 0 0 4 12 0 0

8 1 128 1 0 0 0x9a 0xfd 0x9a 0xfd 0 0

Developer Information 144


Blackmagic Embedded TallyControl Protocol
Version 1.0 (30/04/14)
This section is for third party developers or anybody who may wish to add support for the
Blackmagic Embedded Tally Control Protocol to their products or system. It describes the protocol
for sending tally information embedded in the non-active picture region of a digital video stream.

Data Flow
A master device such as a broadcast switcher embeds tally information into its program feed which
is broadcast to a number of slave devices such as cameras or camera controllers. The output from
the slave devices is typically fed back to the master device, but may also be sent to a video monitor.
The primary flow of tally information is from the master device to the slaves. Each slave device may
use its device id to extract and display the relevant tally information.
Slave devices pass through the tally packet on their output and update the monitor tally status, so
that monitor devices connected to that individual output may display tally status without knowledge
of the device id they are monitoring.

Assumptions
Any data alignment / padding is explicit in the protocol. Bit fields are packed from LSB first.

Blanking Encoding
One tally control packet may be sent per video frame. Packets are encoded as a SMPTE 291M
packet with DID/SDID x51/x52 in the active region of VANC line 15. A tally control packet may contain
up to 256 bytes of tally information.

Packet Format
Each tally status consists of 4 bits of information:
uint4
bit 0: program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0x0)
The first byte of the tally packet contains the monitor device tally status and a version number.
Subsequent bytes of the tally packet contain tally status for pairs of slave devices. The master device
sends tally status for the number of devices configured/supported, up to a maximum of 510.

struct tally
uint8
bit 0: monitor device program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: monitor device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4-7: protocol version (0b0000)

Developer Information 145


uint8[0]
bit 0: slave device 1 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: slave device 1 device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4: slave device 2 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 5: slave device 2 preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 6-7: reserved (0b00)
uint8[1]
bit 0: slave device 3 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: slave device 3 device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4: slave device 4 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 5: slave device 4 preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 6-7: reserved (0b00)
...

Slave Device
(1)

Master Device Slave Device


(2)

Slave Device
Monitor Device
(3)

Byte 7 MSB 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LSB

Version Version Version Version Reserved Reserved Monitor Monitor


0
(0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

Reserved Reserved Slave 1 Slave 1 Reserved Reserved Slave 0 Slave 0


1
(0b0) (0b0) Preview Program (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

Reserved Reserved Slave 3 Slave 3 Reserved Reserved Slave 2 Slave 2


2
(0b0) (0b0) Preview Program (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

3 ...

Developer Information 146


Assistance
Obtenir de l'aide
Le moyen le plus rapide d'obtenir de l'aide est d'accder aux pages d'assistance en ligne de
Blackmagic Design et de consulter les dernires informations concernant votre camra.

Pages d'assistance en ligne de Blackmagic Design


Les dernires versions du manuel, du logiciel et des notes d'assistance peuvent tre consultes sur
la page dassistance technique de Blackmagic Design : www.blackmagicdesign.com/fr/support.

Contacter le service d'assistance de Blackmagic Design


Si vous ne parvenez pas trouver l'aide dont vous avez besoin dans notre matriel de support,
veuillez utiliser l'option Envoyez-nous un email disponible sur la page d'assistance de votre
camra pour envoyer une demande d'assistance par email. Vous pouvez galement cliquer sur le
bouton Trouver un support technique situ sur la page d'assistance et ainsi contacter le centre
d'assistance technique Blackmagic Design le plus proche de chez vous.

Vrification du logiciel actuel


Pour vrifier quelle version du logiciel Blackmagic Camera Setup est installe sur votre ordinateur,
ouvrez la fentre intitule About Blackmagic Camera Setup.
Sur Mac OS X, ouvrez le logiciel Blackmagic Camera Setup dans le dossier Applications.
Slectionnez About Blackmagic Camera Setup dans le menu dapplication pour connatre le
numro de version.
Sur Windows, ouvrez le logiciel Blackmagic Camera Setup dans le menu de dmarrage ou
sur lcran d'accueil. Cliquez sur le menu Aide et slectionnez About Blackmagic Camera
Setup pour connatre le numro de version.
Comment obtenir les dernires mises jour du logiciel
Aprs avoir vrifi la version du logiciel Blackmagic Camera Setup installe sur votre ordinateur,
veuillez visiter la page d'assistance technique de Blackmagic Design ladresse suivante
www.blackmagicdesign.com/fr/support pour vrifier les dernires mises jour. Mme s'il est
gnralement conseill d'installer les dernires mises jour, il est prudent dviter deffectuer ces
mises jour au milieu d'un projet important.

Remplacement de la batterie
La batterie intgre de la Studio Camera nest pas rparable par lutilisateur. Si la batterie doit tre
remplace, vous devrez lexpdier au centre dassistance Blackmagic Design le plus proche. Si la
camra nest plus couverte par la garantie, le remplacement de la batterie se fera moyennant des
frais de services minimaux pour le cot de la batterie, le travail ralis et la rexpdition de votre
camra. Veuillez contacter le service dassistance de Blackmagic Design pour de plus amples
informations sur lexpdition de votre camra, comment l'emballer en toute scurit et les frais de
remplacement de la batterie dans votre pays.

REMARQUE Les Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 et Studio Camera 4K ne comprennent


pas de batterie interne.

Assistance 147
Garantie
Garantie limite 12 mois
Par la prsente, Blackmagic Design garantit que ce produit sera exempt de dfauts matriels et de
fabrication pendant une dure de un an compter de la date d'achat. Si un produit savre
dfectueux pendant la priode de garantie, Blackmagic Design peut, sa seule discrtion, rparer
le produit dfectueux sans frais pour les pices et la main-duvre, ou le remplacer.
Pour se prvaloir du service offert en vertu de la prsente garantie, il vous incombe dinformer
Blackmagic Design de lexistence du dfaut avant expiration de la priode de garantie, et de
prendre les mesures ncessaires pour lexcution des dispositions de ce service. Le consommateur
a la responsabilit de soccuper de lemballage et de l'expdition du produit dfectueux au centre
de service nommment dsign par Blackmagic Design, en frais de port prpay. Il incombe au
consommateur de payer tous les frais de transport, dassurance, droits de douane et taxes et toutes
autres charges relatives aux produits qui nous auront t retourns, et ce quelle que soit la raison.
La prsente garantie ne saurait en aucun cas sappliquer des dfauts, pannes ou dommages
causs par une utilisation inapproprie ou un entretien inadquat ou incorrect. Blackmagic Design
na en aucun cas lobligation de fournir un service en vertu de la prsente garantie : a) pour rparer
les dommages rsultant de tentatives de rparations, dinstallations ou tous services effectus par
du personnel non qualifi par Blackmagic Design, b) pour rparer tout dommage rsultant d'une
utilisation inadquate ou d'une connexion du matriel incompatible, c) pour rparer tout dommage
ou dysfonctionnement causs par lutilisation de pices ou de fournitures nappartenant pas la
marque de Blackmagic Design, d) pour examiner un produit qui a t modifi ou intgr dautres
produits quand limpact dune telle modification ou intgration augmente les dlais ou la difficult
dexaminer ce produit. CETTE GARANTIE REMPLACE TOUTE GARANTIE EXPLICITE OU TACITE.
BLACKMAGIC DESIGN ET SES REVENDEURS DCLINENT EXPRESSMENT TOUTE GARANTIE
TACITE DE COMMERCIALISATION OU D'ADQUATION UNE FIN PARTICULIRE. LA
RESPONSABILIT DE BLACKMAGIC DESIGN POUR RPARER OU REMPLACER UN PRODUIT
S'AVRANT DFECTUEUX CONSTITUE LA TOTALIT ET LE SEUL RECOURS EXCLUSIF PRVU ET
FOURNI AU CONSOMMATEUR POUR TOUT DOMMAGE INDIRECT, SPCIFIQUE, ACCIDENTEL OU
CONSCUTIF, PEU IMPORTE QUE BLACKMAGIC DESIGN OU SES REVENDEURS AIENT T
INFORMS OU SE SOIENT RENDU COMPTE AU PRALABLE DE L'VENTUALIT DE CES
DOMMAGES. BLACKMAGIC DESIGN NE PEUT TRE TENU POUR RESPONSABLE DE TOUTE
UTILISATION ILLICITE DU MATRIEL PAR LE CONSOMMATEUR. BLACKMAGIC DESIGN N'EST PAS
RESPONSABLE DES DOMMAGES RSULTANT DE L'UTILISATION DE CE PRODUIT. LE
CONSOMMATEUR UTILISE CE PRODUIT SES SEULS RISQUES.
Copyright 2017 Blackmagic Design. Tous droits rservs. 'Blackmagic Design, DeckLink, HDLink, Workgroup Videohub,
Multibridge Pro, Multibridge Extreme, Intensity et Leading the creative video revolution sont des marques dposes aux
tats-Unis et dans d'autres pays. Tous les autres noms de socit et de produits peuvent tre des marques dposes des socits
respectives auxquelles ils sont associs.

Garantie 148
Installations- und Bedienungsanleitung

Blackmagic
Studio Cameras
Juni 2017

Deutsch
Willkommen!
Vielen Dank, dass Sie sich zum Kauf einer Blackmagic Studio Camera entschieden haben!
Auch wir sind restlos vom Design der Blackmagic Studio Camera und Micro Studio
Camera 4K begeistert. Schon als Teenager war ich Feuer und Flamme fr die
Liveproduktion, weil sie so spannend ist!
Klassische Kameras mit Talkback und Tally waren frher extrem teuer und derart sperrig,
dass sie schwer zu handhaben waren. Dieses Problem wollten wir mit einer kompakteren
Kamera mit all den Talkback-, Tally- und Kamerabedienfunktionen von physisch erheblich
greren Kameras ausrumen.
Deshalb wurde die Blackmagic Studio Camera entwickelt. Unser Ziel war es, eine viel
kleinere Kamera zu bauen, die sich besser tragen lsst. Aber normalerweise haben
kleine Kameras auch kleine Bildschirme. Und das war nicht Sinn der Sache. Was wir
wirklich wollten, war ein viel grerer Sucher! Das Resultat ist die Blackmagic Studio
Camera, die kleinste unter den Broadcast-Kameras, aber mit einem ubergroen
Sucher ausgerustet. Damit arbeitet es sich wunderbar. Die przise Fokussierung und
Bildausschnittswahl werden mit einem derart groen Sucher zum Kinderspiel.
Selbstverstndlich sind auch Tally-Indikatoren und Talkback mit dabei. Und natrlich
bekommen Sie eine Kamera von ausgezeichneter Qualitt mit flexiblem MFT-
Objektivanschluss. Alles was Sie brauchen in einem kompletten Paket! Sie knnen
grere Mikrofone mit Windschutz und sogar Phantomspeisung anschlieen. berdies
kann der Benutzer ein optionales SFP-Glasfasermodul installieren. Ideal fr den Betrieb
der Kamera aus kilometerweiter Entfernung von Ihrem Mischer. Bei Bedarf knnen Sie
sogar zustzlich einen HyperDeck Shuttle Rekorder anschlieen und die Kamera fr
generelle Produktionszwecke benutzen.
Die Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K geht in puncto kleines Bauma bei groer
Leistung sogar noch einen Schritt weiter als die Blackmagic Studio Camera! Dieser
Kamerawinzling packt einen groartigen Ultra-HD-Sensor in ein verblffend kleines
Gehuse und bietet diverse Mglichkeiten fr die Fernbedienung. Jetzt knnen
Sie an Locations, die frher unmglich gewesen wren, broadcasttaugliches
Produktionsmaterial einfangen, weil die Kamera komplett ber einen ATEM Mischer oder
ber eine anwenderspezifische Fernbedienung steuerbar ist.
Wir wnschen Ihnen frohes Schaffen mit Ihrer neuen Kamera und sind sehr gespannt auf
Ihre kreativen Ergebnisse!

Grant Petty
CEO Blackmagic Design
Inhalt
Blackmagic Studio Cameras

Erste Schritte 149 Einstellungen fr die Fernbedienung 169


Anbringen eines Objektivs 149 Funktionen der Bedientasten 170
Einschalten Ihrer Kamera 149 Videoausgabe der Kamera 171
Anschlieen an einen Mischer 150 Anschlieen von Videomischern 171
Funktionsmerkmale der Kamera 153 Anschlieen von
Funktionsmerkmale der Aufzeichnungsgerten172
Blackmagic Studio Camera 153 Verbinden des Tally anhand
Funktionsmerkmale der eines Blackmagic 3G-SDI
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K  155 Arduino Shields  172
Kamera-Anschlsse 157 Blackmagic Camera Setup 174
Blackmagic Studio Camera
linke Seite 157 Befestigen von Zubehr 175

Blackmagic Studio Camera Gegenlichtblende175


rechte Kameraseite 158 Weiteres Zubehr 175
Blackmagic Micro Studio Arbeiten mit ATEM Software Control 175
Camera 4K linke Kameraseite 159
Die Mischerfunktion Kamerasteuerung 175
Blackmagic Micro Studio
Camera 4K rechte Kameraseite 160 Arbeiten mit der
Mischerfunktion Kamerasteuerung 177
Individualisierung 161
DaVinci Resolve Primary Color
Blackmagic Micro Studio Corrector (DaVinci Resolve
Camera 4K Expansionskabel 161 Tool fr die primre Farbkorrektur) 182
Anschlussplan fr das
Expansionskabel der Developer Information (Englisch) 185
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 162 Blackmagic SDI Camera
Control Protocol 185
Einstellungen 163
Blackmagic Embedded
Kamera-Einstellungen163
TallyControl Protocol 193
Audio-Einstellungen165
Einstellungen fr das Monitoring 166 Hilfe 195

Studio-Einstellungen168 Garantie
196

Inhalt
Erste Schritte
Anbringen eines Objektivs
Um die Arbeit mit Ihrer Blackmagic Studio Camera oder Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
aufzunehmen, brauchen Sie nichts weiter tun, als ein Objektiv anzubringen und die Kamera
einzuschalten. Halten Sie zum Entfernen der Staubschutzkappe vom Objektivanschluss die
Verriegelungstaste gedrckt und drehen Sie dann die Kappe gegen den Uhrzeigersinn, bis sie sich lst.
Wir empfehlen, Ihre Kamera immer auszuschalten, ehe Sie ein Objektiv anbringen oder abnehmen.
So bringen Sie ein Objektiv an:
1 Richten Sie den Punkt an Ihrem Objektiv auf den Punkt am Objektivanschluss der Kamera
aus. Bei vielen Objektiven ist dieser Punkt blau, rot oder wei und manche Objektive sind
auf andere Weise markiert.
2 Drehen Sie das Objektiv im Uhrzeigersinn, bis es einrastet.
3 Halten Sie zum Abnehmen des Objektivs die Verriegelungstaste gedrckt, drehen Sie das
Objektiv gegen den Uhrzeigersinn, bis der Punkt bzw. die Ansetzmarkierung die 12-Uhr-
Position erreicht hat und nehmen Sie das Objektiv vorsichtig ab.
Wenn kein Objektiv an der Kamera angebracht ist, liegt der Objektivanschluss frei und kann leicht
durch Staub oder andere Ablagerungen verschmutzt werden. Deswegen empfiehlt es sich, die
Staubschutzkappe mglichst stndig an der Kamera zu belassen.

1 1
1

1
PUSH

PUSH
3

3
2

2 2
1

1
PUSH

PUSH
3

3
2

So wird ein Objektiv an die Studio Camera angebracht bzw. entfernt

So wird ein Objektiv an die Micro Studio Camera 4K angebracht bzw. entfernt

Einschalten Ihrer Kamera


1 Drcken Sie die Ein-/Austaste unter dem LCD. Bei den Blackmagic Studio Camera und
Studio Camera 4K Modellen erscheint nun das Live-Bild auf dem LCD.
2 Halten Sie die Ein-/Austaste gedrckt, um die Kamera auszuschalten.

Erste Schritte 149


TIPP Die Blackmagic Studio Camera HD und Studio Camera 4K verfgen ber
interne Akkus, die sich ber das mitgelieferte Netzteil aufladen lassen. Diese
Kameras knnen aufgeladen und betrieben werden, whrend sie an eine externe
Stromquelle angeschlossen sind. Sie wechseln unterbrechungsfrei zwischen
Stromquellen hin und her. Die Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 und Studio Camera 4K
2 verfgen ber keinen internen Akku und mssen somit nicht aufgeladen werden.

Die Micro Studio Camera 4K funktioniert mit LP-E6- und LP-E6N-Akkus, die sich ber ein externes
Akkuladegert oder per Erhaltungsladung ber die Kamera aufladen lassen. Die Kamera kann auch
ber eine externe Quelle mit Strom versorgt und bedient werden. Bei Unterbrechung der externen
Stromversorgung schaltet sie automatisch auf die andere Quelle um. Externer Strom wird der
MicroStudio Camera 4K ber ihren Expansionsport zugefhrt.
1 Drcken Sie die Ein-/Austaste an der rechten Seite der Kamera. Das nun aufleuchtende
Tally-Licht zeigt den eingeschalteten Zustand der Kamera an.
2 Halten Sie die Ein-/Austaste gedrckt, um die Kamera auszuschalten.
Das war fr den Einstieg schon alles. Jetzt knnen Sie Ihre Kamera an einen Mischer oder einen
ATEM Converter anschlieen und mit der Erstellung Ihrer Live-Produktion loslegen!

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN

SDI IN

REF

REF

12V

12V

Versorgen Sie die Studio Camera ber das


mitgelieferte Netzteil mit Strom

Anschlieen an einen Mischer


Die Blackmagic Studio Camera und Micro Studio Camera 4K knnen fr eine schnelle,
interaktive Kamerabedienung aus der Ferne ber einen ATEM Mischer via SDI gesteuert werden.

Anschlieen via SDI


1 Koppeln Sie den SDI-Ausgang Ihrer Blackmagic Studio Camera oder Micro Studio Camera 4K
an den SDI-Eingang eines ATEM Mischers.
2 Verbinden Sie einen beliebigen SDI-Ausgang des ATEM Mischers jedoch nicht die
abwrtskonvertierten oder Multi View-Ausgnge mit dem SDI-Programmeingang Ihrer
Studio Camera. Kamerasteuerungssignale werden nicht ber die Multi View-Ausgnge
oder abwrtskonvertierte SDI-Ausgnge bermittelt.

Erste Schritte 150


TIPP Sollte ein optionales SFP-Glasfasermodul installiert worden sein, knnen Sie Ihre
Blackmagic Studio Camera auch ber Glasfaser mit einem ATEM Mischer verbinden.
Daseignet sich gut fr lange Kabelwege, da Glasfaser Signale ber eine Strecke von bis zu
45km leiten kann.
Fr eine komplette Verbindung zwischen Kamera und ATEM Mischer wird ein ATEM Studio
Converter oder ATEM Talkback Converter 4K bentigt. Weitere Informationen zur
Einrichtung von Glasfaserverbindungen finden Sie im Abschnitt Connection Diagrams
imenglischsprachigen ATEM Converters Handbuch.

IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 1 IN 3 1 1 3 1 REMOTE REMOTE
1 3 5 1 7 3 9 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH
STEREO IN

CONTROL CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 IN 2 2 HD 2 HD HD HD HD HD
1 2 4 1 6 2 8 4 10 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 REF IN
PREVIEW AUXPROGRAM
1-3 PREVIEW
OUTPUTS PROGRAM OUTPUTS
MULTI-VIEW MULTI-VIEW
ANALOG AUDIO IN

IN IN IN IN IN 1 3 1 REMOTE
All SDI and HDMI video connections are
1 3 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH SD, HD and Ultra HD switchable unless indicated

CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 2 HD HD HD
1 2 4 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2 CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 PREVIEW PROGRAM OUTPUTS MULTI-VIEW ANALOG AUDIO IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT

Schlieen Sie Ihre Kamera an einen ATEM Mischer an, indem Sie den SDI-Ausgang der Kamera mit
dem SDI-Eingang des Mischers verbinden. Stellen Sie fr die Kamerasteuerung eine Verbindung
zwischen einem beliebigen nicht downkonvertierten Ausgang des ATEM Mischers und dem SDI-
Programmeingang Ihrer Kamera her. Am schnellsten und einfachsten koppeln Sie Ihren Mischer ber
einen seiner Programmausgnge an die Kamera.

Tastenbelegung und Tally


ffnen Sie Preferences (Einstellungen) in der Bediensoftware ATEM Software Control. Belegen Sie
die Tasten des Mischers dann so, dass die jeweilige Kamera mit dem richtigen Tally-Licht
angezeigt wird.
So belegen Sie die Tasten:
1 Klicken Sie auf die Menleiste oben im Bildschirm und ffnen Sie die Einstellungen
Preferences in ATEM Software Control.
2 Klicken Sie dann auf den Mapping-Tab und vergewissern Sie sich, dass die Tasten auf
die korrekte Eingabe ansprechen. Ein Beispiel: Da Ihre Studio Camera an Eingang 1 Ihres
Mischers angeschlossen ist, sollte Button 1 (Taste 1) auf Input 1: Camera 1 (Eingang 1 :
Kamera 1) eingestellt sein.
3 Drcken Sie die MENU-Taste Ihrer Blackmagic Studio Camera. Navigieren Sie zu Studio
Settings > Camera Number (Studio-Einstellungen > Kameranummer) und stellen Sie
diese analog zum Mischereingang ein. Beispiel: Wenn Studio Camera 1 an den ATEM
Mischereingang Cam 1 angeschlossen ist, muss auch die Kameranummer auf 1 eingestellt
sein. So wird das Tally-Signal an die richtige Kamera bermittelt.
Da nun alles angeschlossen und belegt ist, knnen Sie berprfen, ob die Programmausgabe auf
Ihrer Kamera zu sehen ist und ob das Tally funktioniert. Drcken Sie hierfr die PGM-Taste an Ihrer
Blackmagic Studio Camera und aktivieren Sie Farbbalken fr die Programmausgabe Ihres ATEM
Mischers. Zeigt Ihre Kamera nun Farbbalken an, wissen Sie, dass die Programmausgabe auf Ihrer
Kamera richtig dargestellt wird.

Erste Schritte 151


Schalten Sie daraufhin Kamera 1 auf den Programmausgang. Das Tally-Licht an der Studio Camera
sollte nun aufleuchten. Ist dies nicht der Fall, vergewissern Sie sich, dass die Kameranummer dem
entsprechenden Eingang am Mischer zugewiesen ist und dass die Belegungseinstellungen des
Mischers stimmen.

Arbeiten mit der Mischerfunktion Kamerasteuerung


Ihre Blackmagic Studio Camera lsst sich von einem ATEM Mischer aus anhand der
Kamerasteuerungsfunktion in ATEM Software Control bedienen.
Starten Sie ATEM Software Control und klicken Sie am unteren Rand der Benutzeroberflche auf das
Kamerasymbol, um die Seite Kamerasteuerung zu ffnen. Nun wird Ihnen eine Zeile von
Kamerabedienfeldern angezeigt, die mit Kamerakennungen versehen sind. Jedes Bedienfeld enthlt
Tools zum Abgleichen und Verfeinern des Bilds einzelner Kameras. Kamera 1 ist mit der Kennung
Cam 1 versehen. Ist die Kamera auf den Programmausgang geschaltet, wird ein roter On Air-
Status angezeigt.
Innerhalb des Kamerabedienfelds Cam1 knnen Sie Kameraanpassungen vornehmen. Dazu zhlen
Farbkorrektur, Objektivsteuerung bei kompatiblen Objektiven, Kameraeinstellungen und mehr.
Detailliertere Informationen zu den Kamerasteuerungsfunktionen finden Sie im Abschnitt
Arbeitenmit ATEM Software Control.

Anschlieen eines Rekorders


Fr Studioaufnahmen knnen Sie Ihre Blackmagic Studio Camera auch an einen externen
Diskrekorder wie bspw. den Blackmagic HyperDeck Studio anschlieen. Oder fgen Sie Ihrer
Studiokamera einen HyperDeck Shuttle oder Blackmagic Video Assist hinzu und schleifen Sie das
Signal fr ISO-Aufzeichnungen aus dem -Wagen zum Mischer durch.
Fr den Einstieg war das schon alles. Live-Produktionen sind eine aufregende Angelegenheit.
IhreBlackmagic Studio Camera ist daher so konzipiert, dass sie Ihnen die Arbeit erleichtert und ihr
Gebrauch Spa macht. Im weiteren Verlauf dieses Handbuchs erfahren Sie mehr ber die
unterschiedlichen Funktionen und Einstellungen Ihrer Blackmagic Studio Camera.

Erste Schritte 152


Funktionsmerkmale der Kamera
Funktionsmerkmale der Blackmagic Studio Camera
Kamerafront
1 Vorderes Tally-Licht
Zeigt den Darstellern bei Live-Auftritten an, welche Kamera sich gegenwrtig auf Sendung
befindet. Nheres ist dem Abschnitt Einstellungen fr das Monitoring in diesem Handbuch
zu entnehmen.

2
3

4
1

PUSH
5 2

PUSH

Linke Kameraseite
2 LANC-Fernbedienung
Die 2,5mm-Klinkenbuchse fr die LANC-Fernbedienung untersttzt Blenden-, Zoom- und
Fokussiersteuerung.
3 Luftfahrt-Headsets
0,25-Zoll-TRS-Klinkenbuchse fr Luftfahrt-Headsets, um das Audio vom Programm (PGM)
und aus dem Regieraum mitzuhren.
4 Mikrofon-Kopfhrer-Eingang
0,206-Zoll-TRS-Klinkenbuchse fr Luftfahrt-Headsets, um mit dem Regieraum zu
kommunizieren.
5 Audioeingnge
2 x 1/4 Zoll symmetrische XLR-Buchsen fr die Audioeingabe.
Nheres siehe Abschnitt Blackmagic Studio Camera linke Kameraseite
in diesem Handbuch.

Funktionsmerkmale der Kamera 153


Rechte Kameraseite
6 OPTICAL OUT und OPTICAL IN
Der Glasfaser-Eingang und -Ausgang erlaubt Kabellngen von bis zu 45 Kilometern,
soferndas optionale SFP-Glasfasermodul installiert ist.
7 SDI OUT
SDI-Ausgang zum Anschluss an einen Mischer oder andere Gerte.
8 SDI IN
ber den SDI-Eingang kann der Kamerabediener das ausgegebene Programm (PGM)
betrachten.
9 Referenzeingang
Erlaubt die Synchronisierung mehrerer Kameras mit Genlock ber ein Blackburst- oder
Tri-Level-Referenzsignal.
10 Stromversorgung
1224V-Buchse fr die Stromversorgung und wo mglich zum Aufladen des Akkus.
Nheres finden Sie im Abschnitt Blackmagic Studio Camera rechte Kameraseite
in diesem Handbuch.

12
11

6 OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

7 SDI OUT

8 SDI IN

9 REF

13 14 15 16 17 18 19 18 20 21 22 10 12V

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU

Kamerarckseite
11 10-Zoll-LCD
Fr das Monitoring der Live-Kamera- oder Programmausgabe oder zur Menansicht.
Nheres finden Sie im Abschnitt Einstellungen fr das Monitoring in diesem Handbuch.
12 Rckwrtiges Tally-Licht
Im erleuchteten Zustand zeigt es dem Kamerabediener an, dass seine Kamera gegenwrtig
auf Sendung ist.
13 FOCUS-Taste
Einmaliges Drcken der FOCUS-Taste zur automatischen Scharfstellung (Autofokus)
oderzweimaliges Drcken zur Anzeige von Focus Peaking auf dem LCD.
14 IRIS-Taste
Einmaliges Drcken fr Belichtungsautomatik (Auto Exposure).
15 PTT-Taste
Push-to-Talk-Taste zum Sprechen gedrckt halten. Zweimaliges Drcken der PPT-Taste
in schneller Folge ermglicht die handfreie Kommunikation. Erneutes Drcken bringt das
standardmige Verhalten zurck.
16 PGM-Taste
Das Drcken der Programmtaste bewirkt den Wechsel zwischen der Live-Kameraausgabe
und der Programmausgabe vom Mischer-Regieraum.
17 LUT-Taste
Die Look-Up-Table-Taste ist gegenwrtig nicht ausgefhrt.
Funktionsmerkmale der Kamera 154
12V

18 Pfeiltasten fr die Mennavigation


Auf- und Abwrtspfeiltasten zur Navigation durch das LCD-Men.
REF

SDI IN

19 SET-Taste
Besttigen Sie mit der SET-Taste Ihre im Men getroffene Auswahl.
SDI OUT

20 DISP-Taste
OPTICAL IN

OPTICAL OUT

Das Drcken der Displaytaste schaltet eingeblendete Overlays ein oder aus.
21 MENU-Taste
Die Mentaste erlaubt den Zugriff auf das Men auf dem LCD.
22 Ein-/Austaste
Die Blackmagic Studio Camera wird per Druck auf die Ein-/Austaste eingeschaltet.
HaltenSie diese Taste zum Ausschalten der Kamera gedrckt.
Nheres erfahren Sie im Abschnitt Funktionen der Bedientasten in diesem Handbuch.

Kameraunterseite
23 USB-BUCHSE
USB-Mini-B-Port zur Aktualisierung der Kamera-Firmware. Siehe Abschnitt Blackmagic
Camera Setup in diesem Handbuch.

23

Funktionsmerkmale der Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K


Kamerafront
1 Tally-Licht
Das Tally-Licht zeigt Darstellern die aktuell auf Sendung befindliche Kamera an und dem
Bediener den Status der Kamera. Es gibt folgende Szenarien:
Wei eingeschaltet
Rot live
Rot und Orange im Wechsel niedriger Akkustand im Livebetrieb
Wei und Orange im Wechsel niedriger Akkustand
Die Helligkeit des Tally-Lichts lsst sich ber die Einstellungen der Micro Studio Camera 4K
anpassen. Nheres erfahren Sie im Abschnitt Kamera-Einstellungen.

1 2 4
5
6
PUSH

2
7
3
8
PUSH

Funktionsmerkmale der Kamera 155


Linke Kameraseite
2 HDMI-Ausgang
ber den HDMI-Ausgang knnen Sie Ihre Videoausgabe als Vorschau betrachten und
unter Einsatz externer Monitore wie dem Blackmagic Video Assist durch die Kameramens
navigieren. Ungeachtet der Kameraauflsung wird stets in der Auflsung 1080HD
ausgegeben und Sie haben die Wahl, Overlays wie Bildrandmarkierungen, ein Histogramm
und Audiopegel einblenden zu lassen. Nheres finden Sie im Abschnitt Einstellungen fr
das Monitoring in diesem Handbuch.
3 Expansionsport
Der DB-HD15-Verbinder dient zur Versorgung mit externem Strom, gestattet mehrere
Fernsteuerungsmglichkeiten und den Einsatz als Referenzeingang. Nheres erfahren Sie
im Abschnitt Expansionsport der Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K.
4 MENU-Taste
Greifen Sie ber die Mentaste auf die kamerainterne Menfhrung zu, die auf einem
angeschlossenen HDMI-Display dargestellt werden kann.
5 Aufwrts-Taste
Benutzen Sie diese Taste fr die Mennavigation.
6 Abwrts-Taste
Benutzen Sie diese Taste fr die Mennavigation.
7 SET-Taste
Besttigen Sie mit der Set-Taste Ihre im Men getroffene Auswahl.
8 Ein-/Austaste
Die Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K wird per Druck auf die Ein-/Austaste eingeschaltet.
Halten Sie diese Taste zum Ausschalten der Kamera gedrckt.

Rechte Kameraseite
9 Analogaudio-Eingang
3,5mm-Stereoklinkenbuchse, im Men zwischen Mikrofon- und Referenzpegel-Eingang
umschaltbar.
10 SDI OUT
SDI-Ausgang zum Anschluss an einen Mischer, externen Rekorder oder andere Gerte.
11 SDI IN
Der SDI-Eingang gestattet die Steuerung der Kamera ber ATEM Mischer oder das
Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield.
12 Kopfhrer-/Talkback-Anschluss
3,5mm-Buchse fr Talkback mit Headsets von iPhone, Android usw. Durch doppeltes
Drcken der Wiedergabe-/Pausentaste an Ihrem Headset schalten Sie Talkback
ein, durch eimaliges Drcken schalten Sie es wieder aus.

10
13
11

12

Funktionsmerkmale der Kamera 156


Kamerarckseite
13 Akku-Einschub
Die Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K wird mit einem LP-E6-Akku passend fr diesen
Einschub geliefert. Der Akku lsst sich per Erhaltungsladung aufladen, wenn die Kamera
ber den Expansionsport an eine externe Stromquelle angeschlossen ist.

Kameraoberseite
14 Akku-Entriegelung
Schieben Sie den Mechanismus nach vorne, um den Akku zu entriegeln.

Kameraunterseite
15 USB-Buchse
USB-Port zur Aktualisierung der Kamera-Firmware. Siehe Abschnitt Blackmagic Camera
Setup in diesem Handbuch.

14

15

Kamera-Anschlsse
Blackmagic Studio Camera linke Seite
LANC-Fernbedienung
ber den Remote-Port Ihrer Kamera lassen sich bei Einsatz eines kompatiblen Objektivs die
Fokussierung, Blenden- und Zoomeinstellungen des Objektivs fernsteuern. Der Port in Form einer
2,5mm-Stereoklinkenbuchse verwendet das LANC-Standardprotokoll.
Aktive MFT-Objektive gestatten Ihnen, den Zoomservo per LANC-Fernbedienung zu steuern.
Folgende Objektive werden zurzeit untersttzt:
Panasonic Lumix G X Vario PZ 1442 mm f/3,55,6 Objektiv mit Power O.I.S
Panasonic Lumix G X Vario PZ 45175 mm f/4,0-5,6 Zoomobjektiv mit O.I.S.
Olympus M.Zuiko ED 1250mm f/3,56,3 EZ Micro 4/3 Digitalobjektiv
Olympus M.Zuiko Digital ED 14-42mm f/3.5-5.6 EZ Micro 4/3 Lens

Kopfhrerausgang
Ausgang fr Luftfahrt-Headsets mit Fixed Wing-Steckern, um das Audio aus dem Programm und
aus der Tonregie anzuhren. Das Angebot von Luftfahrt-Headsets reicht von Ohrhrermodellen fr
Studioumgebungen bis zu kompletten, lrmreduzierenden Modellen fr Konzerte und
Sportveranstaltungen mit hohen Lautstrkepegeln. Ton wird den Kanlen 15 und 16 des
eingehenden SDI-Signals entnommen. Da die Kanle 15 und 16 nur in den seltensten Fllen whrend
der Produktion eingesetzt werden, bieten sie sich zum Einsatz fr Audio-Talkback an.

Kamera-Anschlsse 157
Mikrofon-Kopfhrer-Eingang
Dieser Eingang ermglicht die Kommunikation mit der Steuerzentrale ber Luftfahrt-Headsets.
Tonwird in Kanal 15 und 16 der SDI-Signalausgabe eingebettet.

Audioeingnge
Zwei Kanle professionelles symmetrisches Analogaudio werden via XLR-Buchsen untersttzt.
Stellen Sie die Eingabepegel fr die beiden Kanle ber das Audiomen ein. Die Eingnge
untersttzen ebenso Mikrofonpegel- wie auch Referenzpegel-Eingaben. Die Eingabeart wird
ebenfalls im Audiomen ausgewhlt. Audio wird in Kanal 1 und 2 des SDI-Datenflusses eingebettet.

1
1
PUSH

3
2

2
1
PUSH

3
2

Blackmagic Studio Camera rechte Kameraseite


OPTICAL IN und OPTICAL OUT
Fr Signalempfang und -ausgabe ber Glasfaser mssen Sie ein optional erhltliches SFP-
Glasfasermodul installieren. Dieses gestattet das Einstecken branchenblicher LC-Verbinder,
die3G-SDI bei der Studio Camera HD bzw. 6G-SDI bei der Studio Camera 4K untersttzen.
DaGlasfaserkabel auch fr Computernetzwerke eingesetzt werden, sind sie berall erhltlich.
MitGlasfaserkabeln lassen sich Signale ber Entfernungen von bis zu 45km bermitteln. Mehr als
genug fr die meisten Auenbertragungen, einschlielich der komplexesten. Wenn sowohl an den
Glasfaser- als auch den SDI-Eingang Gerte angeschlossen sind, wird die Ausgabe des zuerst
angeschlossenen Gerts verwendet. Ein SFP-Glasfasermodul fr Ihre Blackmagic Studio Camera
erhalten Sie von einem Blackmagic Design Fachhndler in Ihrer Nhe. Eine Liste mit Fachhndlern in
Ihrer Umgebung finden Sie auf unsere Website unter www.blackmagicdesign.com/de/resellers.

SDI OUT
Verwenden Sie den SDI-Ausgang, um 10-Bit-Videodaten in 4:2:2 an professionelles SDI-Equipment
wie Kreuzschienen, Monitore, SDI-Erfassungsgerte und Broadcast-Mischer auszugeben. Die
Blackmagic Studio Camera HD untersttzt 3G-SDI, und die Studio Camera 4K untersttzt 12G-SDI.

SDI IN
ber den SDI-Eingang kann der Kamerabediener das ausgegebene Programm (PGM) betrachten.
Drcken Sie einfach die PGM-Taste, um zwischen der Live-Kameraausgabe und der
Programmausgabe aus der Mischregie umzuschalten.
Wenn sowohl an den Glasfaser- als auch an den SDI-Eingang Gerte angeschlossen sind, wird die
Ausgabe des zuerst angeschlossenen Gerts verwendet. Wird mit der Studio Camera auf ein
anderes Gert aufgezeichnet, beispielsweise einen Blackmagic Hyperdeck Shuttle, lsst sich der
Ausgang des Hyperdecks an den SDI-Eingang der Kamera anschlieen. Dies erlaubt die
Wiedergabe des soeben aufgezeichneten Filmmaterials.

Kamera-Anschlsse 158
Referenzeingang
Erlaubt die Synchronisierung mehrerer Kameras mit Genlock ber ein Blackburst- oder Tri-Level-
Referenzsignal. Die Genlock-Synchronisierung von Kameras mit einem externen Referenzsignal
verhindert Zeitversatzfehler, die beim Umschalten zwischen verschiedenen Kameras zu strenden
Bildbewegungen fhren knnen.

Stromversorgung
Verwenden Sie die 1224V-Strombuchse, um Ihr Netzteil anzuschlieen und den Akku der
Blackmagic Studio Camera HD und der Blackmagic Studio Camera 4K aufzuladen. Ein voll
aufgeladener Akku gibt der Studio Camera HD eine Betriebsdauer von rund vier Stunden und der
Studio Camera 4K bis zu drei Stunden.
Die Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 sowie die Studio Camera 4K 2 haben keine integrierten Akkus.

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN

REF

12V

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K linke Kameraseite


HDMI-Ausgang
Der HDMI-Port Ihrer Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K gibt 10-Bit-Video bei 4:2:2 in 1080p aus.
Esenthlt zwei Audiokanle, die zum Monitoring eingesetzt werden knnen. Sie knnen jeden
beliebigen HD-fhigen HDMI-Monitor wie den Blackmagic Video Assist anschlieen, um die
Bildausschnittswahl und Fokussierung von Shots vorzunehmen und um durch die Mens der Micro
Studio Camera 4K zu navigieren.
Die Bildwechselfrequenz der HDMI-Ausgabe wird dem Videoformat der Kamera angepasst. Ist auf
der Kamera bspw. 2160p/30 vorgegeben, so erfolgt die HDMI-Ausgabe in 1080p/30.

MENU
EXPANSION

SET

Kamera-Anschlsse 159
Expansionsport
Das kleine Bauma der Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K macht es einfach, einzigartige Shots
aus unmittelbarer Nhe der Action oder aus schwer zugnglichen Pltzen einzufangen. Man kann
zwar die Micro Studio Camera 4K leicht verbergen, allerdings ist das fr ihren Bediener nicht
unbedingt der Fall. Deshalb ist die Fernbedienung der Kamera ein wichtiger Aspekt, um die Vorteile
ihres winzigen Formfaktors voll auszuschpfen.
ber den SDI-Eingang der Micro Studio Camera 4K knnen Sie einen Teil der Kameraeinstellungen mit
einem ATEM Mischer anpassen. Nheres finden Sie im Abschnitt Die Mischerfunktion Kamerasteuerung
in diesem Handbuch. Die meisten Steueroptionen werden jedoch ber den Expansionsport ermglicht.
Der DB-HD15-Verbinder der Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K bietet mehrere Anschlsse, u.a. fr
Strom, LANC-Fernsteuerung, Schwenk-, Neige-, und Zoom-Funktionen sowie Genlock, deren Benutzung
ber das mitgelieferte Expansionskabel erfolgt. Fr den Zugriff auf spezielle Funktionen empfehlen wir Ihnen
den Gebrauch von berall erhltlichen, gngigen Kabeln. berdies besteht die Alternative, Verbindungen
nach eigenem Bedarf zu lten, um die Micro Studio Camera 4K Ihren Anforderungen anzupassen. Nheres
erfahren Sie im Abschnitt Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K Expansionskabel in diesem Handbuch.

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K rechte Kameraseite


Analogaudio-Eingang
Der 3,5mm-Stereo-Audioeingang eignet sich fr Mikrofon- oder Referenzpegel-Audio. Unter
Audio-Einstellungen knnen Sie zwischen diesen Optionen hin- und herschalten. Es ist wichtig,
dieentsprechende Einstellung auszuwhlen, sonst knnte Ihr Audio zu leise oder zu laut klingen.

SDI OUT
Verwenden Sie den SDI-Ausgang, um 10-Bit-Videodaten in 4:2:2 an professionelles SDI-Equipment
wie Kreuzschienen, Monitore, SDI-Erfassungsgerte und Broadcast-Mischer auszugeben.
DieBlackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K untersttzt 6G-SDI. Um die Gerte ber SDI-Anschlsse in
Originalgre anschlieen zu knnen, bentigen Sie ein DIN-1.0/2.3-zu-SDI-Adapterkabel.

SDI IN
Benutzen Sie den SDI-Anschluss, um Ihre Micro Studio Camera 4K ber den ATEM Mischer zu
steuern. Im Abschnitt Die Mischerfunktion Kamerasteuerung finden Sie Informationen zu den
vorhandenen Steuerungsmglichkeiten.

TIPP Sie knnen Ihre Micro Studio Camera auch ber ein Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino
Shield steuern. Das Shield bettet dieselben Blackmagic Control Datenpakete in das
SDI-Signal ein wie ATEM Mischer. Indem Sie also den Programm-Return-Feed von einem
beliebigen SDI-Mischer durch das Shield und an den SDI-Eingang Ihrer Kamera leiten,
haben Sie Zugriff auf alle Blackmagic Kamerasteuerungsmglichkeiten, die Sie ber einen
ATEM Mischer haben.

Kamera-Anschlsse 160
Kopfhrer-/Talkback-Audio
ber den 3,5mm-Kopfhrer- bzw. Talkback-Anschluss knnen Sie mit gngigen Kopfhrern, wie die
Ihrer iPhone- oder Android-Gerte, mit dem Regieraum kommunizieren. Drcken Sie die
Wiedergabe-/Pausentaste zweimal, um die Talkback-Funktion zu aktivieren. Durch einmaliges
Drcken wird sie deaktiviert. Ton wird in Kanal 15 und 16 der SDI-Signalausgabe eingebettet.

Individualisierung
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K Expansionskabel
Es gibt zwei Mglichkeiten, auf die Funktionen des Expansionsports zuzugreifen. Sie knnen dazu
entweder das Expansionskabel benutzen, das im Lieferumfang Ihrer Micro Studio Camera 4K
enthalten ist, oder Ihre eigenen individualisierten Anschlsse lten.
Das Expansionskabel verfgt ber Anschlsse fr die folgenden Steuermglichkeiten.

4 Micro Studio Cam MSC Breakout Cable Micro Studio Cam MSC Breakout Cable

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K Expansionskabel

1 Stromeingang
Der 12V-Stromanschluss lsst sich ber einen Gleichstromstecker verbinden und speist
die Micro Studio Camera 4K mit Strom. Zudem werden angeschlossene Akkus geladen.
Wenndie Kamera mit Netzstrom versorgt wird, schaltet sie sich automatisch an.
2 Referenzeingang
Erlaubt die Synchronisierung mehrerer Kameras mit Genlock ber ein Blackburst- oder
Tri-Level-Referenzsignal. Die Genlock-Synchronisierung von Kameras mit einem externen
Referenzsignal verhindert Zeitversatzfehler, die beim Umschalten zwischen verschiedenen
Kameras zu strenden Bildbewegungen fhren knnen.
3 LANC
Schlieen Sie drahtgebundene LANC-Fernbedienungen an die 2,5mm-Buchse an,
um unter Einsatz von kompatiblen Objektiven Funktionen wie Zoom-, Blenden- und
Fokuseinstellungen von einem Stativarm aus zu bedienen.
4 Schwenk-, Neige- und Zoom-Funktion
Der RS-422-Anschluss bermittelt vom SDI-Eingang der Micro Studio Camera 4K
eingehende Schwenk-, Neige- und Zoom-Befehle an einen motorbetriebenen Kopf.

Individualisierung 161
5 B4-Kommunikation
Broadcastobjektive, die ber einen MFT-zu-B4-Adapter an die Micro Studio Camera 4K
angeschlossen wurden, knnen ber den DB-9-Anschluss mit Strom versorgt und bedient
werden. Verbinden Sie zur Steuerung eines kompatiblen B4-Objektivs lediglich das
optionale Digital B4 Control Adapterkabel mit dem Kabel des Objektivs und das andere
Ende mit dem seriellen DB-9-Verbinder an Ihrem Expansionskabel.
Nehmen Sie Einstellungen fr Blende, Fokus und Zoom auf dieselbe Weise vor, wie Sie es
bei einem aktiven MFT-Objektiv tun wrden entweder ber das Men Kamerasteuerung
eines ATEM Mischers oder ber die anderen Fernbedienungsinterfaces, auf die Sie ber
das Expansionskabel der Micro Studio Camera 4K zugreifen knnen. Eine Liste untersttzter
digitaler B4-Objektive finden Sie im Blackmagic Design Support Center unter
www.blackmagicdesign.com/de/support/faq/59011.
6 S.Bus Digitalservo
Wenn Sie mithilfe des Futaba-J-Kabels einen kompatiblen S.Bus-Empfnger anschlieen,
stehen Ihnen 18 S.Bus-Kanle zur Verfgung, die mit Funktionen der Kamera belegt und
daraufhin fernbedient werden knnen. Zu diesen Features zhlen Fokus, Servo-Zoom,
Blendeneinstellungen und weitere Funktionen. Weitere Informationen zu Mapping-
Funktionen finden Sie unter Fernbedienungseinstellungen in diesem Handbuch.

Anschlussplan fr das Expansionskabel der


Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera
Wenn Sie mit dem Expansionsport der Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K arbeiten, mchten Sie
unter Umstnden auf nur zwei Funktionen zugreifen. Vielleicht mchten Sie bei gleichzeitigem
Empfang von 12V-Netzstrom und eines Referenzsignals ein aufgesetztes B4-Broadcast-Objektiv
steuern. Whlen Sie zur Bereitstellung dieser Funktionen einfach den geeigneten Verbinder aus und
ignorieren Sie zustzliche, unbenutzte Verbinder.
Der folgende Plan dient als Vorlage, um das mitgelieferte Expansionskabel zu verdrahten oder um
Ihre eigenen Kabel korrekt miteinander zu verdrahten und anzuschlieen. Alle verfgbaren Pole sind
im Bereich P1 aufgelistet, whrend die Untergruppen fr spezielle Funktionen mitsamt Skizze fr den
jeweiligen Verbinder in den Bereichen P2 bis P7 zu finden sind.

P1 PIN ASSIGNMENT
2 S. Bus 1
2 P2
GROUND 3

GROUND 1
12 PTZ RS422 Rx- 2
8 PTZ RS422 Tx+ 3 5
9
GROUND 4 4

GROUND
5
6
3
2
8
7 P3
6
13 PTZ RS422 Rx+ 7 1

3 PTZ RS422 Tx- 8


GROUND 9

5 15
GROUND 1
10 14 B4 Lens Control Transmit 2 5
9
4 14 4
15 B4 Lens Control Receive 3
P4
9 8
3 13 3
8 GROUND 4 2
7
2
7
12 6 Power +12V in* 5 1
6
1 11 OTHER
6

5 Reference Input CENTER


GROUND SLEEVE P5
1 Ground 6 Power +12V in 11 Ground LANC Data
9 TIP
2
3
S. Bus
PTZ RS422 Tx-
7
8
Ground
PTZ RS422 Tx+
12
13
PTZ RS422 Rx-
PTZ RS422 Rx+
10
GROUND
LANC Power RING
SLEEVE
P6
4 Ground 9 LANC Data 14 B4 Lens Control Transmit
5 Reference Input 10 LANC Power 15 B4 Lens Control Receive
6 Power +12V in PIN
GROUND SLEEVE P7

* Power input to the camera is also used to power the lens. Beware of applying excessive voltages if youre using
your own power supply to avoid damage to the lens.

Individualisierung 162
Einstellungen
Fr ein bestmgliches Bild knnen Sie die Einstellungen auf Ihrer Blackmagic Kamera anpassen.
Dazu zhlen Videoformat, Verschlusszeit und Weiabgleich. Auerdem knnen Sie Tonpegel,
Monitoring-Einstellungen, Studio-Tally- und Talkback-Einstellungen fr die Kommunikation mit dem
Regieraum festlegen.
Dieser Handbuchabschnitt enthlt detaillierte Informationen zu jeder Kameraeinstellung, wie:

Kamera-Einstellungen
Um die Einstellungen auf der Blackmagic Studio Camera oder der Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera
4K zu konfigurieren, drcken Sie die MENU-Taste. Benutzen Sie die Pfeiltasten, um Optionen
auszuwhlen, und besttigen Sie Ihre Auswahl per Druck auf die SET-Taste.
Wenn Sie mit der Micro Studio Camera 4K arbeiten, mssen Sie einen externen Monitor an den
HDMI-Kameraport anschlieen, um Meneinstellungen zu sehen.

Video Format
Whlen Sie Ihr gewnschtes Videoformat mithilfe der Pfeiltasten aus. Um bspw. zwischen
den Formaten
1080p und 1080i zu whlen, durchlaufen Sie mit der Rechts- bzw. Linkspfeiltaste die Formatoptionen.
Drcken Sie zur Besttigung des gewnschten Formats die SET-Taste.
Bitte entnehmen Sie die untersttzten Formate der Tabelle auf der nchsten Seite.
Gain
Gain-Einstellungen sind beim Filmen in Verhltnissen mit geringem Licht hilfreich. Der voreingestellte
Wert betrgt 0dB. Der Gain-Wert lsst sich in Schritten von jeweils 6dB bis zu +18dB steigern.
Detail
Diese Einstellung dient zur Schrfung Ihres Bildes live unmittelbar von Ihrer Studio Camera.
Verringern oder steigern Sie das Schrfungsniveau, indem Sie Off (Aus) oder Default (Standard)
fr geringfgige Schrfung bzw. Medium (Mittel) oder High (Hoch) fr strkere Schrfung whlen.
Auto Exposure
Die Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K verfgt ber mehrere Optionen der Belichtungsautomatik.
Iris
Hlt die Verschlusszeit bei wechselnder Blendenffnung konstant und liefert so eine konstante
Belichtung.
Shutter
Hlt die Blendenffnung bei wechselnder Verschlusszeit konstant und liefert so eine konstante Belichtung.

Kamera-Einstellungen Blackmagic Studio Camera Einstellungen 163


Iris + Shutter
Behlt die korrekte Belichtungsstrke durch Anpassung der Blendenffnung bei. Wenn die
Belichtung mit der grten oder kleinsten verfgbaren Blendenffnung nicht beibehalten werden
kann, passt die Micro Studio Camera 4K die Verschlusszeit an, um die Belichtung konstant zu halten.

Shutter + Iris
Behlt die korrekte Belichtungsstrke durch Anpassung der Verschlusszeit bei. Wenn die Belichtung
bei maximal oder minimal verfgbarer Verschlusszeit nicht beibehalten werden kann, beginnt die
Micro Studio Camera 4K mit der Anpassung der Verschlusszeit, um die Blendenffnung konstant
zu halten.

Manual Trigger
Blendenffnung und Verschlusszeit werden manuell vorgegeben und die Belichtung verndert sich
bei variierenden Lichtverhltnissen.

Weiabgleich
Es stehen 18 Weiabgleich-Voreinstellungen fr verschiedene Farbtemperaturverhltnisse zur
Verfgung.
2500K, 2800K, 3000K, 3200K, 3400K, 3600K, 4000K, 4500K und 4800K
fr verschiedene Bedingungen bei Kunstlicht, Glhbirnen- oder Neonlicht oder bei
gedmpftem natrlichen Licht wie Kerzenlicht, Sonnenauf- oder -untergang, Morgen- und
Nachmittagslicht.
5000K, 5200K, 5400K und 5600K fr Auenaufnahmen an klaren, sonnigen Tagen.
6000K, 6500K, 7000 K, 7500K und 8000K fr verschiedenartige Tageslichtverhltnisse.

Shutter Speed
Die Verschlusszeit gibt zusammen mit der Gain-Einstellung die Lichtmenge vor, die auf den Sensor
gelassen wird. Es sind 15 verschiedene Verschlusszeiten von 1/50 sec bis 1/2000 sec verfgbar.

Kamera-Einstellungen Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

Von Blackmagic Studio Cameras untersttzte Videoformate

Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Micro Studio


Camera Camera 4K Camera 4K

720p/50 720p/50 1080i/50

720p/59,94 720p/59,94 1080i/59,94

720p/60 720p/60 1080i/60

1080i/50 1080i/50 1080p/23,98

Einstellungen 164
Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Micro Studio
Camera Camera 4K Camera 4K

1080i/59,94 1080i/59,94 1080p/24

1080i/60 1080i/60 1080p/25

1080p/23,98 1080p/23,98 1080p/29,97

1080p/24 1080p/24 1080p/30

1080p/25 1080p/25 1080p/50

1080p/29,97 1080p/29,97 1080p/59,94

1080p/30 1080p/30 1080p/60

1080p/50 1080p/50 2160p/23,98

1080p/59,94 1080p/59,94 2160p/24

1080p/60 1080p/60 2160p/25

2160p/23,98 2160p/29,97

2160p/24 2160p/30

2160p/25

2160p/29,97

2160p/30

2160p/50

2160p/59,94

2160p/60

Audio-Einstellungen
Drcken Sie zur Vorgabe der Einstellungen fr die Eingabe- und Audiokontrolle Ihrer Blackmagic
Studio Camera die MENU-Taste und whlen Sie das links im Display angezeigte Mikrofonsymbol aus.
Navigieren Sie mithilfe der Pfeiltasten durch die Menoptionen und drcken Sie die SET-Taste, um
Ihre Auswahl zu besttigen.

Audio-Einstellungen Blackmagic Studio Camera

Einstellungen 165
Automatic Gain Control
Die Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K verfgt ber Einstellungen fr die automatische
Lautstrkesteuerung, ber die die Kamera die Aufnahmepegel fr Audioinhalte anpasst. Die Kamera
senkt die Audioverstrkung automatisch, wenn die Eingabepegel zu hoch sind bzw. erhht sie
etwas, wenn die Eingabepegel zu niedrig sind.

Audio Input
Schaltet fr die Audioeingabe zwischen der kamerainternen Mikrofonbuchse und den XLR-
Audiobuchsen der Kamera um.

Microphone Level
ber Microphone input (Mikrofoneingang) knnen die Aufnahmepegel des eingebauten Mikrofons
angepasst werden. Schieben Sie zum Erhhen oder Verringern der Pegel den Audio-Schieberegler nach
links oder rechts. Die Studio Camera weist ein eingebautes Stereomikrofon auf. Wenn keine externe
Audioquelle angeschlossen ist, zeichnet das eingebaute Mikrofon auf die Audiokanle 1 und 2 auf.

Input Level
Anschlsse fr externes Audio untersttzen hochpegelige und niederpegelige Tonsignale. Whlen
Sie Line, um externe Audiogerte wie beispielsweise einen Tonmixer oder Verstrker
anzuschlieen. Geben Sie je nach der Signalstrke Ihres Mikrofons die Einstellung Mic Low
(Niedrig) oder Mic High (Hoch) vor. Es ist wichtig, den passenden Pegel auszuwhlen, damit
vermieden wird, dass Ihr Audio kaum hrbar oder zu laut und verzerrt klingt. Stellen Sie die externen
Audioeingangspegel mithilfe der Links- und Rechtspfeiltasten ein.

Ch 1 Input
Schieben Sie zum Erhhen oder Verringern der Pegel fr Kanal 1 den Audio-Schieberegler nach
links oder rechts. Externe Audioeingaben haben Vorrang vor dem eingebauten Mikrofon und
werden auf Audiokanal 1 ausgegeben.

Ch 2 Uses Ch 1 Input
Aktivieren Sie diese Option, um externes Audio von Channel 1 in die Kanle 1 und 2, die ber den SDI-
Ausgang oder den optionalen Glasfaserausgang bermittelt werden, einzubetten. Dies bewirkt dasselbe
wie wenn Sie Input 1 an beide Audiokanle der Kamera anschlieen. Ntzlich bei Einsatz von Mikrofonen
mit einem einzelnen Mini-Audioausgang, wenn beide Stereoaudiokanle angeschlossen werden sollen.
Die Auswahl von Off bewirkt, dass Kanal-1-Audio nur auf dem einen Kanal bleibt, und Kanal 2 den Ton von
der Kanal-2-Audioeingabe bernimmt. Bei Verwendung von Stereoaudioquellen wird dies bevorzugt.

Ch 2 Input
Schieben Sie zum Erhhen oder Verringern der Pegel fr Kanal 2 den Audio-Schieberegler nach
links oder rechts. Externe Audioeingaben haben Vorrang vor dem eingebauten Mikrofon und
werden auf Audiokanal 2 ausgegeben.

Phantom Power
Phantomspeisung liefert Strom ber Mikrofonkabel und ist praktisch als Stromquelle fr
Kondensatormikrofone. Aktivieren bzw. deaktivieren Sie Phantom Power" fr Studiokameras mit
XLR-Anschlssen, indem Sie zum Audio-Men navigieren und dort mithilfe der Pfeiltasten On (Ein)
bzw. Off (Aus) auswhlen. Phantomspeisung wird automatisch deaktiviert, wenn die Einstellung fr
Line Input Level ausgewhlt ist. Warten Sie mindestens 10 Sekunden, damit sich die Phantomspeisung
entladen kann, ehe sie ein Mikrofon mit eigener Stromversorgung anschlieen. / ein eigenversorgtes
Mikrofon anschlieen. ltere Bndchenmikrofone sind nicht fr die Phantomspeisung geeignet.

Einstellungen fr das Monitoring


Drcken Sie die MENU-Taste und whlen Sie das Monitorsymbol aus, um die Display-Einstellungen
des LCD vorzugeben. Wechseln Sie mithilfe der Pfeiltasten durch die Menoptionen und drcken
Sie die SET-Taste, um Ihre Auswahl zu besttigen.

Einstellungen 166
Einstellungen fr das Monitoring Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

HDMI Meters
Die Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K gibt Ihnen die Mglichkeit, bevorzugte Pegelmesser mit der
HDMI-Ausgabe anzuzeigen.

Histogramm
Das Histogramm stellt die Kontraste zwischen weien und schwarzen Tonwerten anhand einer
horizontalen Skala dar. Am linken Rand des Histogramms werden die Schatten bzw. Schwarzwerte
und ganz rechts die Lichter bzw. Weiwerte angezeigt. Wenn Sie die Blende schlieen oder ffnen,
wird Ihnen auffallen, dass sich die Helligkeitsinformationen im Histogramm entsprechend nach links
oder rechts verschieben.
ber diese Einstellungen wird das Histogramm ein- und ausgeschaltet. Ist das Histogramm
zusammen mit HDMI Overlays aktiviert, erscheint es in der rechten unteren Ecke eines
angeschlossenen Monitors.

Audio
Der Audiopegelmesser stellt die aktuelle Lautstrke der linken und rechten Audiokanle anhand von
zwei horizontalen Balken dar. Der linke Kanal befindet sich oben, der rechte unten. Klettern Ihre
Audiopegel zu hoch, besteht das Risiko einer bersteuerung Ihrer Gipfelwerte mit resultierender
Soundverzerrung. Um dies zu vermeiden, passen Sie die Audioverstrkung auf Ihrer Kamera
solange an, bis Ihre Audiopegel innerhalb des sicheren Bereichs bleiben.
ber diese Einstellungen wird der Audiopegelmesser ein- und ausgeschaltet. Bei Aktivierung
erscheint er unten links auf einem angeschlossenem Monitor, wenn die Option
HDMI Overlays ebenfalls eingeschaltet ist.

HDMI Overlays
Diese Einstellung ist ausschlielich bei der Micro Studio Camera 4K verfgbar. Ist diese Option mit
On aktiviert, enthlt die HDMI-Videoausgabe
Bildrandmarkierungen und Informationen zu den Kamera-Einstellungen und -Identitten sowie
jegliche Pegelmesser, die in der Einstellung HDMI Meters eingeschaltet wurden.

Brightness
Bewegen Sie den Schieberegler nach links oder rechts, um die Helligkeitseinstellungen des LCDs
anzupassen. Die Standardeinstellung betrgt 60%.

Zebra
Blackmagic Cameras sind mit einer Zebra-Funktion ausgestattet, die Aufschluss ber die
Belichtungsstrken gibt. Ein diagonales Linienmuster erscheint ber jedem Videobereich, der die
Zebra-Belichtungsstrke berschreitet.
Schalten Sie Zebra ein und whlen Sie mithilfe der Links- und Rechtspfeiltasten den gewnschten
Zebra-Warnpegel aus. Es ist ein Mittelwert voreingestellt.
Einstellungen 167
Focus Peaking
Erlaubt die Einstellung des Pegels fr Focus Peaking. Verfgbare Einstellungen sind: Off (Aus),
Low (Niedrig), Medium (Mittel) und High (Hoch). Passen Sie diese Einstellung an, wenn Sie ein
extrem scharfes Objektiv benutzen und die Peaking-Markierungen das ganze Bild bedecken. Es ist
ein Mittelwert voreingestellt.

Front Tally Brightness


ndert die Helligkeit des vorderen Tally-Lichts. Verfgbare Einstellungen sind: Off (Aus),
Low(Niedrig), Medium (Mittel) und High (Hoch). Es ist ein Mittelwert voreingestellt.

Rear Tally Brightness


ndert die Helligkeit des rckwrtigen Tally-Lichts. Verfgbare Einstellungen sind: Low (Niedrig),
Medium (Mittel) und High (Hoch). Es ist ein Mittelwert voreingestellt.

Tally Light Brightness


Hier knnen Sie die Helligkeit des Tally-Lichts an Ihrer Micro Studio Camera 4K einstellen.
DieStandardeinstellung ist Medium, jedoch kann diese auf Off (Aus), Low (Niedrig) oder High
(Hoch) eingestellt werden.
Sollten Sie sich fr die Option Off entschieden haben, erleuchtet das Tally-Licht, sobald Ihre
Kamera eingeschaltet wird, erlischt aber kurz darauf wieder.

Anzeige des Akkuladestands


Der Akkuladestand einiger LP-E6-Akkus wird der Kamera ber die digitale serielle Kommunikation
direkt mitgeteilt. Bei Aktivierung dieser Option wird der Akkustand der Micro Studio Camera 4K als
Prozentwert anstatt als grafischer Balken angezeigt. Wenn Ihnen die Prozentanzeige jedoch zu ungenau
ist, knnen Sie die grafische Anzeige erneut einblenden. Sie misst den Ladezustand direkt am Akku.

Studio-Einstellungen
Drcken Sie die MENU-Taste und whlen Sie das Kopfhrersymbol aus, um die Display-
Einstellungen des LCD vorzugeben. Wechseln Sie mithilfe der Pfeiltasten durch die Menoptionen
und drcken Sie die SET-Taste, um Ihre Auswahl zu besttigen.

Kamera-Einstellungen Blackmagic Studio Camera

Kameranummer
Wenn Ihre Studio Camera Tally-Signale von einem ATEM Mischer empfangen soll, mssen Sie auf
Ihrer Kamera zunchst eine Kameranummer vorgeben. Dies gewhrleistet, dass der Mischer das
Tally-Signal an die richtige Kamera bermittelt. Die Kameranummer kann auf einen Wert zwischen
199 eingestellt werden. Die Standardeinstellung betrgt 1.
Einstellungen 168
TIPP Sie knnen den Programm-Return-Feed von einem beliebigen SDI-Mischer ber ein
Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield an Ihre Kamera leiten, sodass Sie auf jeder Kamera
Tally-Signale empfangen knnen. Alle SDI-Mischer mit Open-Collector-Ausgngen fr Tally
sind fr den Empfang von Tally-Signalen ber ein Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield
konfigurierbar. Weitere Informationen finden Sie im Abschnitt Tally ber das Blackmagic
3G-SDI Arduino Shield verbinden.

Reference Source
Dient zur Auswahl der Genlock-Quelle. Die Studio Camera kann Genlock am Programm-SDI-Eingang
oder von einer externen Genlock-Quelle einsetzen. Bereiten Sie sich bei Verwendung einer
externen Genlock-Quelle darauf vor, dass der Wechsel der Quelle hchstwahrscheinlich zu einer
Strung beim Synchronisieren der Kamera fhren wird.

Reference Timing
Erlaubt Ihnen die manuelle Abstimmung der Referenzzeitvorgabe nach Zeilen oder Pixeln.

Headset Level
Bewegen Sie zum Erhhen oder Verringern der Pegel fr das Audio-Monitoring den Lautstrke-
Schieberegler nach links oder rechts. Die Standardeinstellung betrgt 50%.

Headset Mic Level


Bewegen Sie zum Erhhen oder Verringern der Audio-Eingabepegel des Mikrofons den Lautstrke-
Schieberegler nach links oder rechts. Die Standardeinstellung betrgt 50%.

Program Mix
ndert das Lautstrkeverhltnis von Kameraton zu Talkback-Ton. Die Kopfhrer geben den jeweils
auf dem LCD angezeigten Ton aus. Beispiel: Wenn Sie sich in der Kameraansicht befinden, ist der
Ton von der Kamera zu hren. Befinden Sie sich jedoch in der Programmansicht, so ist das
Programmaudio zu hren. Die Standardeinstellung betrgt 0%.

Einstellungen fr die Fernbedienung


Die Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K verfgt ber ein Zusatzmen fr die Einstellung der
Fernbedienungsfunktionen. Wenn Sie Ihre Kamera per S.Bus steuern, lassen sich ber dieses Men
Funktionen wie Blende, Verschlusszeit u.a. verschiedenen S.Bus-Kanlen zuweisen. Whlen Sie
einfach die zu steuernde Funktion aus und weisen Sie diese durch Auf- und Abwrtsnavigieren mit
den Pfeiltasten einem verfgbaren Kanal zu.

Einstellungen fr die Fernbedienung


Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

Einstellungen 169
Funktionen der Bedientasten
Objektiveinstellungen anpassen
Die Blackmagic Studio Camera untersttzt die elektronische Blendensteuerung. Das erlaubt Ihnen,
Blendeneinstellungen wie die ffnungsweite und automatische Fokussierung anzupassen. Mit der
Focus-Peaking-Funktion werden die schrfsten Bildbereiche grn umrandet, damit Sie sich mhelos
Ihrer Scharfstellung vergewissern knnen. Focus Peaking ist ausschlielich auf dem LCD zu sehen
und wirkt sich nicht auf die SDI-Ausgabe aus.
FOCUS-Taste
Drcken Sie bei Einsatz der Studio Camera mit einem Autofokus-Objektiv die FOCUS-Taste fr
Focus Peaking oder Autofokus. Drcken Sie fr Autofokus einmal auf die FOCUS-Taste. Durch
zweimaliges Drcken der FOCUS-Taste in schneller Folge aktivieren Sie Focus Peaking.
Drcken Sie die FOCUS-Taste bei Einsatz eines manuellen Objektivs einmal.
IRIS-Taste
Bei Verwendung der Dynamikumfang-EinstellungVideo wird durch einmaliges Drcken der IRIS-Taste
eine durchschnittliche Belichtungszeit basierend auf der Helligkeitsverteilung in Ihrer Aufnahme
eingestellt. Bei Verwendung der Dynamikumfang-Einstellung Film wird die Belichtung durch Drcken
der Blendentaste (IRIS) auf die Spitzlichter in Ihrer Aufnahme eingestellt. Um die Belichtungszeit Ihrer
Studio Camera manuell einzustellen, drcken Sie die Auf- und Abwrtstasten zur Mennavigation.

Zustzliche Einstellungen
PTT-Taste
Bei Liveproduktionen muss der Kamerabediener unbedingt mit dem Regisseur und anderen
Mitwirkenden im Regieraum sprechen knnen. Halten Sie einfach die PPT-Taste (Push-to-Talk) gedrckt
und fangen Sie an zu sprechen. Zweimaliges Drcken der PPT-Taste in schneller Folge ermglicht die
handfreie Kommunikation. Erneutes Drcken bringt das standardmige Verhalten zurck.

PGM-Taste
Manchmal ist es wichtig, dass Kamerabediener auch die Programmausgabe und nicht blo die Ansicht
von den eigenen Kameras sehen knnen. Drcken Sie die Programmtaste PGM, um zwischen Live-
Kameraausgabe und der Programmausgabe aus der Mischregie umzuschalten. Ihre externe Videoquelle
lsst sich ber den SDI-Eingang oder ber den benutzeraufrstbaren Glasfasereingang anschlieen.

LUT-Taste
Die Look-Up-Table-Taste ist gegenwrtig nicht ausgefhrt.

Pfeiltasten Links, Rechts, Aufwrts, Abwrts


Benutzen Sie diese Tasten fr die Mennavigation.

SET-Taste
Besttigen Sie mit der SET-Taste Ihre im Men getroffene Auswahl.

DISP-Taste
Per Druck auf die Displaytaste erscheinen auf dem 10-Zoll-Monitor Ihrer Studio Camera ntzliche
Informationen wie:
Bildausschnittmarkierungen, Kamera- und Blendeneinstellungen wie Kameranummer,
Videoformat und Framerate, Verschlusszeit, Weiabgleich, Akkuladestatus, Gain-
Einstellungen und Blendenstufe.
Erneutes Drcken der DISP-Taste schaltet die Overlays aus und es wird nur das Bild angezeigt.
Overlays sind auf dem 10-Zoll-Monitor zu sehen. Die SDI-Ausgabe ist jedoch immer einblendungsfrei.

HINWEIS Die Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 und Studio Camera 4K 2 verfgen nicht
ber interne Akkus, daher zeigen sie auch nicht den verbleibenden Ladezustand an.

Einstellungen 170
MENU-Taste
OPTICAL OUT
Drcken Sie diese Taste, um das Men aufzurufen und navigieren Sie mit den Pfeiltasten.
OPTICAL IN

Ein-/Austaste
SDI OUT

Die Blackmagic Studio Camera wird per Druck auf die Ein-/Austaste eingeschaltet. Halten Sie diese
SDI IN Taste zum Ausschalten der Kamera gedrckt.

REF

12V

OPTICAL OUT OPTICAL OUT OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN OPTICAL IN OPTICAL IN

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT FOCUS IRIS SET PTT PGM LUT
DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRISSET PTT PGM DISPLAY
LUT MENU SET DISPLAY MENU
SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT

SDI IN SDI IN SDI IN

REF REF REF

12V 12V 12V

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU

Drcken Sie fr Autofokus Drcken Sie die IRIS-Taste fr Die Studio Camera verfgt
einmal auf die FOCUS-Taste. automatische Belichtung oder ber Einstellungen wie PTT und
Durch zweimaliges Drcken der stellen Sie die Belichtung mit PGM, die fr die Liveproduktion
FOCUS-Taste in schneller Folge den Auf- und Abwrtspfeiltasten unverzichtbar sind
aktivieren Sie Fokus-Peaking manuell ein

Videoausgabe der Kamera


Anschlieen von Videomischern
Blackmagic Studio Cameras geben 10-Bit-Videodaten in 4:2:2 aus, damit Sie Broadcast-Mischer und
anderweitiges SDI-Videoequipment anschlieen knnen. Bei Vorhandensein eines
benutzerinstallierbaren SFP-Moduls knnen Sie Verbindungen ber Glasfaser herstellen. Hiermit
erbrigt sich der kameraseitige Gebrauch von ATEM Camera Convertern.
Wenn Sie eine Blackmagic Studio Camera HD oder Studio Camera 4K im Einsatz haben, knnen Sie
die Programmausgabe (PGM) des Mischers mhelos betrachten, indem Sie diesen Ausgang an den
SDI-Eingang oder bei benutzerinstalliertem SFP-Modul an den Glasfasereingang Ihrer Studio
Camera anschlieen.
Die Blackmagic Studio Camera verfgt auerdem ber einen Referenzeingang, der die Genlock-
Synchronisierung mehrerer Kameras mit einem Blackburst- oder Tri-Level-Referenzsignal erlaubt.
Die Genlock-Synchronisierung von Kameras, MAZen und anderen Gerten mit einem externen
Referenzsignal verhindert Zeitversatzfehler, die beim Umschalten zwischen verschiedenen Quellen
zu strenden Bildbewegungen fhren knnen.

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

OPTICAL OUT

SDI IN
OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

REF
SDI IN

REF

12V

12V

Koppeln Sie Ihre Studio Camera ber SDI oder, sofern ein
optionales SFP-Glasfasermodul installiert wurde, ber Glasfaser

Videoausgabe der Kamera 171


Anschlieen von Aufzeichnungsgerten
Wenn Sie die Ausgabe Ihrer Studio Camera einfach nur aufzeichnen mchten, knnen Sie den
SDI-Ausgang der Kamera an den SDI-Eingang eines SSD-Rekorders, beispielsweise eines
Blackmagic Hyperdeck Shuttle, anschlieen. Der SDI-Ausgang des HyperDecks lsst sich wiederum
an den SDI-Eingang der Studio Camera anschlieen, sodass Sie Ihr aufgezeichnetes Material auf
dem LCD der Kamera betrachten knnen.

+12V POWER HDMI IN HDMI OUT SDI IN SDI OUT

+12V POWER HDMI IN HDMI OUT SDI IN SDI OUT

Schlieen Sie den SDI-Ausgang der Kamera an den SDI-Eingang des HyperDecks an, und den
SDI-Ausgang des HyperDecks an den SDI-Eingang der Kamera, um Ihr aufgezeichnetes Material
zu betrachten

Verbinden des Tally anhand eines


Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shields
Wenn Sie einen SDI-Mischer mit einem Tally-Ausgabeanschluss im Einsatz haben, knnen Sie
dessen Tally-Ausgnge ber ein Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield mit Ihren Blackmagic Studio
Cameras verbinden und Tally-Signale an diese Kameras senden. Somit knnen Sie auch dann ber
den SDI-Programm-Return-Feed Tally-Signale mit Ihren Blackmagic Kameras empfangen, wenn Sie
keinen ATEM Mischer verwenden.
So verbindet sich der parallele Tally-Port Ihres Mischers bspw. ber die Pole D2D9 Ihres
Blackmagic Shields. Der SDI-Ausgang des Shields ist wiederum mit allen Blackmagic Kameras ber
einen Verteilverstrker wie einen Blackmagic Mini Converter SDI Distribution verbunden. Auf diese
Weise knnen Sie Tally-Signale an acht unterschiedliche Blackmagic Kameras senden.
Die Nummer der Blackmagic Kamera muss mit den Tally-Ausgaben des Mischers bereinstimmen.
D.h. Sie mssen sich einen benutzerdefinierten Verbinder zusammenstellen, um sicherzustellen,
dass die Pole den jeweiligen Kameranummern entsprechen. Der gemeinsame GND-Pol vom
Tally-Verbinder des Mischers muss mit dem GND-Pol des Arduino Shields verbunden sein.
Unten finden Sie ein Konfigurationsbeispiel, das zeigt, inwiefern die Blackmagic Kameranummern
den Tally-Ausgaben des Mischers entsprechen, die dann mit den Polen des Blackmagic Arduino
Shields verbunden werden.

Blackmagic Mischer
Kameranummer Eingangsnummer Arduino-Pol

1 1 D2

2 2 D3

3 3 D4

4 4 D5

5 5 D6

6 6 D7

7 7 D8

8 8 D9

Verbinden des Tally anhand eines Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shields 172
In der Beispielskizze unten sehen Sie, nach welchem Schema das Blackmagic Arduino Shield ein
Tally-Signal zu der auf den Programmausgang geschalteten Kamera schickt. Alle SDI-Mischer mit
Open-Collector-Ausgngen sind fr den Empfang von Tally-Signalen ber ein Blackmagic 3G-SDI
Arduino Shield konfigurierbar. Laden Sie sich fr weitere Informationen die Blackmagic 3G-SDI
Arduino Shield Bedienungsanleitung im Blackmagic Design Support-Center
www.blackmagicdesign.com/de/support herunter.

Die Beispielskizze oben zeigt, nach welchem Schema das Blackmagic Arduino Shield ein Tally-Signal
fr Eingang 1 oder 2 ber den Tally-Ausgang des Mischers erkennt und dieses dann in den SDI-
Ausgang des Shields einbettet. Das Tally-Licht leuchtet daraufhin an der entsprechenden Kamera auf

Verbinden des Tally anhand eines Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shields 173
1

PUSH
2

PUSHBlackmagic Camera Setup


So aktualisieren Sie Ihre Kamerasoftware unter Mac OS X
Entpacken Sie die Installationssoftware Blackmagic Camera Setup nach erfolgtem Download und
doppelklicken Sie auf die .dmg-Disk-Image-Datei. Starten Sie Blackmagic Camera Setup und folgen
Sie den Anweisungen auf dem Bildschirm.

Blackmagic Camera Setup Software


1
PUSH

2
PUSH

So aktualisieren Sie Ihre Kamera software unter Windows


Nachdem Sie die heruntergeladene Installationssoftware Blackmagic Camera Setup entpackt
haben, erscheint das Installationsfenster Blackmagic Camera Setup. Doppelklicken Sie auf das
Installationssymbol und folgen Sie den auf dem Bildschirm angezeigten Aufforderungen zur
Fertigstellung der Installation.
Klicken Sie nach abgeschlossener Installation auf das Windows-Startmen und gehen Sie zu
AlleProgramme. Klicken Sie auf den Blackmagic Design Ordner, um die Installationssoftware
Blackmagic Camera Setup und die Handbcher zu ffnen.

So aktualisieren Sie die Firmware Ihrer Kamera


Schlieen Sie Ihren Computer nach erfolgter Installation der Blackmagic Camera Setup Software mit
einem USB-Kabel an Ihre Kamera an. Der Mini-USB-2.0-Port befindet sich am Kameraboden.
Starten Sie Blackmagic Camera Setup und folgen Sie den auf dem Bildschirm angezeigten
Aufforderungen zur Aktualisierung der Kamerasoftware.

Der Mini-USB-2.0-Port befindet sich am Kameraboden

Blackmagic Camera Setup 174


Befestigen von Zubehr
Gegenlichtblende
Die mit der Studio Camera gelieferte faltbare Gegenlichtblende dient zum Schutz des LCDs vor
grellem Licht, damit das Display jederzeit klar erkennbar ist.
1 Legen Sie sich die im Lieferumfang Ihrer Studio Camera enthaltenen sechs
Flgelschrauben zurecht.
2 Schieben Sie die Bohrlcher in der Gegenlichtblende ber die Befestigungspunkte an der
Kamera. Drehen Sie dann jeweils zwei der Flgelschrauben seitlich der Kamera und an ihrer
Ober- und Unterseite fest, bis die Gegenlichtblende festsitzt.

Weiteres Zubehr
Fr den Einsatz im Studio mag es wnschenswert sein, die Kamera auf ein Rollstativ zu setzen und
Schienen fr gewichtige Broadcast-Objektive und Teleprompter anzubringen. Der Gebrauch der
Kamera bei Auenbertragungen hingegen erfordert vielleicht den Anschluss von Mikrofonen,
externen Batterien und LANC-Fernbedienungen. Die Kamera ist am Boden mit zwei 3/8-Zoll-
Befestigungspunkten und seitlich und oben mit zehn 1/4-Zoll Befestigungspunkten versehen.
Dasgibt Ihnen die Flexibilitt, Ihr Rig fr Produktionen aller Gren umzubauen.

1
1
PUSH

3
2

2
1
PUSH

3
2

Arbeiten mit ATEM Software Control


Die Mischerfunktion Kamerasteuerung
Ihre Blackmagic Studio Camera lsst sich von einem ATEM Mischer ber die Funktion
Kamerasteuerung in der Bediensoftware ATEM Software Control bedienen. Ein Klick auf die
Kamera-Schaltflche ruft das Kamerasteuerungsfenster auf. Die Einstellungen fr Iris (Blende),
Gain (Lichter) und Focus (Fokus) lassen sich bei Einsatz kompatibler Objektive bequem justieren.
Sie knnen auch mehrere Kameras farblich abgleichen und mit DaVinci Resolve Primary Color
Corrector, dem Tool fr die primre Farbkorrektur, einzigartige Looks kreieren.
Mit der ATEM Mischersteuerung werden Datenpakete zur Steuerung der Kamera ber alle nicht
abwrtskonvertierten SDI-Ausgnge eines ATEM Mischers bermittelt. Sie knnen also einen SDI-
Ausgang Ihres ATEM Mischers an den Videoeingang der Kamera anschlieen. Da die Kamera die
Steuerungspakete ber die SDI-Verbindung erkennt, erlaubt dies die Steuerung von Funktionen in der
Kamera selbst. Ihre Kamera lsst sich sowohl ber eine regulre SDI- als auch ber eine vom Benutzer
aufrstbare Glasfaserverbindung steuern, sofern ein SFP-Glasfasermodul installiert ist.

Arbeiten mit ATEM Software Control 175


ATEM Kamerasteuerung

Anschlieen via SDI


1 Koppeln Sie den SDI-Ausgang Ihrer Blackmagic Studio Camera an den SDI-Eingang des
ATEM Mischers.
2 Verbinden Sie einen beliebigen SDI-Ausgang des ATEM Mischers jedoch nicht die
abwrtskonvertierten oder Multi View-Ausgnge mit dem SDI-Eingang Ihrer Studio
Camera. Kamerasteuerungssignale werden nicht ber die Multi View-Ausgnge oder
abwrtskonvertierte SDI-Ausgnge bermittelt.
3 Drcken Sie die MENU-Taste Ihrer Blackmagic Studio Camera. Navigieren Sie zu Studio
Settings > Camera Number (Studio-Einstellungen > Kameranummer) und stellen Sie
diese analog zum Mischereingang ein. Beispiel: Wenn Studio Camera 1 an den ATEM
Mischereingang Cam 1 angeschlossen ist, muss die Nummer Ihrer Kamera ebenfalls auf 1
eingestellt sein. So wird das Tally-Signal an die richtige Kamera bermittelt.

IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 1 IN 3 1 1 3 1 REMOTE REMOTE
1 3 5 1 7 3 9 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH
STEREO IN

CONTROL CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 IN 2 2 HD 2 HD HD HD HD HD
1 2 4 1 6 2 8 4 10 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 REF IN
PREVIEW AUXPROGRAM
1-3 PREVIEW
OUTPUTS PROGRAM OUTPUTS
MULTI-VIEW MULTI-VIEW
ANALOG AUDIO IN

IN IN IN IN IN 1 3 1 REMOTE
All SDI and HDMI video connections are
1 3 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH SD, HD and Ultra HD switchable unless indicated

CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 2 HD HD HD
1 2 4 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2 CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 PREVIEW PROGRAM OUTPUTS MULTI-VIEW ANALOG AUDIO IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT

Schlieen Sie Ihre Blackmagic Studio Camera an einen


beliebigen SDI-Eingang Ihres ATEM Mischers an

Arbeiten mit ATEM Software Control 176


Anschlieen via Glasfaser
1 Verbinden Sie nach der Installation des SFP-Glasfasermoduls die Glasfaser-Ein-/Ausgnge
Ihrer Studio Camera mit den Glaserfaser-Ein-/Ausgnge des ATEM Studio Converters.
2 Verbinden Sie einen geeigneten SDI-Ausgang des ATEM Studio Converters mit einem
beliebigen SDI-Eingang des ATEM Mischers.
3 Verbinden Sie einen beliebigen SDI-Ausgang des ATEM Mischers jedoch nicht die
abwrtskonvertierten oder Multi View-Ausgnge mit dem SDI-Eingang des ATEM Studio
Converters. Kamerasteuerungssignale werden nicht ber die Multi View-Ausgnge oder
abwrtskonvertierte SDI-Ausgnge bermittelt.
4 Drcken Sie die MENU-Taste Ihrer Blackmagic Studio Camera. Navigieren Sie zu Studio
Settings > Camera Number (Studio-Einstellungen > Kameranummer) und stellen Sie
diese analog zum Mischereingang ein. Beispiel: Wenn Studio Camera 1 an den ATEM
Mischereingang Cam 1 angeschlossen ist, muss die Nummer Ihrer Kamera ebenfalls auf 1
eingestellt sein. So wird das Tally-Signal an die richtige Kamera bermittelt.
ffnen Sie Preferences (Einstellungen) in ATEM Software Control und belegen Sie die Tasten des
Mischers so, dass die jeweilige Kamera mit dem richtigen Tally-Licht angezeigt wird. Jetzt wo eine
Videoverbindung von Ihrem Mischer zu Ihrer Blackmagic Studio Camera besteht, knnen Sie auch
die Tally-Indikatoren an Ihrer Kamera nutzen und per Druck der PGM-Taste Ihrer Kamera den
Programm-Feed ansehen.

AES/EBU TALKBACK LOOPS

3 1 4 2 OUT
3OUT OUT
4

L R

UT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT IN IN SDI OUT IN

L +12V
R BACKUP L L R R L L R R L R
POWER USB 2.0
OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN
OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG
ANALOG AUDIO OUTAUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO
OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG
OUT AUDIO OUT PGM SDI OPTICAL
MICOUT/IN H/PHONE ANALOG AUDIO OUT OP

AES/EBU TALKBACK LOOPS

1 2 3 4 OUT OUT OUT

L R

SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT IN IN IN

+12V BACKUP L R L R L R L R
POWER USB 2.0 OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT PGM SDI MIC H/PHONE

Verbinden Sie mehrere Blackmagic Studio Cameras ber


Glasfaser mittels eines ATEM Studio Converters

Arbeiten mit der Mischerfunktion Kamerasteuerung


Starten Sie die Bediensoftware ATEM Software Control und klicken Sie am unteren Rand der
Benutzeroberflche auf das Kamerasymbol. Nun wird eine Zeile mit gekennzeichneten
Kamerabedienfeldern angezeigt, die leistungsfhige Tools zur Anpassung und Verfeinerung des
Bildes der jeweiligen Kamera enthalten. Die Bedienfelder sind einfach handhabbar. Klicken Sie die
Symbole mit Ihrer Maus an oder nehmen Sie Anpassungen per Klick und einer Ziehbewegung vor.

Auswahl der zu steuernden Kameras


Die Schaltflchenzeile im oberen Bereich des Kamera-Arbeitsraums erlaubt Ihnen, die zu
steuernde Kamera anhand ihrer Nummer auszuwhlen. Wenn Sie mehrere Kameras haben, deren
Anzeigen in das Fenster passen und ohne Scrollen sichtbar sind, oder das Farbkorrekturfenster
geffnet ist, knnen Sie ber diese Schaltflchen die jeweils zu steuernde Kamera auswhlen.
WennSie einen Aux-Ausgang zur Kontrolle Ihrer Kamerasteuerung benutzen, bewirkt das Drcken
dieser Schaltflchen nicht nur, dass eine andere Kamera gesteuert wird, sondern auch, dass die
Videoausgabe dieser Kamera zu einem Aux-Ausgang gesendet wird. Den gewnschten Aux-
Ausgang fr die Kamerasteuerung knnen Sie in den allgemeinen Mischereinstellungen vorgeben.

Arbeiten mit ATEM Software Control 177


Kanalstatus
Die Kanalstatus-Box am oberen Rand jedes Kamerabedienfelds zeigt die Kamerakennung,
denOn-Air-Status und eine Sperrschaltflche an. Klicken Sie auf die Sperrschaltflche, um alle
Bedienelemente einer spezifischen Kamera zu sperren. Wenn die Kamera auf Sendung ist, leuchtet
der Kanalstatus rot auf und zeigt die On-Air-Warnung an.

Die Kanalstatus-Box in jedem Kamerabedienfeld


zeigt an, welche Kamera sich auf Sendung befindet.
Justieren Sie anhand der Farbrder die Einstellungen
von Lift, Gamma und Gain einzelner YRGB-Kanle

Farbrad
Das Farbrad ist eine leistungsstarke Funktion des DaVinci Resolve Farbkorrektors zur Vornahme
farblicher Anpassungen an den Einstellungen fr Lift, Gamma und Gain einzelner YRGB-Kanle.
Die Auswahl der anzupassenden Einstellung erfolgt per Klick auf eine der drei Auswahlschaltflchen
ber dem Farbrad.

Masterrad
Passen Sie mithilfe des nachstehenden Farbrads die Kontraste aller YRGB-Kanle auf einmal an
oder justieren Sie nur jeweils die Leuchtdichte der Einstellungen fr Lift, Gamma und Gain.

Kamera-Einstellungen
ber den Button fr Kamera-Einstellungen unten links neben dem Masterrad knnen Sie die
Farbbalkenfunktion auf Blackmagic Studio Cameras, Micro Studio Cameras und URSA Minis
aktivieren. Zustzlich lassen sich Detaileinstellungen fr das Bildsignal einer jeden Kamera justieren.

Farbbalken anzeigen/verbergen
Blackmagic Studio Cameras verfgen ber eine integrierte Farbbalken-Funktion, die sich per
Aktivierung der entsprechenden Modi zeigen bzw. verbergen lsst. Beim Aufbau fr Ihre
Liveproduktion ist das eine sehr praktische Feature zur visuellen Identifizierung einzelner Kameras.
Mit den Farbbalken wird auch Testton ausgegeben. So knnen Sie die Audiopegel der einzelnen
Kameras bequem prfen.

Detail
Diese Einstellung dient zur Scharfzeichnung Ihres Live-Kamerabilds. Senken bzw. erhhen Sie das
Schrfungsniveau, indem Sie eine dieser Optionen vorgeben: Schrfe aus, Standardschrfe fr
geringfgige Scharfzeichnung, Mittlere Schrfe oder Hohe Schrfe.

Arbeiten mit ATEM Software Control 178


Der Button fr Kamera-Einstellungen lsst
Sie Farbbalken ein- oder ausschalten und die
kamerainterne Scharfzeichnung von Bildern
der angeschlossenen Blackmagic Studio
Cameras vornehmen

Reset-Symbole
Anhand des Reset-Symbols, das sich rechts unten in allen Kamerabedienfeldern befindet, knnen
Sie bequem auswhlen, welche Farbkorrektureinstellungen zurckgesetzt, kopiert oder eingefgt
werden sollen. Jedes Farbrad verfgt ber ein zugehriges Reset-Symbol. Klicken Sie es an, um
eine Einstellung auf ihren Standardwert zurckzusetzen oder um sie zu kopieren bzw. einzufgen.
Gesperrte Bedienelemente bleiben von der Einfgefunktion unberhrt.
Das Master-Resetsymbol unten rechts im Farbkorrektorfenster lsst Sie die Farbrder fr Lift, Gamma
und Gain sowie die Einstellungen fr Kontrast, Farbton, Sttigung und Lum Mix (Luminanzmischung)
zurcksetzen. Sie knnen Farbkorrektureinstellungen in einzelne Kamerabedienfenster kopieren
oder dies fr einen durchgngigen Look fr alle Kameras auf einmal tun. Die Einstellungen fr Blende,
Grob und Schwarzwert bleiben von der Einfgefunktion unberhrt. Bei Anwendung von In alle
einfgen werden Sie durch einen Warnhinweis gebeten, den Vorgang zu besttigen. Dies soll das
versehentliche Einfgen neuer Einstellungen fr auf Sendung befindliche Kameras verhindern.

Bei Anwendung von In alle einfgen werden Sie durch einen Warnhinweis
gebeten, den Vorgang zu besttigen. Dies soll das versehentliche Einfgen
neuer Einstellungen fr auf Sendung befindliche Kameras verhindern

Blenden-/Schwarzabhebungssteuerung
Blende und Schwarzabhebung werden ber den kreisfrmigen Button im Fadenkreuz der einzelnen
Kamerabedienfelder gesteuert. Dieser Button leuchtet rot auf, wenn die Kamera auf Sendung ist.

Arbeiten mit ATEM Software Control 179


Eine rot leuchtende Blenden-/Schwarzabhebungssteuerung
zeigt an, dass die jeweilige Kamera auf Sendung ist

Ziehen Sie den Button zum ffnen oder Schlieen der Blende nach oben oder unten. Bei gedrckt
gehaltener Shift-Taste ist nur der Blendenwert anpassbar.
Ziehen Sie den Button nach links oder rechts, um die Schwarzabhebung zu vertiefen oder
anzuheben. Bei gedrckt gehaltener Command-Taste (Mac) bzw. gedrckt gehaltener
Steuerungstaste (Windows) lsst sich die Schwarzabhebung separat justieren.

Zoom-Steuerung
Bei Einsatz kompatibler Objektive mit elektronischer Zoomfunktion knnen Sie Ihr Objektiv mithilfe
der Zoom-Steuerung ein- und auszoomen. Das Steuerelement funktioniert so hnlich wie eine
Zoomwippe an einem Objektiv, mit Teleobjektiveinstellungen am einen und
Weitwinkelobjektiveinstellungen am anderen Ende. Klicken Sie auf die Zoom-Steuerung ber dem
GROB-Schieberegler und ziehen Sie sie zum Einzoomen nach oben bzw. zum Auszoomen
nach unten.
Bei Objektiven, die keine elektronische Blendensteuerung haben oder keine Zoom-Steuerung ber
das SDI-Kamerasteuerungsprotokoll untersttzen, bleiben diese Einstellungen wirkungslos.
Versichern Sie sich bei Einsatz einer Blackmagic Studio Camera oder Blackmagic Studio Camera 4K,
dass die Kamera mit einem Kamerasoftware-Update in der Version v1.9.11 oder hher um Support zur
Steuerung von MFT-Objektiven mit elektronischem Zoom erweitert wurde.

GROB-Einstellung
Mit dem links vom Blenden/Schwarzabhebungs-Button angeordneten GROB-Schieberegler lassen
sich die zulssigen Blendenwerte begrenzen. Diese Funktion hilft zu verhindern, dass berbelichtete
Bilder auf Sendung gehen.
So stellen Sie den GROB-Grenzwert ein: ffnen Sie die Blende mithilfe der Blendensteuerung so
weit es geht. Ziehen Sie dann den GROB-Regler nach oben oder unten, um den optimalen
Blendenwert einzustellen. Jetzt verhindert der GROB-Grenzwert beim Einstellen der Blende, dass
Ihr optimaler Blendenwert berschritten wird.

Arbeiten mit ATEM Software Control 180


Blenden-Indikator
Der Blenden-Indikator rechts neben der Blenden-/Schwarzabhebungssteuerung stellt den Status
der Blendenffnung visuell dar. Der Blenden-Indikator wird durch die GROB-Einstellung beeinflusst.

Autofokus-Button
Jedes Kamerabedienfenster weist unten links einen Autofokus-Button auf. Klicken Sie auf diesen
Button, um bei Einsatz eines Objektivs mit elektronischer Blendensteuerung automatisch zu
fokussieren. Wichtig: Die meisten Objektive untersttzten elektronische Fokussierung. Stellen Sie
jedoch bei Objektiven, die automatisch und manuell fokussierbar sind, den Autofokusmodus ein.
Beimanchen Objektiven erfolgt dies durch Vorwrts- oder Rckwrtsschieben des Fokusrings.

Klicken Sie zur Scharfstellung eines kompatiblen Objektivs auf den


Autofokus-Button oder ziehen Sie den Fokussier-Regler nach links oder rechts

Manuelle Fokuseinstellung
Mithilfe des unten in jedem Kamerabedienfensters befindlichen Fokusrings knnen Sie Ihre Kamera
manuell scharfstellen. Ziehen Sie den Fokusring nach links oder rechts, um die Schrfe manuell
einzustellen. Prfen Sie dabei anhand des Videofeeds von der Kamera, ob Ihr Bild scharf ist.

Kameraeinstellung Gain
ber die Kameraeinstellung Gain knnen Sie die von der Kamera wiedergegebenen hellen
Tonwerte verstrken. Wichtig ist dies beim Filmen bei schlechten Lichtverhltnissen, wenn eine
Verstrkung der Lichter auf dem Niveau des Sensors erwnscht ist, um eine Unterbelichtung Ihrer
Aufnahmen zu vermeiden. Sie knnen Gain abschwchen oder verstrken, indem Sie den Pfeil links
oder rechts von der Anzeige des dB-Wertes anklicken.
Bei Bedarf knnen Sie den Gain-Wert verstrken. Beispielsweise bei Auendrehs wenn Sie Ihr Bild
im schwcher werden Licht eines Sonnenuntergangs aufhellen mchten. Zu beachten ist hierbei
jedoch, dass mehr Gain auch strkeres Bildrauschen bewirkt.

Verschlusszeit-Steuerung
Die Verschlusszeit-Steuerung ist zwischen dem Farbrad und der Blenden-/
Schwarzabhebungssteuerung angeordnet. Reduzieren oder erhhen Sie die Verschlusszeit, indem
Sie Ihre Maus ber die Verschlusszeit-Anzeige schieben und den Links- oder Rechtspfeil anklicken.
Eventuelles Lichtflimmern lsst sich durch Senken der Verschlusszeit beseitigen. Durch eine
niedrigere Verschlusszeit lassen sich Ihre Bilder ohne Einsatz der Kameraeinstellung Gain
aufhellen, da der Bildsensor so lnger dem Licht ausgesetzt wird. Eine hhere Verschlusszeit
reduziert auch Bewegungsunschrfe und bietet sich daher fr gestochen scharfe Action-Shots mit
minimaler Bewegungsunschrfe an.

Weiabgleich
Die Weiabgleicheinstellung neben der Verschlusszeit-Steuerung lsst sich durch Anklicken der
beiderseits der Farbtemperaturanzeige befindlichen Links- und Rechtspfeile anpassen.
Verschiedene Lichtquellen geben unterschiedlich warme oder kalte Farben aus, was Sie durch
Anpassen des Weiabgleichs kompensieren knnen. So wird dafr gesorgt, dass die Weitne in
Ihrem Bild wei bleiben.

Arbeiten mit ATEM Software Control 181


Schieben Sie Ihren Mauszeiger ber die Anzeigen fr Gain (Lichter), Verschlusszeit und
Weiabgleich. ber die nun angezeigten Pfeile lassen sich die jeweiligen Einstellungen justieren

DaVinci Resolve Primary Color Corrector (DaVinci Resolve


Tool fr die primre Farbkorrektur)
Wer mit Farbkorrektur vertraut ist, kann statt der fr Mischer gebruchlichen CCU-
Benutzeroberflche der Kamerasteuerung fr eine Benutzeroberflche optieren, die dem Tool fr
die primre Farbkorrektur eines Postproduktions-Gradingsystems gleicht.
Ihre Blackmagic Studio Camera ist mit einem integrierten DaVinci Resolve Tool fr die primre
Farbkorrektur ausgestattet. Wenn Sie bereits mit DaVinci Resolve gearbeitet haben, knnen Sie Ihre
dabei gesammelten Erfahrungen bei Liveproduktionen fr kreatives Colorgrading mit der
Blackmagic Studio Camera einsetzen, da dies genauso funktioniert.
Das Farbkorrekturfenster lsst sich von jedem Kamerabedienfenster ausklappen und bietet eine
erweiterte Farbkorrektursteuerung mit zustzlichen Einstellungen und einer Bedienoberflche mit
allen Tools fr die primre Farbkorrektur.
Zur Verfgung stehen Ihnen hier Farbrder und Einstellungen wie Sttigung. Zustzlich sind
Einstellungen fr Schatten, Mitteltne und Lichter alle gleichzeitig sichtbar. Wechseln Sie einfach
mithilfe der Schaltflchen fr die Kameraauswahl oben im Fenster zwischen Kameras hin und her.

Klicken Sie das DaVinci Resolve Primary Color Corrector Symbol an,
um das Farbkorrekturfenster zu erweitern und Einstellungen anzupassen

Farbrder
Die Schaltflchen Lift, Gamma und Gain gestatten die Anpassung entlang des gesamten
Tonwertspektrums, selbst in sich berlappenden Bereichen. Im fotografischen Sinne versteht man
unter Lift, Gamma und Gain die Schatten, Mitten und Lichter.

Arbeiten mit ATEM Software Control 182


Die Farbrder fr Lichter, Mitten und Schatten im Farbkorrekturfenster

So verwenden Sie die Farbrder, um feine oder rigorose Anpassungen vorzunehmen:



Fhren Sie irgendwo im Farbrad einen Klick und eine Ziehbewegung aus:
Hinweis:DieFarbbalance-Anzeige selbst braucht nicht bewegt zu werden. Die unter der
Farbbalance-Anzeige gelegenen RGB-Parameter verschieben sich analog zur Farbbalance-
Justierung und reflektieren so an einzelnen Kanlen vorgenommene Anpassungen.
Fhren Sie mittels Shift-Klick eine Ziehbewegung im Farbrad aus: Versetzt die
Farbbalance-Anzeige auf die absolute Position des Mauszeigers und gestattet schnellere,
extremere Anpassungen.
Fhren Sie einen Doppelklick im Farbrad aus: Setzt die Farbanpassung zurck, ohne die
Anpassung des Masterrads fr dieses Steuerelement zu beeinflussen.
Klicken Sie auf die Reset-Steuerung oben rechts in einem Farbrad: Dies setzt die
Farbbalance zusammen mit dem ihr zugehrigen Masterrad zurck.

Masterrder
Benutzen Sie die Masterrder unter den Farbrdern, um die Lift-, Gamma- und Gain-
Steuerungen fr jeden YRGB-Kanal individuell anzupassen.

Passen Sie die Masterrder an, indem Sie das Rad


nach links oder rechts ziehen

So nehmen Sie Anpassungen mithilfe des Masterrads vor:


Drehen Sie das Masterrad nach links oder rechts: Durch Drehen nach links wird der
ausgewhlte Parameter des Bildes verdunkelt, durch Drehen nach rechts wird er erhellt.
Wenn Sie eine Anpassung vornehmen, ndern sich dabei die darunter liegenden YRGB-
Parameter und reflektieren Ihre soeben vorgenommene Anpassung. Fhren Sie bei
gedrckt gehaltener ALT-Taste eine Drehbewegung nach links oder rechts aus, um nur den
Y-Wert anzupassen. Da der Farbkorrektor sich der YRGB-Verarbeitung bedient, knnen
Sie Ihre Kreativitt ausleben und einzigartige Effekte allein durch Anpassung des Y-Kanals
erzielen. Anpassungen am Y-Kanal lassen sich am besten vornehmen, wenn die Lum
Mix-Einstellung fr eine YRGB-Verarbeitung nach rechts gesetzt ist. Ist diese nach links
gesetzt, erfolgt eine regulre RGB-Verarbeitung. Normalerweise arbeiten die meisten
DaVinci Resolve Coloristen mit dem YRGB-Farbkorrektor, da dieser mehr Mglichkeiten zur
Steuerung der Farbbalance bietet, ohne dabei die hellen Bereiche (Gain) insgesamt zu
beeinflussen. So kriegen Sie Ihren gewnschten Look schneller hin.

Arbeiten mit ATEM Software Control 183


Ziehen Sie die Schieberegler nach rechts oder links, um die Einstellungen
fr Kontrast, Sttigung, Farbton und Luminanzmischung anzupassen.

Kontrast-Einstellung
Die Kontrasteinstellung lsst Sie die Spanne zwischen den dunkelsten und hellsten Tonwerten in
einem Bild steuern. Die erzielte Wirkung hnelt dem Einsatz der Lift- und Gain-Masterrder,
umentgegengesetzte Anpassungen vorzunehmen. Die Standardeinstellung betrgt 50%.

Sttigungs-Einstellung
Mit der Sttigungseinstellung lsst sich der im Bild vorhandene Farbanteil erhhen oder senken.
DieStandardeinstellung betrgt 50%.

Tonwert-Einstellung
Mit der Farbtoneinstellung lassen sich alle in einem Bild auftretenden Farbtne um den gesamten
Umfang des Farbrads drehen. Die Standardeinstellung von 180 Grad zeigt die ursprngliche
Farbtonverteilung an. Die Steigerung bzw. Senkung dieses Wertes bewirkt, dass alle Farbtne
gem der auf dem Farbrad sichtbaren Farbtonverteilung gedreht werden.

Lum Mix-Einstellung
Ihre Blackmagic Studio Camera ist mit einem integrierten DaVinci Resolve Tool fr die primre
Farbkorrektur ausgestattet. DaVinci baut seit Anfang der 1980er Jahre Farbkorrektursysteme und es
werden mehr Hollywood-Spielfilme mit DaVinci Resolve gegradet als mit jeder anderen Applikation.
Das bedeutet fr Sie, dass der in Ihre Blackmagic Studio Camera integrierte Farbkorrektor eine
Reihe einzigartiger Features mitbringt, die Ihren kreativen Spielraum erweitern. Eines dieser
Leistungsmerkmale ist die YRGB-Verarbeitung.
Fr das Colorgrading knnen Sie wahlweise die RGB-Verarbeitung oder die YRGB-Verarbeitung
nutzen. High-End-Coloristen favorisieren YRGB-Verarbeitung, da diese mehr Kontrolle ber die
Farbe gewhrt, die Anpassung separater Kanle ermglicht und mehr kreative Mglichkeiten bietet.
Ein ganz nach rechts gezogener Lum Mix-Schieberegler bedeutet eine 100-prozentige Ausgabe
des YRGB-Farbkorrektors. Ist Lum Mix ganz nach links gezogen, bedeutet das eine 100-prozentige
Ausgabe des RGB-Farbkorrektors. Der Lum Mix-Regler kann beliebig weit nach rechts oder links
gezogen werden, um eine im entsprechenden Verhltnis gemischte Augabe der RGB- und YRGB-
Korrektoren zu bewirken.
Welche Einstellung ist die richtige? Das ist bei diesem rein kreativen Vorgang allein Ihre
Entscheidung. Es gibt kein richtig und falsch, denn es zhlt nur, was Ihnen am besten gefllt!

Synchronisation von Einstellungen


Ist die Kamera an einen ATEM Mischer gekoppelt, so bermittelt dieser Mischer die Signale zur
Steuerung der Kamera an Ihre Blackmagic Studio Camera. Wenn kameraseitig versehentlich eine
Einstellung Ihrer Studio Camera gendert wird, lst dies ein automatisches Zurcksetzen dieser
Einstellung aus, damit die Synchronisation gewahrt bleibt.

Arbeiten mit ATEM Software Control 184


Developer Information (Englisch)
Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol
Version 1.1
If you are a software developer you can use the SDI Camera Control Protocol to construct devices
that integrate with our products. Here at Blackmagic Design our approach is to open up our
protocols and we eagerly look forward to seeing what you come up with!

Overview
The Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol is used by ATEM switchers, Blackmagic 3G-SDI
Arduino Shield and Blackmagic Camera Remote to provide Camera Control functionality with
supported Blackmagic Design cameras. Please refer to the Understanding Studio Camera Control
chapter section of this manual, or the ATEM Switchers Manual and SDKmanual for more information.
These can be downloaded at www.blackmagicdesign.com/support.
This document describes an extensible protocol for sending a uni directional stream of small control
messages embedded in the non-active picture region of a digital video stream. Thevideo stream
containing the protocol stream may be broadcast to a number of devices. Device addressing is used
to allow the sender to specify which device each message is directed to.

Assumptions
Alignment and padding constraints are explicitly described in the protocol document. Bit fields are
packed from LSB first. Message groups, individual messages and command headers are defined as,
and can be assumed to be, 32 bit aligned.

Blanking Encoding
A message group is encoded into a SMPTE 291M packet with DID/SDID x51/x53 in the active region
of VANC line 16.

Message Grouping
Up to 32 messages may be concatenated and transmitted in one blanking packet up to a maximum
of 255 bytes payload. Under most circumstances, this should allow all messages to be sent with a
maximum of one frame latency.
If the transmitting device queues more bytes of message packets than can be sent in a single frame,
it should use heuristics to determine which packets to prioritize and send immediately. Lower priority
messages can be delayed to later frames, or dropped entirely as appropriate.

Abstract Message Packet Format


Every message packet consists of a three byte header followed by an optional variable length data
block. The maximum packet size is 64 bytes.

Device addresses are represented as an 8 bit unsigned integer. Individual


Destination device (uint8) devices are numbered 0 through 254 with the value 255 reserved to
indicate a broadcast message to all devices.

The command length is an 8 bit unsigned integer which specifies the


Command length (uint8) length of the included command data. The length does NOT include the
length of the header or any trailing padding bytes.

Developer Information (Englisch) 185


The command id is an 8 bit unsigned integer which indicates themessage
type being sent. Receiving devices should ignore any commands that they
Command id (uint8) do not understand. Commands 0 through 127 are reserved for commands
that apply to multiple types of devices. Commands 128 through 255 are
device specific.

This byte is reserved for alignment and expansion purposes. Itshould be


Reserved (uint8)
set to zero.

The command data may contain between 0 and 60 bytes of data.


Command data(uint8[])
The format of the data section is defined by the command itself.

Messages must be padded up to a 32 bit boundary with 0x0bytes.


Padding(uint8[])
Any padding bytes are NOT included in the command length.

Receiving devices should use the destination device address and or the command identifier to
determine which messages to process. The receiver should use the command length to skip
irrelevant or unknown commands and should be careful to skip the implicit padding as well.

Defined Commands
Command 0 : change configuration

The category number specifies one of up to 256 configuration categories


Category (uint8)
available on the device.

The parameter number specifies one of 256 potential configuration


parameters available on the device. Parameters 0 through 127 are device
Parameter (uint8)
specific parameters. Parameters 128 though 255 are reserved for
parameters that apply to multiple types of devices.

The data type specifies the type of the remaining data. Thepacket length is
Data type (uint8) used to determine the number of elements in the message. Each message
must contain an integral number of data elements.

Currently defined values are:

A void value is represented as a boolean array of length zero.


0: void / boolean The data field is a 8 bit value with 0 meaning false and all other values
meaning true.

1: signed byte Data elements are signed bytes

2: signed 16bit integer Data elements are signed 16 bit values

3: signed 32bit integer Data elements are signed 32 bit values

4: signed 64bit integer Data elements are signed 64 bit values

5: UTF-8 string Data elements represent a UTF-8 string with no terminating character.

Data types 6 through 127 are reserved.

Data elements are signed 16 bit integers representing a real number with
5 bits for the integer component and 11 bits for the fractional component.
128: signed 5.11fixed point The fixed point representation is equal to the real value multiplied by 2^11.
The representable range is from -16.0 to 15.9995
(15 + 2047/2048).

Developer Information (Englisch) 186


Data types 129 through 255 are available for device specific purposes.

The operation type specifies what action to perform on the specified


Operation type (uint8)
parameter. Currently defined values are:

The supplied values are assigned to the specified parameter. Each


element will be clamped according to its valid range. A void parameter
0: assign value may only be assigned an empty list of boolean type. This operation will
trigger the action associated with that parameter. A boolean value may be
assigned the value zero for false, and any other value for true.

Each value specifies signed offsets of the same type to be added to the
current parameter values. The resulting parameter value will be clamped
1: offset / toggle value according to their valid range. It is not valid to apply an offset to a void
value. Applying any offset other than zero to a boolean value will invert
that value.

Operation types 2 through 127 are reserved.

Operation types 128through 255 are available for device specific purposes.

The data field is 0 or more bytes as determined by the data type and
Data (void)
number of elements.

The category, parameter, data type and operation type partition a 24 bit operation space.

Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

.0 Focus fixed16 0 1 0.0=near, 1.0=far

trigger
.1 Instantaneous autofocus void
instantaneous autofocus

Aperture Value (where


.2 Aperture (f-stop) fixed16 -1 16
fnumber = sqrt(2^AV))

.3 Aperture (normalised) fixed16 0 1 0.0=smallest, 1.0=largest

Steps through available


aperture values from
.4 Aperture (ordinal) int16 0 n
minimum (0) to
maximum (n)

Instantaneous trigger instantaneous


.5 void
Lens auto aperture auto aperture

Optical image true=enabled,


.6 boolean
stabilisation false=disabled

Move to specified focal


length in mm, from
.7 Set absolute zoom (mm) int16 0 max
minimum (0) to
maximum (max)

Set absolute zoom Move to specified focal


.8 fixed16 0 1
(normalised) length: 0.0=wide, 1.0=tele

Start/stop zooming at
Set continuous specified rate: -1.0=zoom
.9 fixed16 -1 +1.0
zoom (speed) wider fast, 0.0=stop,
+1=zoom tele fast

Developer Information (Englisch) 187


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation
1
[0] = frame rate 24, 25, 30, 50, 60
[1] = M-rate 0=regular, 1=M-rate
0=NTSC, 1=PAL, 2=720,
[2] = dimensions 3=1080, 4=2k, 5=2k DCI,
.0 Video mode int8 6=4k, 7=4k DCI
0=progressive,
[3] = interlaced
1=interlaced
[4] =
0=YUV
colour space
.1 Sensor Gain int8 1 16 1x, 2x, 4x, 8x, 16x gain
int16 color temp 2500 10000 Colour temperature in K
.2 Manual White Balance
int16 tint -50 50 tint
Calculate and set auto
.3 Set auto WB void
white balance
Use latest auto white
.4 Restore auto WB void
balance setting
.5 Exposure (us) int32 1 42000 time in us
Steps through
availableexposure
.6 Exposure (ordinal) int16 0 n
valuesfrom minimum (0)
tomaximum (n)
int8
.7 Dynamic Range Mode 0 1 0 = film, 1 = video
enum
Video int8
.8 Video sharpening level 0 3
enum
fps as integer
[0] = file
(eg 24, 25, 30,
frame rate
50, 60, 120)
fps as integer, valid when
sensor-off-speed set
[1] = sensor (eg 24,25, 30, 33, 48, 50,

frame rate 60, 120), no change will
beperformed if this value
is set to 0
[2] = frame width in pixels
.9 Recording format int16
[3] =
in pixels
frame height
[0]=file-M-rate
[1]=sensor-M-rate,
valid when sensor-
[4] = flags off-speed-set
[2]=sensor-off-speed
[3]=interlaced
[4]=windowed mode
0=Manual Trigger,
1=Iris,
.10 Set auto exposure mode int8 0 4 2=Shutter,
3=Iris + Shutter,
4=Shutter + Iris

Developer Information (Englisch) 188


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation
2
0.0=minimum,
.0 Mic level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0.0=minimum,
.1 Headphone level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0.0=minimum,
.2 Headphone program mix fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0.0=minimum,
.3 Speaker level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Audio 0=internal mic,
1=line level input,
.4 Input type int8 0 2
2=low mic level input,
3=high mic level input
0.0=minimum,
[0] ch0 0 1
1.0=maximum
.5 Input levels fixed16
0.0=minimum,
[1] ch1 0 1
1.0=maximum
true = powered,
.6 Phantom power boolean
false = not powered
3
bit flags: [0] = display
status, [1] = display
frame guides
uint16
.0 Overlay enables Some cameras don't
bit field
allow separate control of
frame guides and
status overlays.
0=off, 1=2.4:1, 2=2.39:1,
Frame guides style [0] = frame
.1 int8 0 8 3=2.35:1, 4=1.85:1, 5=16:9,
(Camera 3.x) guides style
Output 6=14:9, 7=4:3
Frame guides opacity [1] = frame 0.0=transparent,
.2 fixed16 0.1 1
(Camera 3.x) guide opacity 1.0=opaque
0=off, 1=2.4:1, 2=2.39:1,
[0] = frame
3=2.35:1, 4=1.85:1, 5=16:9,
guides style
Overlays 6=14:9, 7=4:3
(replaces .1 and .2 [1] = frame 0=transparent,
.3 int8 0 100
abovefrom guide opacity 100=opaque
Cameras 4.0) percentage of full frame
[2] = safe area
0 100 used by safe area guide
percentage
(0 means off)
4
0.0=minimum,
.0 Brightness fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0x4 = zebra
Display int16
.1 Overlay enables 0x8 = peaking
bit field

0.0=minimum,
.2 Zebra level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

Developer Information (Englisch) 189


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation
0.0=minimum,
.3 Peaking level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0=disable bars,
Color bars display
.4 int8 0 30 1-30=enable bars with
time (seconds)
timeout (s)

Display [0] = focus 0=Peak,



assist method 1=Colored lines
0=Red,
.5 Focus Assist int8 1=Green,
[1] = focus
2=Blue,
line color
3=White,
4=Black
5
Sets the tally front and
tally rear brightness to
.0 Tally brightness fixed16 0 1 the same level.
0.0=minimum,
1.0=maximum
Sets the tally front
Tally brightness.
.1 Front tally brightness fixed16 0 1
0.0=minimum,
1.0=maximum
Sets the tally rear
brightness.
0.0=minimum,
.2 Rear tally brightness fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Tally rear brightness
cannot be turned off
6
0=internal,
int8
Reference .0 Source 0 2 1=program,
enum
2=external
.1 Offset int32 +/- offset in pixels
7
[0] time _ _ BCD - HHMMSSFF (UCT)
.0 Real Time Clock int32
[1] date _ _ BCD - YYYYMMDD
ISO-639-1 two character
.1 System language string _ _ _
language code
.2 Timezone int32 _ _ _ Minutes offset from UTC
BCD -
s0DDdddddddddddd
Confi- where s is the sign:
guration [0] latitude _ _ 0=north (+), 1=south (-);
DD degrees,
dddddddddddd
.3 Location int64 decimal degrees
BCD -
sDDDdddddddddddd
where s is the sign:
[1] longitude _ _
0=west (-), 1=east (+); DDD
degrees, dddddddddddd
decimal degrees

Developer Information (Englisch) 190


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation
8
[0] red -2 2 default 0.0
[1] green -2 2 default 0.0
.0 Lift Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -2 2 default 0.0
[3] luma -2 2 default 0.0
[0] red -4 4 default 0.0
[1] green -4 4 default 0.0
.1 Gamma Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -4 4 default 0.0
[3] luma -4 4 default 0.0
[0] red 0 16 default 1.0
[1] green 0 16 default 1.0
.2 Gain Adjust fixed16
Colour [2] blue 0 16 default 1.0
Correction
[3] luma 0 16 default 1.0
[0] red -8 8 default 0.0
[1] green -8 8 default 0.0
.3 Offset Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -8 8 default 0.0
[3] luma -8 8 default 0.0
[0] pivot 0 1 default 0.5
.4 Contrast Adjust fixed16
[1] adj 0 2 default 1.0

.5 Luma mix fixed16 0 1 default 1.0

[0] hue -1 1 default 0.0


.6 Colour Adjust fixed16
[1] sat 0 2 default 1.0
.7 Correction Reset Default void reset to defaults
10
0 = RAW, 1 = DNxHD,
[0] = basic codec
2 = ProRes
RAW: 0=Uncompressed,
int8
.0 Codec 1=lossy 3:1, 2=lossy 4:1
enum [1] =
codec variant ProRes: 0=HQ, 1=422,
2=LT, 3=Proxy,
4=444, 5=444XQ
0=Preview,
[0] = mode
1=Play, 2=Record
Media
-ve = multiple speeds
backwards, 0 = pause,
[1] = speed
+ve = multiple
speeds forwards
.1 Transport mode int8 1<<0=loop, 1<<1=play all,
1<<5=disk1 active,
[2] = flags 1<<6=disk2 active,
1<<7=time-
lapse recording
[3] = active
0=CFast card, 1=SD
storage medium

Developer Information (Englisch) 191


Example Protocol Packets

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15

header command data

destination

parameter
command

operation
reserved

category
length

type
trigger instantaneous
8 4 4 0 0 0 1 0 0
auto focus on camera 4

turn on OIS on all cameras 12 255 5 0 0 0 6 0 0 1 0 0 0

set exposure to 10 ms on
camera 4 (10 ms = 10000 12 4 8 0 0 1 5 3 0 0x10 0x27 0x00 0x00
us = 0x00002710)

add 15% to zebra level


12 4 6 0 0 4 2 128 1 0x33 0x01 0 0
(15 % = 0.15 f = 0x0133 fp)

select 1080p 23.98 mode on


16 255 9 0 0 1 0 1 0 24 1 3 0 0 0 0 0
all cameras

subtract 0.3 from gamma


adjust for green & blue 16 4 12 0 0 8 1 128 1 0 0 0x9a 0xfd 0x9a 0xfd 0 0
(-0.3 ~= 0xfd9a fp)

all operations combined 76 4 4 0 0 0 1 0 0 255 5 0 0 0 6 0 0

1 0 0 0 4 8 0 0 1 5 3 0 0x10 0x27 0x00 0x00

4 6 0 0 4 2 128 1 0x33 0x01 0 0 255 9 0 0

1 0 1 0 24 1 3 0 0 0 0 0 4 12 0 0

8 1 128 1 0 0 0x9a 0xfd 0x9a 0xfd 0 0

Developer Information (Englisch) 192


Blackmagic Embedded TallyControl Protocol
Version 1.0 (30/04/14)
This section is for third party developers or anybody who may wish to add support for the
Blackmagic Embedded Tally Control Protocol to their products or system. It describes the protocol
for sending tally information embedded in the non-active picture region of a digital video stream.

Data Flow
A master device such as a broadcast switcher embeds tally information into its program feed which
is broadcast to a number of slave devices such as cameras or camera controllers. The output from
the slave devices is typically fed back to the master device, but may also be sent to a video monitor.
The primary flow of tally information is from the master device to the slaves. Each slave device may
use its device id to extract and display the relevant tally information.
Slave devices pass through the tally packet on their output and update the monitor tally status, so
that monitor devices connected to that individual output may display tally status without knowledge
of the device id they are monitoring.

Assumptions
Any data alignment / padding is explicit in the protocol. Bit fields are packed from LSB first.

Blanking Encoding
One tally control packet may be sent per video frame. Packets are encoded as a SMPTE 291M
packet with DID/SDID x51/x52 in the active region of VANC line 15. A tally control packet may contain
up to 256 bytes of tally information.

Packet Format
Each tally status consists of 4 bits of information:
uint4
bit 0: program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0x0)
The first byte of the tally packet contains the monitor device tally status and a version number.
Subsequent bytes of the tally packet contain tally status for pairs of slave devices. The master device
sends tally status for the number of devices configured/supported, up to a maximum of 510.

struct tally
uint8
bit 0: monitor device program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: monitor device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4-7: protocol version (0b0000)

Developer Information (Englisch) 193


uint8[0]
bit 0: slave device 1 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: slave device 1 device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4: slave device 2 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 5: slave device 2 preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 6-7: reserved (0b00)
uint8[1]
bit 0: slave device 3 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: slave device 3 device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4: slave device 4 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 5: slave device 4 preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 6-7: reserved (0b00)
...

Slave Device
(1)

Master Device Slave Device


(2)

Slave Device
Monitor Device
(3)

Byte 7 MSB 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LSB

Version Version Version Version Reserved Reserved Monitor Monitor


0
(0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

Reserved Reserved Slave 1 Slave 1 Reserved Reserved Slave 0 Slave 0


1
(0b0) (0b0) Preview Program (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

Reserved Reserved Slave 3 Slave 3 Reserved Reserved Slave 2 Slave 2


2
(0b0) (0b0) Preview Program (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

3 ...

Developer Information (Englisch) 194


Hilfe
So erhalten Sie Hilfe
Am schnellsten erhalten Sie Hilfe ber die Online-Support-Seiten auf der Blackmagic Design-
Website. Sehen Sie dort nach der aktuellsten Support-Dokumentation fr Ihre Kamera.

Blackmagic Design Online Support Seiten


Die aktuellsten Versionen der Bedienungsanleitung, Produktsoftware und der Support-Hinweise
finden Sie im Blackmagic Support-Center unter https://www.blackmagicdesign.com/de/support.

Kontaktaufnahme mit Blackmagic Design Support


Wenn unser Support-Material Ihnen nicht die gewnschte Hilfe gibt, gehen Sie bitte auf unsere
Support-Seite, klicken Sie dort auf Senden Sie uns eine E-Mail und schicken Sie uns Ihre Support-
Anfrage. Oder klicken Sie auf Finden Sie Ihr lokales Support-Team und rufen Sie Ihre
nchstgelegene Blackmagic Design Support Stelle an.

berprfen der aktuell installierten Softwareversion


Um zu berprfen, welche Version der Blackmagic Camera Setup Software auf Ihrem Computer
installiert ist, ffnen Sie das Fenster About Blackmagic Camera Setup.
ffnen Sie unter Mac OS X die Blackmagic Camera Setup Software ber den Ordner
Applications (Programme). Whlen Sie im Men About Blackmagic Camera Setup,
um die Versionsnummer anzuzeigen.
ffnen Sie unter Windows die Blackmagic Camera Setup Software ber das Startmen
oder den Standardbildschirm. Klicken Sie auf das Men Hilfe und whlen Sie About
Blackmagic Camera Setup aus, um die Versionsnummer anzuzeigen.
So erhalten Sie die aktuellsten Software-Updates
Nachdem Sie berprft haben, welche Version der Blackmagic Camera Setup Software auf Ihrem
Computer installiert ist, besuchen Sie zum Auffinden der neuesten Aktualisierungen bitte das
Blackmagic Support-Center unter www.blackmagicdesign.com/de/support. In der Regel empfiehlt es
sich, die neuesten Updates zu laden. Vermeiden Sie Software-Updates jedoch whrend Sie an
einem wichtigen Projekt arbeiten.

Austauschen des Akkus


Der integrierte Akku kann nicht vom Benutzer gewartet werden. Wenn der Akku ausgetauscht
werden muss, mssen Sie die Kamera zu diesem Zweck an ein Blackmagic Design Service-Center in
Ihrer Nhe schicken. Wenn die Garantiezeit der Kamera abgelaufen ist, wird fr den Austausch des
Akkus, Arbeitszeit und Rucksendung der Kamera eine geringfgige Servicegebhr erhoben. Bitte
wenden Sie sich an den Blackmagic Design Support, um herauszufinden, an welche Adresse die
Kamera zu versenden ist, wie Sie sie sicher verpacken und wie viel der Akkuaustausch in Ihrem
Land kostet.

HINWEIS Die Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 sowie die Blackmagic Studio Camera
4K 2 haben keine integrierten Akkus.

Hilfe 195
Garantie
12 Monate eingeschrnkte Garantie
Fr dieses Produkt gewhrt die Firma Blackmagic Design eine Garantie auf Material- und
Verarbeitungsfehler von 12 Monaten ab Kaufdatum. Sollte sich ein Produkt innerhalb dieser
Garantiezeit als fehlerhaft erweisen, wird die Firma Blackmagic Design nach ihrem Ermessen das
defekte Produkt entweder ohne Kostenerhebung fur Teile und Arbeitszeit reparieren oder Ihnen das
defekte Produkt ersetzen.
Zur Inanspruchnahme der Garantieleistungen mussen Sie als Kunde Blackmagic Design uber den
Defekt innerhalb der Garantiezeit in Kenntnis setzen und die entsprechenden Vorkehrungen fr die
Leistungserbringung treffen. Es obliegt dem Kunden, fur die Verpackung und den bezahlten Versand
des defekten Produkts an ein spezielles von Blackmagic Design benanntes Service-Center zu
sorgen und hierfr aufzukommen. Smtliche Versandkosten, Versicherungen, Zlle, Steuern und
sonstige Abgaben im Zusammenhang mit der Rucksendung von Waren an uns, ungeachtet des
Grundes, sind vom Kunden zu tragen.
Diese Garantie gilt nicht fr Mngel, Fehler oder Schden, die durch unsachgeme Handhabung
oder unsachgeme oder unzureichende Wartung und Pflege verursacht wurden. Blackmagic
Design ist im Rahmen dieser Garantie nicht verpflichtet, die folgenden Serviceleistungen zu
erbringen: a) Behebung von Schden infolge von Versuchen Dritter, die Installation, Reparatur oder
Wartung des Produkts vorzunehmen, b) Behebung von Schden aufgrund von unsachgemer
Handhabung oder Anschluss an nicht kompatible Gerte, c) Behebung von Schden oder
Strungen, die durch die Verwendung von nicht Blackmagic-Design-Ersatzteilen oder
-Verbrauchsmaterialien entstanden sind, d) Service fur ein Produkt, das verndert oder in andere
Produkte integriert wurde, sofern eine solche nderung oder Integration zu einer Erhhung des
Zeitaufwands oder zu Schwierigkeiten bei der Wartung des Produkts fuhrt. BER DIE IN DIESER
GARANTIEERKLRUNG AUSDRCKLICH AUFGEFHRTEN ANSPRCHE HINAUS BERNIMMT
BLACKMAGIC DESIGN KEINE WEITEREN GARANTIEN, WEDER AUSDRCKLICH NOCH
STILLSCHWEIGEND. DIE FIRMA BLACKMAGIC DESIGN UND IHRE HNDLER LEHNEN JEGLICHE
STILLSCHWEIGENDEN GARANTIEN IN BEZUG AUF AUSSAGEN ZUR MARKTGNGIGKEIT UND
GEBRAUCHSTAUGLICHKEIT FR EINEN BESTIMMTEN ZWECK AB. DIE VERANTWORTUNG VON
BLACKMAGIC DESIGN, FEHLERHAFTE PRODUKTE ZU REPARIEREN ODER ZU ERSETZEN, IST DIE
EINZIGE UND AUSSCHLIESSLICHE ABHILFE, DIE GEGENBER DEM KUNDEN FR ALLE
INDIREKTEN, SPEZIELLEN, NEBEN- ODER FOLGESCHDEN ZUR VERFGUNG GESTELLT WIRD,
UNABHNGIG DAVON, OB BLACKMAGIC DESIGN ODER DER HNDLER VON DER MGLICHKEIT
SOLCHER SCHDEN ZUVOR IN KENNTNIS GESETZT WURDE. BLACKMAGIC DESIGN IST NICHT
HAFTBAR FR JEGLICHE WIDERRECHTLICHE VERWENDUNG DER GERTE DURCH DEN
KUNDEN. BLACKMAGIC HAFTET NICHT FR SCHDEN, DIE SICH AUS DER VERWENDUNG DES
PRODUKTS ERGEBEN. NUTZUNG DES PRODUKTS AUF EIGENE GEFAHR.
Copyright 2017 Blackmagic Design. Alle Rechte vorbehalten. Blackmagic Design, DeckLink, HDLink, Workgroup
Videohub, Multibridge Pro, Multibridge Extreme, Intensity und Leading the creative video revolution sind eingetragene
Warenzeichen in den USA und in anderen Lndern. Alle anderen Unternehmens- und Produktnamen sind mglicherweise
Warenzeichen der jeweiligen Firmen, mit denen sie verbunden sind.

Garantie 196
Manual de instalacin y funcionamiento

Blackmagic
Studio Camera
Junio 2017

Espaol
Bienvenido
Gracias por haber adquirido este producto.

Estamos muy contentos de haber diseado los modelos Blackmagic Studio Camera y Micro
Studio Camera 4K. Desde adolescente, siempre tuve pasin por las producciones en directo.
Son tan emocionantes!

Las cmaras con intercomunicadores y luces piloto siempre han sido sumamente costosas
y difciles de manejar, debido a sus dimensiones considerables. Quisimos solucionar este
problema desarrollando un producto ms compacto que tuviera los mismos controles y
prestaciones de las versiones de gran tamao.

Por eso diseamos el modelo Blackmagic Studio Camera. Queramos una cmara ms
pequea que brindara una mayor portabilidad, pero generalmente las versiones de menores
dimensiones tienen pantallas diminutas. Esto no era lo que tenamos en mente. Nuestra idea
era ofrecer un visor mucho ms grande. Entonces desarrollamos esta cmara profesional
pequea con una pantalla enorme que es fantstica. Gracias a ella, resulta sumamente fcil
enfocar la imagen y ajustarla con precisin.

Asimismo, este modelo cuenta con luces piloto, conexiones para micrfonos y auriculares,
batera integrada y, por supuesto, una montura Micro Cuatro Tercios. Es todo lo que necesitas
en una solucin completa. Puedes conectar micrfonos de mayor tamao con proteccin para
el viento y alimentacin fantasma, o utilizar la cmara a kilmetros de distancia de tu mezclador
instalando un mdulo ptico SFP opcional. Incluso es posible valerse de la cmara para realizar
todo tipo de producciones en general conectndola a un dispositivo HyperDeck Shuttle.

Por su parte, el modelo Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K permite aprovechar an ms


el diseo compacto y las funciones de la versin original. Esta cmara ofrece un sensor
UHD extraordinario en un armazn de reducidas dimensiones, y cuenta con un sinfn de
opciones para controlarla en forma remota. A su vez, permite capturar imgenes con calidad
profesional en lugares donde antes era imposible, y brinda al usuario la posibilidad de
manejarla desde un mezclador ATEM.

Esperamos que aproveches tu nueva cmara al mximo al llevar a cabo producciones en


directo y que te permita realizar proyectos increbles. Estamos muy entusiasmados por ver
plasmada toda tu creatividad.

Grant Petty
Director ejecutivo de Blackmagic Design
ndice
Blackmagic Studio Camera

Primeros pasos 197 Ajustes para el set de grabacin 216


Colocacin del objetivo 197 Control remoto 217
Encendido de la cmara 197 Modificacin de ajustes 218
Conexin a mezcladores 198 Salida de video 219
Caractersticas de la cmara 201 Conexin a mezcladores 219
Blackmagic Studio Camera 201 Conexin a dispositivos de grabacin 220
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K 203 Conexin de una tarjeta
Conexiones de la cmara 205 Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield 220
Blackmagic Studio Camera Programa Blackmagic Camera Setup 222
lateral izquierdo 205
Colocacin de accesorios 223
Blackmagic Studio Camera
lateral derecho 206 Parasol223
Blackmagic Micro Studio Otros accesorios 223
Camera 4K lateral izquierdo 207 Programa ATEM Software Control 223
Blackmagic Micro Studio
Introduccin223
Camera 4K lateral derecho 208
Control de cmaras 225
Personalizacin 209
Herramientas de DaVinci
Cable de expansin 209 Resolve para correcciones primarias 230
Diagrama de conexiones en el
Developer Information 233
cable de expansin del modelo
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K 210 Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol 233
Ajustes 211 Blackmagic Embedded
TallyControl Protocol 241
Ajustes de la cmara 211
Ajustes de audio 213 Ayuda 243

Ajustes de monitorizacin 214 Garanta 244

ndice
Primeros pasos
Colocacin del objetivo
Para comenzar a utilizar la cmara, basta con colocar un objetivo y encenderla. A efectos de quitar
la tapa protectora de la montura, mantenga presionado el botn de bloqueo y grela hacia la
izquierda para aflojarla. Recomendamos siempre apagar la cmara antes de colocar o retirar
un objetivo.
Para colocar un objetivo:
1 El punto en el objetivo debe estar alineado con el de la montura de la cmara. Muchos
objetivos tienen un punto azul, rojo o blanco, o algn otro indicador.
2 Gire el objetivo hacia la derecha hasta que calce en su lugar.
3 Para quitar el objetivo, mantenga presionado el botn de bloqueo, gire el objetivo hacia la
izquierda hasta aflojarlo y retrelo con cuidado.
Cuando no hay ningn objetivo colocado en la cmara, el sensor queda expuesto al polvo y la
suciedad, por lo cual se recomienda mantenerlo cubierto con la tapa protectora de ser posible.

1 1
1

1
PUSH

PUSH
3

3
2

2 2
1

1
PUSH

PUSH
3

3
2

Colocacin y retiro del objetivo en el modelo Studio Camera

Colocacin y retiro del objetivo en el modelo Micro Studio Camera 4K

Encendido de la cmara
1 Presione el botn de encendido situado debajo de la pantalla. En los modelos Studio Camera
y Studio Camera 4K, la imagen captada por la cmara podr verse en la pantalla.
2 Mantenga presionado el botn de encendido para apagar la cmara.

SUGERENCIA: Los modelos Studio Camera HD y Studio Camera 4K disponen de


bateras internas que se cargan mediante el transformador suministrado. Es posible
cargar las cmaras mientras estn en funcionamiento, y estas alternan entre distintos
modos de alimentacin sin interrupciones. Las versiones Studio Camera 2 y Studio
Camera 4K no disponen de bateras internas. Por consiguiente, no es necesario cargarlas.

Primeros pasos 197


El modelo Micro Studio Camera 4K funciona con bateras LP-E6 y LP-E6N que pueden recargarse
empleando la cmara o un cargador adicional. Asimismo, es posible alimentar la cmara mediante una
fuente externa. Si ocurre una interrupcin en el suministro elctrico, esta cambiar automticamente el
modo de alimentacin. La corriente se proporciona mediante el puerto de expansin.
1 Presione el botn de encendido situado en el lateral derecho para prender la cmara.
La luz blanca indica que est encendida.
2 Mantenga presionado el botn de encendido para apagar la cmara.
Esto es todo lo que se necesita saber para comenzar a utilizar la cmara. Ahora es posible
conectarla a un mezclador o conversor ATEM para llevar a cabo producciones en directo
extraordinarias.

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN

SDI IN

REF

REF

12V

12V

Utilice el adaptador incluido para suministrar


corriente a la cmara y cargar la batera.

Conexin a mezcladores
El modelo Blackmagic Studio Camera puede controlarse desde un mezclador ATEM mediante una
seal SDI, a fin de realizar producciones con mayor profesionalismo.

Conexin SDI
1 Conecte la salida SDI de la cmara a cualquiera de las entradas correspondientes en el
mezclador.
2 Conecte cualquier salida SDI del mezclador a la entrada SDI de la cmara. Ntese que
no es posible transmitir la seal de control a travs de las salidas destinadas al modo
de visualizacin mltiple o a la transmisin de imgenes cuya definicin original ha
sido reducida.

SUGERENCIA: Al instalar un mdulo SFP, es posible conectar la cmara al mezclador


mediante un cable de fibra ptica. Este tipo de conexin permite cubrir distancias de hasta
45 kilmetros.
Conviene subrayar que, en este caso, es necesario contar con un dispositivo ATEM Studio
Converter o ATEM Talkback Converter 4K. Consulte el diagrama de conexiones para
obtener ms informacin al respecto.

Primeros pasos 198


IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 1 IN 3 1 1 3 1 REMOTE REMOTE
1 3 5 1 7 3 9 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH
STEREO IN

CONTROL CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 IN 2 2 HD 2 HD HD HD HD HD
1 2 4 1 6 2 8 4 10 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 REF IN
PREVIEW AUXPROGRAM
1-3 PREVIEW
OUTPUTS PROGRAM OUTPUTS
MULTI-VIEW MULTI-VIEW
ANALOG AUDIO IN

IN IN IN IN IN 1 3 1 REMOTE
All SDI and HDMI video connections are
1 3 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH SD, HD and Ultra HD switchable unless indicated

CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 2 HD HD HD
1 2 4 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2 CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 PREVIEW PROGRAM OUTPUTS MULTI-VIEW ANALOG AUDIO IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT

Conecte la salida SDI de la cmara a cualquiera de las entradas correspondientes en el mezclador.


Para controlar la cmara, conecte cualquier salida SDI del mezclador a la entrada SDI de esta. Ntese que no
es posible transmitir la seal de control a travs de las salidas destinadas al modo de visualizacin mltiple o
a la transmisin seales subconvertidas. Una forma fcil de lograr este cometido es mediante las salidas de
programa del mezclador.

Asignacin de botones y luces piloto


Compruebe la asignacin de los botones en las preferencias del programa ATEM Software Control
para asegurarse de que hayan sido vinculados a la cmara correcta.
Para asignar un botn a una cmara, siga los pasos descritos a continuacin:
1 En la barra de mens situada en la parte superior de la ventana, seleccione ATEM Software
Control y haga clic en la opcin Preferencias.
2 Haga clic en la pestaa Asignacin y compruebe que los botones estn asignados a la
entrada que corresponde. Por ejemplo, dado que la cmara est conectada a la entrada 1
del mezclador, es preciso seleccionar la opcin Entrada 1: Cmara 1 para el Botn 1 .
3 Presione el botn MENU en la cmara. Seleccione la opcin Studio Settings y luego
modifique el campo Camera Number de forma que coincida con la entrada del mezclador.
Por ejemplo, si la cmara est conectada a la entrada Cam 1, el valor tambin deber ser 1.
De este modo, es posible asegurarse de que la seal se enve a la cmara correcta.
Luego de conectar ambos dispositivos y asignar los botones, verifique que la seal principal del
mezclador pueda verse en la pantalla de la cmara y que la luz piloto funcione correctamente.
Paraello, presione el botn PGM en la cmara y asigne una seal de barras de color a la salida
principal del mezclador. Si es posible visualizar la barras en la cmara, la conexin entre los
dispositivos se ha establecido adecuadamente.
A continuacin, asigne la cmara 1 a la salida principal. La luz piloto de la cmara debera
encenderse. En caso contrario, compruebe que el nmero de cmara coincida con el de la entrada
en el mezclador y verifique la asignacin de los botones.

Control de cmaras
El modelo Studio Camera puede manejarse desde un mezclador ATEM mediante el mdulo de
control del programa ATEM Software Control.
Ejecute el programa ATEM Software Control y haga clic en la pestaa Cmara situada en la parte
inferior de la ventana. Ver una serie de controladores con herramientas para ajustar y mejorar la
imagen de cada cmara. La cmara 1 se denomina Cam 1. Si esta ha sido vinculada a la salida
principal del mezclador, notar que en la parte superior del controlador correspondiente a la misma
dice Al aire.
El controlador incluye diversas herramientas que permiten ajustar el color de la imagen, manejar
objetivos compatibles y modificar la configuracin de la cmara, entre otras posibilidades. Consulte
los apartados Control de cmaras y ATEM Software Control para obtener ms informacin
al respecto.

Primeros pasos 199


Conexin a dispositivos de grabacin
El modelo Studio Camera tambin puede conectarse a equipos de grabacin externos, tales como
el dispositivo HyperDeck Studio de Blackmagic. Asimismo, es posible instalar los productos
HyperDeck Shuttle o Video Assist en la cmara y conectarlos al mezclador para realizar grabaciones
aisladas durante una transmisin desde exteriores.
Esto es todo lo que se necesita saber para comenzar. La realizacin de producciones en directo es
apasionante, y el modelo Studio Camera ha sido diseado para garantizar que esta experiencia sea
fcil y divertida. Contine leyendo el manual para obtener ms informacin sobre las diferentes
prestaciones que ofrece la cmara.

Primeros pasos 200


Caractersticas de la cmara
Blackmagic Studio Camera
Panel frontal
1 Luz piloto frontal
Indica a la persona frente a las cmaras cul de ellas est al aire. Consulte el apartado
Monitorizacin para obtener ms informacin al respecto.

2
3

4
1

PUSH
5 2

PUSH

Panel izquierdo
2 LANC
Conexin estreo de 2.5 mm para controlar la apertura del diafragma, la distancia focal y el
enfoque en forma remota.

3 Auriculares
Conector TRS de 0.25 para supervisar el sonido mediante auriculares profesionales.

4 Micrfono
Conector TRS de 0.206 para comunicarse con la sala de control mediante auriculares con
micrfono incluido.
5 Entradas de audio
2 x XLR de 0.25 para seales balanceadas.
Consulte el apartado Blackmagic Studio Camera lateral izquierdo para obtener ms
informacin al respecto.

Caractersticas de la cmara 201


Panel derecho
6 Entrada/Salida para fibra ptica
Permite emplear cables con una longitud mxima de 45 km al instalar un mdulo SFP para
fibra ptica opcional.
7 SALIDA SDI
Salida para conectar mezcladores u otros dispositivos.
8 Entrada SDI
Permite que el operador vea la seal principal (PGM).
9 Referencia
Entrada que permite sincronizar varias cmaras segn una seal Blackburst o Tri-level.
10 Alimentacin
Entrada para fuentes de alimentacin de 12-24 voltios y carga de la batera, si corresponde.
Consulte el apartado Blackmagic Studio Camera lateral derecho para obtener ms
informacin al respecto.

12
11

6 OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

7 SDI OUT

8 SDI IN

9 REF

13 14 15 16 17 18 19 18 20 21 22 10 12V

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU

Panel trasero
11 Pantalla LCD DE 10
Permite supervisar las imgenes transmitidas por la cmara o la seal principal, adems
de ver el men. Consulte el apartado Monitorizacin para obtener ms informacin
al respecto.
12 Luz piloto trasera
Al encenderse, indica al operador que su cmara est al aire.
13 FOCUS
Presione este botn una vez para enfocar automticamente o dos veces para ver el
indicador de enfoque en la pantalla.
14 IRIS
Presione este botn una vez para ajustar la exposicin automticamente.
15 PTT PUSH TO TALK
Mantenga este botn presionado para hablar. Presinelo dos veces rpidamente para
activar el modo manos libres. Presinelo nuevamente para volver al modo normal.
16 PGM PROGRAMA
Presione este botn para ver las imgenes captadas por la cmara en directo o la seal
principal transmitida por el mezclador desde la sala de control.
17 Tabla de conversin (LUT)
Esta prestacin ser implementada prximamente.

Caractersticas de la cmara 202


12V

18 Botones direccionales
Utilice estos botones para acceder a las distintas opciones en la pantalla.
REF

SDI IN

19 SET SDI OUT

Este botn permite confirmar las opciones seleccionadas.


OPTICAL IN

20 DISPLAY
OPTICAL OUT

Presione este botn para mostrar u ocultar informacin en la pantalla.

21 MENU
Presione este botn para acceder al men en pantalla.

22 Encendido
Presione este botn para encender la cmara. Mantngalo presionado para apagarla.
Consulte el apartado correspondiente para obtener ms informacin al respecto.

Panel inferior
23 CONECTOR USB
Puerto USB Mini-B para actualizar el sistema operativo interno de la cmara. Consulte el
apartado Programa utilitario para obtener ms informacin al respecto.

23

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K


Panel frontal
1 Luz piloto
Indica el estado del dispositivo y sirve para alertar a la persona situada frente a la cmara
cuando esta se encuentra grabando. Cada color indica un estado distinto.
Blanco: alimentacin conectada.
Rojo: al aire.
Rojo/Naranja: batera baja mientras la cmara est al aire.
Blanco/Naranja: batera baja.
Es posible ajustar la intensidad de la luz piloto. Consulte el apartado Ajustes de la cmara para
obtener ms informacin al respecto.

1 2 4
5
6
PUSH

7
3
2

8
PUSH

Caractersticas de la cmara 203


Panel izquierdo
2 Salida HDMI
Permite ver las imgenes captadas y los mens en un dispositivo externo, tal como el
monitor Blackmagic Video Assist. Cabe destacar que la cmara siempre transmite una seal
HD 1080, independientemente de la definicin utilizada al filmar. Asimismo, es posible ver
informacin adicional en la pantalla del monitor conectado, tal como las guas de encuadre,
el histograma y la intensidad del volumen. Consulte el apartado Monitorizacin para
obtener ms informacin al respecto.
3 Puerto de expansin
Conector DB-HD15. Se utiliza para fuentes de alimentacin externas, seales de referencia
y distintas opciones de mando a distancia. Consulte el apartado Cable de expansin para
obtener ms informacin al respecto.
4 MENU
Presione este botn para acceder al men de la cmara y ver las distintas opciones en la
pantalla o el monitor HDMI conectado.
5 Arriba
Presione este botn para desplazarse hacia arriba dentro de un men.
6 Abajo
Presione este botn para desplazarse hacia abajo dentro de un men.
7 SET
Presione este botn para confirmar las opciones seleccionadas.
8 Encendido
Presione este botn para encender la cmara. Mantngalo presionado para apagarla.

Panel derecho
9 Entrada de audio analgico
Conexin estreo de 3.5 mm que admite seales a nivel de lnea o micrfono.
10 Salida SDI
Conexin para mezcladores, grabadores externos y otros dispositivos.
11 Entrada SDI
Permite controlar la cmara mediante un mezclador ATEM o una tarjeta Blackmagic 3G-SDI
Arduino Shield.
12 Auriculares / Comunicacin
Conector de 3.5 mm para auriculares compatibles con equipos iPhone y Android.
Presione dos veces el botn de pausa/reproduccin en los auriculares para establecer la
comunicacin. Presinelo nuevamente una vez para interrumpirla.

10
13
11

12

Caractersticas de la cmara 204


Panel trasero
13 Compartimiento para la batera
El modelo Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K incluye una batera LP-E6 que se coloca
en este compartimiento. Esta se carga en forma lenta y continua mientras la cmara est
conectada a una fuente de alimentacin externa a travs del puerto de expansin.

Panel superior
14 Seguro para la batera
Deslice el seguro hacia adelante para quitar la batera.

Panel inferior
15 Conector USB
Puerto USB para actualizar el sistema operativo interno de la cmara. Consulte el apartado
Programa utilitario para obtener ms informacin al respecto.

14

15

Conexiones de la cmara
Blackmagic Studio Camera lateral izquierdo
Conexin LANC
Esta conexin permite controlar objetivos compatibles a distancia para ajustar el enfoque, acercar o
alejar la imagen y modificar la apertura del diafragma. Incluye un conector hembra estreo de 2.5
mm que emplea el protocolo LANC convencional.
Es posible controlar el servomotor en objetivos activos con montura tipo Micro Cuatro Tercios
mediante un controlador LANC. Actualmente, la cmara es compatible con los siguientes objetivos:
Panasonic Lumix G X Vario PZ 14-42 mm f/3.5-5.6 Power con estabilizador ptico
de imagen.
Panasonic Lumix G X Vario PZ 45-175 mm f/4.0-5.6 Zoom con estabilizador ptico
de imagen.
Olympus M.Zuiko Digital ED 12-50 mm f/3.5-6.3 EZ Micro 4/3
Olympus M.Zuiko Digital ED 14-42 mm f/3.5-5.6 EZ Micro 4/3

Salida para auriculares


Esta salida permite supervisar el audio mediante auriculares profesionales con conectores fijos.
Losdistintos modelos abarcan desde auriculares con audfonos individuales, para uso en estudios
de grabacin, hasta aquellos de mayor tamao con supresin de ruido, ms apropiados para cubrir
conciertos o espectculos deportivos. El audio se integra en los canales 15 y 16 de la seal SDI
entrante. Es muy raro que estos canales se utilicen en una produccin, de modo que la mayor parte
del tiempo estn disponibles.

Conexiones de la cmara 205


Entrada para el micrfono de los auriculares
Esta conexin permite comunicarse con la sala de control mediante auriculares profesionales.
El audio se integra a los canales 1 y 2 de la seal SDI.

Entradas de audio
Las conexiones XLR admiten dos canales de audio analgico balanceado profesional. El volumen
de entrada para cada canal se puede ajustar en el men correspondiente. Las entradas permiten
utilizar seales a nivel de lnea o micrfono. El tipo de entrada se selecciona desde el mismo men.
El audio se integra a los canales 1 y 2 de la seal SDI.

1
1
PUSH

3
2

2
1
PUSH

3
2

Blackmagic Studio Camera lateral derecho


Entrada/Salida para fibra ptica
Para este tipo de conexiones, es necesario instalar un mdulo SFP opcional. De este modo,
esposible emplear conectores LC convencionales para seales SDI 3G en el modelo Studio Camera
HD y SDI 6G en la versin Studio Camera 4K. Existe una gran variedad de cables de fibra ptica
disponibles en el mercado, ya que son los mismos que se utilizan en las redes informticas. Las
conexiones de fibra ptica permiten extender la longitud de los cables hasta una distancia de 45
km, lo cual resulta ms que suficiente, incluso para las transmisiones desde exteriores ms
exigentes. Al emplear la entrada SDI en simultneo con la entrada para fibra ptica, la seal del
dispositivo conectado en primer lugar tiene prioridad. Para adquirir un mdulo SFP compatible con
los modelos Studio Camera, pngase en contacto con el distribuidor de productos Blackmagic ms
cercano. Visite la pgina www.blackmagicdesign.com/es/resellers para obtener ms informacin.

Salida SDI
Esta salida permite transmitir seales en formato 4:2:2 de 10 bits a dispositivos SDI profesionales,
tales como mezcladores, matrices de conmutacin y tarjetas de captura. El modelo Studio Camera
HD admite seales SDI 3G, mientras que la versin Studio Camera 4K permite transmitir
contenidos SDI 12G.

Entrada SDI
Esta entrada permite al operador ver la seal transmitida por el mezclador en la pantalla de la
cmara. Basta con presionar el botn PGM para alternar entre las imgenes captadas por la cmara
en directo o la seal principal transmitida por el mezclador desde la sala de control.
Al emplear la entrada SDI en simultneo con la entrada para fibra ptica, la seal del dispositivo
conectado en primer lugar tiene prioridad. Si se utiliza el modelo Studio Camera para grabar
imgenes en un equipo tal como el dispositivo Hyperdeck Shuttle de Blackmagic, la salida de este
ltimo puede conectarse a la entrada SDI de la cmara para reproducir el material grabado.

Conexiones de la cmara 206


Entrada para seales de referencia
Esta entrada permite sincronizar varias cmaras segn una seal Blackburst o Tri-level.
Lasincronizacin de las cmaras con una seal de referencia externa ayuda a prevenir errores de
coordinacin que podran dar como resultado saltos en la imagen al alternar entre
distintas unidades.

Alimentacin
La entrada de 12-24 voltios permite conectar la fuente de alimentacin y cargar la batera interna.
Los modelos Studio Camera HD y Studio Camera 4K tienen una autonoma de 4 y 3 horas
respectivamente con la batera completamente cargada.
Los modelos Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 y Studio Camera 4K no cuentan con bateras internas.

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN

REF

12V

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K lateral izquierdo


Salida HDMI
El puerto HDMI de la cmara permite transmitir seales en formato 4:2:2 de 10 bits (1080p) con dos
canales de audio para supervisar las imgenes. Es posible conectar cualquier monitor HD
compatible (p. ej., el modelo Blackmagic Video Assist) para encuadrar y enfocar los planos o
acceder a las distintas opciones de los mens.
La frecuencia de imagen de esta conexin coincide con el formato de grabacin en la cmara.
Porejemplo, si esta se ha configurado para grabar en 2160p30, la salida HDMI transmitir imgenes
en formato 1080p30.

MENU
EXPANSION

SET

Conexiones de la cmara 207


Puerto de expansin
El diseo compacto de la cmara facilita la captura de imgenes desde sitios de difcil acceso o
cercanos al lugar donde se desarrollan los acontecimientos. Aunque este modelo se puede ocultar
fcilmente, no ocurre lo mismo con un operador. Por lo tanto, es importante poder controlar la
cmara en forma remota, a fin de aprovechar al mximo sus reducidas dimensiones.
Algunos ajustes se pueden modificar mediante un mezclador ATEM conectado a la entrada SDI,
segn se detalla en el apartado Control de la cmara. Sin embargo, la mayora de las opciones de
control estn disponibles mediante el puerto de expansin.
El conector DB-HD15 de la cmara ofrece una amplia gama de conexiones para fuentes de
alimentacin, controles remotos, intersincronizadores y otros dispositivos mediante el cable de
expansin incluido. Sugerimos utilizar cualquiera de los cables disponibles en el mercado para
acceder a ciertas funciones especficas. De manera alternativa, el usuario cuenta con la posibilidad
de crear sus propias conexiones para adaptar la cmara a sus necesidades. Consulte el apartado
Cable de expansin para obtener ms informacin al respecto.

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K lateral derecho


Entrada de audio analgico
El conector estreo de 3.5 mm admite seales de audio a nivel de lnea o micrfono. Se puede
alternar entre ambas opciones desde el men Audio Settings en la cmara. Es importante
seleccionar los ajustes adecuados para evitar que el sonido sea excesivamente alto o bajo.

Salida SDI
Esta salida permite transmitir seales en formato 4:2:2 de 10 bits a dispositivos SDI profesionales,
tales como mezcladores, matrices de conmutacin y tarjetas de captura. La cmara admite una
velocidad de transmisin mxima de 6 Gb/s. Ntese que es necesario un cable adaptador DIN
1.0/2.3 para conectar equipos con conexiones SDI comunes.

Entrada SDI
Esta conexin permite controlar la cmara desde un mezclador ATEM. Consulte el apartado Control
de la cmara para obtener ms informacin al respecto.

SUGERENCIA: El modelo Micro Studio Camera tambin puede controlarse mediante una
tarjeta Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield. Esta permite integrar paquetes de datos en la
seal SDI proveniente del mezclador. De esta forma, al conectar ambos dispositivos a
travs de la tarjeta, es posible acceder a todas las prestaciones que brindan los modelos
de la lnea ATEM.

Conexiones de la cmara 208


Conexin para auriculares
La conexin de 3.5 mm permite establecer la comunicacin con la sala de control mediante
auriculares utilizados con equipos iPhone y Android. Presione dos veces el botn de pausa/
reproduccin en los auriculares para activar el sistema de comunicacin. Presinelo nuevamente
una vez para desactivarlo. El audio se integra a los canales 1 y 2 de la seal SDI.

Personalizacin
Cable de expansin
Existen dos maneras de acceder a las prestaciones que ofrece el puerto de expansin. Una de ellas
es mediante el cable incluido con la cmara. De manera alternativa, el usuario cuenta con la
posibilidad de armar sus propias conexiones.
El cable de expansin incluye los siguientes tipos de conectores.

4 Micro Studio Cam MSC Breakout Cable Micro Studio Cam MSC Breakout Cable

Cable de expansin

1 Alimentacin
La entrada para fuentes de alimentacin de 12 voltios incluye un conector para corriente
continua. Adems de suministrar energa elctrica a la cmara, permite cargar la batera.
Lacmara se enciende automticamente cuando se conecta a una red de suministro
elctrico.
2 Referencia
Esta entrada permite sincronizar varias cmaras segn una seal Blackburst o Tri-level.
Lasincronizacin de las cmaras con una seal de referencia externa ayuda a prevenir
errores de coordinacin que podran dar como resultado saltos en la imagen al alternar
entre distintas unidades.
3 LANC
El conector de 2.5 mm permite enchufar diversos cables para controlar ciertas funciones,
tales como el inicio y la detencin de la grabacin, la apertura del diafragma y el enfoque
manual, desde el brazo de un trpode, al utilizar objetivos compatibles.
4 PTZ
El conector RS-422 permite trasmitir al cabezal motorizado los comandos recibidos por la
cmara mediante la entrada SDI.

Personalizacin 209
5 Comunicacin B4
El conector DB-9 permite controlar y suministrar corriente elctrica a los objetivos B4
profesionales que se colocan en la cmara usando el adaptador correspondiente. Para ello,
basta con conectar el objetivo al conector DB-9 en el cable de expansin.
Es posible modificar la apertura del diafragma, el enfoque, la distancia focal y otros ajustes
de la misma manera que con un objetivo Micro Cuatro Tercios con montura activa, es decir,
mediante un mezclador ATEM o a travs de las dems interfaces de control remoto que
ofrece el cable de expansin. Consulte la pgina www.blackmagicdesign.com/support/
faq/59011 para ver una lista de objetivos B4 compatibles.
6 Servo S.Bus Digital
Al conectar la cmara a un receptor S.Bus compatible mediante un cable Futaba J,
esposible acceder a 18 canales de control remoto que pueden asignarse a diferentes
funciones. Estas incluyen el enfoque, la distancia focal y la apertura del diafragma,
entreotras. Consulte el apartado correspondiente en este manual para obtener ms
informacin al respecto.

Diagrama de conexiones en el cable de expansin del


modelo Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
Segn las necesidades de cada usuario, es posible que solo se requiera acceder a una o dos de las
funciones que ofrece el puerto de expansin, por ejemplo, controlar un objetivo B4 profesional
instalado en la cmara y simultneamente recibir corriente elctrica de una fuente de 12 voltios.
Paratal fin, se puede fabricar con suma facilidad un conector que permita emplear dichas
prestaciones solamente, sin tener conexiones sueltas adicionales.
Utilice el diagrama que se muestra a continuacin para configurar el cable proporcionado, o como
gua para asignar conexiones al disear una versin propia. La seccin P1 incluye una lista completa
de todos los pines, mientras que los distintos grupos destinados a funciones particulares se indican
en las secciones P2 a P7.

P1 PIN ASSIGNMENT
2 S. Bus 1
2 P2
GROUND 3

GROUND 1
12 PTZ RS422 Rx- 2
8 PTZ RS422 Tx+ 3 5
9
GROUND 4 4

GROUND
5
6
3
2
8
7 P3
6
13 PTZ RS422 Rx+ 7 1

3 PTZ RS422 Tx- 8


GROUND 9

5 15
GROUND 1
10 14 B4 Lens Control Transmit 2 5
9
4 14 4
15 B4 Lens Control Receive 3
P4
9 8
3 13 3
8 GROUND 4 2
7
2
7
12 6 Power +12V in* 5 1
6
1 11 OTHER
6

5 Reference Input CENTER


GROUND SLEEVE P5
1 Ground 6 Power +12V in 11 Ground LANC Data
9 TIP
2
3
S. Bus
PTZ RS422 Tx-
7
8
Ground
PTZ RS422 Tx+
12
13
PTZ RS422 Rx-
PTZ RS422 Rx+
10
GROUND
LANC Power RING
SLEEVE
P6
4 Ground 9 LANC Data 14 B4 Lens Control Transmit
5 Reference Input 10 LANC Power 15 B4 Lens Control Receive
6 Power +12V in PIN
GROUND SLEEVE P7

* Power input to the camera is also used to power the lens. Beware of applying excessive voltages if youre using
your own power supply to avoid damage to the lens.

Personalizacin 210
Ajustes
La cmara permite ajustar el formato de la seal, la velocidad de obturacin y el balance de blancos,
entre otros parmetros, a fin de obtener imgenes de gran calidad. Asimismo, es posible modificar
la intensidad del audio, las opciones de monitorizacin y la forma en que se establece la
comunicacin con la sala de control.
Este apartado del manual brinda informacin detallada sobre cada uno de los ajustes que ofrece
la cmara.

Ajustes de la cmara
Presione el botn MENU para modificar los ajustes generales en los modelos Blackmagic Studio
Camera o Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K. Utilice los botones direccionales para resaltar las
opciones disponibles y presione el botn SET para confirmar los parmetros seleccionados.
En el modelo Micro Studio Camera 4K, es necesario conectar un monitor externo mediante el puerto
HDMI de la cmara para poder ver los mens.

Formato
La opcin Video Format permite seleccionar el formato deseado mediante los botones de
navegacin. Por ejemplo, para escoger 1080p o 1080i, presione la flecha hacia la derecha o la
izquierda y luego el botn SET, a fin de confirmar la opcin seleccionada.
Ms adelante se proporciona una lista de formatos compatibles.

Ganancia
La opcin Gain resulta de utilidad al rodar en condiciones de poca luz. El valor predeterminado es 0
dB, y este puede aumentarse en incrementos de 6 dB hasta un mximo de 18 dB.

Detalles
La opcin Detail permite ajustar al instante la nitidez de las imgenes captadas por el modelo Studio
Camera. Las opciones disponibles son Off, Low, Medium y High.

Exposicin automtica
El modelo Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K ofrece varias opciones de exposicin automtica.
Diafragma
La opcin Iris permite mantener la velocidad de obturacin y modificar la apertura para lograr una
exposicin constante.
Obturador
La opcin Shutter permite mantener la apertura y modificar la velocidad de obturacin para lograr
una exposicin constante.

Ajustes de la cmara en el modelo Blackmagic Studio Camera Ajustes 211


Diafragma y obturador
La opcin Iris + Shutter permite mantener una exposicin adecuada ajustando primero la apertura
del diafragma. Cuando no sea posible mantener una exposicin constante a pesar de haber
alcanzado el grado mximo o mnimo de apertura, la cmara intentar ajustar la velocidad de
obturacin para lograr dicho cometido.

Obturador y diafragma
La opcin Shutter + Iris permite mantener una exposicin adecuada ajustando la velocidad de
obturacin. Cuando no sea posible mantener una exposicin constante a pesar de haber alcanzado
la velocidad de obturacin mxima o mnima, la cmara intentar ajustar la apertura para lograr
dicho cometido.

Activacin manual
La opcin Manual Trigger permite modificar la apertura del diafragma y la velocidad de obturacin
en forma manual. El grado de exposicin podra variar segn las condiciones de iluminacin.

Balance de blancos
La opcin White Balance incluye 18 ajustes predeterminados para diferentes temperaturas de color.
2500, 2800, 3000, 3200, 3400, 3600, 4000, 4500 y 4800 K para luz de tungsteno,
incandescente o fluorescente, o condiciones de luz natural escasa, por ejemplo, al
amanecer y al atardecer, durante la maana y la tarde, o al rodar a la luz de las velas.
5000, 5200, 5400 y 5600 K para exteriores en un da claro y soleado.
6000, 6500, 7000, 7500 y 8000 K para distintas condiciones de luz diurna.

Velocidad de obturacin
La opcin Shutter Speed permite complementar el valor de ganancia al controlar la cantidad de luz
captada por el sensor. Existen 15 velocidades disponibles, desde 1/50 hasta 1/2000 segundos.

Ajustes de la cmara en el modelo


Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

Formatos compatibles

Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Micro Studio


Camera Camera 4K Camera 4K

720p50 720p50 1080i50

720p59.94 720p59.94 1080i59.94

720p60 720p60 1080i60

1080i50 1080i50 1080p23.98

Ajustes 212
Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Micro Studio
Camera Camera 4K Camera 4K

1080i59.94 1080i59.94 1080p24

1080i60 1080i60 1080p25

1080p23.98 1080p23.98 1080p29.97

1080p24 1080p24 1080p30

1080p25 1080p25 1080p50

1080p29.97 1080p29.97 1080p59.94

1080p30 1080p30 1080p60

1080p50 1080p50 2160p23.98

1080p59.94 1080p59.94 2160p24

1080p60 1080p60 2160p25

2160p23.98 2160p29.97

2160p24 2160p30

2160p25

2160p29.97

2160p30

2160p50

2160p59.94

2160p60

Ajustes de audio
Para modificar los ajustes de audio en la cmara, presione el botn MENU y seleccione el cono del
micrfono situado a la izquierda de la pantalla. Utilice los botones direccionales para resaltar las
opciones disponibles y presione el botn SET para confirmar.

Ajustes de audio en el modelo


Blackmagic Studio Camera

Ajustes 213
Control de ganancia automtica
Al activar la funcin Automatic Gain Control, la cmara ajustar la intensidad del audio en forma
automtica durante la grabacin. Esta opcin permite aumentar o reducir el nivel de ganancia,
dependiendo del volumen de la fuente.

Entrada de audio
La opcin Audio Input permite seleccionar el audio captado por el micrfono interno de la cmara o
recibido mediante las conexiones XLR.

Intensidad del micrfono


La opcin Microphone Level permite modificar la intensidad del audio captado por el micrfono de
la cmara. Mueva el control hacia la izquierda o la derecha para aumentar o disminuir el volumen.
Lacmara cuenta con un micrfono estreo. El micrfono integrado graba el sonido en los canales
de audio 1 y 2 cuando no se detecta una fuente de audio externa.

Volumen de entrada
Las conexiones de audio externas admiten seales a nivel de lnea o micrfono. Seleccione Mic
Low o Mic High en la opcin Input Levels segn la fuerza de la seal del micrfono. Es importante
seleccionar el volumen apropiado para asegurarse de que el audio externo pueda escucharse o
evitar que suene muy alto y distorsionado. Ajuste los niveles de entrada del audio externo mediante
las flechas.

Entrada canal 1
Mueva el control deslizante en la opcin Ch 1 Input hacia la izquierda o la derecha para disminuir o
aumentar respectivamente la intensidad del canal 1. La seal de audio externa anula el micrfono de
la cmara y se transmite a travs del canal 1.

El Canal 2 usa la entrada del Canal 1


Seleccione On en la opcin Ch2 Uses Ch 1 Input para integrar el audio externo del canal 1 a los
canales 1 y 2 de la seal transmitida mediante la conexin SDI o por fibra ptica. Esto es lo mismo
que conectar la entrada 1 a ambos canales de audio en la cmara y resulta til cuando es necesario
conectar dichos canales a micrfonos con una sola salida de audio. Seleccione Off si desea que el
audio del canal 1 permanezca en un solo canal. En este caso, el canal 2 transmitir el audio
proveniente de la entrada correspondiente, lo cual es preferible al utilizar fuentes en estreo.

Entrada canal 2
Mueva el control deslizante en la opcin Ch 2 Input hacia la izquierda o la derecha para disminuir o
aumentar respectivamente la intensidad del canal 2. La seal de audio externa anula el micrfono
de la cmara y se transmite a travs del canal 2.

Alimentacin fantasma
La alimentacin fantasma funciona a travs de los cables para micrfonos y es particularmente
conveniente en modelos de condensador. Active o desactive la opcin Phantom Power para ambas
entradas XLR seleccionando On u Off mediante las flechas correspondientes. Este tipo de
suministro elctrico se deshabilita automticamente al elegir la opcin Line Input Level. Asegrese
de esperar al menos 10 segundos luego de desconectar el micrfono para que la alimentacin
fantasma sea nula antes de conectar un micrfono independiente. Los micrfonos de cinta no son
compatibles con esta forma de alimentacin.

Ajustes de monitorizacin
Para modificar los ajustes de la pantalla, presione el botn MENU y seleccione el cono del monitor.
Utilice los botones direccionales para resaltar las opciones disponibles y presione el botn SET para
confirmar.

Ajustes 214
Ajustes de monitorizacin en el modelo
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K.

Indicadores HDMI
El modelo Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K brinda la posibilidad de seleccionar los indicadores
que se muestran en las imgenes transmitidas a travs de la salida HDMI.

Histograma
El histograma permite visualizar el contraste entre las luces y las sombras a lo largo de una lnea
horizontal. El extremo izquierdo corresponde a las partes ms oscuras de la imagen, mientras que el
derecho representa las zonas ms claras. Al modificar la apertura del diafragma, es posible ver
cmo los valores se desplazan hacia la izquierda o la derecha, segn corresponda.
Mediante esta opcin, es posible activar o desactivar el histograma. Una vez habilitado, aparece en
la esquina inferior derecha del monitor en uso, cuando la funcin HDMI Overlays est activada.

Audio
El vmetro digital representa el volumen de los canales de audio mediante dos barras horizontales.
La barra superior corresponde al canal izquierdo, y la inferior al derecho. Cuando la intensidad del
volumen es demasiado alta, puede ocurrir una distorsin. Para evitar este inconveniente, ajuste la
ganancia de audio en la cmara hasta que los niveles se siten dentro de los parmetros adecuados.
Mediante esta opcin, es posible activar o desactivar el vmetro digital. Una vez habilitado, aparece
en la esquina inferior izquierda del monitor en uso, cuando la funcin HDMI Overlays est activada.

Informacin superpuesta en seales HDMI


La opcin HDMI Overlays solo est disponible en el modelo Micro Studio Camera 4K. Una vez
habilitada, las imgenes transmitidas a travs de la salida HDMI incluirn guas de encuadre y otros
datos de la cmara y sus ajustes, as como los indicadores seleccionados en la opcin
HDMI Meters.

Brillo
Mueva el control deslizante en la opcin Brightness hacia la izquierda o la derecha para ajustar el
brillo de la pantalla. El valor preestablecido es 60%.

Cebra
Las cmaras de Blackmagic cuentan con una funcin denominada Zebra, que indica los niveles de
exposicin en la imagen por medio de lneas diagonales, segn el nivel configurado.
Active la funcin Zebra y seleccione el porcentaje deseado mediante las flechas direccionales.
Elnivel predeterminado es Medium.

Ajustes 215
Indicador de enfoque
La opcin Focus Peaking permite cambiar el nivel del indicador de enfoque. Los ajustes disponibles
son Off, Low, Medium y High. Modifique este parmetro al utilizar un objetivo de gran nitidez para
disminuir la cantidad de puntos en la imagen. El nivel predeterminado es Medium.

Brillo de la luz piloto frontal


La opcin Front Tally Light Brightness permite ajustar el brillo de la luz piloto frontal. Los ajustes
disponibles son Off, Low, Medium y High. El nivel predeterminado es Medium.

Brillo de la luz piloto trasera


La opcin Rear Tally Light Brightness permite ajustar el brillo de la luz piloto frontal. Los ajustes
disponibles son Off, Low, Medium y High. El nivel predeterminado es Medium.

Brillo de la luz piloto


La opcin Tally Light Brightness permite ajustar el brillo de la luz piloto en el modelo Micro Studio
Camera 4K. Los ajustes disponibles son Off, Low, Medium (predeterminado) y High.
Al seleccionar Off, la luz se encender brevemente al prender la cmara.

Porcentaje de carga de la batera


Algunas bateras LP-E6 son capaces de indicar su duracin restante mediante un sistema de
comunicacin digital en serie. Al activar la opcin Display Battery Percentage en el modelo Micro
Studio Camera 4K, es posible conocer el nivel de carga de la batera expresado como un
porcentaje, en lugar de un grfico de barras. No obstante, si esta forma de representacin resulta
inexacta, es posible habilitar nuevamente las barras que miden directamente el estado de la carga.

Ajustes para el set de grabacin


Para modificar estos ajustes, presione el botn MENU y seleccione el cono de los auriculares.
Utilice los botones direccionales para resaltar las opciones disponibles y presione el botn SET para
confirmar.

Ajustes para el set de grabacin en el modelo Blackmagic Studio Camera

Nmero de cmara
Para que la cmara pueda utilizar el sistema de sealizacin en forma conjunta con el mezclador,
espreciso identificarla con un nmero mediante la opcin Camera Number. Esto brinda la
posibilidad de garantizar que el dispositivo enve la seal a la cmara indicada. Las cmaras pueden
identificarse con cualquier nmero entre 1 y 99. El valor predeterminado es 1.

Ajustes 216
SUGERENCIA: La seal SDI proveniente de cualquier mezclador puede transmitirse a la
cmara mediante la tarjeta Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield, a fin de que la luz piloto se
encienda cuando est al aire. Todos los modelos de mezcladores que disponen de salidas
en colector abierto son compatibles con dicha tarjeta. Consulte el apartado Conexin de
una tarjeta Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield para obtener ms informacin al respecto.

Referencia
La opcin Reference Source permite seleccionar la fuente utilizada para la sincronizacin.
Lacmara puede sincronizarse con la seal principal recibida a travs de la entrada SDI o mediante
una fuente externa. En este ltimo caso, conviene subrayar que podra ocurrir un salto en la imagen
al realizar la sincronizacin con la cmara.

Modo de referencia
La opcin Reference Timing permite ajustar manualmente el modo de referencia segn lneas o pixeles.

Volumen del auricular


Mueva el control hacia la derecha o la izquierda en la opcin Headset Level para aumentar o
disminuir el volumen del audio que se escucha a travs de los auriculares. El valor
predeterminado es 50 %.

Volumen del micrfono de los auriculares


Mueva el control hacia la derecha o la izquierda en la opcin Headset Mic Level para aumentar o
disminuir el volumen del micrfono de los auriculares. El valor predeterminado es 50 %.

Mezcla de audio
La opcin Program Mix permite cambiar el balance entre el sonido de la cmara y del intercomunicador.
La seal de audio se transmitir por los auriculares segn el modo activo indicado en la pantalla.
Porejemplo, al filmar, se escuchar el audio de la cmara. Al reproducir las imgenes transmitidas al
aire, se escuchar el audio correspondiente al programa. El valor predeterminado es 0%.

Control remoto
El modelo Micro Studio Camera 4K ofrece un men adicional denominado Remote que permite
configurar las opciones de control a distancia. Desde all, es posible asignar funciones tales como la
apertura del diafragma y la velocidad de obturacin a canales individuales en la conexin S.Bus.
Basta con seleccionar el parmetro que se desea controlar y asignarle un canal disponible mediante
los botones direccionales y el botn SET.

Ajustes para control remoto en el modelo


Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

Ajustes 217
Modificacin de ajustes
Ajustes del objetivo
El modelo Studio Camera permite controlar el objetivo en forma electrnica, lo cual hace posible
modificar ajustes tales como la apertura del diafragma y el enfoque automtico. El indicador de
enfoque genera un borde verde alrededor de las partes ms ntidas de la imagen para facilitar el
enfoque. Es visible solamente en la pantalla de la cmara y no afecta a las imgenes grabadas.

Botn FOCUS
Al utilizar la cmara con un objetivo de enfoque automtico, presione este botn para activar el
indicador de enfoque o la funcin de enfoque automtico. Presione el botn FOCUS una vez para
activar el enfoque automtico. Oprmalo dos veces rpidamente para activar el indicador de enfoque.
Al emplear un objetivo manual, presione el botn FOCUS una vez para activar el indicador
de enfoque.

Botn IRIS
Al utilizar el rango dinmico en el modo Video, presione este botn una vez para establecer un valor
de exposicin promedio segn las partes ms claras y oscuras de la imagen. Al emplearlo en el
modo Film, oprmalo para ajustar la exposicin segn las zonas ms brillantes de la imagen. Para
ajustar la apertura manualmente, presione los botones con las flechas hacia arriba y abajo.

Ajustes adicionales
Botn PTT
Al llevar a cabo una produccin en directo, es de suma importancia que los camargrafos puedan
comunicarse con el director y con los dems integrantes del equipo en la sala de control. Para ello,
simplemente oprima este botn y mantngalo presionado mientras habla. Presinelo dos veces
rpidamente para activar el modo manos libres. Presinelo nuevamente para volver al modo normal.

Botn PGM
A veces es importante que el camargrafo vea la seal que sale al aire y no solo las imgenes
captadas por su cmara. Presione este botn para ver las imgenes captadas por la cmara en
directo o la seal principal transmitida por el mezclador desde la sala de control. La fuente externa
se puede conectar a la entrada SDI o al mdulo opcional para fibra ptica.

Botn LUT
Por el momento, no se han implementado funciones para este botn.

Flechas
Utilice estos botones para acceder a los distintos mens.

Botn SET
Permite confirmar las opciones seleccionadas.

Botn DISPLAY
Presione este botn para ver datos tiles en la pantalla de la cmara, tales como
las guas de encuadre, el nmero de cmara, el formato y la frecuencia de imagen, la
velocidad de obturacin, el balance de blancos, la duracin restante de la batera, la
ganancia y la relacin focal.
Presione este botn nuevamente para ocultar dicha informacin y ver solo la imagen. La informacin
adicional es visible solamente en la pantalla de la cmara, no as en las imgenes transmitidas
mediante la salida SDI.

NOTA: Puesto que los modelos Studio Camera 2 y Studio Camera 4K no tienen
una batera interna, el porcentaje de carga restante no se muestra en la pantalla.

Ajustes 218
Botn MENU
OPTICAL OUT
Presione este botn para acceder al men y luego utilice las flechas para desplazarse por las
distintas opciones.
OPTICAL IN

Botn de encendido
SDI OUT

SDI IN Presione este botn para encender la cmara. Mantngalo presionado para apagarla.

REF

12V

OPTICAL OUT OPTICAL OUT OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN OPTICAL IN OPTICAL IN

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT FOCUS IRIS SET PTT PGM LUT
DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRISSET PTT PGM DISPLAY
LUT MENU SET DISPLAY MENU
SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT

SDI IN SDI IN SDI IN

REF REF REF

12V 12V 12V

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU

Presione el botn FOCUS una Presione el botn IRIS para El modelo Studio Camera ofrece
vez para activar el enfoque activar la funcin de exposicin prestaciones que son esenciales
automtico. Oprmalo dos veces automtica, o utilice las flechas para cualquier produccin
rpidamente para activar el hacia arriba y abajo para ajustar en directo.
indicador de enfoque. este parmetro en forma manual.

Salida de video
Conexin a mezcladores
Los modelos Studio Camera transmiten imgenes en formato 4:2:2 de 10 bits, de modo que es
posible conectarlos a mezcladores y otros equipos SDI. Por otra parte, al instalar un mdulo SFP
opcional, brindan conectividad para cables de fibra ptica, evitando de este modo la necesidad de
utilizar un dispositivo ATEM Camera Converter.
Conecte la salida principal (PGM) del mezclador a la entrada SDI de la cmara o al mdulo ptico
para ver la seal en la pantalla.
El modelo Studio Camera cuenta adems con una entrada para seales de referencia que permite
sincronizar cmaras, videocaseteras y otros dispositivos con una seal externa, ayudando de este
modo a prevenir errores de coordinacin que podran dar como resultado saltos en la imagen al
cambiar de una fuente a otra.

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

OPTICAL OUT

SDI IN
OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

REF
SDI IN

REF

12V

12V

Conecte el modelo Studio Camera a un mezclador mediante las


conexiones SDI o el mdulo SFP para fibra ptica.

Salida de video 219


Conexin a dispositivos de grabacin
La cmara puede conectarse a dispositivos tales como el modelo Hyperdeck Shuttle de Blackmagic
para grabar las imgenes captadas por esta. Al mismo tiempo, es posible ver el material grabado
por el dispositivo en la pantalla de la cmara.

+12V POWER HDMI IN HDMI OUT SDI IN SDI OUT

+12V POWER HDMI IN HDMI OUT SDI IN SDI OUT

Conecte la salida SDI de la cmara a la entrada correspondiente en el grabador. A continuacin, conecte


la salida SDI del grabador a la entrada correspondiente en la cmara para ver el contenido captado.

Conexin de una tarjeta Blackmagic


3G-SDI Arduino Shield
Es posible conectar las salidas para luces piloto de un mezclador a una tarjeta Blackmagic
3G-SDI Arduino Shield, a fin de enviar seales a distintas unidades Studio Camera. Aunque no
se utilice un mezclador ATEM, se puede igualmente implementar un sistema de sealizacin
mediante seales SDI.
Concretamente, el puerto en paralelo del mezclador se conecta a los pines D2-D9 de la tarjeta.
A su vez, la salida SDI de esta se conecta a todas las cmaras mediante un amplificador de
distribucin, tal como el modelo Blackmagic Mini Converter SDI Distribution. De esta forma,
esposible enviar seales a ocho cmaras distintas para encender o apagar las luces piloto
segn corresponda.
El nmero de cmara debe coincidir con el de la salida en el mezclador. En consecuencia,
puede que sea necesario fabricar un conector adaptado para asegurarse de que los pines
correspondan a cada nmero de cmara. Es necesario que el pin a tierra del conector del
mezclador est conectado al pin a tierra de la tarjeta.
La siguiente tabla indica la correspondencia entre los nmeros de cmara y las conexiones en
el mezclador y la tarjeta.

Nmero de cmara Nmero de entrada


Blackmagic en el mezclador Tarjeta Arduino

1 1 D2

2 2 D3

3 3 D4

4 4 D5

5 5 D6

6 6 D7

7 7 D8

8 8 D9

Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield 220


A continuacin se brinda un ejemplo de cdigo mediante el que la tarjeta se programa para que
encienda la luz piloto en la cmara cuando esta transmite la seal principal proveniente del
mezclador. Todos los mezcladores que disponen de salidas en colector abierto son compatibles
con la tarjeta Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield. Consulte su manual en la pgina
www.blackmagicdesign.com/support para obtener ms informacin al respecto.

Este ejemplo muestra cmo programar la tarjeta Arduino para detectar una seal proveniente del mezclador
y transmitirla mediante la salida SDI, lo cual permite encender la luz piloto en la cmara correspondiente.

Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield 221


1

PUSH
2

PUSHPrograma Blackmagic Camera Setup


Actualizacin del software de la cmara en Mac OS X
Luego de descargar el programa Blackmagic Camera Setup, descomprima el archivo que lo
contiene y haga doble clic en la imagen de disco correspondiente (.dmg). Ejecute el instalador y siga
las instrucciones que aparecen en la pantalla.

Blackmagic Camera Setup


1
PUSH

Actualizacin del software de la cmara en Windows


2
PUSH

Luego de descargar y descomprimir el archivo, se abrir una ventana correspondiente al programa


Blackmagic Camera Setup. Haga doble clic en el instalador de la aplicacin y siga las instrucciones
que aparecen en la pantalla para completar el procedimiento.
Al finalizar la instalacin, haga clic en Inicio y seleccione la opcin Todos los programas.
A continuacin, abra la carpeta Blackmagic Design para ejecutar el programa o acceder al manual
de instrucciones.

Actualizacin del sistema operativo interno de la cmara


Luego de instalar la ltima versin del programa de configuracin de la cmara en el equipo
informtico, conecte ambos dispositivos mediante un cable USB. El puerto USB 2.0 Mini B se
encuentra en la parte inferior de la cmara.
Ejecute el programa Blackmagic Camera Setup y siga las instrucciones que aparecen en la pantalla
para actualizar el sistema operativo interno.

Los puertos USB 2.0 Mini B se encuentran en la parte inferior de las cmaras.

Programa Blackmagic Camera Setup 222


Colocacin de accesorios
Parasol
El modelo Studio Camera incluye un parasol plegable para dar sombra a la pantalla en condiciones
de luz intensa y asegurar una visualizacin ptima en todo momento.
1 Localice las seis tuercas de mariposa incluidas con la cmara.
2 Haga coincidir los agujeros del parasol con las roscas de la cmara. Coloque dos tuercas
en la parte superior y en cada costado de la misma para sujetarlo.

Otros accesorios
A efectos de utilizar la cmara en un estudio de grabacin, quizs sea conveniente colocarla sobre
un pedestal y aadirle rieles para objetivos de mayor tamao o apuntadores electrnicos. En el caso
de transmisiones desde exteriores, podra ser necesario agregar micrfonos, bateras externas o
controladores remotos. La cmara incluye dos orificios roscados de 9.5 mm en la parte inferior y
diez de 6.35 mm en la parte superior y los laterales. De esta manera, ofrece la flexibilidad necesaria
para adaptarla a distintos tipos de producciones y valerse de una amplia gama de accesorios.

1
1
PUSH

3
2

2
1
PUSH

3
2

Programa ATEM Software Control


Introduccin
El modelo Studio Camera puede manejarse desde un mezclador ATEM mediante el mdulo de
control del programa ATEM Software Control. Para acceder al mismo, basta con hacer clic en la
pestaa Cmara de la interfaz. Asimismo, esta prestacin permite modificar con facilidad diferentes
parmetros, tales como la apertura del diafragma, la ganancia y la distancia focal, al emplear
objetivos compatibles, as como ajustar el color de las cmaras y crear imgenes extraordinarias con
las herramientas para correcciones primarias de DaVinci Resolve.
El mdulo de control enva paquetes de instrucciones a la cmara mediante cualquiera de las salidas
SDI del mezclador, excepto aquellas correspondientes a seales subconvertidas. Al conectar una
salida SDI del dispositivo a la entrada de la cmara, esta detecta las instrucciones integradas en la
seal, permitiendo de este modo controlar los diferentes parmetros. La cmara puede manejarse a
travs de la conexin SDI comn o mediante cables de fibra ptica al instalar un mdulo SFP opcional.

Programa ATEM Software Control 223


Control de cmaras

Conexin SDI
1 Conecte la salida SDI 12G de la cmara a cualquier entrada SDI del mezclador.
2 Conecte cualquier salida SDI del mezclador a la entrada SDI de la cmara. Ntese que
no es posible transmitir la seal de control a travs de las salidas destinadas al modo
de visualizacin mltiple o a la transmisin de imgenes cuya definicin original ha
sido reducida.
3 Presione el botn MENU en la cmara. Seleccione la opcin Studio Settings y luego
modifique el campo Camera Number de forma que coincida con la entrada del mezclador.
Por ejemplo, si la cmara est conectada a la entrada Cam 1, el valor tambin deber ser 1.
De este modo, es posible asegurarse de que la seal se enve a la cmara correcta.

IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 1 IN 3 1 1 3 1 REMOTE REMOTE
1 3 5 1 7 3 9 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH
STEREO IN

CONTROL CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 IN 2 2 HD 2 HD HD HD HD HD
1 2 4 1 6 2 8 4 10 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 REF IN
PREVIEW AUXPROGRAM
1-3 PREVIEW
OUTPUTS PROGRAM OUTPUTS
MULTI-VIEW MULTI-VIEW
ANALOG AUDIO IN

IN IN IN IN IN 1 3 1 REMOTE
All SDI and HDMI video connections are
1 3 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH SD, HD and Ultra HD switchable unless indicated

CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 2 HD HD HD
1 2 4 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2 CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 PREVIEW PROGRAM OUTPUTS MULTI-VIEW ANALOG AUDIO IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT

Conecte el modelo Studio Camera a cualquiera de las entradas SDI del mezclador.

Programa ATEM Software Control 224


Conexin mediante fibra ptica
1 Luego de instalar el mdulo SFP en la cmara, conecte un dispositivo ATEM Studio
Converter mediante un cable de fibra ptica.
2 Conecte una salida SDI de dicho dispositivo a cualquier entrada SDI del mezclador.
3 Conecte cualquier salida SDI del mezclador a la entrada SDI del dispositivo. Ntese que
no es posible transmitir la seal de control a travs de las salidas destinadas al modo
de visualizacin mltiple o a la transmisin de imgenes cuya definicin original ha
sido reducida.
4 Presione el botn MENU en la cmara. Seleccione la opcin Studio Settings y luego
modifique el campo Camera Number de forma que coincida con la entrada del mezclador.
Por ejemplo, si la cmara est conectada a la entrada Cam 1, el valor tambin deber ser 1.
De este modo, es posible asegurarse de que la seal se enve a la cmara correcta.
Compruebe la asignacin de los botones en las preferencias del programa ATEM Software Control
para asegurarse de que hayan sido vinculados a la cmara correcta. Luego de establecer la
conexin, el usuario dispondr de un sistema de sealizacin que indica si la cmara est al aire
mediante el uso de la luz piloto. Al mismo tiempo, podr ver la seal principal transmitida por el
mezclador en la pantalla de la misma presionando el botn PGM.

AES/EBU TALKBACK LOOPS

3 1 4 2 OUT
3OUT OUT
4

L R

UT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT IN IN SDI OUT IN

L +12V
R BACKUP L L R R L L R R L R
POWER USB 2.0
OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN
OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG
ANALOG AUDIO OUTAUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO
OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG
OUT AUDIO OUT PGM SDI OPTICAL
MICOUT/IN H/PHONE ANALOG AUDIO OUT OP

AES/EBU TALKBACK LOOPS

1 2 3 4 OUT OUT OUT

L R

SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT IN IN IN

+12V BACKUP L R L R L R L R
POWER USB 2.0 OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT PGM SDI MIC H/PHONE

Conecte varios modelos Studio Camera mediante fibra ptica


utilizando un dispositivo ATEM Studio Converter.

Control de cmaras
Ejecute el programa ATEM Software Control y haga clic en la pestaa Cmara situada en la parte
inferior de la ventana. Ver una serie de controladores con herramientas para ajustar y mejorar la
imagen de cada cmara. Los controladores son fciles de usar. Simplemente haga clic en los
botones o mantenga presionado el botn del ratn y muvalo para ajustar la imagen.

Seleccin de cmaras
La fila de botones situada en la parte superior de la ventana permite seleccionar la cmara que el
usuario desea controlar. En la ventana de ajuste del color, tambin se pueden utilizar estos botones
para seleccionar una cmara. Cuando se emplea una salida auxiliar para la monitorizacin, la seal
de la cmara seleccionada tambin se transmitir a travs de dicha salida. Esta puede seleccionarse
en el panel de ajustes generales del mezclador.

Programa ATEM Software Control 225


Estado de la cmara
En la parte superior de cada controlador se identifica la cmara y se indica si la misma est al aire.
Adems, hay un botn que permite bloquear todos los controles de la cmara. Cuando la cmara
est al aire, la barra superior de la ventana se enciende en rojo e indica Al aire.

En la parte superior de cada controlador


se indica si la cmara est al aire. Utilice los
controles generales debajo de cada crculo
cromtico para ajustar las sombras, los tonos
intermedios y las luces en cada canal.

Crculo cromtico
El crculo cromtico es una herramienta til de DaVinci Resolve que permite ajustar el color en las
luces, tonos intermedios y sombras de cada canal YRGB. Para seleccionar el parmetro que desea
modificar, haga clic en una de las tres pestaas situadas en la parte superior del controlador.

Control general
El control general situado debajo del crculo cromtico permite ajustar el contraste en todos los
canales YRGB al mismo tiempo, o la luminancia de las luces, los tonos intermedios y las sombras en
forma independiente.

Ajustes de la cmara
El botn para modificar los ajustes de la cmara situado en la esquina superior izquierda del
controlador permite activar las barras de color en los modelos Studio Camera, Micro Studio Camera
y URSA Mini, y ofrece la posibilidad de ajustar los detalles de la seal correspondiente a
cada cmara.

Mostrar/ocultar barras de color


Las barras de color en las cmaras de Blackmagic se pueden activar o desactivar mediante las
opciones Mostrar y Ocultar. Esta funcin es de suma utilidad para identificar las unidades de forma
visual durante la preparacin de un programa en directo. Asimismo, dicha seal incluye un tono
auditivo que brinda la posibilidad de comprobar o modificar la intensidad del volumen de
cada cmara.

Detalles
Este ajuste permite dar mayor nitidez a las imgenes en directo captadas por las cmaras.
Lasopciones disponibles son Desactivados, Predeterminado, Medio y Alto.

Programa ATEM Software Control 226


El botn de configuracin permite mostrar u ocultar
la carta de barras de color y ajustar la nitidez de las
imgenes en las cmaras de Blackmagic.

Botn de reajuste
Este botn situado cerca de la parte superior derecha de cada controlador permite seleccionar los
ajustes que se desean restablecer, copiar o aplicar. A su vez, cada crculo cromtico tambin cuenta
con un botn de reajuste. Haga clic sobre el mismo para copiar, aplicar o restablecer los parmetros
a los valores predeterminados. Cabe destacar que los ajustes de los controladores bloqueados no
se modifican al copiar y aplicar otros parmetros.
El botn situado en la esquina inferior derecha del controlador permite restablecer los valores
predeterminados para los crculos cromticos y los ajustes de contraste, saturacin, matiz y
luminancia. Es posible aplicar parmetros de etalonaje a todas las cmaras en general o a cada una
en forma individual para lograr una apariencia uniforme en las imgenes. Los valores
correspondientes a la apertura del diafragma, el enfoque, el control primario y el pedestal no se
alteran al copiar y aplicar otros ajustes. Al modificar parmetros en todas las cmaras
simultneamente, el sistema solicita una confirmacin previa por parte del usuario. De esta forma,
esposible evitar cambios en las cmaras no bloqueadas cuya seal est al aire.

Al modificar parmetros en todas las cmaras simultneamente, el sistema


solicita una confirmacin previa por parte del usuario. De esta forma, es
posible evitar cambios en las cmaras no bloqueadas cuya seal est al aire.

Control del diafragma/pedestal


Este control se encuentra en el retculo central de cada controlador y se enciende en rojo cuando la
cmara est al aire.

Programa ATEM Software Control 227


El control del diafragma/pedestal se enciende en rojo cuando
la cmara est al aire.

Para abrir o cerrar el diafragma, arrastre el crculo hacia arriba o abajo. Al mantener presionada la
tecla de maysculas mientras se mueve el crculo, solo se modifica la apertura del diafragma.
Para oscurecer o incrementar el pedestal, arrastre el crculo hacia la izquierda o derecha.
Almantener presionada la tecla Command en Mac o Control en Windows mientras se mueve el
crculo, solo se modifica el pedestal.

Control del zoom


Este control brinda la posibilidad de acercar o alejar la imagen al utilizar objetivos compatibles con
servomecanismos integrados. Funciona de la misma manera que el interruptor fsico de la cmara,
elcual permite aumentar o disminuir la distancia focal presionando el extremo correspondiente.
Haga clic sobre el control y arrstrelo hacia arriba para acercar la imagen, o hacia abajo
para alejarla.
Estos ajustes no producirn cambio alguno si el objetivo no es compatible con esta funcin, o si la
cmara no permite acercar realizar este procedimiento mediante el protocolo de control SDI.
Alutilizar cualquiera de las versiones del modelo Studio Camera, asegrese de actualizar el sistema
operativo interno a la versin 1.9.11 o posterior, a efectos de contar con la funcin de control para
objetivos Micro Cuatro Tercios.

Control primario
Este control se encuentra a la izquierda del control del diafragma/pedestal y permite limitar la
apertura mxima del diafragma. Es de suma utilidad para evitar que salgan al aire imgenes
sobreexpuestas.
Para limitar la apertura del diafragma, bralo completamente usando el control circular y luego utilice
el control primario para ajustar la exposicin. De esta forma, al modificar la apertura del diafragma,
dicho umbral impedir que se exceda el lmite mximo de exposicin.

Indicador del diafragma


El indicador del diafragma se encuentra a la derecha del control circular y brinda una rpida
referencia visual de la apertura. Esta indicacin depende del ajuste establecido mediante el
control primario.

Programa ATEM Software Control 228


Botn de enfoque automtico
El botn de enfoque automtico se encuentra en la esquina inferior izquierda del controlador.
Presinelo para ajustar el enfoque en forma automtica si cuenta con un objetivo activo compatible
con dicha funcin. Cabe destacar que, aunque la mayora de los objetivos brindan la posibilidad de
ajustar el enfoque electrnicamente, algunos igual disponen de un modo de ajuste manual, por lo
cual es importante asegurarse de elegir el modo automtico. En algunos casos, el modo se
selecciona deslizando el anillo de enfoque en el objetivo hacia adelante o atrs.

Para enfocar mediante un objetivo compatible, haga clic sobre el botn de enfoque
automtico o deslice el control de enfoque hacia la izquierda o la derecha.

Enfoque manual
Para modificar el enfoque de la cmara en forma manual, utilice el dial situado en la parte inferior de
cada controlador. Deslice la rueda hacia la izquierda o derecha para ajustar el enfoque manualmente
al mirar la seal de la cmara, a fin de obtener imgenes claras y ntidas.

Ganancia de la cmara
Este control permite aumentar la ganancia de la cmara. Es de suma importancia al filmar en
condiciones de luz escasa para evitar que las imgenes queden subexpuestas. Para aumentar o
disminuir la ganancia, haga clic sobre las flechas correspondientes.
La ganancia se puede aumentar siempre que sea necesario, por ejemplo al rodar en exteriores
cuando la intensidad de la luz disminuye al atardecer y es preciso aumentar el brillo de la imagen.
Ntese que, al incrementar la ganancia, tambin aumentar el ruido en las imgenes.

Control de la velocidad de obturacin


El indicador de la velocidad de obturacin se encuentra situado entre el crculo cromtico y el
control del diafragma/pedestal. Para aumentar o disminuir este parmetro, coloque el puntero del
ratn sobre el indicador y luego haga clic sobre la flecha izquierda o derecha.
Si la imagen parpadea, disminuya la velocidad de obturacin para resolver el problema. Una buena
forma de obtener ms brillo en las imgenes sin modificar la ganancia es disminuyendo la velocidad
de obturacin, ya que de este modo se incrementa el tiempo de exposicin del sensor. Al aumentar
la velocidad de obturacin, se reduce el rastro dejado por los objetos en movimiento, por lo cual
este parmetro tambin puede emplearse para lograr una mayor nitidez en las tomas de accin.

Balance de blancos
Este parmetro se encuentra junto al control de la velocidad de obturacin y puede modificarse
mediante las flechas situadas a ambos lados del indicador de la temperatura del color. Permite
compensar los colores clidos o fros emitidos por diferentes fuentes de luz. De este modo,
esposible conservar la pureza de los blancos en la imagen.

Programa ATEM Software Control 229


Las flechas para ajustar la ganancia, la velocidad de obturacin
y el balance de blancos aparecen al colocar el puntero del ratn
sobre los indicadores correspondientes.

Herramientas de DaVinci Resolve para correcciones primarias


La ventana del mdulo de control de la cmara puede convertirse en una interfaz similar a la que
contiene las herramientas para correcciones primarias en un programa de edicin.
Estas funciones de etalonaje estn integradas en la cmara. Las herramientas son idnticas a las
utilizadas en DaVinci Resolve, de modo que si el usuario est familiarizado con ellas, podr valerse
de su experiencia en materia de etalonaje durante las producciones en directo.
Se puede expandir el panel de correccin desde el controlador de la cmara para acceder a la
interfaz completa con ajustes adicionales.
Esta dispone de crculos cromticos y otros controles que permiten ver las luces, los tonos
intermedios y las sombras al mismo tiempo. Para cambiar de cmara, utilice los botones en la parte
superior de la ventana.

Si desea acceder a las herramientas para correcciones primarias de DaVinci Resolve, haga clic sobre
el botn situado en la parte inferior, a la derecha del crculo cromtico.

Crculos cromticos
Los controles Lift, Gamma y Gain permiten realizar ajustes interdependientes pero a su vez
especficos para ciertas tonalidades. En trminos fotogrficos, dichos controles corresponden a las
partes ms oscuras de la imagen, los matices intermedios y las zonas ms luminosas, respectivamente.

Programa ATEM Software Control 230


Crculos cromticos para las luces, los tonos intermedios y las sombras en el panel de etalonaje.

Para realizar ajustes drsticos o sutiles, utilice los crculos cromticos de las siguientes maneras:
 aga clic dentro del crculo y arrastre el ratn: Ntese que no es necesario arrastrar
H
el indicador de balance de color. A medida que este se desplaza, los valores debajo del
crculo cambian, reflejando de este modo los ajustes realizados en cada canal.
Mantenga presionada la tecla de maysculas y haga clic en cualquier parte dentro del
crculo: Esto permite situar el indicador del balance de color en la posicin indicada por el
puntero del ratn para realizar ajustes significativos con rapidez.
Haga clic dos veces dentro del crculo: Se restablecen los valores originales sin reajustar
el control general para dicho parmetro.
Haga clic en el botn de reajuste situado en la esquina superior derecha: Se restablecen
todos los ajustes.

Controles generales
Los controles generales situados debajo de cada crculo cromtico permiten ajustar las sombras,
lostonos intermedios y las luces en cada canal YRGB.

Mueva los controles generales hacia la izquierda o la derecha para realizar ajustes.

Para realizar ajustes mediante el control general:


Arrastre el control hacia la izquierda o la derecha: Esto permite oscurecer o aclarar
respectivamente el parmetro de la imagen seleccionado. Al ajustar un valor, el cambio se
ver reflejado en los campos correspondientes a cada canal, situados debajo del crculo
cromtico. Para ajustar solo la luminancia, mantenga presionada la tecla Alt o Command y
arrastre el control a la izquierda o derecha. El color y la luminancia se procesan en forma
individual, de modo que es posible lograr efectos interesantes modificando solo el canal Y.
Este ajuste funciona mejor si el control Mezclador de luminancia se desliza a la derecha.
Sise encuentra sobre el lado izquierdo, el programa procesar los canales de color de
forma normal. Por lo general, la mayora de los coloristas utilizan el mtodo YRGB, ya que
permite obtener un mayor control del balance de color sin afectar la luminancia general,
afin de lograr la apariencia deseada con mayor rapidez.

Programa ATEM Software Control 231


Mueva los controles hacia la izquierda o derecha para ajustar el contraste,
la saturacin, el matiz y la mezcla de luminancia.

Contraste
Este control permite ajustar el rango entre los valores ms claros y oscuros de una imagen. El efecto
es similar al que se obtiene realizando ajustes opuestos mediante los controles generales situados
debajo de las opciones Sombras y Luces. El valor predeterminado es 50 %.

Saturacin
Este control permite aumentar o disminuir la cantidad de color en la imagen. El valor
predeterminado es 50 %.

Matiz
Este control permite modificar los matices de la imagen recorriendo el permetro del crculo
cromtico. El valor predeterminado de 180 grados muestra la distribucin original del matiz.
Alincrementarlo o disminuirlo, todos los matices se modificarn en sentido horario o antihorario en
el crculo cromtico.

Mezcla de luminancia
Las funciones de etalonaje en el modelo Studio Camera estn basadas en las herramientas para
correcciones primarias de DaVinci Resolve. Este programa fue desarrollado a principio de los aos
80 y es el ms utilizado en la produccin de largometrajes en Hollywood.
El corrector cromtico de la cmara incluye funciones sumamente tiles y creativas. Una de ellas es
el mtodo de procesamiento YRGB.
Al corregir el color, se puede emplear el mtodo RGB o YRGB. Aquellos coloristas con ms
experiencia usan el sistema YRGB, ya que ofrece un control ms preciso sobre el color y permite
ajustar los canales en forma independiente, lo cual a su vez brinda ms opciones creativas.
Cuando el control Mezclador de luminancia se desliza totalmente a la derecha, se utiliza el modo
YRGB. Si se desliza totalmente a la izquierda, se emplea el modo RGB. Asimismo, se puede
seleccionar cualquier posicin intermedia para obtener una mezcla de ambos modos de correccin.
Cul es el mejor ajuste? Esto depende del usuario, ya que el proceso de etalonaje es totalmente
creativo y no hay estilos correctos o incorrectos. El ajuste ms apropiado depende de las
preferencias del usuario y de lo que luzca bien segn su criterio.

Sincronizacin de ajustes
El mezclador transmite la seal de control a la cmara cuando ambos dispositivos estn conectados.
Si se modifica un ajuste por error en la cmara, la unidad de control del mezclador restablecer
automticamente los valores para mantener la sincronizacin.

Programa ATEM Software Control 232


Developer Information
Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol
Version 1.1
If you are a software developer you can use the SDI Camera Control Protocol to construct devices
that integrate with our products. Here at Blackmagic Design our approach is to open up our
protocols and we eagerly look forward to seeing what you come up with!

Overview
The Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol is used by ATEM switchers, Blackmagic 3G-SDI
Arduino Shield and Blackmagic Camera Remote to provide Camera Control functionality with
supported Blackmagic Design cameras. Please refer to the Understanding Studio Camera Control
chapter section of this manual, or the ATEM Switchers Manual and SDKmanual for more information.
These can be downloaded at www.blackmagicdesign.com/support.
This document describes an extensible protocol for sending a uni directional stream of small control
messages embedded in the non-active picture region of a digital video stream. Thevideo stream
containing the protocol stream may be broadcast to a number of devices. Device addressing is used
to allow the sender to specify which device each message is directed to.

Assumptions
Alignment and padding constraints are explicitly described in the protocol document. Bit fields are
packed from LSB first. Message groups, individual messages and command headers are defined as,
and can be assumed to be, 32 bit aligned.

Blanking Encoding
A message group is encoded into a SMPTE 291M packet with DID/SDID x51/x53 in the active region
of VANC line 16.

Message Grouping
Up to 32 messages may be concatenated and transmitted in one blanking packet up to a maximum
of 255 bytes payload. Under most circumstances, this should allow all messages to be sent with a
maximum of one frame latency.
If the transmitting device queues more bytes of message packets than can be sent in a single frame,
it should use heuristics to determine which packets to prioritize and send immediately. Lower priority
messages can be delayed to later frames, or dropped entirely as appropriate.

Abstract Message Packet Format


Every message packet consists of a three byte header followed by an optional variable length data
block. The maximum packet size is 64 bytes.

Device addresses are represented as an 8 bit unsigned integer. Individual


Destination device (uint8) devices are numbered 0 through 254 with the value 255 reserved to indicate
a broadcast message to all devices.

The command length is an 8 bit unsigned integer which specifies the length of
Command length (uint8) the included command data. The length does NOT include the length of the
header or any trailing padding bytes.

Developer Information 233


The command id is an 8 bit unsigned integer which indicates themessage
type being sent. Receiving devices should ignore any commands that they do
Command id (uint8) not understand. Commands 0 through 127 are reserved for commands that
apply to multiple types of devices. Commands 128 through 255 are
device specific.

This byte is reserved for alignment and expansion purposes. Itshould be


Reserved (uint8)
set to zero.

The command data may contain between 0 and 60 bytes of data. The format
Command data(uint8[])
of the data section is defined by the command itself.

Messages must be padded up to a 32 bit boundary with 0x0bytes.


Padding(uint8[])
Any padding bytes are NOT included in the command length.

Receiving devices should use the destination device address and or the command identifier to
determine which messages to process. The receiver should use the command length to skip
irrelevant or unknown commands and should be careful to skip the implicit padding as well.

Defined Commands
Command 0 : change configuration

The category number specifies one of up to 256 configuration categories


Category (uint8)
available on the device.

The parameter number specifies one of 256 potential configuration parameters


available on the device. Parameters 0 through 127 are device specific
Parameter (uint8)
parameters. Parameters 128 though 255 are reserved for parameters that apply
to multiple types of devices.

The data type specifies the type of the remaining data. Thepacket length is
Data type (uint8) used to determine the number of elements in the message. Each message must
contain an integral number of data elements.

Currently defined values are:

A void value is represented as a boolean array of length zero.


0: void / boolean The data field is a 8 bit value with 0 meaning false and all other values
meaning true.

1: signed byte Data elements are signed bytes

2: signed 16bit integer Data elements are signed 16 bit values

3: signed 32bit integer Data elements are signed 32 bit values

4: signed 64bit integer Data elements are signed 64 bit values

5: UTF-8 string Data elements represent a UTF-8 string with no terminating character.

Data types 6 through 127 are reserved.

Data elements are signed 16 bit integers representing a real number with 5
bits for the integer component and 11 bits for the fractional component.
128: signed 5.11fixed point
The fixed point representation is equal to the real value multiplied by 2^11.
The representable range is from -16.0 to 15.9995 (15 + 2047/2048).

Developer Information 234


Data types 129 through 255 are available for device specific purposes.

The operation type specifies what action to perform on the specified


Operation type (uint8)
parameter. Currently defined values are:

The supplied values are assigned to the specified parameter. Each element
will be clamped according to its valid range. A void parameter may only be
0: assign value assigned an empty list of boolean type. This operation will trigger the action
associated with that parameter. A boolean value may be assigned the value
zero for false, and any other value for true.

Each value specifies signed offsets of the same type to be added to the
current parameter values. The resulting parameter value will be clamped
1: offset / toggle value
according to their valid range. It is not valid to apply an offset to a void value.
Applying any offset other than zero to a boolean value will invert that value.

Operation types 2 through 127 are reserved.

Operation types 128through 255 are available for device specific purposes.

The data field is 0 or more bytes as determined by the data type and number
Data (void)
of elements.

The category, parameter, data type and operation type partition a 24 bit operation space.

Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

.0 Focus fixed16 0 1 0.0=near, 1.0=far

trigger
.1 Instantaneous autofocus void
instantaneous autofocus

Aperture Value (where


.2 Aperture (f-stop) fixed16 -1 16
fnumber = sqrt(2^AV))

.3 Aperture (normalised) fixed16 0 1 0.0=smallest, 1.0=largest

Steps through available


aperture values from
.4 Aperture (ordinal) int16 0 n
minimum (0) to
maximum (n)

Instantaneous trigger instantaneous


.5 void
Lens auto aperture auto aperture

Optical image true=enabled,


.6 boolean
stabilisation false=disabled

Move to specified focal


length in mm, from
.7 Set absolute zoom (mm) int16 0 max
minimum (0) to
maximum (max)

Set absolute zoom Move to specified focal


.8 fixed16 0 1
(normalised) length: 0.0=wide, 1.0=tele

Start/stop zooming at
Set continuous specified rate: -1.0=zoom
.9 fixed16 -1 +1.0
zoom (speed) wider fast, 0.0=stop,
+1=zoom tele fast

Developer Information 235


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

[0] = frame rate 24, 25, 30, 50, 60

[1] = M-rate 0=regular, 1=M-rate

0=NTSC, 1=PAL, 2=720,


[2] = dimensions 3=1080, 4=2k, 5=2k DCI,
.0 Video mode int8
6=4k, 7=4k DCI

0=progressive,
[3] = interlaced
1=interlaced

[4] = colour space 0=YUV

.1 Sensor Gain int8 1 16 1x, 2x, 4x, 8x, 16x gain

int16 color temp 2500 10000 Colour temperature in K


.2 Manual White Balance
int16 tint -50 50 tint

Calculate and set auto


.3 Set auto WB void
white balance

Use latest auto white


.4 Restore auto WB void
balance setting

.5 Exposure (us) int32 1 42000 time in us

Steps through
availableexposure
.6 Exposure (ordinal) int16 0 n
valuesfrom minimum (0)
tomaximum (n)

.7 Dynamic Range Mode int8 enum 0 1 0 = film, 1 = video


Video
.8 Video sharpening level int8 enum 0 3

[0] = file fps as integer



frame rate (eg 24, 25, 30, 50, 60, 120)

fps as integer, valid when


sensor-off-speed set
[1] = sensor (eg 24,25, 30, 33, 48, 50,

frame rate 60, 120), no change will
beperformed if this value
is set to 0

[2] = frame width in pixels


.9 Recording format int16
[3] = frame height in pixels

[0]=file-M-rate

[1]=sensor-M-rate,
valid when sensor-
off-speed-set
[4] = flags
[2]=sensor-off-speed

[3]=interlaced

[4]=windowed mode

0=Manual Trigger,
1=Iris,
.10 Set auto exposure mode int8 0 4 2=Shutter,
3=Iris + Shutter,
4=Shutter + Iris

Developer Information 236


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

0.0=minimum,
.0 Mic level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

0.0=minimum,
.1 Headphone level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

Headphone 0.0=minimum,
.2 fixed16 0 1
program mix 1.0=maximum

0.0=minimum,
.3 Speaker level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Audio
0=internal mic,
1=line level input,
.4 Input type int8 0 2
2=low mic level input,
3=high mic level input

0.0=minimum,
[0] ch0 0 1
1.0=maximum
.5 Input levels fixed16
0.0=minimum,
[1] ch1 0 1
1.0=maximum

true = powered,
.6 Phantom power boolean
false = not powered

bit flags: [0] = display


status, [1] = display
uint16 frame guides
.0 Overlay enables
bit field Some cameras don't allow
separate control of frame
guides and status overlays.

0=off, 1=2.4:1, 2=2.39:1,


Frame guides style [0] = frame
.1 int8 0 8 3=2.35:1, 4=1.85:1, 5=16:9,
(Camera 3.x) guides style
6=14:9, 7=4:3
Output
Frame guides opacity [1] = frame 0.0=transparent,
.2 fixed16 0.1 1
(Camera 3.x) guide opacity 1.0=opaque

0=off, 1=2.4:1, 2=2.39:1,


[0] = frame
3=2.35:1, 4=1.85:1, 5=16:9,
guides style
6=14:9, 7=4:3
Overlays
(replaces .1 and .2 [1] = frame 0=transparent,
.3 int8 0 100
abovefrom guide opacity 100=opaque
Cameras 4.0)
percentage of full frame
[2] = safe area
0 100 used by safe area guide
percentage
(0 means off)

0.0=minimum,
.0 Brightness fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

0x4 = zebra
Display int16
.1 Overlay enables 0x8 = peaking
bit field

0.0=minimum,
.2 Zebra level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

Developer Information 237


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

0.0=minimum,
.3 Peaking level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

0=disable bars,
Color bars display
.4 int8 0 30 1-30=enable bars with
time (seconds)
timeout (s)

Display [0] = focus 0=Peak,



assist method 1=Colored lines

0=Red,
.5 Focus Assist int8 1=Green,
[1] = focus
2=Blue,
line color
3=White,
4=Black

Sets the tally front and tally


rear brightness to the
.0 Tally brightness fixed16 0 1 same level.
0.0=minimum,
1.0=maximum

Sets the tally front


Tally brightness.
.1 Front tally brightness fixed16 0 1
0.0=minimum,
1.0=maximum

Sets the tally rear


brightness.
0.0=minimum,
.2 Rear tally brightness fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Tally rear brightness
cannot be turned off

0=internal,
Reference .0 Source int8 enum 0 2 1=program,
2=external

.1 Offset int32 +/- offset in pixels

[0] time _ _ BCD - HHMMSSFF (UCT)


.0 Real Time Clock int32
[1] date _ _ BCD - YYYYMMDD

ISO-639-1 two character


.1 System language string _ _ _
language code

.2 Timezone int32 _ _ _ Minutes offset from UTC

BCD -
Confi- s0DDdddddddddddd
guration where s is the sign:
[0] latitude _ _
0=north (+), 1=south (-); DD
degrees, dddddddddddd
decimal degrees
.3 Location int64
BCD -
sDDDdddddddddddd
where s is the sign: 0=west
[1] longitude _ _
(-), 1=east (+); DDD degrees,
dddddddddddd
decimal degrees

Developer Information 238


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

[0] red -2 2 default 0.0

[1] green -2 2 default 0.0


.0 Lift Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -2 2 default 0.0

[3] luma -2 2 default 0.0

[0] red -4 4 default 0.0

[1] green -4 4 default 0.0


.1 Gamma Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -4 4 default 0.0

[3] luma -4 4 default 0.0

[0] red 0 16 default 1.0

[1] green 0 16 default 1.0


.2 Gain Adjust fixed16
Colour [2] blue 0 16 default 1.0
Correction
[3] luma 0 16 default 1.0

[0] red -8 8 default 0.0

[1] green -8 8 default 0.0


.3 Offset Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -8 8 default 0.0

[3] luma -8 8 default 0.0

[0] pivot 0 1 default 0.5


.4 Contrast Adjust fixed16
[1] adj 0 2 default 1.0

.5 Luma mix fixed16 0 1 default 1.0

[0] hue -1 1 default 0.0


.6 Colour Adjust fixed16
[1] sat 0 2 default 1.0

.7 Correction Reset Default void reset to defaults

10

0 = RAW, 1 = DNxHD,
[0] = basic codec
2 = ProRes

RAW: 0=Uncompressed,
int8
.0 Codec 1=lossy 3:1, 2=lossy 4:1
enum
[1] = codec variant ProRes: 0=HQ, 1=422,
2=LT, 3=Proxy,
4=444, 5=444XQ

0=Preview,
Media [0] = mode
1=Play, 2=Record

-ve = multiple speeds


[1] = speed backwards, 0 = pause, +ve
= multiple speeds forwards
.1 Transport mode int8 1<<0=loop, 1<<1=play all,
1<<5=disk1 active,
[2] = flags
1<<6=disk2 active,
1<<7=time-lapse recording

[3] = active
0=CFast card, 1=SD
storage medium

Developer Information 239


Example Protocol Packets

Packet
Operation Length Byte

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15

header command data


destination

parameter
command

operation
reserved

category
length

type
trigger instantaneous
8 4 4 0 0 0 1 0 0
auto focus on camera 4

turn on OIS on all cameras 12 255 5 0 0 0 6 0 0 1 0 0 0

set exposure to 10 ms on
camera 4 (10 ms = 10000 12 4 8 0 0 1 5 3 0 0x10 0x27 0x00 0x00
us = 0x00002710)

add 15% to zebra level


12 4 6 0 0 4 2 128 1 0x33 0x01 0 0
(15 % = 0.15 f = 0x0133 fp)

select 1080p 23.98 mode on


16 255 9 0 0 1 0 1 0 24 1 3 0 0 0 0 0
all cameras

subtract 0.3 from gamma


adjust for green & blue 16 4 12 0 0 8 1 128 1 0 0 0x9a 0xfd 0x9a 0xfd 0 0
(-0.3 ~= 0xfd9a fp)

all operations combined 76 4 4 0 0 0 1 0 0 255 5 0 0 0 6 0 0

1 0 0 0 4 8 0 0 1 5 3 0 0x10 0x27 0x00 0x00

4 6 0 0 4 2 128 1 0x33 0x01 0 0 255 9 0 0

1 0 1 0 24 1 3 0 0 0 0 0 4 12 0 0

8 1 128 1 0 0 0x9a 0xfd 0x9a 0xfd 0 0

Developer Information 240


Blackmagic Embedded TallyControl Protocol
Version 1.0 (30/04/14)
This section is for third party developers or anybody who may wish to add support for the
Blackmagic Embedded Tally Control Protocol to their products or system. It describes the protocol
for sending tally information embedded in the non-active picture region of a digital video stream.

Data Flow
A master device such as a broadcast switcher embeds tally information into its program feed which
is broadcast to a number of slave devices such as cameras or camera controllers. The output from
the slave devices is typically fed back to the master device, but may also be sent to a video monitor.
The primary flow of tally information is from the master device to the slaves. Each slave device may
use its device id to extract and display the relevant tally information.
Slave devices pass through the tally packet on their output and update the monitor tally status, so
that monitor devices connected to that individual output may display tally status without knowledge
of the device id they are monitoring.

Assumptions
Any data alignment / padding is explicit in the protocol. Bit fields are packed from LSB first.

Blanking Encoding
One tally control packet may be sent per video frame. Packets are encoded as a SMPTE 291M
packet with DID/SDID x51/x52 in the active region of VANC line 15. A tally control packet may contain
up to 256 bytes of tally information.

Packet Format
Each tally status consists of 4 bits of information:
uint4
bit 0: program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0x0)
The first byte of the tally packet contains the monitor device tally status and a version number.
Subsequent bytes of the tally packet contain tally status for pairs of slave devices. The master device
sends tally status for the number of devices configured/supported, up to a maximum of 510.

struct tally
uint8
bit 0: monitor device program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: monitor device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4-7: protocol version (0b0000)

Developer Information 241


uint8[0]
bit 0: slave device 1 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: slave device 1 device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4: slave device 2 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 5: slave device 2 preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 6-7: reserved (0b00)
uint8[1]
bit 0: slave device 3 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: slave device 3 device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4: slave device 4 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 5: slave device 4 preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 6-7: reserved (0b00)
...

Slave Device
(1)

Master Device Slave Device


(2)

Slave Device
Monitor Device
(3)

Byte 7 MSB 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LSB

Version Version Version Version Reserved Reserved Monitor Monitor


0
(0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

Reserved Reserved Slave 1 Slave 1 Reserved Reserved Slave 0 Slave 0


1
(0b0) (0b0) Preview Program (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

Reserved Reserved Slave 3 Slave 3 Reserved Reserved Slave 2 Slave 2


2
(0b0) (0b0) Preview Program (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

3 ...

Developer Information 242


Ayuda
Ayuda
Visite la pgina de soporte tcnico en el sitio web de Blackmagic Design para obtener ayuda
rpidamente y acceder al material de apoyo ms reciente para los productos descritos en
este manual.

Pgina de soporte tcnico


Las versiones ms recientes del manual, el software y el material de apoyo estn disponibles en el
centro de soporte tcnico de Blackmagic Design: www.blackmagicdesign.com/es/support

Cmo ponerse en contacto con Blackmagic Design


Si no encuentra la ayuda que necesita, solicite asistencia mediante el botn Enviar correo
electrnico, situado en la parte inferior de la pgina de soporte tcnico en nuestro sitio web.
Demanera alternativa, haga clic en el botn Soporte tcnico local para acceder al nmero
telefnico del centro de atencin ms cercano.

Cmo comprobar la versin del software instalada


Para comprobar la versin del programa utilitario instalada en su equipo informtico, acceda al men
About Blackmagic Camera Setup.
En Mac OS X, ejecute el programa desde la carpeta de aplicaciones. Seleccione el men
About Blackmagic Camera Setup en la barra superior de la ventana para ver el nmero de
la versin.
En Windows 7, ejecute el programa Blackmagic Camera Setup haciendo clic en el cono
situado en el men Inicio. Acceda al men Ayuda y seleccione la opcin About Blackmagic
Camera Setup para ver el nmero de versin.

Cmo obtener las actualizaciones ms recientes


Luego de comprobar la versin del programa instalada en el equipo informtico, visite el centro de
soporte tcnico de Blackmagic Design para comprobar si existen actualizaciones disponibles.
Aunque generalmente es recomendable instalar las versiones ms recientes, evite realizar
modificaciones al sistema operativo interno del dispositivo si se encuentra llevando a cabo un
proyecto importante.

Reemplazo de la batera
La batera del modelo Studio Camera no puede ser reemplazada por el usuario. En caso de que sea
necesario sustituirla, deber enviarla al centro de asistencia tcnica de Blackmagic ms cercano.
Siel perodo de garanta de la cmara ha finalizado, el reemplazo de la batera tendr un pequeo
cargo de servicio por el costo de la misma, la mano de obra y la devolucin de la cmara. Pngase
en contacto con el centro de asistencia tcnica de Blackmagic Design para obtener ms informacin
acerca del lugar donde debe enviar su cmara, cmo empaquetarla de forma segura y cul es el
costo del reemplazo en su pas.

NOTA: Los modelos Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 y Studio Camera 4K no cuentan


con bateras internas.

Ayuda 243
Garanta
12 meses de garanta limitada
Blackmagic Design garantiza que el producto adquirido no presentar defectos en los materiales o
en su fabricacin por un perodo de 12 meses a partir de su fecha de compra. Si un producto resulta
defectuoso durante el perodo de validez de la garanta, Blackmagic Design podr optar por
reemplazarlo o repararlo sin cargo alguno por concepto de piezas y/o mano de obra.
Para acceder al servicio proporcionado de acuerdo con los trminos de esta garanta, el Cliente
deber dar aviso del defecto a Blackmagic Design antes del vencimiento del perodo de garanta y
encargarse de los arreglos necesarios para la prestacin del mismo. El Cliente ser responsable del
empaque y el envo del producto defectuoso al centro de servicio tcnico designado por
Blackmagic Design y deber abonar las tarifas postales por adelantado. El Cliente ser responsable
de todos los gastos de envo, seguros, aranceles, impuestos y cualquier otro importe que surja con
relacin a la devolucin de productos por cualquier motivo.
Esta garanta carecer de validez ante defectos o daos causados por un uso indebido del producto
o por falta de cuidado y mantenimiento. Blackmagic Design no tendr obligacin de prestar el
servicio estipulado en esta garanta para (a) reparar daos provocados por intentos de personal
ajeno a Blackmagic Design de instalar, reparar o realizar un mantenimiento del producto; (b) reparar
daos resultantes del uso de equipos incompatibles o conexiones a los mismos; (c) reparar cualquier
dao o mal funcionamiento provocado por el uso de piezas o repuestos no suministrados por
Blackmagic Design; o (d) brindar servicio tcnico a un producto que haya sido modificado o
integrado con otros productos, cuando dicha modificacin o integracin tenga como resultado un
aumento de la dificultad o el tiempo necesario para reparar el producto. ESTA GARANTA
OFRECIDA POR BLACKMAGIC DESIGN REEMPLAZA CUALQUIER OTRA GARANTA, EXPRESA O
IMPLCITA. POR MEDIO DE LA PRESENTE, BLACKMAGIC DESIGN Y SUS DISTRIBUIDORES
RECHAZAN CUALQUIER GARANTA IMPLCITA DE COMERCIALIZACIN O IDONEIDAD PARA UN
PROPSITO PARTICULAR. LA RESPONSABILIDAD DE BLACKMAGIC DESIGN EN CUANTO A LA
REPARACIN O SUSTITUCIN DE PRODUCTOS DEFECTUOSOS CONSTITUYE UNA
COMPENSACIN COMPLETA Y EXCLUSIVA PROPORCIONADA AL CLIENTE POR CUALQUIER
DAO INDIRECTO, ESPECIAL, FORTUITO O EMERGENTE, AL MARGEN DE QUE BLACKMAGIC
DESIGN O SUS DISTRIBUIDORES HAYAN SIDO ADVERTIDOS CON ANTERIORIDAD SOBRE LA
POSIBILIDAD DE TALES DAOS. BLACKMAGIC DESIGN NO SE HACE RESPONSABLE POR EL USO
ILEGAL DE EQUIPOS POR PARTE DEL CLIENTE. BLACKMAGIC DESIGN NO SE HACE
RESPONSABLE POR DAOS CAUSADOS POR EL USO DE ESTE PRODUCTO. EL USUARIO UTILIZA
EL PRODUCTO BAJO SU PROPIA RESPONSABILIDAD.
Copyright 2017 Blackmagic Design. Todos los derechos reservados. Blackmagic Design, DeckLink, HDLink, Videohub
Workgroup, Multibridge Pro, Multibridge Extreme, Intensity y Leading the creative video revolution son marcas
registradas en Estados Unidos y otros pases. Todos los dems nombres de compaas y productos pueden ser marcas
comerciales de las respectivas empresas a las que estn asociadas.

Garanta 244

Blackmagic
Studio Camera
20176


Blackmagic Studio Camera

Blackmagic Studio CameraMicro Studio Camera 4K

Tally
Tally

Blackmagic Studio Camera

Blackmagic Studio Camera

TallyMFT

SFP
HyperDeck Shuttle

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4KBlackmagic Studio Camera


Ultra HD
ATEM

Grant Petty
Blackmagic Design

Blackmagic Studio Camera

248 268
248 269
248 270
249 270

252 271
Blackmagic Studio Camera 252 Blackmagic 3G-SDI
Blackmagic Micro Studio Arduino ShieldTally 271
Camera 4K 254
Blackmagic Camera Setup 273
256
Blackmagic Studio Camera - 256 274

Blackmagic Studio Camera - 257 274


Blackmagic Micro Studio 274
Camera 4K - 258 ATEM Software Control
Blackmagic Micro Studio 274
Camera 4K - 259
274
260 276

Blackmagic Micro Studio DaVinci Resolve 281
Camera 4K 260
Developer Information 284
Blackmagic Micro Studio
Camera 261 Blackmagic SDI Camera
Control Protocol 284
262
Blackmagic Embedded
262
TallyControl Protocol 292
264
294
265
267 295

Blackmagic Studio CameraBlackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

Blackmagic

1

2
3

1 1
1

1
PUSH

PUSH
3

3
2

2 2
1

1
PUSH

PUSH
3

3
2

Studio Camera

Micro Studio Camera 4K

1 LCDBlackmagic Studio CameraStudio Camera 4K


LCD
2

Blackmagic Studio Camera HDStudio Camera 4K



Blackmagic Studio Camera 2Studio Camera 4K
2

248
Micro Studio Camera 4KLP-E6LP-E6N

Micro Studio Camera 4K


1 Tally
2
ATEM Converter

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN

SDI IN

REF

REF

12V

12V

Studio Camera

SDIATEMBlackmagic Studio CameraMicro Studio Camera 4K

SDI
1 Blackmagic Studio CameraMicro Studio Camera 4KSDIATEM
SDI
2 ATEMSDIMulti ViewStudio Camera
SDIMulti ViewSDI

SFPBlackmagic Studio
CameraATEM
2845
ATEMATEM Studio ConverterATEM Talkback
Converter 4KATEM Converter

249
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 1 IN 3 1 1 3 1 REMOTE REMOTE
1 3 5 1 7 3 9 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH
STEREO IN

CONTROL CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 IN 2 2 HD 2 HD HD HD HD HD
1 2 4 1 6 2 8 4 10 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 REF IN
PREVIEW AUXPROGRAM
1-3 PREVIEW
OUTPUTS PROGRAM OUTPUTS
MULTI-VIEW MULTI-VIEW
ANALOG AUDIO IN

IN IN IN IN IN 1 3 1 REMOTE
All SDI and HDMI video connections are
1 3 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH SD, HD and Ultra HD switchable unless indicated

CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 2 HD HD HD
1 2 4 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2 CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 PREVIEW PROGRAM OUTPUTS MULTI-VIEW ANALOG AUDIO IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT

ATEMSDI
SDIATEM
SDI

Tally
ATEM Software Control
Tally

1 ATEM Software Control
2 Studio Camera
1111
3 Blackmagic Studio CameraMENUStudio Settings>Camera
NumberStudio Camera
ATEMCam 11Tally

Tally
Blackmagic Studio CameraPGMATEM

1Studio CameraTallyTally


ATEM Software ControlCamera ControlATEM
Blackmagic Studio Camera
ATEM Software Control

1Cam 1

Cam 1
ATEM Software Control

250

Blackmagic Studio CameraBlackmagic HyperDeck Studio
Studio CameraHyperDeck ShuttleBlackmagic Video
AssistISO
Blackmagic Studio Camera
Blackmagic Studio Camera

251

Blackmagic Studio Camera

1 Tally

2
3

4
1

PUSH
5 2

PUSH

2 LANC
2.5mmLANC
3
0.25TRSPGM
4
0.206TRS
5
21/4XLR
Blackmagic Studio Camera -

252

6 /
SFP45
7 SDI
SDI
8 SDI
PGM
9

10
12 24V
Blackmagic Studio Camera -

12
11

6 OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

7 SDI OUT

8 SDI IN

9 REF

13 14 15 16 17 18 19 18 20 21 22 10 12V

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU

11 10LCD


12 Tally

13
LCD
14

15 PTT

16 PGM

17 LUT

253
18 12V

LCD REF

19 SET SDI IN


SDI OUT

20 OPTICAL IN

OPTICAL OUT


21
LCD
22
Blackmagic Studio Camera

23 USB
USB Mini-BBlackmagic Camera Setup

23

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

1 Tally


-
-
-
-
Micro Studio Camera 4KTally

1 2 4
5
6
PUSH

2
7
3
8
PUSH

254

2 HDMI
Blackmagic Video Assist
1080HD

3
DB-HD15Blackmagic
Micro Studio Camera 4K
4
HDMI
5

6

7 SET

8
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

9
3.5mm
10 SDI

11 SDI
ATEMBlackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield
12 /
3.5mmiPhone/

10
13
11

12

255

13
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4KLP-E6

14

15 USB
USBBlackmagic Camera Setup

14

15

Blackmagic Studio Camera -


LANC

2.5mmLANC
MFTLANC
Lumix G X Vario PZ 14-42mm f/3.5-5.6 Power O.I.S.
Lumix G X Vario PZ 45-175mm f/4.0-5.6 Zoom O.I.S.
M.Zuiko Digital ED 12-50mm f/3.5-6.3 EZ Micro 4/3
M.Zuiko Digital ED 14-42mm f/3.5-5.6 EZ Micro 4/3

SDI15
161516

256

SDI1516

XLR
SDI12

1
1
PUSH

3
2

2
1
PUSH

3
2

Blackmagic Studio Camera -


/
SFPLCStudio
Camera HD3G-SDIStudio Camera 4K6G-SDI
2845
SDI
Blackmagic DesignBlackmagic Studio CameraSFP
www.blackmagicdesign.com/cn/resellers

SDI
SDI10bit 4:2:2SDISDI
Blackmagic Studio Camera HD3G-SDIStudio Camera 4K12G-SDI

SDI
SDIPGMPGM

SDIBlackmagic HyperDeck
ShuttleStudio CameraHyperDeckSDI

257

12-24VBlackmagic Studio Camera HDBlackmagic Studio Camera 4K


Studio Camera HD4
Studio Camera 4K3
Blackmagic Studio Camera 2Studio Camera 4K 2

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN

REF

12V

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K -


HDMI
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4KHDMI10bit 4:2:2 1080p2
Blackmagic Video AssistHDMI
Micro Studio Camera 4K
HDMI2160p30HDMI
1080p30

MENU
EXPANSION

SET

258
EXPANSION
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

SDIATEMMicro Studio Camera 4K

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4KDB-HD15LANC


PTZ
Micro Studio Camera 4K
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K -

3.5mm

SDI
SDI10bit 4:2:2SDISDI
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K6G-SDIDIN 1.0/2.3SDI
SDI

SDI
ATEMMicro Studio Camera 4K

Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino ShieldMicro Studio


CameraBlackmagicSDIATEM
SDI
SDIATEMBlackmagic

259
/
3.5mm/iPhone
/SDI
1516

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K


Micro Studio Camera 4K

4 Micro Studio Cam MSC Breakout Cable Micro Studio Cam MSC Breakout Cable

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

1
12VDCMicro Studio Camera 4K

2



3 LANC
LANC2.5mm

4 PTZ
RS-422Micro Studio Camera 4KSDIPTZ

260
5 B4
DB-9Micro Studio Camera 4KMFTB4B4
B4Digital B4 Control Adapter Cable
DB-9
ATEMMicro Studio Camera 4K
MFT
Blackmagic Designwww.blackmagicdesign.com/support/
faq/59011B4
6 S.Bus
Futaba JS.Bus18S.Bus
S.Bus

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera


Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
B412V


P1P2P7

P1 PIN ASSIGNMENT
2 S. Bus 1
2 P2
GROUND 3

GROUND 1
12 PTZ RS422 Rx- 2
8 PTZ RS422 Tx+ 3 5
9
GROUND 4 4

GROUND
5
6
3
2
8
7 P3
6
13 PTZ RS422 Rx+ 7 1

3 PTZ RS422 Tx- 8


GROUND 9

5 15
GROUND 1
10 14 B4 Lens Control Transmit 2 5
9
4 14 4
15 B4 Lens Control Receive 3
P4
9 8
3 13 3
8 GROUND 4 2
7
2
7
12 6 Power +12V in* 5 1
6
1 11 OTHER
6

5 Reference Input CENTER


GROUND SLEEVE P5
1 Ground 6 Power +12V in 11 Ground LANC Data
9 TIP
2
3
S. Bus
PTZ RS422 Tx-
7
8
Ground
PTZ RS422 Tx+
12
13
PTZ RS422 Rx-
PTZ RS422 Rx+
10
GROUND
LANC Power RING
SLEEVE
P6
4 Ground 9 LANC Data 14 B4 Lens Control Transmit
5 Reference Input 10 LANC Power 15 B4 Lens Control Receive
6 Power +12V in PIN
GROUND SLEEVE P7

* Power input to the camera is also used to power the lens. Beware of applying excessive voltages if youre using
your own power supply to avoid damage to the lens.

261

Blackmagic
Tally

Blackmagic Studio CameraBlackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4KMENU


SET
Micro Studio Camera 4KHDMI

Video Format
1080p1080i
SET

Gain
0dB6dB18dB
Detail
Studio CameraOff
Default

Medium
High
Auto Exposure
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
Iris

Shutter

- Blackmagic Studio Camera

262
Iris + Shutter+
Micro Studio
Camera 4K

Shutter + Iris+

Micro Studio Camera 4K

Manual Trigger

White Balance
18
250028003000320034003600400045004800K
/

5000520054005600K
60006500700075008000K

Shutter Speed
Gain151/50
1/2000

- Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

Blackmagic Studio Camera

Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Micro


Camera Camera 4K Studio Camera 4K

720p50 720p50 1080i50

720p59.94 720p59.94 1080i59.94

720p60 720p60 1080i60

1080i50 1080i50 1080p23.98

263
Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Micro
Camera Camera 4K Studio Camera 4K

1080i59.94 1080i59.94 1080p24

1080i60 1080i60 1080p25

1080p23.98 1080p23.98 1080p29.97

1080p24 1080p24 1080p30

1080p25 1080p25 1080p50

1080p29.97 1080p29.97 1080p59.94

1080p30 1080p30 1080p60

1080p50 1080p50 2160p23.98

1080p59.94 1080p59.94 2160p24

1080p60 1080p60 2160p25

2160p23.98 2160p29.97

2160p24 2160p30

2160p25

2160p29.97

2160p30

2160p50

2160p59.94

2160p60

Blackmagic Studio CameraMENU


SET

- Blackmagic Studio Camera

264
Automatic Gain Control
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

Audio Input
XLR

Microphone Level
Studio Camera
12

Input Level

LineMic LowMic High

Ch 1 Input1
11

Ch 2 Uses Ch 1 Input21
112SDIOn

1
1
122
Off

Ch 2 Input2
22

Phantom Power
Studio
Camera XLRAudio On
OffLine Input Level

10

LCDMENU
SET

265
- Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

HDMI MetersHDMI
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4KHDMI

Histogram

HDMI Overlays

Audio

HDMI Overlays

HDMI OverlaysHDMI
Micro Studio Camera 4KON
HDMI
IDHDMI

Brightness
LCD60%

Zebra
Blackmagic

Medium

266
Focus Peaking
OffLowMediumHigh
Medium

Front Tally BrightnessTally


TallyOffLowMediumHigh
Medium

Rear Tally BrightnessTally


TallyLowMediumHigh
Medium

Tally Light BrightnessTally


Micro Studio Camera 4KTallyMedium

HighLowOff
TallyOffTally

Display Battery Percentage


LP-E6Micro Studio
Camera 4K

LCDMENU
SET

- Blackmagic Studio Camera

Camera Number
Studio CameraATEMTally
1991

267
Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino ShieldSDI
TallyOpen
CollectorSDIBlackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino ShieldTally
Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino ShieldTally

Reference Source
Studio CameraSDI

Reference Timing

Headset Level
50%

Headset Mic Level


50%

Program Mix
LCD

0%

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4KS.Bus


S.Bus
Set

- Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

268

Blackmagic Studio Camera


LCD
SDI

FOCUS
Studio CameraFOCUS
FOCUSFOCUS
FOCUS

IRIS
VideoIRIS
FilmIRIS
Studio Camera

PTT

PGM

SDI

LUT

SET

DISP
Studio Camera10

Gainf
DISP10
SDI

Blackmagic Studio Camera 2Studio Camera 4K 2


269
OPTICAL OUT
MENU
OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN Blackmagic Studio Camera

REF

12V

OPTICAL OUT OPTICAL OUT OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN OPTICAL IN OPTICAL IN

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT FOCUS IRIS SET PTT PGM LUT
DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRISSET PTT PGM DISPLAY
LUT MENU SET DISPLAY MENU
SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT

SDI IN SDI IN SDI IN

REF REF REF

12V 12V 12V

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU

FOCUS IRIS Studio CameraPTT


FOCUS PGM



Blackmagic Studio Camera10bit 4:2:2SDI
SFPATEM Camera Converter

Blackmagic Studio Camera HDStudio Camera 4KStudio Camera
SDISFPPGM

Blackmagic Studio Camera
VTR

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

OPTICAL OUT

SDI IN
OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

REF
SDI IN

REF

12V

12V

SDISFPStudio
Camera

270

Studio CameraSDIBlackmagic
HyperDeck ShuttleSSDSDIHyperDeckSDIStudio
CameraSDILCD

+12V POWER HDMI IN HDMI OUT SDI IN SDI OUT

+12V POWER HDMI IN HDMI OUT SDI IN SDI OUT

SDIHyperDeckSDIHyperDeckSDI
SDI

Blackmagic 3G-SDI
Arduino ShieldTally
SDITallyTallyBlackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino
ShieldBlackmagic Studio CameraTallyATEM
BlackmagicSDITally
TallyBlackmagicD2-D9SDI
Blackmagic Mini Converter SDI DistributionBlackmagic
8BlackmagicTally
BlackmagicTally
TallyCommon GND
ArduinoGND
BlackmagicTally
TallyBlackmagic Arduino

Blackmagic
Arduino

1 1 D2

2 2 D3

3 3 D4

4 4 D5

5 5 D6

6 6 D7

7 7 D8

8 8 D9

Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino ShieldTally 271


Blackmagic ArduinoSketch
TallyOpen CollectorSDI
Blackmagic 3G -SDI Arduino ShieldTallyBlackmagic Design
www.blackmagicdesign.com/supportBlackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield

SketchBlackmagic ArduinoTally1
2TallyTallySDITally

Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino ShieldTally 272


PUS
2

PUSH
Blackmagic Camera Setup
Mac OS X
Blackmagic Camera Setup.dmg
Blackmagic Camera Setup

1
PUSH

Blackmagic Camera Setup


2
PUSH

Windows
Blackmagic Camera SetupBlackmagic Camera
Setup
WindowsBlackmagic Design
Blackmagic Camera Setup


Blackmagic Camera SetupUSB
Mini-B USB 2.0
Blackmagic Camera Setup

Mini-B USB 2.0

Blackmagic Camera Setup 273


Studio CameraLCD

1 Studio Camera6
2 2

LANC
3/81/4

1
1
PUSH

3
2

2
1
PUSH

3
2

ATEM Software Control

ATEM Software ControlCamera ControlATEM


Blackmagic Studio Camera

DaVinci Resolve
ATEMATEMSDI
ATEMSDI
SDISDI
SFP

ATEM Software Control 274


ATEM

SDI
1 Blackmagic Studio CameraSDI OutATEMSDI In

2 ATEMSDIMulti ViewStudio Camera
SDI InMulti ViewSDI
3 Blackmagic Studio CameraMENUStudio Settings>Camera Number
Studio Camera 1
ATEMCam 11Tally

IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 1 IN 3 1 1 3 1 REMOTE REMOTE
1 3 5 1 7 3 9 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH
STEREO IN

CONTROL CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 IN 2 2 HD 2 HD HD HD HD HD
1 2 4 1 6 2 8 4 10 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 REF IN
PREVIEW AUXPROGRAM
1-3 PREVIEW
OUTPUTS PROGRAM OUTPUTS
MULTI-VIEW MULTI-VIEW
ANALOG AUDIO IN

IN IN IN IN IN 1 3 1 REMOTE
All SDI and HDMI video connections are
1 3 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH SD, HD and Ultra HD switchable unless indicated

CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 2 HD HD HD
1 2 4 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2 CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 PREVIEW PROGRAM OUTPUTS MULTI-VIEW ANALOG AUDIO IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT

Blackmagic Studio CameraATEMSDI

ATEM Software Control 275



1 Studio CameraSFP/
OpticalOut/InATEM Studio Converter/
2 ATEM Studio ConverterSDI OutATEM
SDI In
3 ATEMSDIMulti ViewATEM Studio
ConverterSDI InMulti ViewSDI
4 Blackmagic Studio CameraMENUStudio Settings>Camera Number
Studio Camera 1
ATEMCam 11Tally

ATEM Software Control
TallyBlackmagic Studio Camera
TallyPGM

AES/EBU TALKBACK LOOPS

3 1 4 2 OUT
3OUT OUT
4

L R

UT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT IN IN SDI OUT IN

L +12V
R BACKUP L L R R L L R R L R
POWER USB 2.0
OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN
OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG
ANALOG AUDIO OUTAUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO
OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG
OUT AUDIO OUT PGM SDI OPTICAL
MICOUT/IN H/PHONE ANALOG AUDIO OUT OP

AES/EBU TALKBACK LOOPS

1 2 3 4 OUT OUT OUT

L R

SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT IN IN IN

+12V BACKUP L R L R L R L R
POWER USB 2.0 OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT PGM SDI MIC H/PHONE

ATEM Studio ConverterBlackmagic Studio Camera


ATEM Software ControlCamera

ATEM Software Control 276




YRGB
LiftGammaGain

DaVinci ResolveYRGBLiftGamma
Gain

Y RG B Lif tGammaGain

Blackmagic Studio CameraMicro Studio Camera


URSA Mini

/
Blackmagic

ATEM Software Control 277



Blackmagic

LiftGammaGain

/
/

ATEM Software Control 278


/

Shift
Maccommand
WindowsControl

Zoom
Coarse
Zoom
SDI
Blackmagic Studio CameraBlackmagic Studio Camera 4K
v1.9.11MFT

Coarse/

ATEM Software Control 279


dB

ATEM Software Control 280


Gain

DaVinci Resolve
CCU

Blackmagic Studio CameraDaVinci Resolve Primary Color Corrector


Blackmagic Studio CameraDaVinci Resolve
DaVinci Resolve

DaVinci Resolve Primary Color Corrector

Lift/Gamma/Gain
LiftGammaGain

ATEM Software Control 281


LiftGammaGain


RGB

Shift


YRGBLiftGammaGain


YRGBY
ALTCommandYRGB
Y
YRGBRGB
DaVinci ResolveYRGB

ATEM Software Control 282


LiftGain
50%

50%

180

Blackmagic Studio CameraDaVinci ResolveDaVinci


2080DaVinci Resolve
Blackmagic Studio Camera
YRGB
RGBYRGBYRGB

100%YRGB
100%RGB0100
RGBYRGB

ATEMBlackmagic Studio Camera


Studio Camera

ATEM Software Control 283


Developer Information
Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol
Version 1.1
If you are a software developer you can use the SDI Camera Control Protocol to construct devices
that integrate with our products. Here at Blackmagic Design our approach is to open up our
protocols and we eagerly look forward to seeing what you come up with!

Overview
The Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol is used by ATEM switchers, Blackmagic 3G-SDI
Arduino Shield and Blackmagic Camera Remote to provide Camera Control functionality with
supported Blackmagic Design cameras. Please refer to the Understanding Studio Camera
Control chapter section of this manual, or the ATEM Switchers Manual and SDKmanual for more
information. These can be downloaded at www.blackmagicdesign.com/support.
This document describes an extensible protocol for sending a uni directional stream of small control
messages embedded in the non-active picture region of a digital video stream. Thevideo stream
containing the protocol stream may be broadcast to a number of devices. Device addressing is
used to allow the sender to specify which device each message is directed to.

Assumptions
Alignment and padding constraints are explicitly described in the protocol document. Bit fields
are packed from LSB first. Message groups, individual messages and command headers are
defined as, and can be assumed to be, 32 bit aligned.

Blanking Encoding
A message group is encoded into a SMPTE 291M packet with DID/SDID x51/x53 in the active region
of VANC line 16.

Message Grouping
Up to 32 messages may be concatenated and transmitted in one blanking packet up to a maximum
of 255 bytes payload. Under most circumstances, this should allow all messages to be sent with
a maximum of one frame latency.
If the transmitting device queues more bytes of message packets than can be sent in a single
frame, it should use heuristics to determine which packets to prioritize and send immediately.
Lower priority messages can be delayed to later frames, or dropped entirely as appropriate.

Abstract Message Packet Format


Every message packet consists of a three byte header followed by an optional variable length
data block. The maximum packet size is 64 bytes.

Device addresses are represented as an 8 bit unsigned integer. Individual


Destination device (uint8) devices are numbered 0 through 254 with the value 255 reserved to indicate
a broadcast message to all devices.

The command length is an 8 bit unsigned integer which specifies the length
Command length (uint8) of the included command data. The length does NOT include the length of
the header or any trailing padding bytes.

Developer Information 284


The command id is an 8 bit unsigned integer which indicates themessage
type being sent. Receiving devices should ignore any commands that they
Command id (uint8) do not understand. Commands 0 through 127 are reserved for commands
that apply to multiple types of devices. Commands 128 through 255 are
device specific.

This byte is reserved for alignment and expansion purposes. Itshould be


Reserved (uint8)
set to zero.

The command data may contain between 0 and 60 bytes of data. The format
Command data(uint8[])
of the data section is defined by the command itself.

Messages must be padded up to a 32 bit boundary with 0x0bytes. Any


Padding(uint8[])
padding bytes are NOT included in the command length.

Receiving devices should use the destination device address and or the command identifier to
determine which messages to process. The receiver should use the command length to skip
irrelevant or unknown commands and should be careful to skip the implicit padding as well.

Defined Commands
Command 0 : change configuration

The category number specifies one of up to 256 configuration categories


Category (uint8)
available on the device.

The parameter number specifies one of 256 potential configuration parameters


available on the device. Parameters 0 through 127 are device specific
Parameter (uint8)
parameters. Parameters 128 though 255 are reserved for parameters that
apply to multiple types of devices.

The data type specifies the type of the remaining data. Thepacket length is
Data type (uint8) used to determine the number of elements in the message. Each message
must contain an integral number of data elements.

Currently defined values are:

A void value is represented as a boolean array of length zero.


0: void / boolean The data field is a 8 bit value with 0 meaning false and all other values
meaning true.

1: signed byte Data elements are signed bytes

2: signed 16bit integer Data elements are signed 16 bit values

3: signed 32bit integer Data elements are signed 32 bit values

4: signed 64bit integer Data elements are signed 64 bit values

5: UTF-8 string Data elements represent a UTF-8 string with no terminating character.

Data types 6 through 127 are reserved.

Data elements are signed 16 bit integers representing a real number with 5
128: signed 5.11fixed bits for the integer component and 11 bits for the fractional component. The
point fixed point representation is equal to the real value multiplied by 2^11. The
representable range is from -16.0 to 15.9995 (15 + 2047/2048).

Developer Information 285


Data types 129 through 255 are available for device specific purposes.

The operation type specifies what action to perform on the specified


Operation type (uint8)
parameter. Currently defined values are:

The supplied values are assigned to the specified parameter. Each element
will be clamped according to its valid range. A void parameter may only be
0: assign value assigned an empty list of boolean type. This operation will trigger the
action associated with that parameter. A boolean value may be assigned the
value zero for false, and any other value for true.

Each value specifies signed offsets of the same type to be added to the
current parameter values. The resulting parameter value will be clamped
1: offset / toggle value
according to their valid range. It is not valid to apply an offset to a void value.
Applying any offset other than zero to a boolean value will invert that value.

Operation types 2 through 127 are reserved.

Operation types 128through 255 are available for device specific purposes.

The data field is 0 or more bytes as determined by the data type and number
Data (void)
of elements.

The category, parameter, data type and operation type partition a 24 bit operation space.

Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

.0 Focus fixed16 0 1 0.0=near, 1.0=far

trigger
.1 Instantaneous autofocus void
instantaneous autofocus

Aperture Value (where


.2 Aperture (f-stop) fixed16 -1 16
fnumber = sqrt(2^AV))

.3 Aperture (normalised) fixed16 0 1 0.0=smallest, 1.0=largest

Steps through available


aperture values from
.4 Aperture (ordinal) int16 0 n
minimum (0) to
maximum (n)

Instantaneous trigger instantaneous


.5 void
Lens auto aperture auto aperture

Optical image true=enabled,


.6 boolean
stabilisation false=disabled

Move to specified focal


length in mm, from
.7 Set absolute zoom (mm) int16 0 max
minimum (0) to
maximum (max)

Set absolute zoom Move to specified focal


.8 fixed16 0 1
(normalised) length: 0.0=wide, 1.0=tele

Start/stop zooming at
Set continuous specified rate: -1.0=zoom
.9 fixed16 -1 +1.0
zoom (speed) wider fast, 0.0=stop,
+1=zoom tele fast

Developer Information 286


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation
1
[0] = frame rate 24, 25, 30, 50, 60
[1] = M-rate 0=regular, 1=M-rate
0=NTSC, 1=PAL, 2=720,
[2] =
3=1080, 4=2k, 5=2k DCI,
dimensions
.0 Video mode int8 6=4k, 7=4k DCI
0=progressive,
[3] = interlaced
1=interlaced
[4] =
0=YUV
colour space
.1 Sensor Gain int8 1 16 1x, 2x, 4x, 8x, 16x gain
int16 color temp 2500 10000 Colour temperature in K
.2 Manual White Balance
int16 tint -50 50 tint
Calculate and set auto
.3 Set auto WB void
white balance
Use latest auto white
.4 Restore auto WB void
balance setting
.5 Exposure (us) int32 1 42000 time in us
Steps through
availableexposure
.6 Exposure (ordinal) int16 0 n
valuesfrom minimum (0)
tomaximum (n)
int8
.7 Dynamic Range Mode 0 1 0 = film, 1 = video
enum
int8
Video .8 Video sharpening level 0 3
enum
fps as integer
[0] = file
(eg 24, 25, 30,
frame rate
50, 60, 120)
fps as integer, valid when
sensor-off-speed set
[1] = sensor (eg 24,25, 30, 33, 48, 50,

frame rate 60, 120), no change will
beperformed if this value
is set to 0
[2] =
in pixels
.9 Recording format int16 frame width
[3] =
in pixels
frame height
[0]=file-M-rate
[1]=sensor-M-rate,
valid when sensor-
[4] = flags off-speed-set
[2]=sensor-off-speed
[3]=interlaced
[4]=windowed mode
0=Manual Trigger,
1=Iris,
.10 Set auto exposure mode int8 0 4 2=Shutter,
3=Iris + Shutter,
4=Shutter + Iris

Developer Information 287


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation
2
0.0=minimum,
.0 Mic level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0.0=minimum,
.1 Headphone level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0.0=minimum,
.2 Headphone program mix fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0.0=minimum,
.3 Speaker level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Audio
0=internal mic,
1=line level input,
.4 Input type int8 0 2
2=low mic level input,
3=high mic level input
0.0=minimum,
[0] ch0 0 1
1.0=maximum
.5 Input levels fixed16
0.0=minimum,
[1] ch1 0 1
1.0=maximum
true = powered,
.6 Phantom power boolean
false = not powered
3
bit flags: [0] = display
status, [1] = display
frame guides
uint16
.0 Overlay enables Some cameras don't
bit field
allow separate control of
frame guides and
status overlays.
0=off, 1=2.4:1, 2=2.39:1,
Frame guides style [0] = frame
.1 int8 0 8 3=2.35:1, 4=1.85:1, 5=16:9,
(Camera 3.x) guides style
Output 6=14:9, 7=4:3
Frame guides opacity [1] = frame 0.0=transparent,
.2 fixed16 0.1 1
(Camera 3.x) guide opacity 1.0=opaque
0=off, 1=2.4:1, 2=2.39:1,
[0] = frame
3=2.35:1, 4=1.85:1, 5=16:9,
guides style
6=14:9, 7=4:3
Overlays
(replaces .1 and .2 [1] = frame 0=transparent,
.3 int8 0 100
abovefrom guide opacity 100=opaque
Cameras 4.0)
percentage of full frame
[2] = safe area
0 100 used by safe area guide
percentage
(0 means off)
4
0.0=minimum,
.0 Brightness fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0x4 = zebra
Display int16
.1 Overlay enables 0x8 = peaking
bit field

0.0=minimum,
.2 Zebra level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

Developer Information 288


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation
0.0=minimum,
.3 Peaking level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0=disable bars,
Color bars display
.4 int8 0 30 1-30=enable bars with
time (seconds)
timeout (s)

Display [0] = focus 0=Peak,



assist method 1=Colored lines
0=Red,
.5 Focus Assist int8 1=Green,
[1] = focus
2=Blue,
line color
3=White,
4=Black
5
Sets the tally front and
tally rear brightness to
.0 Tally brightness fixed16 0 1 the same level.
0.0=minimum,
1.0=maximum
Sets the tally front
Tally brightness.
.1 Front tally brightness fixed16 0 1
0.0=minimum,
1.0=maximum
Sets the tally rear
brightness.
0.0=minimum,
.2 Rear tally brightness fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Tally rear brightness
cannot be turned off
6
0=internal,
int8
Reference .0 Source 0 2 1=program,
enum
2=external
.1 Offset int32 +/- offset in pixels

7
[0] time _ _ BCD - HHMMSSFF (UCT)
.0 Real Time Clock int32
[1] date _ _ BCD - YYYYMMDD
ISO-639-1 two character
.1 System language string _ _ _
language code
.2 Timezone int32 _ _ _ Minutes offset from UTC
BCD -
s0DDdddddddddddd
Confi- where s is the sign:
guration [0] latitude _ _ 0=north (+), 1=south (-);
DD degrees,
dddddddddddd
.3 Location int64 decimal degrees
BCD -
sDDDdddddddddddd
where s is the sign:
[1] longitude _ _
0=west (-), 1=east (+); DDD
degrees, dddddddddddd
decimal degrees

Developer Information 289


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

8
[0] red -2 2 default 0.0
[1] green -2 2 default 0.0
.0 Lift Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -2 2 default 0.0
[3] luma -2 2 default 0.0
[0] red -4 4 default 0.0
[1] green -4 4 default 0.0
.1 Gamma Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -4 4 default 0.0
[3] luma -4 4 default 0.0
[0] red 0 16 default 1.0
[1] green 0 16 default 1.0
.2 Gain Adjust fixed16
Colour [2] blue 0 16 default 1.0
Correction
[3] luma 0 16 default 1.0
[0] red -8 8 default 0.0
[1] green -8 8 default 0.0
.3 Offset Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -8 8 default 0.0
[3] luma -8 8 default 0.0
[0] pivot 0 1 default 0.5
.4 Contrast Adjust fixed16
[1] adj 0 2 default 1.0

.5 Luma mix fixed16 0 1 default 1.0

[0] hue -1 1 default 0.0


.6 Colour Adjust fixed16
[1] sat 0 2 default 1.0
.7 Correction Reset Default void reset to defaults

10
[0] = 0 = RAW, 1 = DNxHD,

basic codec 2 = ProRes
RAW: 0=Uncompressed,
int8
.0 Codec 1=lossy 3:1, 2=lossy 4:1
enum [1] =
codec variant ProRes: 0=HQ, 1=422,
2=LT, 3=Proxy,
4=444, 5=444XQ
0=Preview,
[0] = mode
1=Play, 2=Record
Media
-ve = multiple speeds
backwards, 0 = pause,
[1] = speed
+ve = multiple
speeds forwards
.1 Transport mode int8 1<<0=loop, 1<<1=play all,
1<<5=disk1 active,
[2] = flags 1<<6=disk2 active,
1<<7=time-
lapse recording
[3] = active
0=CFast card, 1=SD
storage medium

Developer Information 290


Example Protocol Packets

Packet
Operation Length Byte

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15

header command data


destination

parameter
command

operation
reserved

category
length

type
trigger instantaneous
8 4 4 0 0 0 1 0 0
auto focus on camera 4

turn on OIS on all cameras 12 255 5 0 0 0 6 0 0 1 0 0 0

set exposure to 10 ms on camera


4 (10 ms = 10000 12 4 8 0 0 1 5 3 0 0x10 0x27 0x00 0x00
us = 0x00002710)

a d d 1 5% to ze b r a l eve l
12 4 6 0 0 4 2 128 1 0x33 0x01 0 0
(15 % = 0.15 f = 0x0133 fp)

select 1080p 23.98 mode on


16 255 9 0 0 1 0 1 0 24 1 3 0 0 0 0 0
all cameras

subtrac t 0. 3 from gamma


adjus t for green & blue 16 4 12 0 0 8 1 128 1 0 0 0x9a 0xfd 0x9a 0xfd 0 0
(-0.3 ~= 0xfd9a fp)

all operations combined 76 4 4 0 0 0 1 0 0 255 5 0 0 0 6 0 0

1 0 0 0 4 8 0 0 1 5 3 0 0x10 0x27 0x00 0x00

4 6 0 0 4 2 128 1 0x33 0x01 0 0 255 9 0 0

1 0 1 0 24 1 3 0 0 0 0 0 4 12 0 0

8 1 128 1 0 0 0x9a 0xfd 0x9a 0xfd 0 0

Developer Information 291


Blackmagic Embedded TallyControl Protocol
Version 1.0 (30/04/14)
This section is for third party developers or anybody who may wish to add support for the Blackmagic
Embedded Tally Control Protocol to their products or system. It describes the protocol for sending
tally information embedded in the non-active picture region of a digital video stream.

Data Flow
A master device such as a broadcast switcher embeds tally information into its program feed which
is broadcast to a number of slave devices such as cameras or camera controllers. The output from
the slave devices is typically fed back to the master device, but may also be sent to a video monitor.
The primary flow of tally information is from the master device to the slaves. Each slave device
may use its device id to extract and display the relevant tally information.
Slave devices pass through the tally packet on their output and update the monitor tally status, so
that monitor devices connected to that individual output may display tally status without knowledge
of the device id they are monitoring.

Assumptions
Any data alignment / padding is explicit in the protocol. Bit fields are packed from LSB first.

Blanking Encoding
One tally control packet may be sent per video frame. Packets are encoded as a SMPTE 291M
packet with DID/SDID x51/x52 in the active region of VANC line 15. A tally control packet may
contain up to 256 bytes of tally information.

Packet Format
Each tally status consists of 4 bits of information:
uint4
bit 0: program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0x0)
The first byte of the tally packet contains the monitor device tally status and a version number.
Subsequent bytes of the tally packet contain tally status for pairs of slave devices. The master
device sends tally status for the number of devices configured/supported, up to a maximum of 510.

struct tally
uint8
bit 0: monitor device program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: monitor device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4-7: protocol version (0b0000)

Developer Information 292


uint8[0]
bit 0: slave device 1 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: slave device 1 device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4: slave device 2 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 5: slave device 2 preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 6-7: reserved (0b00)
uint8[1]
bit 0: slave device 3 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: slave device 3 device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4: slave device 4 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 5: slave device 4 preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 6-7: reserved (0b00)
...

Slave Device
(1)

Master Device Slave Device


(2)

Slave Device
Monitor Device
(3)

Byte 7 MSB 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LSB

Version Version Version Version Reserved Reserved Monitor Monitor


0
(0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

Reserved Reserved Slave 1 Slave 1 Reserved Reserved Slave 0 Slave 0


1
(0b0) (0b0) Preview Program (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

Reserved Reserved Slave 3 Slave 3 Reserved Reserved Slave 2 Slave 2


2
(0b0) (0b0) Preview Program (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

3 ...

Developer Information 293


Blackmagic Design

Blackmagic Design
Blackmagic Designwww.blackmagicdesign.com/cn/support

Blackmagic Design

Blackmagic Design

Blackmagic Camera SetupAbout Blackmagic Camera


Setup
Mac OS XBlackmagic Camera Setup
About Blackmagic Camera Setup
WindowsBlackmagic Camera SetupHelp
About Blackmagic Camera Setup

B l a c k m a g i c C a m e r a S e t u p
www.blackmagicdesign.com/cn/supportBlackmagic

Studio CameraBlackmagic Design

Blackmagic Design Support

Blackmagic Studio Camera 2Blackmagic Studio Camera 4K 2

294

12
Blackmagic Design12
Blackmagic Design

Blackmagic
DesignBlackmagic Design

Blackmagic Design1. Blackmagic Design


2.
3. Blackmagic Design
4.
BLACKMAGIC DESIGN
BLACKMAGIC DESIGN
BLACKMAGIC DESIGN
BLACKMAGIC DESIGN
BLACKMAGIC DESIGN
BLACKMAGIC DESIGN
Copyright 2017 Blackmagic Design Blackmagic DesignDeckLink HDLink Workgroup Videohub
Multibridge Pro Multibridge Extreme
IntensityLeading the creative video revolution

295

Blackmagic
Studio Cameras
2017 6

.
Blackmagic Studio Camera .

Blackmagic Studio Camera .



!


. ,

.

Blackmagic Studio Camera .


,
.
. !
Blackmagic Studio Camera !
!

Balckmagic Studio Camera MFT


.
! ,
.
SFP . HyperDeck Shuttle
!

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K Blackmagic Studio Camera


! Ultra
HD .
ATEM
.

Studio Camera
! !

Blackmagic Design
CEO

Blackmagic Studio Camera

299 (Monitoring) 316


299 (Button Settings) 320
299 321
300 321
303 322
Blackmagic Studio Camera Blackmagic3G-SDI Arduino
303 Shield 322
Blackmagic Micro Studio Blackmagic Camera 324
Camera 4K 305
325
307
325
Blackmagic Studio Camera - 307
325
Blackmagic Studio Camera - 308
ATEM Software Control 325
Blackmagic Micro Studio
Camera 4K - 309 325
Blackmagic Micro Studio 327
Camera 4K - 310 DaVinci Resolve
311 332

Blackmagic Micro Studio Developer Information 335


Camera 4K 311 Blackmagic SDI Camera
Blackmagic Micro Studio Control Protocol 335
Camera 4K 312 Blackmagic Embedded
TallyControl Protocol 343
313
313 345

(Audio) 315 346




, Blackmagic Studio Camera Blackmagic Micro Studio
Camera 4K .
. Blackmagic Camera
.

1 .
, .
2 .
3
12 , .

.

1 1
1

1
PUSH

PUSH
3

3
2

2 2
1

1
PUSH

PUSH
3

3
2

Studio Camera .

Micro Studio Camera .


1 LCD . Blackmagic Studio Camera Studio
Camera 4K LCD .
2 .

Blackmagic Studio Camera HD Studio Camera 4K


.

. Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 Studio
Camera 4K 2 .

299
Micro Studio Camera 4K LP-E6 LPE6N
.
.
Micro Studio Camera 4K .
1 .
.
2 .
. Blackmagic Studio Camera ATEM
Converter !

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN

SDI IN

REF

REF

12V

12V


Studio Camera .


Blackmagic Studio Camera Micro Studio Camera 4K
SDI ATEM
.

SDI
1 Blackmagic Studio Camera Micro Studio Camera 4K SDI ATEM
SDI .
2 ATEM SDI Studio
Camera SDI .
SDI .

SFP Blackmagic Studio


Camera ATEM Switcher . 45km
.
ATEM Switcher ATEM Studio Converter ATEM
Talkback Converter 4K .
ATEM Converter [] .

300
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 1 IN 3 1 1 3 1 REMOTE REMOTE
1 3 5 1 7 3 9 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH
STEREO IN

CONTROL CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 IN 2 2 HD 2 HD HD HD HD HD
1 2 4 1 6 2 8 4 10 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 REF IN
PREVIEW AUXPROGRAM
1-3 PREVIEW
OUTPUTS PROGRAM OUTPUTS
MULTI-VIEW MULTI-VIEW
ANALOG AUDIO IN

IN IN IN IN IN 1 3 1 REMOTE
All SDI and HDMI video connections are
1 3 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH SD, HD and Ultra HD switchable unless indicated

CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 2 HD HD HD
1 2 4 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2 CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 PREVIEW PROGRAM OUTPUTS MULTI-VIEW ANALOG AUDIO IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT

ATEM SDI SDI .


ATEM SDI .

.


ATEM Software Control Preference
.

1 ATEM Software Control Preferences .
2 Mapping .
Studio Camera 1 Button 1 Input
1: Camera 1 .
3 Blackmagic Studio Camera Menu . Studio Settings>Camera
Number .
Studio Camera ATEM CAM 1 1
. .

.
Blackmagic Studio Camera , ATEM
.
.
1 . Studio Camera
.
.


ATEM Software Control Camera Control ATEM Blackmagic
Studio Camera .
ATEM Software Control Camera
.
. .
1 Cam 1. . On Air
.
Cam 1 ,
. [ATEM Software Control ]
.

301

Blackmagic Studio Camera .
Blackmagic HyperDeck Studio
. HyperDeck Shuttle Blackmagic Video Assist
ISO .
. Blackmagic Studio Camera
.
Blackmagic Studio Camera .

302

Blackmagic Studio Camera

1
.
[ (Monitoring Settings)] .

2
3

4
1

PUSH
5 2

PUSH


2 LANC
, , LANC 2.5mm .
3
PGM 0.25" TRS .
4
0.206" TRS .
5
1/4 XLR .
[Blackmagic Studio Camera - ] .

303

6 /
SFP 45km /.
7 SDI
SDI .
8 SDI
PGM SDI .
9
(tri-level) .
10
12 24V .
[Blackmagic Studio Camera - ]
.

12
11

6 OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

7 SDI OUT

8 SDI IN

9 REF

13 14 15 16 17 18 19 18 20 21 22 10 12V

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU


11 10 LCD
.
[ (Monitoring Settings)] .
12

.
13 FOCUS
,
LCD .
14 IRIS
.
15 PTT(Push To Talk)
. .
16 PGM()

.
17 LUT()
.

304
18 12V

LCD .
REF

19 SET
.
SDI IN

SDI OUT

20 DISPLAY
.
OPTICAL IN

OPTICAL OUT

21 MENU
LCD .
22
Blackmagic Studio Camera .
.
[ (Button Settings)] .


23 USB
USB B .
[Blackmagic Camera Setup] .

23

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K



1

'' . .
-
-
/ -
/ -
Micro Studio Camera 4K .
[ (Camera Settings)] .

1 2 4
5
6
PUSH

7
3 2

8
PUSH

305

2 HDMI
Blackmagic Video Assist HDMI
.
1080HD , ,
. [
(Monitoring Settings)] .
3
DB-HD15 . ,
. [Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K ]
.
4 MENU
HDMI
.
5
.
6
.
7 SET
.
8
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera .
.


9
3.5mm ( ).
10 SDI
, , SDI .
11 SDI
SDI ATEM Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield
.
12 /
3.5mm ( ). /
,
.

10
13
11

12

306

13
LP-E6 Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
.
.


14
.


15 USB
USB .
[Blackmagic Camera Setup] .

14

15


Blackmagic Studio Camera -
LANC
, ,
. 2.5mm LANC .
MFT LANC .
.
Panasonic Lumix G X Vario PZ 14-42mm f/3.5-5.6 Power O.I.S. Lens
Panasonic Lumix G X Vario PZ 45-175mm f/4.0-5.6 Zoom O.I.S. Lens
Olympus M.Zuiko Digital ED 12-50mm f/3.5-6.3 EZ Micro 4/3 Lens
Olympus M.Zuiko Digital ED 14-42mm f/3.5-5.6 EZ Micro 4/3 Lens


() .

. SDI 15
16 . 15 16
.

307

. SDI
15 16 .


XLR .
.
. SDI 1
2 .

1
1
PUSH

3
2

2
1
PUSH

3
2

Blackmagic Studio Camera -


/
/ SFP .
Studio Camera HD 3G-SDI Studio Camera 4K 6G-SDI LC
.
. 45Km
. SDI
. Blackmagic Studio Camera SFP
Blackmagic Design . www.blackmagicdesign.com/kr/resellers
.

SDI
SDI 10 4:2:2 , SDI ,
SDI . Blackmagic Studio Camera HD
3G-SDI Studio Camera 4K 12G-SDI .

SDI
SDI PGM() . PGM

.
SDI .
Blackmagic Hyperdeck Shuttle Studio Camera
Hyperdeck SDI .

308
REF
(Tri-level) .

.

12 V -24V Blackmagic Studio Camera HD


Blackmagic Studio Camera 4K . Studio Camera
HD 4 Studio Camera 4K 3 .
Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 Studio Camera 4K 2 .

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN

REF

12V

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K -


HDMI
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K HDMI 2 10
4:2:2 1080p . Blackmagic Video Assist HD HDMI
Micro Studio Camera 4K ,
.
HDMI . 2160p30
HDMI 1080p30 .

MENU
EXPANSION

SET

309

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
. Micro Studio Camera 4K
.
.
[ ] SDI ATEM
Micro Studio Camera 4K .
.
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K DB-HD15
LANC , , , , .
,
Micro Studio Camera 4K .
[Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K ] .

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K -



3.5mm .
(Audio Settings) .
.

SDI
SDI 10 4:2:2 , , SDI ,
SDI . Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
6G-SDI . SDI DIN
1.0/2.3-SDI .

SDI
SDI ATEM Micro Studio Camera 4K .
[ ] .

Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield Micro Studio Camera


. ATEM Blackmagic
SDI . , SDI
SDI ATEM
Blackmagic .

310
/
3.5mm /
. /
, . SDI 15 16
.

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K


. Micro Studio Camera 4K
,
.
.

4 Micro Studio Cam MSC Breakout Cable Micro Studio Cam MSC Breakout Cable

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K .

1
12V DC
Micro Studio Camera 4K .
.
2
(tri-level)
.
.
3 LACN
LANC 2.5mm
/, , .
4 , ,
RS-422 Micro Studio Camera 4K SDI , ,
.

311
5 B4
DB-9 MFT B4 Micro Studio
Camera 4K B4 . B4
Digital B4 Control Adapter
, DB-9 .
B4 , , MFT
, ATEM Micro Studio Camrea 4K
.
B4 Blackmagic Design
(www.blackmagicdesign.com/kr/support) .
6 S.Bus
Futaba J S.Bus 18 S.Bus
. , ,
. S.Bus
[ ] .

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K


Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
. , 12V B4
.
.

. P1 P2
P7
.

P1 PIN ASSIGNMENT
2 S. Bus 1
2 P2
GROUND 3

GROUND 1
12 PTZ RS422 Rx- 2
8 PTZ RS422 Tx+ 3 5
9
GROUND 4 4

GROUND
5
6
3
2
8
7 P3
6
13 PTZ RS422 Rx+ 7 1

3 PTZ RS422 Tx- 8


GROUND 9

5 15
GROUND 1
10 14 B4 Lens Control Transmit 2 5
9
4 14 4
15 B4 Lens Control Receive 3
P4
9 8
3 13 3
8 GROUND 4 2
7
2
7
12 6 Power +12V in* 5 1
6
1 11 OTHER
6

5 Reference Input CENTER


GROUND SLEEVE P5
1 Ground 6 Power +12V in 11 Ground LANC Data
9 TIP
2
3
S. Bus
PTZ RS422 Tx-
7
8
Ground
PTZ RS422 Tx+
12
13
PTZ RS422 Rx-
PTZ RS422 Rx+
10
GROUND
LANC Power RING
SLEEVE
P6
4 Ground 9 LANC Data 14 B4 Lens Control Transmit
5 Reference Input 10 LANC Power 15 B4 Lens Control Receive
6 Power +12V in PIN
GROUND SLEEVE P7

* Power input to the camera is also used to power the lens. Beware of applying excessive voltages if youre using
your own power supply to avoid damage to the lens.

312

Blackmagic ,

/ .
.


Blackmagic Studio Camera Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
. [Set]
.
Micro Studio Camera 4K HDMI
.


. / 1080p 1080i
. SET .
.

(Gain)
. 0dB
6dB 18dB .

(Detail)
Studio Camera . Off
Default( ), Medium( ), High( )
.

(Auto Exposure)
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K .
(Iris)
.
(Shutter)
.

- Blackmagic Studio Camera

313
+ (Iris+Shutter)
.
Micro Studio Camera 4K
.

+ (Shutter+Iris)
.
Micro Studio Camera 4K
.

(Manual Trigger)

.

(White Balance)
18 .
, , , , ,
2500K, 2800K, 3000K, 3200K 3400K, 3600K, 4000K,
4500K, 4800K .
5000K, 5200K, 5400K, 5600K
.
6000K, 6500K, 7000K, 7500K,
8000K .

(Shutter Speed)
.
1/50 1/2000 15 .

- Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K.

Blackmagic Studio Camera

Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Micro


Camera Camera 4K Studio Camera 4K

720p50 720p50 1080i50

720p59.94 720p59.94 1080i59.94

720p60 720p60 1080i60

1080i50 1080i50 1080p23.98

314
Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Micro
Camera Camera 4K Studio Camera 4K

1080i59.94 1080i59.94 1080p24

1080i60 1080i60 1080p25

1080p23.98 1080p23.98 1080p29.97

1080p24 1080p24 1080p30

1080p25 1080p25 1080p50

1080p29.97 1080p29.97 1080p59.94

1080p30 1080p30 1080p60

1080p50 1080p50 2160p23.98

1080p59.94 1080p59.94 2160p24

1080p60 1080p60 2160p25

2160p23.98 2160p29.97

2160p24 2160p30

2160p25

2160p29.97

2160p30

2160p50

2160p59.94

2160p60

(Audio)
Blackmagic Studio Camera MENU
, .
, SET .

- Blackmagic Studio Camera.

315
(Automatic Gain Control)
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
.
.

(Audio Input)
XLR .

(Microphone Level)
.
. Studio Camera
. 1 2
.

Input Level
.
Line .
Mic Low Mic High .
. /
.

Ch 1 Input
1 .
1 .

Ch 2 Uses Ch 1 Input ( 1 2)
1 SDI 1 2
On . 1

. 1 2
2 Off.
Off .

Ch 2 Input
2 .
2 .

(Phantom Power)

. On/Off XLR
. Line input
level .
10 .
.

(Monitoring)
LCD MENU , .
, SET .

316
- Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K.

HDMI (HDMI Meters)


Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K HDMI
.

.
,
. , /
.
. HDMI On
.

(Audio)
/ .
, .
.
.
.

HDMI (HDMI Overlays)


Micro Studio Camera 4K . HDMI
[HDMI Meters]
.

(Brightness)
/ LCD . 60%.

(Zebra)
Blackmagic .
.
/ .
(Medium).

317
(Focus Peaking)
. (Off), (Low), (Medium),
(High) .
. (Medium).

(Tally Brightness)
. (Off), (Low), (Medium),
(High) . (Medium).

(Tally Brightness)
. (Low), (Medium), (High)
. (Medium).

(Tally Light Brightness)


Micro Studio Camera 4K . (Medium)
(High), (Low), (Off) .
(Off)
.

(Display Battery Percentage)


LP-E6
. Micro Studio Camera 4K
. ,
.

(Studio Settings)
MENU , LCD .
, SET .

- Blackmagic Studio Camera.

(Camera Number)
ATEM Studio Camera
. .
1~99 . 1.

318
, Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield SDI

. SDI Blackmagic 3G-SDI
ArduinoShield .
[Blackmagic3G-SDI Arduino Shield ] .

(Reference Source)
. Studio Camera SDI
. ,
.

(Reference Timing)
.

(Headset Level)
/ .
50%.

(Headset Mic Level)


/ .
50%.

(Program Mix)
. LCD
. ,
. .
0%.

(Remote Settings)
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K . S.Bus
, S.Bus
. , //SET
.

- Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K.

319
(Button Settings)

Blackmagic Studio Camera ,
.
. LCD ,
SDI .

FOCUS
Studio Camera , FOCUS
. FOCUS
. FOCUS .
, FOCUS .

Iris
Video , IRIS
. Film , IRIS
.
Studio Camera , / .

(Additional Settings)
(PTT)

. PTT .
. .

(PGM)
.
PGM
. SDI .

(LUT)
.

///
.

SET
.

(DISP)
Studio Camera 10 .
, , , , ,
, F .
DISP .
10 . SDI .

Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 Studio Camera 4K 2


.

320
MENU
OPTICAL OUT MENU .
OPTICAL IN


Blackmagic Studio Camera .
SDI OUT

SDI IN .

REF

12V

OPTICAL OUT OPTICAL OUT OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN OPTICAL IN OPTICAL IN

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT FOCUS IRIS SET PTT PGM LUT
DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRISSET PTT PGM DISPLAY
LUT MENU SET DISPLAY MENU
SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT

SDI IN SDI IN SDI IN

REF REF REF

12V 12V 12V

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU

FOCUS IRIS Studio Camera PTT


. , PGM
FOCUS /
.
. .



Blackmagic Studio Camera 10 4:2:2 SDI
. SFP
ATEM Camera Converter .
Blackmagic Studio Camera HD Studio Camera 4K , Studio Camera
SDI SFP (PGM)
.
Blackmagic Studio Camera
Tri-level . VTR,

.

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

OPTICAL OUT

SDI IN
OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

REF
SDI IN

REF

12V

12V

SDI SFP Studio Camera .

321

Studio Camera , SDI Blackmagic Hyperdeck Shuttle
SSD SDI . , Hyperdeck SDI Studio Camera
SDI LCD .
+12V POWER HDMI IN HDMI OUT SDI IN SDI OUT

+12V POWER HDMI IN HDMI OUT SDI IN SDI OUT

SDI Hyperdeck SDI Hyperdeck SDI


SDI .

Blackmagic3G-SDI Arduino Shield



SDI , Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino
Shield Blackmagic Studio Camera . , SDI
ATEM Blackmagic
.
, Blackmagic Shield D2~D9 , SDI
Blackmagic Mini Converter SDI Distribution Blackmagic
. 8 Blackmagic .
Blackmagic . ,
.
GND Arduino Shield .
Blackmagic Blackmagic
Arduino Shield .

Blackmagic
Arduino

1 1 D2

2 2 D3

3 3 D4

4 4 D5

5 5 D6

6 6 D7

7 7 D8

8 8 D9

Blackmagic3G-SDI Arduino Shield 322



Blackmagic Arduino Shield .
SDI Blackmagic 3G-SDI ArduinoShield
. Blackmagic Design (www.blackmagicdesign.com/
support) Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield .

1 2
SDI Blackmagic Arduino Shield
. .

Blackmagic3G-SDI Arduino Shield 323


1

PUSH
2

PUSH
Blackmagic Camera
Mac OS X
Blackmagic Camera Setup ,
.dmg . Blackmagic Camera Setup
.

1
PUSH

Blackmagic Camera Setup .


2
PUSH

Windows
Blackmagic Camera Setup Blackmagic
Camera Setup . ,
.
Windows [] [ ] . Blackmagic
Design Blackmagic Camera Setup .


Blackmagic Camera Setup , USB
. Mini-B USB 2.0 .
Blackmagic Camera Setup ,
.

Mini-B USB 2.0 .

Blackmagic Camera 324


Studio Camera LCD


.
1 Studio Camera 6 .
2
.


,
. , LANC
. Studio Camera 3/8
, 10 1/4 . ,
.

1
1
PUSH

3
2

2
1
PUSH

3
2

ATEM Software Control



ATEM Software Control Camera Control ATEM Blackmagic
Studio Camera . Camera Camera Control .
, , , DaVinci Resolve
.
ATEM SDI
. , ATEM SDI
SDI
. SDI SFP
.

ATEM Software Control 325


ATEM Camera Control.

SDI
1 Blacmagic Studio Camera SDI ATEM SDI .
2 ATEM SDI
Studio Camera SDI .
SDI .
3 Blackmagic Studio Camera MENU . Studio Settings>Camera
Number .
, Studio Camera 1 ATEM Cam 1 , 1
. .

IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 1 IN 3 1 1 3 1 REMOTE REMOTE
1 3 5 1 7 3 9 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH
STEREO IN

CONTROL CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 IN 2 2 HD 2 HD HD HD HD HD
1 2 4 1 6 2 8 4 10 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 REF IN
PREVIEW AUXPROGRAM
1-3 PREVIEW
OUTPUTS PROGRAM OUTPUTS
MULTI-VIEW MULTI-VIEW
ANALOG AUDIO IN

IN IN IN IN IN 1 3 1 REMOTE
All SDI and HDMI video connections are
1 3 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH SD, HD and Ultra HD switchable unless indicated

CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 2 HD HD HD
1 2 4 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2 CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 PREVIEW PROGRAM OUTPUTS MULTI-VIEW ANALOG AUDIO IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT

Blackmagic Studio Camera ATEM SDI .

ATEM Software Control 326



1 SFP Studio Camera / ATEM Studio Converter
/ .
2 ATEM Studio Converter SDI ATEM SDI .
3 ATEM SDI ATEM
Studio Converter SDI .
SDI .
4 Blackmagic Studio Camera MENU . Studio Settings>Camera
Number .
, 1 ATEM Cam 1 ,
1 . .
ATEM Software Control Preference
. Blackmagic Studio Camera

PGM .

AES/EBU TALKBACK LOOPS

3 1 4 2 OUT
3OUT OUT
4

L R

UT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT IN IN SDI OUT IN

L +12V
R BACKUP L L R R L L R R L R
POWER USB 2.0
OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN
OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG
ANALOG AUDIO OUTAUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO
OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG
OUT AUDIO OUT PGM SDI OPTICAL
MICOUT/IN H/PHONE ANALOG AUDIO OUT OP

AES/EBU TALKBACK LOOPS

1 2 3 4 OUT OUT OUT

L R

SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT IN IN IN

+12V BACKUP L R L R L R L R
POWER USB 2.0 OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT PGM SDI MIC H/PHONE

ATEM Studio Converter


Blackmagic Studio Camera .


ATEM Software Control .

. .
.


.

, .
,
.
.

ATEM Software Control 327



On Air ,
.
. On Air .

On Air
.
YRGB ,
, .

DaVinci Resolve YRGB , ,


.
.


YRGB ,
// .


Blackmagic Studio Camera Micro
Studio Camera, URSA Mini
.

/
Blackmagic [ ] [ ]
.
.
.

(Detail)
.
. , ( ), ,
.

ATEM Software Control 328



, Blackmagic
.



. .
/ .
.
, //
, , , .
, . ,
, , .
.
.


.
.

/
/ .
.

ATEM Software Control 329


/
.

/ . SHIFT
.
/ . Mac
COMMAND , Windows CONTROL
.


, /
. (T), (W)
. Coarse
,
.
SDI
.
Blackmagic Studio Camera Blackmagic Studio Camera 4K ,
MFT v1.9.11
.


Coarse / ,
. .
,
/ .
.


/
. .

ATEM Software Control 330



.
.
,
, .
.


/ .



.
/ .


.

. (db) / /
.
.
.
.


/ .
/ / .

.
.

(White Balance)
/
.
.
.

ATEM Software Control 331


, ,
.

DaVinci Resolve
CCU

.
Blackmagic Studio Camera DaVinci Resolve .
DaVinci Resolve , Blackmagic Studio Camera

.

.
, ,
.
.

DaVinci Resolve
.

// ,
. , , ,
, .

ATEM Software Control 332


// .

.
.
.
RGB .
Shift .

.
.
.
.
.

YRGB , ,
.

/ .

.
/ .
.
YRGB ALT Command
/ Y . YRGB
Y
. Lum Mix YRGB
Y RGB
. DaVinci Resolve YRGB
,
, .

ATEM Software Control 333


/ , , , .


.
. 50%.


. 50%.


. 180
.
.


Blackmagic Studio Camera DaVinci Resolve
. DaVinci Resolve 1980

.
Blackmagic Studio Camera
. YRGB .
RGB YRGB .
YRGB .
.
YRGB 100%
. RGB 100%
. / RGB YRGB .
' ? .

.


Blackmagic Studio Camera ATEM Camera Control
. Studio Camera , Camera Control
.

ATEM Software Control 334


Developer Information
Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol
Version 1.1
If you are a software developer you can use the SDI Camera Control Protocol to construct
devices that integrate with our products. Here at Blackmagic Design our approach is to open
up our protocols and we eagerly look forward to seeing what you come up with!

Overview
The Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol is used by ATEM switchers, Blackmagic 3G-SDI
Arduino Shield and Blackmagic Camera Remote to provide Camera Control functionality with
supported Blackmagic Design cameras. Please refer to the Understanding Studio Camera
Control chapter section of this manual, or the ATEM Switchers Manual and SDKmanual for
more information. These can be downloaded at www.blackmagicdesign.com/support.
This document describes an extensible protocol for sending a uni directional stream of small
control messages embedded in the non-active picture region of a digital video stream.
Thevideo stream containing the protocol stream may be broadcast to a number of devices.
Device addressing is used to allow the sender to specify which device each message is
directed to.

Assumptions
Alignment and padding constraints are explicitly described in the protocol document. Bit fields
are packed from LSB first. Message groups, individual messages and command headers are
defined as, and can be assumed to be, 32 bit aligned.

Blanking Encoding
A message group is encoded into a SMPTE 291M packet with DID/SDID x51/x53 in the active
region of VANC line 16.

Message Grouping
Up to 32 messages may be concatenated and transmitted in one blanking packet up to a
maximum of 255 bytes payload. Under most circumstances, this should allow all messages to
be sent with a maximum of one frame latency.
If the transmitting device queues more bytes of message packets than can be sent in a single
frame, it should use heuristics to determine which packets to prioritize and send immediately.
Lower priority messages can be delayed to later frames, or dropped entirely as appropriate.

Abstract Message Packet Format


Every message packet consists of a three byte header followed by an optional variable length
data block. The maximum packet size is 64 bytes.

Device addresses are represented as an 8 bit unsigned integer.


Destination device (uint8) Individual devices are numbered 0 through 254 with the value 255
reserved to indicate a broadcast message to all devices.

The command length is an 8 bit unsigned integer which specifies the


Command length (uint8) length of the included command data. The length does NOT include the
length of the header or any trailing padding bytes.

Developer Information 335


The command id is an 8 bit unsigned integer which indicates
themessage type being sent. Receiving devices should ignore any
Command id (uint8) commands that they do not understand. Commands 0 through 127 are
reserved for commands that apply to multiple types of devices.
Commands 128 through 255 are device specific.

This byte is reserved for alignment and expansion purposes. Itshould be


Reserved (uint8)
set to zero.

The command data may contain between 0 and 60 bytes of data.


Command data(uint8[])
The format of the data section is defined by the command itself.

Messages must be padded up to a 32 bit boundary with 0x0bytes.


Padding(uint8[])
Any padding bytes are NOT included in the command length.

Receiving devices should use the destination device address and or the command identifier to
determine which messages to process. The receiver should use the command length to skip
irrelevant or unknown commands and should be careful to skip the implicit padding as well.

Dened Commands
Command 0 : change configuration

The category number specifies one of up to 256 configuration categories


Category (uint8)
available on the device.

The parameter number specifies one of 256 potential configuration


parameters available on the device. Parameters 0 through 127 are device
Parameter (uint8)
specific parameters. Parameters 128 though 255 are reserved for
parameters that apply to multiple types of devices.

The data type specifies the type of the remaining data. Thepacket length
Data type (uint8) is used to determine the number of elements in the message. Each
message must contain an integral number of data elements.

Currently defined values are:

A void value is represented as a boolean array of length zero.


0: void / boolean The data field is a 8 bit value with 0 meaning false and all other values
meaning true.

1: signed byte Data elements are signed bytes

2: signed 16bit integer Data elements are signed 16 bit values

3: signed 32bit integer Data elements are signed 32 bit values

4: signed 64bit integer Data elements are signed 64 bit values

5: UTF-8 string Data elements represent a UTF-8 string with no terminating character.

Data types 6 through 127 are reserved.

Data elements are signed 16 bit integers representing a real number with
5 bits for the integer component and 11 bits for the fractional component.
128: signed 5.11fixed
The fixed point representation is equal to the real value multiplied by
point
2^11. The representable range is from -16.0 to 15.9995
(15 + 2047/2048).

Developer Information 336


Data types 129 through 255 are available for device specific purposes.

The operation type specifies what action to perform on the specified


Operation type (uint8)
parameter. Currently defined values are:

The supplied values are assigned to the specified parameter. Each


element will be clamped according to its valid range. A void parameter
0: assign value may only be assigned an empty list of boolean type. This operation will
trigger the action associated with that parameter. A boolean value may
be assigned the value zero for false, and any other value for true.

Each value specifies signed offsets of the same type to be added to the
current parameter values. The resulting parameter value will be clamped
1: offset / toggle value according to their valid range. It is not valid to apply an offset to a void
value. Applying any offset other than zero to a boolean value will invert
that value.

Operation types 2 through 127 are reserved.

Operation types 128through 255 are available for device specific purposes.

The data field is 0 or more bytes as determined by the data type and
Data (void)
number of elements.

The category, parameter, data type and operation type partition a 24 bit operation space.

Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

.0 Focus fixed16 0 1 0.0=near, 1.0=far

trigger
.1 Instantaneous autofocus void
instantaneous autofocus

Aperture Value (where


.2 Aperture (f-stop) fixed16 -1 16
fnumber = sqrt(2^AV))

.3 Aperture (normalised) fixed16 0 1 0.0=smallest, 1.0=largest

Steps through available


aperture values from
.4 Aperture (ordinal) int16 0 n
minimum (0) to
maximum (n)

Instantaneous trigger instantaneous


.5 void
Lens auto aperture auto aperture

Optical image true=enabled,


.6 boolean
stabilisation false=disabled

Move to specified focal


length in mm, from
.7 Set absolute zoom (mm) int16 0 max
minimum (0) to
maximum (max)

Set absolute zoom Move to specified focal


.8 fixed16 0 1
(normalised) length: 0.0=wide, 1.0=tele

Start/stop zooming at
Set continuous specified rate: -1.0=zoom
.9 fixed16 -1 +1.0
zoom (speed) wider fast, 0.0=stop,
+1=zoom tele fast

Developer Information 337


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

1
[0] = frame rate 24, 25, 30, 50, 60
[1] = M-rate 0=regular, 1=M-rate
0=NTSC, 1=PAL, 2=720,
[2] =
3=1080, 4=2k, 5=2k DCI,
dimensions
.0 Video mode int8 6=4k, 7=4k DCI
0=progressive,
[3] = interlaced
1=interlaced
[4] =
0=YUV
colour space
.1 Sensor Gain int8 1 16 1x, 2x, 4x, 8x, 16x gain
int16 color temp 2500 10000 Colour temperature in K
.2 Manual White Balance
int16 tint -50 50 tint
Calculate and set auto
.3 Set auto WB void
white balance
Use latest auto white
.4 Restore auto WB void
balance setting
.5 Exposure (us) int32 1 42000 time in us
Steps through
availableexposure
.6 Exposure (ordinal) int16 0 n
valuesfrom minimum (0)
tomaximum (n)
int8
.7 Dynamic Range Mode 0 1 0 = film, 1 = video
enum
Video int8
.8 Video sharpening level 0 3
enum
fps as integer
[0] = file
(eg 24, 25, 30,
frame rate
50, 60, 120)
fps as integer, valid when
sensor-off-speed set
[1] = sensor (eg 24,25, 30, 33, 48, 50,

frame rate 60, 120), no change will
beperformed if this
value is set to 0
[2] =
in pixels
.9 Recording format int16 frame width
[3] =
in pixels
frame height
[0]=file-M-rate
[1]=sensor-M-rate,
valid when sensor-
[4] = flags off-speed-set
[2]=sensor-off-speed
[3]=interlaced
[4]=windowed mode
0=Manual Trigger,
1=Iris,
Set auto
.10 int8 0 4 2=Shutter,
exposure mode
3=Iris + Shutter,
4=Shutter + Iris

Developer Information 338


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

2
0.0=minimum,
.0 Mic level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0.0=minimum,
.1 Headphone level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Headphone 0.0=minimum,
.2 fixed16 0 1
program mix 1.0=maximum
0.0=minimum,
.3 Speaker level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Audio
0=internal mic,
1=line level input,
.4 Input type int8 0 2
2=low mic level input,
3=high mic level input
0.0=minimum,
[0] ch0 0 1
1.0=maximum
.5 Input levels fixed16
0.0=minimum,
[1] ch1 0 1
1.0=maximum
true = powered,
.6 Phantom power boolean
false = not powered
3
bit flags: [0] = display
status, [1] = display
frame guides
uint16
.0 Overlay enables Some cameras don't
bit field
allow separate control of
frame guides and
status overlays.
0=off, 1=2.4:1, 2=2.39:1,
Frame guides style [0] = frame
.1 int8 0 8 3=2.35:1, 4=1.85:1, 5=16:9,
(Camera 3.x) guides style
Output 6=14:9, 7=4:3
Frame guides opacity [1] = frame 0.0=transparent,
.2 fixed16 0.1 1
(Camera 3.x) guide opacity 1.0=opaque
0=off, 1=2.4:1, 2=2.39:1,
[0] = frame
3=2.35:1, 4=1.85:1, 5=16:9,
guides style
6=14:9, 7=4:3
Overlays
(replaces .1 and .2 [1] = frame 0=transparent,
.3 int8 0 100
abovefrom guide opacity 100=opaque
Cameras 4.0)
percentage of full frame
[2] = safe area
0 100 used by safe area guide
percentage
(0 means off)
4
0.0=minimum,
.0 Brightness fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0x4 = zebra
Display int16
.1 Overlay enables 0x8 = peaking
bit field

0.0=minimum,
.2 Zebra level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

Developer Information 339


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation
0.0=minimum,
.3 Peaking level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0=disable bars,
Color bars display
.4 int8 0 30 1-30=enable bars with
time (seconds)
timeout (s)
[0] = focus 0=Peak,
Display
assist method 1=Colored lines
0=Red,
.5 Focus Assist int8 1=Green,
[1] = focus
2=Blue,
line color
3=White,
4=Black
5
Sets the tally front and
tally rear brightness to
.0 Tally brightness fixed16 0 1 the same level.
0.0=minimum,
1.0=maximum
Sets the tally front
Tally brightness.
.1 Front tally brightness fixed16 0 1
0.0=minimum,
1.0=maximum
Sets the tally rear
brightness.
0.0=minimum,
.2 Rear tally brightness fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Tally rear brightness
cannot be turned off
6
0=internal,
int8
Reference .0 Source 0 2 1=program,
enum
2=external
.1 Offset int32 +/- offset in pixels

7
[0] time _ _ BCD - HHMMSSFF (UCT)
.0 Real Time Clock int32
[1] date _ _ BCD - YYYYMMDD
ISO-639-1 two character
.1 System language string _ _ _
language code
.2 Timezone int32 _ _ _ Minutes offset from UTC
BCD -
s0DDdddddddddddd
Confi- where s is the sign:
guration [0] latitude _ _ 0=north (+), 1=south (-);
DD degrees,
dddddddddddd
decimal degrees
.3 Location int64
BCD -
sDDDdddddddddddd
where s is the sign:
[1] longitude _ _ 0=west (-), 1=east (+);
DDD degrees,
dddddddddddd
decimal degrees

Developer Information 340


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

8
[0] red -2 2 default 0.0
[1] green -2 2 default 0.0
.0 Lift Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -2 2 default 0.0
[3] luma -2 2 default 0.0
[0] red -4 4 default 0.0
[1] green -4 4 default 0.0
.1 Gamma Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -4 4 default 0.0
[3] luma -4 4 default 0.0
[0] red 0 16 default 1.0
[1] green 0 16 default 1.0
.2 Gain Adjust fixed16
Colour [2] blue 0 16 default 1.0
Correction [3] luma 0 16 default 1.0
[0] red -8 8 default 0.0
[1] green -8 8 default 0.0
.3 Offset Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -8 8 default 0.0
[3] luma -8 8 default 0.0
[0] pivot 0 1 default 0.5
.4 Contrast Adjust fixed16
[1] adj 0 2 default 1.0

.5 Luma mix fixed16 0 1 default 1.0

[0] hue -1 1 default 0.0


.6 Colour Adjust fixed16
[1] sat 0 2 default 1.0
Correction
.7 void reset to defaults
Reset Default
10
[0] = 0 = RAW, 1 = DNxHD,

basic codec 2 = ProRes
RAW: 0=Uncompressed,
int8
.0 Codec 1=lossy 3:1, 2=lossy 4:1
enum [1] =
codec variant ProRes: 0=HQ, 1=422,
2=LT, 3=Proxy,
4=444, 5=444XQ
0=Preview,
[0] = mode
1=Play, 2=Record
Media
-ve = multiple speeds
backwards, 0 = pause,
[1] = speed
+ve = multiple
speeds forwards
.1 Transport mode int8 1<<0=loop, 1<<1=play all,
1<<5=disk1 active,
[2] = flags 1<<6=disk2 active,
1<<7=time-
lapse recording
[3] = active
0=CFast card, 1=SD
storage medium

Developer Information 341


Example Protocol Packets

Packet
Operation Length Byte

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15

header command data


destination

parameter
command

operation
reserved

category
length

type
trigger instantaneous
8 4 4 0 0 0 1 0 0
auto focus on camera 4

turn on OIS on all cameras 12 255 5 0 0 0 6 0 0 1 0 0 0

set exposure to 10 ms on
camera 4 (10 ms = 10000 12 4 8 0 0 1 5 3 0 0x10 0x27 0x00 0x00
us = 0x00002710)

add 15% to zebra level


12 4 6 0 0 4 2 128 1 0x33 0x01 0 0
(15 % = 0.15 f = 0x0133 fp)

select 1080p 23.98 mode on


16 255 9 0 0 1 0 1 0 24 1 3 0 0 0 0 0
all cameras

subtract 0.3 from gamma


adjust for green & blue 16 4 12 0 0 8 1 128 1 0 0 0x9a 0xfd 0x9a 0xfd 0 0
(-0.3 ~= 0xfd9a fp)

all operations combined 76 4 4 0 0 0 1 0 0 255 5 0 0 0 6 0 0

1 0 0 0 4 8 0 0 1 5 3 0 0x10 0x27 0x00 0x00

4 6 0 0 4 2 128 1 0x33 0x01 0 0 255 9 0 0

1 0 1 0 24 1 3 0 0 0 0 0 4 12 0 0

8 1 128 1 0 0 0x9a 0xfd 0x9a 0xfd 0 0

Developer Information 342


Blackmagic Embedded TallyControl Protocol
Version 1.0 (30/04/14)
This section is for third party developers or anybody who may wish to add support for the
Blackmagic Embedded Tally Control Protocol to their products or system. It describes the
protocol for sending tally information embedded in the non-active picture region of a digital
video stream.

Data Flow
A master device such as a broadcast switcher embeds tally information into its program feed
which is broadcast to a number of slave devices such as cameras or camera controllers. The
output from the slave devices is typically fed back to the master device, but may also be sent
to a video monitor.
The primary flow of tally information is from the master device to the slaves. Each slave device
may use its device id to extract and display the relevant tally information.
Slave devices pass through the tally packet on their output and update the monitor tally status,
so that monitor devices connected to that individual output may display tally status without
knowledge of the device id they are monitoring.

Assumptions
Any data alignment / padding is explicit in the protocol. Bit fields are packed from LSB first.

Blanking Encoding
One tally control packet may be sent per video frame. Packets are encoded as a SMPTE 291M
packet with DID/SDID x51/x52 in the active region of VANC line 15. A tally control packet may
contain up to 256 bytes of tally information.

Packet Format
Each tally status consists of 4 bits of information:
uint4
bit 0: program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0x0)
The first byte of the tally packet contains the monitor device tally status and a version number.
Subsequent bytes of the tally packet contain tally status for pairs of slave devices. The master
device sends tally status for the number of devices configured/supported, up to a
maximum of 510.

struct tally
uint8
bit 0: monitor device program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: monitor device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4-7: protocol version (0b0000)

Developer Information 343


uint8[0]
bit 0: slave device 1 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: slave device 1 device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4: slave device 2 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 5: slave device 2 preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 6-7: reserved (0b00)
uint8[1]
bit 0: slave device 3 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: slave device 3 device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4: slave device 4 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 5: slave device 4 preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 6-7: reserved (0b00)
...

Slave Device
(1)

Master Device Slave Device


(2)

Slave Device
Monitor Device
(3)

Byte 7 MSB 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LSB

Version Version Version Version Reserved Reserved Monitor Monitor


0
(0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

Reserved Reserved Slave 1 Slave 1 Reserved Reserved Slave 0 Slave 0


1
(0b0) (0b0) Preview Program (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

Reserved Reserved Slave 3 Slave 3 Reserved Reserved Slave 2 Slave 2


2
(0b0) (0b0) Preview Program (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

3 ...

Developer Information 344




Blackmagic Design
.

Blackmagic Design
, Blackmagic
(www.blackmagicdesign.com/kr/support) .

Blackmagic Design
[ ]
. ,
[ ] Blackmagic Design
.


Blackmagic Camera Setup [About Blackmagic
Camera Setup] .
Mac OS X [Blackmagic Camera Setup]
. [About Blackmagic Camera Setup]
.
Windows Blackmagic Camera Setup
. [About Blackmagic Camera Setup]
.

Blackmagic Camera Setup , Blackmagic Design
(www.blackmagicdesign.com/kr/support)
. ,
.


Studio Camera .
Blackmagic Design .
,
. Blackmagic Design
, .

Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 Studio Camera 4K 2


.

345

12
Blackmagic Design 12
. , Blackmagic Design
.
Blackmagic Design
. Blackmagic Design
, .
, , , ,
.
, , , .
Blackmagic Design . a) Blackmagic
Design . b)
. c) Blackmagic Design
. d)
. BLACKMAGIC DESIGN
. BLACKMAGIC DESIGN
.
BLACKMAGIC DESIGN BLACKMAGIC DESIGN
, ,
, . BLACKMAGIC DESIGN
. BLACKMAGIC
.
.
Copyright 2017 Blackmagic Design. . Blackmagic Design, DeckLink, HDLink, Workgroup Videohub,
Multibridge Pro, Multibridge Extreme, Intensity, Leading the creative video revolution
. .

346

Blackmagic
2017 .

!
Blackmagic Studio Camera.

Blackmagic Studio Camera Micro Studio Camera 4K


, .


, .
, .

Blackmagic Studio Camera .


,
. Blackmagic Studio Camera
,
.

,
MFT. Blackmagic Studio Camera
.
, SFP,
.
HyperDeck Shuttle.

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K Blackmagic Studio Camera


. Ultra HD-
, .

.

, .
!

Grant Petty
Blackmagic Design

Blackmagic

341 358
341 Studio 360
341 Remote 361
342 362

345 363
Blackmagic Studio Camera 345 363
Blackmagic Micro 364
Studio Camera 4K 347 Tally-
349
Blackmagic3G-SDI Arduino Shield 364
Blackmagic Studio Camera
349 Blackmagic Camera Setup 366
Blackmagic Studio Camera
367
350
367
Blackmagic Micro Studio
Camera 4K 351 367
Blackmagic Micro Studio ATEM Software Control 367
Camera 4K 352
367
353
369
DaVinci Resolve Primary Color Corrector 374
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K 353
Developer Information 377

Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol 377
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K 354 Blackmagic Embedded
TallyControl Protocol 385
355
Camera 355 387

AUDIO 357 388




Blackmagic Studio Camera Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
. ,
.
.

1 . ,
.
2 .
3 , ,
12 ,
.
, ,
.

1 1
1

1
PUSH

PUSH
3

3
2

2 2
1

1
PUSH

PUSH
3

3
2

(Studio Camera)

(Micro Studio Camera 4K)


1 -. Blackmagic Studio Camera Studio Camera
4K .
2 , .

. Blackmagic Studio Camera HD Studio Camera 4K


, .
,
.
. Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 Studio
Camera 4K 2 .

341
Micro Studio Camera 4K LP-E6 LP-E6N,
.
.
.
Micro Studio Camera 4K.
1 .
.
2 , .
.
ATEMConverter, .

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN

SDI IN

REF

REF

12V

12V

Studio Camera,


ATEM SDI- Blackmagic Studio
Camera Micro Studio Camera 4K,
.

SDI
1 SDI- (Out) Blackmagic Studio Camera Micro Studio Camera 4K
SDI- (In) ATEM.
2 SDI- ATEM ( ,
) SDI- .
SDI-
.

. SFP- Blackmagic
Studio Camera ATEM
. 45 .
ATEM ATEM Studio Converter
ATEM Talkback Converter 4K. .
ATEM Converter.

342
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 1 IN 3 1 1 3 1 REMOTE REMOTE
1 3 5 1 7 3 9 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH
STEREO IN

CONTROL CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 IN 2 2 HD 2 HD HD HD HD HD
1 2 4 1 6 2 8 4 10 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 REF IN
PREVIEW AUXPROGRAM
1-3 PREVIEW
OUTPUTS PROGRAM OUTPUTS
MULTI-VIEW MULTI-VIEW
ANALOG AUDIO IN

IN IN IN IN IN 1 3 1 REMOTE
All SDI and HDMI video connections are
1 3 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH SD, HD and Ultra HD switchable unless indicated

CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 2 HD HD HD
1 2 4 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2 CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 PREVIEW PROGRAM OUTPUTS MULTI-VIEW ANALOG AUDIO IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT

ATEM, SDI- SDI-


. , SDI-
ATEM ( ,
) SDI- .
.

Tally-
ATEM Software Control Preferences ,
.

1 ATEM Software Control Preferences.
2 Mapping ,
. , Studio Camera 1 ,
Button 1 Input 1: Camera 1.
3 MENU Blackmagic Studio Camera. Studio Settings>Camera Number
. ,
Studio Camera 1 Cam 1 ATEM, Camera Number
1.
.

. PGM
Blackmagic Studio Camera,
ATEM. ,
.
Camera 1 . Studio Camera
. , ,
.


ATEM Software Control Blackmagic Studio
ATEM.
ATEM Software Control Camera
, .
,
. Camera 1 Cam 1. ,
On Air.
Cam 1 ,
. .
ATEM Software Control.

343

, Blackmagic Studio Camera
, Blackmagic HyperDeck Studio.
, HyperDeck Shuttle Blackmagic Video
Assist .
! Blackmagic Studio Camera ,
.
.

344

Blackmagic Studio Camera

1
, . .
.

2
3

4
1

PUSH
5 2

PUSH


2 LANC
2,5 ,
LANC.
3
TRS 0,25
.
4
TRS 0,206
.
5
XLR 1/4 .
. Blackmagic Studio Camera .

345

6 OPTICAL IN/OUT
45
SFP.
7 SDI OUT
SDI .
8 SDI IN
SDI (PGM).
9 REF
c blackburst tri-level.
10
1224
( ).
. Blackmagic Studio Camera .

12
11

6 OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

7 SDI OUT

8 SDI IN

9 REF

13 14 15 16 17 18 19 18 20 21 22 10 12V

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU


11 10- -
,
. . .
12
. , .
13 FOCUS

-.
14 IRIS
.
15 PTT
.
. .
16 PGM
PGM
.
17 LUT
.

346
12V

18 REF

-.
SDI IN

19 SET
SDI OUT

.
OPTICAL IN

20 DISPLAY
OPTICAL OUT

.
21 MENU
-.
22
, Blackmagic Studio Camera. ,
.
. .


23 USB
USB Mini-B . . "Blackmagic Camera Setup".

23

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K



1
, ,
. .
.
.
.
.
Micro Studio Camera 4K
. . Camera

1 2 4
5
6
7
3
PUSH

2 8
PUSH

347

2 HDMI
HDMI , Blackmagic Video
Assist, .
1080HD.
, . .
.
3
DB-HD15.
, . .
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K.
4 MENU
HDMI-.
5
.
6
.
7 SET
.
8
, Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K.
, .


9
3,5 .
10 SDI OUT
SDI , .
11 SDI IN
SDI Blackmagic 3G-SDI
Arduino Shield.
12
3,5 iPhone- Android-
. /
, .

10
13
11

12

348

13
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K LP-E6,
.
.


14
, .


15 USB
USB . . "Blackmagic Camera Setup".

14

15


Blackmagic Studio Camera
LANC
LANC , ,
.
2,5 LANC.
MFT
. :
Panasonic Lumix G X Vario PZ 14-42mm f/3.5-5.6 Power O.I.S.
Panasonic Lumix G X Vario PZ 45-175mm f/4.0-5.6 Zoom O.I.S.
Olympus M.Zuiko Digital ED 12-50mm f/3.5-6.3 EZ Micro 4/3
Olympus M.Zuiko Digital ED 14-42mm f/3.5-5.6 EZ Micro 4/3



. ,

. 15 16 SDI-
. , .

349

.
15 16 SDI-.

XLR
. ,
.
. . SDI-
1 2.

1
1
PUSH

3
2

2
1
PUSH

3
2

Blackmagic Studio Camera


/
SFP-.
LC 3G-SDI Studio Camera
HD 6G-SDI Studio Camera 4K.
. , 45 ,
. SDI- ,
, . SFP
Blackmagic Studio Camera, Blackmagic Design.
- www.blackmagicdesign.com/ru/resellers.

SDI OUT
SDI 10- 4:2:2 SDI-,
, , . Blackmagic Studio
Camera HD 3G-SDI, Studio Camera 4K 12G-SDI.

SDI IN
SDI (PGM).
PGM
.
SDI- ,
, . Studio Camera
, Blackmagic Hyperdeck Shuttle, Hyperdeck
SDI, .

350

blackburst
tri-level. ,
.

1224
Blackmagic Studio Camera HD Blackmagic Studio Camera 4K. Studio Camera
HD , Studio Camera 4K .
Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 Studio Camera 4K 2 .

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

SDI IN

REF

12V

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K


HDMI
HDMI Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K 10- 1080p
4:2:2, . ,
HDMI-
HD-, Blackmagic Video Assist.
HDMI- . ,
2160p/30 HDMI-
1080p/30.

MENU
EXPANSION

SET

351

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
. ,
.
.
Micro Studio Camera 4K SDI-
(. ).
.
DB-HD15 Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
, LANC ,
.
.
. Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K.

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K



3,5 .
Audio. ,
.

SDI OUT
SDI 10- 4:2:2 SDI-,
, , . Blackmagic Micro
Studio Camera 4K 6G-SDI. SDI-
DIN 1.0/2.3.

SDI IN
SDI Micro Studio Camera 4K .
. .

. Micro Studio Camera


Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield. SDI-
, ATEM. ,
,
ATEM , SDI-.

352

3,5 iPhone- Android-
. /
. 15 16
SDI-.



Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
. ,
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K, .
.

4 Micro Studio Cam MSC Breakout Cable Micro Studio Cam MSC Breakout Cable

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

1
12 Micro Studio Camera 4K
.
.
2
blackburst
tri-level. ,
.
3 LANC
2,5 LANC- .
,
.
4 , ,
RS-422 SDI-,
Micro Studio Camera 4K.

353
5 B4-
DB-9 4,
Micro Studio Camera 4K MFT/B4.
, DB-9
B4 Control Adapter Cable.
, , MFT-
Camera Control
Micro Studio Camera 4K. B4-
- Blackmagic Design www.blackmagicdesign.com/support/
faq/59011.
6 S.Bus
18 ,
S.Bus- Futaba J.
, , .
S.Bus . Remote.


Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
, 4,
12 . ,
.

. .
1, . 2-7.

P1 PIN ASSIGNMENT
2 S. Bus 1
2 P2
GROUND 3

GROUND 1
12 PTZ RS422 Rx- 2
8 PTZ RS422 Tx+ 3 5
9
GROUND 4 4

GROUND
5
6
3
2
8
7 P3
6
13 PTZ RS422 Rx+ 7 1

3 PTZ RS422 Tx- 8


GROUND 9

5 15
GROUND 1
10 14 B4 Lens Control Transmit 2 5
9
4 14 4
15 B4 Lens Control Receive 3
P4
9 8
3 13 3
8 GROUND 4 2
7
2
7
12 6 Power +12V in* 5 1
6
1 11 OTHER
6

5 Reference Input CENTER


GROUND SLEEVE P5
1 Ground 6 Power +12V in 11 Ground LANC Data
9 TIP
2
3
S. Bus
PTZ RS422 Tx-
7
8
Ground
PTZ RS422 Tx+
12
13
PTZ RS422 Rx-
PTZ RS422 Rx+
10
GROUND
LANC Power RING
SLEEVE
P6
4 Ground 9 LANC Data 14 B4 Lens Control Transmit
5 Reference Input 10 LANC Power 15 B4 Lens Control Receive
6 Power +12V in PIN
GROUND SLEEVE P7

* Power input to the camera is also used to power the lens. Beware of applying excessive voltages if youre using
your own power supply to avoid damage to the lens.

354

Blackmagic , ,
, ,
.
.

Camera
Blackmagic Studio Camera Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
MENU. , ,
SET.
Micro Studio Camera 4K
HDMI .


. ,
1080p 1080i .
SET.
.
Gain
.
0 , 18 6 .
Detail
.
, : Off (.),
Default (.), Medium (.) High (.).

Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
.
Iris

.
Shutter

.

355
Camera Blackmagic Studio Camera
Iris + Shutter
.

, Micro Studio Camera 4K .

Shutter + Iris
.
,
Micro Studio Camera 4K .

Manual Trigger
,
.

White Balance ( )
18
.
2500, 2800, 3000, 3200, 3400, 3600, 4000, 4500 4800K
, ,
, , ,
;
5000, 5200, 5400 5600K ;
6000, 6500, 7000, 7500 8000K
.

Shutter Speed ( )
, ,
Gain. 15 1/50 1/2000 .

Camera Blackmagic
Micro Studio Camera 4K

, Blackmagic Studio Camera

Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Micro Studio


Camera Camera 4K Camera 4K

720p/50 720p/50 1080i/50

720p/59,94 720p/59,94 1080i/59,94

720p/60 720p/60 1080i/60

1080i/50 1080i/50 1080p/23,98


356
Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Studio Blackmagic Micro Studio
Camera Camera 4K Camera 4K

1080i/59,94 1080i/59,94 1080p/24

1080i/60 1080i/60 1080p/25

1080p/23,98 1080p/23,98 1080p/29,97

1080p/24 1080p/24 1080p/30

1080p/25 1080p/25 1080p/50

1080p/29,97 1080p/29,97 1080p/59,94

1080p/30 1080p/30 1080p/60

1080p/50 1080p/50 2160p/23,98

1080p/59,94 1080p/59,94 2160p/24

1080p/60 1080p/60 2160p/25

2160p/23,98 2160p/29,97

2160p/24 2160p/30

2160p/25

2160p/29,97

2160p/30

2160p/50

2160p/59,94

2160p/60

AUDIO
Blackmagic Studio Camera,
MENU .
,
SET.

Audio Blackmagic Studio Camera

357
Automatic Gain Control
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
. , ,
.

Audio Input
XLR.

Microphone Level ( )
.
. Studio
Camera . ,
1 2.

Input Level ( )

. , ,
Line.
Mic Low Mic High. ,
. .

Ch 1 Input ( 1)
1 .
1,
.

Ch 2 Uses Ch 1 Input ( 1 2)
, , 1,
1 2 SDI- .
, ,
. ,
.

Ch 2 Input ( 2)
2 .
2,
.

Phantom Power ( )

. XLR-, Audio
On (.) Off (.). Line
Input Level . Phantom
Power 10
. .


-, MENU
. ,
SET.

358
Monitoring
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

HDMI Meters
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
HDMI-.

.
, .
.
. ,
.
HDMI Overlays On.

Audio

. , .
. ,
.
. ,
.
HDMI Overlays On.

HDMI Overlays
Micro Studio Camera 4K. On,
HDMI- , ,
, HDMI Meters.

Brightness
- .
60%.

Zebra ()
Blackmagic Zebra, .
, , .
.
.

359
Focus Peaking ( )
.
: Off (.), Low (.), Medium (.) High (.).
, .
.

Front Tally Brightness ( )


. : Off (.),
Low(.), Medium (.) High (.). .

Rear Tally Brightness ( )


. : Low (.),
Medium (.) High (.). .

Tally Light Brightness ( )


Tally- Micro Studio Camera 4K.
,
.
Off (.) , .

Display Battery Percentage


LP-E6
. , Micro Studio Camera 4K
. ,
, .

Studio
, MENU
. ,
SET.

Studio Blackmagic Studio Camera

Camera Number ( )
ATEM Studio Camera,
.
. 1 99. 1.

360
.
Tally-, Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino
Shield. SDI-, ,
Blackmagic 3G-SDI ArduinoShield.
. Tally-
Blackmagic3G-SDI Arduino Shield.

Reference Source ( )
. Studio Camera
SDI .
,
- .

Reference Timing ( )
.

Headset Level ( )
.
50%.

Headset Mic Level ( )



. 50%.

Program Mix
.
, -. ,
.
, .
0%.

Remote
Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K
. S.Bus S.Bus
, .
, , SET.

Remote Blackmagic Micro Studio Camera 4K

361


Blackmagic Studio Camera ,
.
, .
- SDI-.

Focus
Studio Camera , FOCUS
.
FOCUS.
FOCUS.
,
FOCUS .

IRIS

. IRIS
. ,
.


PTT

. .
. .

PGM
,
.
.
SDI- .

LUT
.

, , ,
.

SET
.

DISPLAY
, 10- :
, ,
, , , , ,
.
, DISP .
10- SDI-.

. Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 Studio Camera 4K 2


, .

362
MENU
OPTICAL OUT
.
OPTICAL IN


SDI OUT

, Blackmagic Studio Camera. ,


SDI IN .

REF

12V

OPTICAL OUT OPTICAL OUT OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN OPTICAL IN OPTICAL IN

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT FOCUS IRIS SET PTT PGM LUT
DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRISSET PTT PGM DISPLAY
LUT MENU SET DISPLAY MENU
SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT

SDI IN SDI IN SDI IN

REF REF REF

12V 12V 12V

FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU FOCUS IRIS PTT PGM LUT SET DISPLAY MENU

IRIS Studio Camera


, PTT PGM,
FOCUS. /



FOCUS.



Blackmagic Studio Camera 10- 4:2:2 ,
SDI-.
SFP ,
ATEM Camera Converter.
Blackmagic Studio Camera HD Studio Camera 4K
SDI- ,
SFP.
Blackmagic Studio Camera
blackburst tri-level. ,
,
.

OPTICAL OUT

OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

OPTICAL OUT

SDI IN
OPTICAL IN

SDI OUT

REF
SDI IN

REF

12V

12V

Studio Camera ,
SDI- SFP

363

Studio Camera,
SDI- Blackmagic HyperDeck Shuttle.
SDI- Studio Camera, - .

+12V POWER HDMI IN HDMI OUT SDI IN SDI OUT

+12V POWER HDMI IN HDMI OUT SDI IN SDI OUT

SDI-
SDI- HyperDeck

Tally-
Blackmagic3G-SDI
Arduino Shield
ATEM, SDI-, Blackmagic Studio Camera
.
, Tally- Blackmagic 3G-SDI
Arduino Shield.
Tally- D2-D9 Blackmagic,
SDI- Blackmagic -,
Blackmagic Mini Converter SDI Distribution.
.
Blackmagic Tally- .
. GND
GND Arduino.
, Blackmagic Tally-
Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield.


Blackmagic Arduino

1 1 D2

2 2 D3

3 3 D4

4 4 D5

5 5 D6

6 6 D7

7 7 D8

8 8 D9

Tally- Blackmagic3G-SDI Arduino Shield 364


, Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino Shield
Tally- , . SDI-
, ,
Blackmagic 3G-SDI ArduinoShield. ,
-
www.blackmagicdesign.com/support.

, Blackmagic 3G-SDI ArduinoShield


Tally- 1 2 SDI-.
.

Tally- Blackmagic3G-SDI Arduino Shield 365


1

PUSH
2

PUSHBlackmagic Camera Setup


Mac OS X
Blackmagic Camera Setup
.dmg. Blackmagic Camera Setup
.

1
PUSH

Blackmagic Camera Setup


2
PUSH

Windows
Blackmagic Camera Setup
Blackmagic Camera Setup.
.
.
Blackmagic
Blackmagic Design.


Blackmagic Camera Setup
USB. Mini-B USB 2.0 .
Blackmagic Camera Setup
.

Mini-B USB 2.0

Blackmagic Camera Setup 366




Studio
- .
1 , Studio Camera.
2 ,
.



.
, LANC- .
3/8 1/4
.
.

1
1
PUSH

3
2

2
1
PUSH

3
2

ATEM Software Control



ATEM Software Control Blackmagic Studio
ATEM. , Camera.
, ,
,
DaVinci Resolve Primary Color Corrector.
SDI-
, . SDI-
ATEM ,
.
SDI-, SFP .

ATEM Software Control 367


Camera ATEM Software Control

SDI
1 SDI- Blackmagic Studio Camera SDI- .
2 SDI- ATEM ( ,
) SDI- . SDI-

.
3 MENU Blackmagic Studio Camera. Studio Settings>Camera Number
. ,
Studio Camera 1 Cam 1 ATEM, Camera Number
1.
.

IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 1 IN 3 1 1 3 1 REMOTE REMOTE
1 3 5 1 7 3 9 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH
STEREO IN

CONTROL CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 IN 2 2 HD 2 HD HD HD HD HD
1 2 4 1 6 2 8 4 10 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 REF IN
PREVIEW AUXPROGRAM
1-3 PREVIEW
OUTPUTS PROGRAM OUTPUTS
MULTI-VIEW MULTI-VIEW
ANALOG AUDIO IN

IN IN IN IN IN 1 3 1 REMOTE
All SDI and HDMI video connections are
1 3 5 7 9 STEREO IN PUSH PUSH SD, HD and Ultra HD switchable unless indicated

CONTROL
IN IN IN IN IN IN 2 2 HD HD HD
1 2 4 6 8 10

CH 1 CH 2 CH 1 CH 2
USB 2.0 HDMI IN
SDI INPUTS REF IN AUX 1-3 PREVIEW PROGRAM OUTPUTS MULTI-VIEW ANALOG AUDIO IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT

Blackmagic Studio Camera SDI- ATEM

ATEM Software Control 368



1 SFP,
Optical Out/In Optical Out/In ATEM Studio Converter.
2 SDI- ATEM Studio Converter SDI In
ATEM.
3 SDI- ATEM ( ,
) SDI- (In) ATEM Studio
Converter. SDI-
.
4 MENU Blackmagic Studio Camera. Studio Settings>Camera Number
. ,
Studio Camera 1 Cam 1 ATEM, Camera Number
1.
.
ATEM Software Control Preferences ,
. Blackmagic
Studio Camera
PGM .

AES/EBU TALKBACK LOOPS

3 1 4 2 OUT
3OUT OUT
4

L R

UT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT IN IN SDI OUT IN

L +12V
R BACKUP L L R R L L R R L R
POWER USB 2.0
OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN
OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG
ANALOG AUDIO OUTAUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO
OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG
OUT AUDIO OUT PGM SDI OPTICAL
MICOUT/IN H/PHONE ANALOG AUDIO OUT OP

AES/EBU TALKBACK LOOPS

1 2 3 4 OUT OUT OUT

L R

SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT SDI OUT IN IN IN

+12V BACKUP L R L R L R L R
POWER USB 2.0 OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT OPTICAL OUT/IN ANALOG AUDIO OUT PGM SDI MIC H/PHONE

Blackmagic Studio
ATEM Studio Converter


ATEM Software Control Camera
. ,
.
.


, .
,
.
, . AUX
.

ATEM Software Control 369



,
On Air .
, .
On Air.


,
, .

,
,
YRGB-.


DaVinci Resolve.
, ,
YRGB. ,
.



YRGB : ,
.

Camera
.
Blackmagic Studio Camera, Micro Studio Camera URSA
Mini, .

/
Blackmagic ,
Show () Hide ().
,
.

Detail
.
, : Off (.), Default (.),
Medium (.) High (.).

ATEM Software Control 370



,
Blackmagic



, , .
. ,
/ . Paste ()
.
, ,
,
Contrast, Hue, Saturation Lum Mix.
,
. Paste () , ,
Coarse . Paste to all ( ) ,
.
, .

Paste to all ( ) ,
.

, .

/
/
. , .

ATEM Software Control 371


,
/

, .
Shift, .
,
. Command ( Mac) Control ( Windows),
.



Zoom Control. , ,
.
Coarse , , , .

SDI-, .
Blackmagic Studio Camera Blackmagic Studio Camera 4K MFT-
1.9.11 .

Coarse
Coarse /
.
.
Coarse,
, Coarse
. Coarse
.


/
. Coarse.

ATEM Software Control 372



.
,
. ,
,
.
.


,
.
.


.
,
, .
dB.
,
. , .



/ . ,
, .
.
, ,
. ,
,
.

White Balance ( )
,
( ).

.

ATEM Software Control 373


,
,
,

DaVinci Resolve Primary Color Corrector


, ,
.
Blackmagic Studio Camera DaVinci Resolve.
, DaVinci Resolve, Blackmagic
Studio Camera .

.
, ,
, .
, .

DaVinci Resolve Primary Color Corrector,



Lift/Gamma/Gain
. ,
.

ATEM Software Control 374


,


.
, .
RGB ,
.
Shift .
, ,
.
.
.
Reset, .
.


, , ,
YRGB.


.
,
. YRGB
. (Y)
ALT Command.
YRGB,
. ,
Lum Mix .
YRGB, RGB.
, ,
.
, .

ATEM Software Control 375


Contrast, Saturation, Hue Lum
Mix

Contrast

. ,
Lift Gain, .
50%.

Saturation
.
50%.

Hue
Hue .
180 , .

.

Lum Mix
Blackmagic Studio Camera DaVinci
Resolve. DaVinci 80- . ,
.
Blackmagic Studio Camera
. YRGB.
RGB YRGB.
YRGB,
.
Lum Mix , 100%
YRGB. Lum Mix , 100%
RGB. Lum Mix
, RGB YRGB.
,
.


ATEM Blackmagic
Studio Camera. - ,
.

ATEM Software Control 376


Developer Information
Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol
Version 1.1
If you are a software developer you can use the SDI Camera Control Protocol to construct devices that
integrate with our products. Here at Blackmagic Design our approach is to open up our protocols and
we eagerly look forward to seeing what you come up with!

Overview
The Blackmagic SDI Camera Control Protocol is used by ATEM switchers, Blackmagic 3G-SDI Arduino
Shield and Blackmagic Camera Remote to provide Camera Control functionality with supported
Blackmagic Design cameras. Please refer to the Understanding Studio Camera Control chapter
section of this manual, or the ATEM Switchers Manual and SDKmanual for more information. These
can be downloaded at www.blackmagicdesign.com/support.
This document describes an extensible protocol for sending a uni directional stream of small control
messages embedded in the non-active picture region of a digital video stream. Thevideo stream
containing the protocol stream may be broadcast to a number of devices. Device addressing is used
to allow the sender to specify which device each message is directed to.

Assumptions
Alignment and padding constraints are explicitly described in the protocol document. Bit fields are
packed from LSB first. Message groups, individual messages and command headers are defined as,
and can be assumed to be, 32 bit aligned.

Blanking Encoding
A message group is encoded into a SMPTE 291M packet with DID/SDID x51/x53 in the active region of
VANC line 16.

Message Grouping
Up to 32 messages may be concatenated and transmitted in one blanking packet up to a maximum of
255 bytes payload. Under most circumstances, this should allow all messages to be sent with a
maximum of one frame latency.
If the transmitting device queues more bytes of message packets than can be sent in a single frame,
itshould use heuristics to determine which packets to prioritize and send immediately. Lower priority
messages can be delayed to later frames, or dropped entirely as appropriate.

Abstract Message Packet Format


Every message packet consists of a three byte header followed by an optional variable length data
block. The maximum packet size is 64 bytes.

Device addresses are represented as an 8 bit unsigned integer. Individual


Destination device (uint8) devices are numbered 0 through 254 with the value 255 reserved to
indicate a broadcast message to all devices.

The command length is an 8 bit unsigned integer which specifies the


Command length (uint8) length of the included command data. The length does NOT include the
length of the header or any trailing padding bytes.

Developer Information 377


The command id is an 8 bit unsigned integer which indicates themessage
type being sent. Receiving devices should ignore any commands that they
Command id (uint8) do not understand. Commands 0 through 127 are reserved for commands
that apply to multiple types of devices. Commands 128 through 255 are
device specific.

This byte is reserved for alignment and expansion purposes. Itshould be


Reserved (uint8)
set to zero.

The command data may contain between 0 and 60 bytes of data.


Command data(uint8[])
The format of the data section is defined by the command itself.

Messages must be padded up to a 32 bit boundary with 0x0bytes.


Padding(uint8[])
Any padding bytes are NOT included in the command length.

Receiving devices should use the destination device address and or the command identifier to
determine which messages to process. The receiver should use the command length to skip
irrelevant or unknown commands and should be careful to skip the implicit padding as well.

Defined Commands
Command 0 : change configuration

The category number specifies one of up to 256 configuration categories


Category (uint8)
available on the device.

The parameter number specifies one of 256 potential configuration


parameters available on the device. Parameters 0 through 127 are device
Parameter (uint8)
specific parameters. Parameters 128 though 255 are reserved for
parameters that apply to multiple types of devices.

The data type specifies the type of the remaining data. Thepacket length is
Data type (uint8) used to determine the number of elements in the message. Each message
must contain an integral number of data elements.

Currently defined values are:

A void value is represented as a boolean array of length zero.


0: void / boolean The data field is a 8 bit value with 0 meaning false and all other values
meaning true.

1: signed byte Data elements are signed bytes

2: signed 16bit integer Data elements are signed 16 bit values

3: signed 32bit integer Data elements are signed 32 bit values

4: signed 64bit integer Data elements are signed 64 bit values

5: UTF-8 string Data elements represent a UTF-8 string with no terminating character.

Data types 6 through 127 are reserved.

Data elements are signed 16 bit integers representing a real number with 5
bits for the integer component and 11 bits for the fractional component. The
128: signed 5.11fixed point
fixed point representation is equal to the real value multiplied by 2^11. The
representable range is from -16.0 to 15.9995 (15 + 2047/2048).

Developer Information 378


Data types 129 through 255 are available for device specific purposes.

The operation type specifies what action to perform on the specified


Operation type (uint8)
parameter. Currently defined values are:

The supplied values are assigned to the specified parameter. Each element
will be clamped according to its valid range. A void parameter may only be
0: assign value assigned an empty list of boolean type. This operation will trigger the
action associated with that parameter. A boolean value may be assigned
the value zero for false, and any other value for true.

Each value specifies signed offsets of the same type to be added to the
current parameter values. The resulting parameter value will be clamped
1: offset / toggle value according to their valid range. It is not valid to apply an offset to a void
value. Applying any offset other than zero to a boolean value will invert
that value.

Operation types 2 through 127 are reserved.

Operation types 128through 255 are available for device specific purposes.

The data field is 0 or more bytes as determined by the data type and
Data (void)
number of elements.

The category, parameter, data type and operation type partition a 24 bit operation space.

Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

.0 Focus fixed16 0 1 0.0=near, 1.0=far

trigger
.1 Instantaneous autofocus void
instantaneous autofocus

Aperture Value (where


.2 Aperture (f-stop) fixed16 -1 16
fnumber = sqrt(2^AV))

.3 Aperture (normalised) fixed16 0 1 0.0=smallest, 1.0=largest

Steps through available


aperture values from
.4 Aperture (ordinal) int16 0 n
minimum (0) to
maximum (n)

Instantaneous trigger instantaneous


.5 void
Lens auto aperture auto aperture

Optical image true=enabled,


.6 boolean
stabilisation false=disabled

Move to specified focal


length in mm, from
.7 Set absolute zoom (mm) int16 0 max
minimum (0) to
maximum (max)

Set absolute zoom Move to specified focal


.8 fixed16 0 1
(normalised) length: 0.0=wide, 1.0=tele

Start/stop zooming at
Set continuous specified rate: -1.0=zoom
.9 fixed16 -1 +1.0
zoom (speed) wider fast, 0.0=stop,
+1=zoom tele fast

Developer Information 379


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

1
[0] = frame rate 24, 25, 30, 50, 60
[1] = M-rate 0=regular, 1=M-rate
0=NTSC, 1=PAL, 2=720,
[2] = dimensions 3=1080, 4=2k, 5=2k DCI,
.0 Video mode int8 6=4k, 7=4k DCI
0=progressive,
[3] = interlaced
1=interlaced
[4] =
0=YUV
colour space
.1 Sensor Gain int8 1 16 1x, 2x, 4x, 8x, 16x gain
int16 color temp 2500 10000 Colour temperature in K
.2 Manual White Balance
int16 tint -50 50 tint
Calculate and set auto
.3 Set auto WB void
white balance
Use latest auto white
.4 Restore auto WB void
balance setting
.5 Exposure (us) int32 1 42000 time in us
Steps through
availableexposure
.6 Exposure (ordinal) int16 0 n
valuesfrom minimum (0)
tomaximum (n)
.7 Dynamic Range Mode int8 enum 0 1 0 = film, 1 = video
Video
.8 Video sharpening level int8 enum 0 3
[0] = file fps as integer

frame rate (eg 24, 25, 30, 50, 60, 120)
fps as integer, valid when
sensor-off-speed set
[1] = sensor (eg 24,25, 30, 33, 48, 50,

frame rate 60, 120), no change will
beperformed if this value
is set to 0
[2] = frame width in pixels
.9 Recording format int16 [3] =
in pixels
frame height
[0]=file-M-rate
[1]=sensor-M-rate,
valid when sensor-
[4] = flags off-speed-set
[2]=sensor-off-speed
[3]=interlaced
[4]=windowed mode
0=Manual Trigger,
1=Iris,
Set auto
.10 int8 0 4 2=Shutter,
exposure mode
3=Iris + Shutter,
4=Shutter + Iris

Developer Information 380


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

2
0.0=minimum,
.0 Mic level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0.0=minimum,
.1 Headphone level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Headphone 0.0=minimum,
.2 fixed16 0 1
program mix 1.0=maximum
0.0=minimum,
.3 Speaker level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Audio
0=internal mic,
1=line level input,
.4 Input type int8 0 2
2=low mic level input,
3=high mic level input
0.0=minimum,
[0] ch0 0 1
1.0=maximum
.5 Input levels fixed16
0.0=minimum,
[1] ch1 0 1
1.0=maximum
true = powered,
.6 Phantom power boolean
false = not powered
3
bit flags: [0] = display
status, [1] = display
frame guides
uint16
.0 Overlay enables Some cameras don't
bit field
allow separate control of
frame guides and
status overlays.
0=off, 1=2.4:1, 2=2.39:1,
Frame guides style [0] = frame
.1 int8 0 8 3=2.35:1, 4=1.85:1, 5=16:9,
(Camera 3.x) guides style
Output 6=14:9, 7=4:3
Frame guides opacity [1] = frame 0.0=transparent,
.2 fixed16 0.1 1
(Camera 3.x) guide opacity 1.0=opaque
0=off, 1=2.4:1, 2=2.39:1,
[0] = frame
3=2.35:1, 4=1.85:1, 5=16:9,
guides style
Overlays 6=14:9, 7=4:3
(replaces .1 and .2 [1] = frame 0=transparent,
.3 int8 0 100
abovefrom guide opacity 100=opaque
Cameras 4.0) percentage of full frame
[2] = safe area
0 100 used by safe area guide
percentage
(0 means off)
4
0.0=minimum,
.0 Brightness fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0x4 = zebra
Display int16
.1 Overlay enables 0x8 = peaking
bit field

0.0=minimum,
.2 Zebra level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum

Developer Information 381


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation
0.0=minimum,
.3 Peaking level fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
0=disable bars,
Color bars display
.4 int8 0 30 1-30=enable bars with
time (seconds)
timeout (s)
[0] = focus 0=Peak,
Display
assist method 1=Colored lines
0=Red,
.5 Focus Assist int8 1=Green,
[1] = focus
2=Blue,
line color
3=White,
4=Black
5
Sets the tally front and
tally rear brightness to the
.0 Tally brightness fixed16 0 1 same level.
0.0=minimum,
1.0=maximum
Sets the tally front
Tally brightness.
.1 Front tally brightness fixed16 0 1
0.0=minimum,
1.0=maximum
Sets the tally rear
brightness.
0.0=minimum,
.2 Rear tally brightness fixed16 0 1
1.0=maximum
Tally rear brightness
cannot be turned off
6
0=internal,
Reference .0 Source int8 enum 0 2 1=program,
2=external
.1 Offset int32 +/- offset in pixels

7
[0] time _ _ BCD - HHMMSSFF (UCT)
.0 Real Time Clock int32
[1] date _ _ BCD - YYYYMMDD
ISO-639-1 two character
.1 System language string _ _ _
language code
.2 Timezone int32 _ _ _ Minutes offset from UTC
BCD -
Confi- s0DDdddddddddddd
guration where s is the sign:
[0] latitude _ _
0=north (+), 1=south (-); DD
degrees, dddddddddddd
decimal degrees
.3 Location int64
BCD -
sDDDdddddddddddd
where s is the sign:
[1] longitude _ _
0=west (-), 1=east (+); DDD
degrees, dddddddddddd
decimal degrees

Developer Information 382


Group ID Parameter Type Index Minimum Maximum Interpretation

8
[0] red -2 2 default 0.0
[1] green -2 2 default 0.0
.0 Lift Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -2 2 default 0.0
[3] luma -2 2 default 0.0
[0] red -4 4 default 0.0
[1] green -4 4 default 0.0
.1 Gamma Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -4 4 default 0.0
[3] luma -4 4 default 0.0
[0] red 0 16 default 1.0
[1] green 0 16 default 1.0
.2 Gain Adjust fixed16
Colour [2] blue 0 16 default 1.0
Correction [3] luma 0 16 default 1.0
[0] red -8 8 default 0.0
[1] green -8 8 default 0.0
.3 Offset Adjust fixed16
[2] blue -8 8 default 0.0
[3] luma -8 8 default 0.0
[0] pivot 0 1 default 0.5
.4 Contrast Adjust fixed16
[1] adj 0 2 default 1.0

.5 Luma mix fixed16 0 1 default 1.0

[0] hue -1 1 default 0.0


.6 Colour Adjust fixed16
[1] sat 0 2 default 1.0
Correction
.7 void reset to defaults
Reset Default
10
[0] = 0 = RAW, 1 = DNxHD,

basic codec 2 = ProRes
RAW: 0=Uncompressed,
int8
.0 Codec 1=lossy 3:1, 2=lossy 4:1
enum [1] =
codec variant ProRes: 0=HQ, 1=422,
2=LT, 3=Proxy,
4=444, 5=444XQ
0=Preview,
[0] = mode
1=Play, 2=Record
Media
-ve = multiple speeds
backwards, 0 = pause,
[1] = speed
+ve = multiple
speeds forwards
.1 Transport mode int8 1<<0=loop, 1<<1=play all,
1<<5=disk1 active,
[2] = flags 1<<6=disk2 active,
1<<7=time-
lapse recording
[3] = active
0=CFast card, 1=SD
storage medium

Developer Information 383


Example Protocol Packets

Packet
Operation Length Byte

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15

header command data


destination

parameter
command

operation
reserved

category
length

type
trigger instantaneous
8 4 4 0 0 0 1 0 0
auto focus on camera 4

turn on OIS on all cameras 12 255 5 0 0 0 6 0 0 1 0 0 0

set exposure to 10 ms on
camera 4 (10 ms = 10000 12 4 8 0 0 1 5 3 0 0x10 0x27 0x00 0x00
us = 0x00002710)

add 15% to zebra level


12 4 6 0 0 4 2 128 1 0x33 0x01 0 0
(15 % = 0.15 f = 0x0133 fp)

select 1080p 23.98 mode on


16 255 9 0 0 1 0 1 0 24 1 3 0 0 0 0 0
all cameras

subtract 0.3 from gamma


adjust for green & blue 16 4 12 0 0 8 1 128 1 0 0 0x9a 0xfd 0x9a 0xfd 0 0
(-0.3 ~= 0xfd9a fp)

all operations combined 76 4 4 0 0 0 1 0 0 255 5 0 0 0 6 0 0

1 0 0 0 4 8 0 0 1 5 3 0 0x10 0x27 0x00 0x00

4 6 0 0 4 2 128 1 0x33 0x01 0 0 255 9 0 0

1 0 1 0 24 1 3 0 0 0 0 0 4 12 0 0

8 1 128 1 0 0 0x9a 0xfd 0x9a 0xfd 0 0

Developer Information 384


Blackmagic Embedded TallyControl Protocol
Version 1.0 (30/04/14)
This section is for third party developers or anybody who may wish to add support for the Blackmagic
Embedded Tally Control Protocol to their products or system. It describes the protocol for sending
tally information embedded in the non-active picture region of a digital video stream.

Data Flow
A master device such as a broadcast switcher embeds tally information into its program feed which is
broadcast to a number of slave devices such as cameras or camera controllers. The output from the
slave devices is typically fed back to the master device, but may also be sent to a video monitor.
The primary flow of tally information is from the master device to the slaves. Each slave device may
use its device id to extract and display the relevant tally information.
Slave devices pass through the tally packet on their output and update the monitor tally status, so that
monitor devices connected to that individual output may display tally status without knowledge of the
device id they are monitoring.

Assumptions
Any data alignment / padding is explicit in the protocol. Bit fields are packed from LSB first.

Blanking Encoding
One tally control packet may be sent per video frame. Packets are encoded as a SMPTE 291M packet
with DID/SDID x51/x52 in the active region of VANC line 15. A tally control packet may contain up to
256 bytes of tally information.

Packet Format
Each tally status consists of 4 bits of information:
uint4
bit 0: program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0x0)
The first byte of the tally packet contains the monitor device tally status and a version number.
Subsequent bytes of the tally packet contain tally status for pairs of slave devices. The master device
sends tally status for the number of devices configured/supported, up to a maximum of 510.

struct tally
uint8
bit 0: monitor device program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: monitor device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4-7: protocol version (0b0000)

Developer Information 385


uint8[0]
bit 0: slave device 1 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: slave device 1 device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4: slave device 2 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 5: slave device 2 preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 6-7: reserved (0b00)
uint8[1]
bit 0: slave device 3 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 1: slave device 3 device preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 2-3: reserved (0b00)
bit 4: slave device 4 program tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 5: slave device 4 preview tally status (0=off, 1=on)
bit 6-7: reserved (0b00)
...

Slave Device
(1)

Master Device Slave Device


(2)

Slave Device
Monitor Device
(3)

Byte 7 MSB 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LSB

Version Version Version Version Reserved Reserved Monitor Monitor


0
(0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

Reserved Reserved Slave 1 Slave 1 Reserved Reserved Slave 0 Slave 0


1
(0b0) (0b0) Preview Program (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

Reserved Reserved Slave 3 Slave 3 Reserved Reserved Slave 2 Slave 2


2
(0b0) (0b0) Preview Program (0b0) (0b0) Preview Program

3 ...

Developer Information 386





BlackmagicDesign .

Blackmagic Design
,
Blackmagic Design
www.blackmagicdesign.com/ru/support.

Blackmagic Design
,
"Send us an email" .
Blackmagic Design,
-.


Blackmagic Camera Setup, ,
About Blackmagic Camera Setup.
Mac OS X Blackmagic Camera Setup
. About Blackmagic Camera Setup,
.
Windows Blackmagic Camera Setup
. About Blackmagic Camera Setup,
.

Blackmagic Teranex, Blackmagic
www.blackmagicdesign.com/ru/support, .
,
.


Studio Camera . ,
Blackmagic Design.
,
. ,
Blackmagic Design.

. Blackmagic Studio Camera 2 Studio Camera 4K 2


.

387

12
Blackmagic Design
12 .
, Blackmagic Design
.
, Blackmagic
Design
.
Blackmagic Design .
, ,
.
, , -
, . Blackmagic
Design : ) ,
, ,
Blackmagic Design; ) ,
;
) ,
; )
,
.
BLACKMAGIC DESIGN
. BLACKMAGIC DESIGN
-
. BLACKMAGIC DESIGN
,
, ,
, ,
BLACKMAGIC DESIGN ( )
. BLACKMAGIC DESIGN
. BLACKMAGIC DESIGN
, .
, , .
Copyright 2017 Blackmagic Design. . Blackmagic Design, DeckLink, HDLink, Workgroup Videohub,
Multibridge Pro, Multibridge Extreme, Intensity "Leading the creative video revolution"
.
.

388

Anda mungkin juga menyukai